1 //===--- SemaDecl.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Declarations ----------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file implements semantic analysis for declarations. 10 // 11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12 13 #include "TypeLocBuilder.h" 14 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/CommentDiagnostic.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/NonTrivialTypeVisitor.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/Randstruct.h" 28 #include "clang/AST/StmtCXX.h" 29 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h" 30 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 31 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 32 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 33 #include "clang/Lex/HeaderSearch.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 34 #include "clang/Lex/Lexer.h" // TODO: Extract static functions to fix layering. 35 #include "clang/Lex/ModuleLoader.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 36 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" // Included for isCodeCompletionEnabled() 37 #include "clang/Sema/CXXFieldCollector.h" 38 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" 39 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" 40 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 41 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 42 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" 43 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h" 44 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" 45 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 46 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 47 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 48 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h" 49 #include <algorithm> 50 #include <cstring> 51 #include <functional> 52 #include <unordered_map> 53 54 using namespace clang; 55 using namespace sema; 56 57 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::ConvertDeclToDeclGroup(Decl *Ptr, Decl *OwnedType) { 58 if (OwnedType) { 59 Decl *Group[2] = { OwnedType, Ptr }; 60 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group, 2)); 61 } 62 63 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef(Ptr)); 64 } 65 66 namespace { 67 68 class TypeNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 69 public: 70 TypeNameValidatorCCC(bool AllowInvalid, bool WantClass = false, 71 bool AllowTemplates = false, 72 bool AllowNonTemplates = true) 73 : AllowInvalidDecl(AllowInvalid), WantClassName(WantClass), 74 AllowTemplates(AllowTemplates), AllowNonTemplates(AllowNonTemplates) { 75 WantExpressionKeywords = false; 76 WantCXXNamedCasts = false; 77 WantRemainingKeywords = false; 78 } 79 80 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 81 if (NamedDecl *ND = candidate.getCorrectionDecl()) { 82 if (!AllowInvalidDecl && ND->isInvalidDecl()) 83 return false; 84 85 if (getAsTypeTemplateDecl(ND)) 86 return AllowTemplates; 87 88 bool IsType = isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND); 89 if (!IsType) 90 return false; 91 92 if (AllowNonTemplates) 93 return true; 94 95 // An injected-class-name of a class template (specialization) is valid 96 // as a template or as a non-template. 97 if (AllowTemplates) { 98 auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ND); 99 if (!RD || !RD->isInjectedClassName()) 100 return false; 101 RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getDeclContext()); 102 return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() || 103 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD); 104 } 105 106 return false; 107 } 108 109 return !WantClassName && candidate.isKeyword(); 110 } 111 112 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 113 return std::make_unique<TypeNameValidatorCCC>(*this); 114 } 115 116 private: 117 bool AllowInvalidDecl; 118 bool WantClassName; 119 bool AllowTemplates; 120 bool AllowNonTemplates; 121 }; 122 123 } // end anonymous namespace 124 125 /// Determine whether the token kind starts a simple-type-specifier. 126 bool Sema::isSimpleTypeSpecifier(tok::TokenKind Kind) const { 127 switch (Kind) { 128 // FIXME: Take into account the current language when deciding whether a 129 // token kind is a valid type specifier 130 case tok::kw_short: 131 case tok::kw_long: 132 case tok::kw___int64: 133 case tok::kw___int128: 134 case tok::kw_signed: 135 case tok::kw_unsigned: 136 case tok::kw_void: 137 case tok::kw_char: 138 case tok::kw_int: 139 case tok::kw_half: 140 case tok::kw_float: 141 case tok::kw_double: 142 case tok::kw___bf16: 143 case tok::kw__Float16: 144 case tok::kw___float128: 145 case tok::kw___ibm128: 146 case tok::kw_wchar_t: 147 case tok::kw_bool: 148 case tok::kw___underlying_type: 149 case tok::kw___auto_type: 150 return true; 151 152 case tok::annot_typename: 153 case tok::kw_char16_t: 154 case tok::kw_char32_t: 155 case tok::kw_typeof: 156 case tok::annot_decltype: 157 case tok::kw_decltype: 158 return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 159 160 case tok::kw_char8_t: 161 return getLangOpts().Char8; 162 163 default: 164 break; 165 } 166 167 return false; 168 } 169 170 namespace { 171 enum class UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult { 172 NotFound, 173 FoundNonType, 174 FoundType 175 }; 176 } // end anonymous namespace 177 178 /// Tries to perform unqualified lookup of the type decls in bases for 179 /// dependent class. 180 /// \return \a NotFound if no any decls is found, \a FoundNotType if found not a 181 /// type decl, \a FoundType if only type decls are found. 182 static UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult 183 lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(Sema &S, const IdentifierInfo &II, 184 SourceLocation NameLoc, 185 const CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 186 if (!RD->hasDefinition()) 187 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 188 // Look for type decls in base classes. 189 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 190 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 191 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) { 192 const CXXRecordDecl *BaseRD = nullptr; 193 if (auto *BaseTT = Base.getType()->getAs<TagType>()) 194 BaseRD = BaseTT->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 195 else if (auto *TST = Base.getType()->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 196 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 197 // templates. 198 if (!TST || !TST->isDependentType()) 199 continue; 200 auto *TD = TST->getTemplateName().getAsTemplateDecl(); 201 if (!TD) 202 continue; 203 if (auto *BasePrimaryTemplate = 204 dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl())) { 205 if (BasePrimaryTemplate->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl()) 206 BaseRD = BasePrimaryTemplate; 207 else if (auto *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) { 208 if (const ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *PS = 209 CTD->findPartialSpecialization(Base.getType())) 210 if (PS->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl()) 211 BaseRD = PS; 212 } 213 } 214 } 215 if (BaseRD) { 216 for (NamedDecl *ND : BaseRD->lookup(&II)) { 217 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(ND)) 218 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 219 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 220 } 221 if (FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound) { 222 switch (lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, BaseRD)) { 223 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType: 224 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 225 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType: 226 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 227 break; 228 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound: 229 break; 230 } 231 } 232 } 233 } 234 235 return FoundTypeDecl; 236 } 237 238 static ParsedType recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(Sema &S, 239 const IdentifierInfo &II, 240 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 241 // Lookup in the parent class template context, if any. 242 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr; 243 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 244 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 245 for (DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext; 246 DC && FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 247 DC = DC->getParent()) { 248 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 249 // templates. 250 RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 251 if (RD && RD->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 252 FoundTypeDecl = lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, RD); 253 } 254 if (FoundTypeDecl != UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType) 255 return nullptr; 256 257 // We found some types in dependent base classes. Recover as if the user 258 // wrote 'typename MyClass::II' instead of 'II'. We'll fully resolve the 259 // lookup during template instantiation. 260 S.Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_found_in_dependent_base) << &II; 261 262 ASTContext &Context = S.Context; 263 auto *NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, false, 264 cast<Type>(Context.getRecordType(RD))); 265 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_Typename, NNS, &II); 266 267 CXXScopeSpec SS; 268 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 269 270 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 271 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 272 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 273 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 274 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 275 return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 276 } 277 278 /// If the identifier refers to a type name within this scope, 279 /// return the declaration of that type. 280 /// 281 /// This routine performs ordinary name lookup of the identifier II 282 /// within the given scope, with optional C++ scope specifier SS, to 283 /// determine whether the name refers to a type. If so, returns an 284 /// opaque pointer (actually a QualType) corresponding to that 285 /// type. Otherwise, returns NULL. 286 ParsedType Sema::getTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc, 287 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS, 288 bool isClassName, bool HasTrailingDot, 289 ParsedType ObjectTypePtr, 290 bool IsCtorOrDtorName, 291 bool WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo, 292 bool IsClassTemplateDeductionContext, 293 IdentifierInfo **CorrectedII) { 294 // FIXME: Consider allowing this outside C++1z mode as an extension. 295 bool AllowDeducedTemplate = IsClassTemplateDeductionContext && 296 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !IsCtorOrDtorName && 297 !isClassName && !HasTrailingDot; 298 299 // Determine where we will perform name lookup. 300 DeclContext *LookupCtx = nullptr; 301 if (ObjectTypePtr) { 302 QualType ObjectType = ObjectTypePtr.get(); 303 if (ObjectType->isRecordType()) 304 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(ObjectType); 305 } else if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty()) { 306 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(*SS, false); 307 308 if (!LookupCtx) { 309 if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 310 // C++ [temp.res]p3: 311 // A qualified-id that refers to a type and in which the 312 // nested-name-specifier depends on a template-parameter (14.6.2) 313 // shall be prefixed by the keyword typename to indicate that the 314 // qualified-id denotes a type, forming an 315 // elaborated-type-specifier (7.1.5.3). 316 // 317 // We therefore do not perform any name lookup if the result would 318 // refer to a member of an unknown specialization. 319 if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName) 320 return nullptr; 321 322 // We know from the grammar that this name refers to a type, 323 // so build a dependent node to describe the type. 324 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) 325 return ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, II, NameLoc).get(); 326 327 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = SS->getWithLocInContext(Context); 328 QualType T = CheckTypenameType(ETK_None, SourceLocation(), QualifierLoc, 329 II, NameLoc); 330 return ParsedType::make(T); 331 } 332 333 return nullptr; 334 } 335 336 if (!LookupCtx->isDependentContext() && 337 RequireCompleteDeclContext(*SS, LookupCtx)) 338 return nullptr; 339 } 340 341 // FIXME: LookupNestedNameSpecifierName isn't the right kind of 342 // lookup for class-names. 343 LookupNameKind Kind = isClassName ? LookupNestedNameSpecifierName : 344 LookupOrdinaryName; 345 LookupResult Result(*this, &II, NameLoc, Kind); 346 if (LookupCtx) { 347 // Perform "qualified" name lookup into the declaration context we 348 // computed, which is either the type of the base of a member access 349 // expression or the declaration context associated with a prior 350 // nested-name-specifier. 351 LookupQualifiedName(Result, LookupCtx); 352 353 if (ObjectTypePtr && Result.empty()) { 354 // C++ [basic.lookup.classref]p3: 355 // If the unqualified-id is ~type-name, the type-name is looked up 356 // in the context of the entire postfix-expression. If the type T of 357 // the object expression is of a class type C, the type-name is also 358 // looked up in the scope of class C. At least one of the lookups shall 359 // find a name that refers to (possibly cv-qualified) T. 360 LookupName(Result, S); 361 } 362 } else { 363 // Perform unqualified name lookup. 364 LookupName(Result, S); 365 366 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 367 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 368 if (Result.empty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && (!SS || SS->isEmpty())) { 369 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 370 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, II, NameLoc)) 371 return TypeInBase; 372 } 373 } 374 375 NamedDecl *IIDecl = nullptr; 376 UsingShadowDecl *FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; 377 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 378 case LookupResult::NotFound: 379 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 380 if (CorrectedII) { 381 TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/true, isClassName, 382 AllowDeducedTemplate); 383 TypoCorrection Correction = CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Kind, 384 S, SS, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery); 385 IdentifierInfo *NewII = Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 386 TemplateTy Template; 387 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 388 UnqualifiedId TemplateName; 389 TemplateName.setIdentifier(NewII, NameLoc); 390 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = Correction.getCorrectionSpecifier(); 391 CXXScopeSpec NewSS, *NewSSPtr = SS; 392 if (SS && NNS) { 393 NewSS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 394 NewSSPtr = &NewSS; 395 } 396 if (Correction && (NNS || NewII != &II) && 397 // Ignore a correction to a template type as the to-be-corrected 398 // identifier is not a template (typo correction for template names 399 // is handled elsewhere). 400 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewSSPtr && 401 isTemplateName(S, *NewSSPtr, false, TemplateName, nullptr, false, 402 Template, MemberOfUnknownSpecialization))) { 403 ParsedType Ty = getTypeName(*NewII, NameLoc, S, NewSSPtr, 404 isClassName, HasTrailingDot, ObjectTypePtr, 405 IsCtorOrDtorName, 406 WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo, 407 IsClassTemplateDeductionContext); 408 if (Ty) { 409 diagnoseTypo(Correction, 410 PDiag(diag::err_unknown_type_or_class_name_suggest) 411 << Result.getLookupName() << isClassName); 412 if (SS && NNS) 413 SS->MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 414 *CorrectedII = NewII; 415 return Ty; 416 } 417 } 418 } 419 // If typo correction failed or was not performed, fall through 420 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 421 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 422 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 423 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 424 return nullptr; 425 426 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 427 // Recover from type-hiding ambiguities by hiding the type. We'll 428 // do the lookup again when looking for an object, and we can 429 // diagnose the error then. If we don't do this, then the error 430 // about hiding the type will be immediately followed by an error 431 // that only makes sense if the identifier was treated like a type. 432 if (Result.getAmbiguityKind() == LookupResult::AmbiguousTagHiding) { 433 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 434 return nullptr; 435 } 436 437 // Look to see if we have a type anywhere in the list of results. 438 for (LookupResult::iterator Res = Result.begin(), ResEnd = Result.end(); 439 Res != ResEnd; ++Res) { 440 NamedDecl *RealRes = (*Res)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 441 if (isa<TypeDecl, ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>( 442 RealRes) || 443 (AllowDeducedTemplate && getAsTypeTemplateDecl(RealRes))) { 444 if (!IIDecl || 445 // Make the selection of the recovery decl deterministic. 446 RealRes->getLocation() < IIDecl->getLocation()) { 447 IIDecl = RealRes; 448 FoundUsingShadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Res); 449 } 450 } 451 } 452 453 if (!IIDecl) { 454 // None of the entities we found is a type, so there is no way 455 // to even assume that the result is a type. In this case, don't 456 // complain about the ambiguity. The parser will either try to 457 // perform this lookup again (e.g., as an object name), which 458 // will produce the ambiguity, or will complain that it expected 459 // a type name. 460 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 461 return nullptr; 462 } 463 464 // We found a type within the ambiguous lookup; diagnose the 465 // ambiguity and then return that type. This might be the right 466 // answer, or it might not be, but it suppresses any attempt to 467 // perform the name lookup again. 468 break; 469 470 case LookupResult::Found: 471 IIDecl = Result.getFoundDecl(); 472 FoundUsingShadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Result.begin()); 473 break; 474 } 475 476 assert(IIDecl && "Didn't find decl"); 477 478 QualType T; 479 if (TypeDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(IIDecl)) { 480 // C++ [class.qual]p2: A lookup that would find the injected-class-name 481 // instead names the constructors of the class, except when naming a class. 482 // This is ill-formed when we're not actually forming a ctor or dtor name. 483 auto *LookupRD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(LookupCtx); 484 auto *FoundRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TD); 485 if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName && LookupRD && FoundRD && 486 FoundRD->isInjectedClassName() && 487 declaresSameEntity(LookupRD, cast<Decl>(FoundRD->getParent()))) 488 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_out_of_line_qualified_id_type_names_constructor) 489 << &II << /*Type*/1; 490 491 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IIDecl, NameLoc); 492 493 T = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD); 494 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(TD->getLocation(), TD, /*OdrUse=*/false); 495 } else if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IIDecl)) { 496 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IDecl, NameLoc); 497 if (!HasTrailingDot) 498 T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(IDecl); 499 FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; // FIXME: Target must be a TypeDecl. 500 } else if (auto *UD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) { 501 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(UD, NameLoc); 502 // Recover with 'int' 503 T = Context.IntTy; 504 FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; 505 } else if (AllowDeducedTemplate) { 506 if (auto *TD = getAsTypeTemplateDecl(IIDecl)) { 507 assert(!FoundUsingShadow || FoundUsingShadow->getTargetDecl() == TD); 508 TemplateName Template = 509 FoundUsingShadow ? TemplateName(FoundUsingShadow) : TemplateName(TD); 510 T = Context.getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(Template, QualType(), 511 false); 512 // Don't wrap in a further UsingType. 513 FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; 514 } 515 } 516 517 if (T.isNull()) { 518 // If it's not plausibly a type, suppress diagnostics. 519 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 520 return nullptr; 521 } 522 523 if (FoundUsingShadow) 524 T = Context.getUsingType(FoundUsingShadow, T); 525 526 // NOTE: avoid constructing an ElaboratedType(Loc) if this is a 527 // constructor or destructor name (in such a case, the scope specifier 528 // will be attached to the enclosing Expr or Decl node). 529 if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty() && !IsCtorOrDtorName && 530 !isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) { 531 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) { 532 // Construct a type with type-source information. 533 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 534 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 535 536 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 537 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 538 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 539 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)); 540 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 541 } else { 542 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 543 } 544 } 545 546 return ParsedType::make(T); 547 } 548 549 // Builds a fake NNS for the given decl context. 550 static NestedNameSpecifier * 551 synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(ASTContext &Context, DeclContext *DC) { 552 for (;; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 553 DC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 554 auto *ND = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 555 if (ND && !ND->isInline() && !ND->isAnonymousNamespace()) 556 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, ND); 557 else if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) 558 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(), 559 RD->getTypeForDecl()); 560 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 561 return NestedNameSpecifier::GlobalSpecifier(Context); 562 } 563 llvm_unreachable("something isn't in TU scope?"); 564 } 565 566 /// Find the parent class with dependent bases of the innermost enclosing method 567 /// context. Do not look for enclosing CXXRecordDecls directly, or we will end 568 /// up allowing unqualified dependent type names at class-level, which MSVC 569 /// correctly rejects. 570 static const CXXRecordDecl * 571 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(const DeclContext *DC) { 572 for (; DC && DC->isDependentContext(); DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 573 DC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 574 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) 575 if (MD->getParent()->hasAnyDependentBases()) 576 return MD->getParent(); 577 } 578 return nullptr; 579 } 580 581 ParsedType Sema::ActOnMSVCUnknownTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, 582 SourceLocation NameLoc, 583 bool IsTemplateTypeArg) { 584 assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && "shouldn't be called in non-MSVC mode"); 585 586 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = nullptr; 587 if (IsTemplateTypeArg && getCurScope()->isTemplateParamScope()) { 588 // If we weren't able to parse a default template argument, delay lookup 589 // until instantiation time by making a non-dependent DependentTypeName. We 590 // pretend we saw a NestedNameSpecifier referring to the current scope, and 591 // lookup is retried. 592 // FIXME: This hurts our diagnostic quality, since we get errors like "no 593 // type named 'Foo' in 'current_namespace'" when the user didn't write any 594 // name specifiers. 595 NNS = synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(Context, CurContext); 596 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_ms_delayed_template_argument) << &II; 597 } else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = 598 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(CurContext)) { 599 // Build a DependentNameType that will perform lookup into RD at 600 // instantiation time. 601 NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(), 602 RD->getTypeForDecl()); 603 604 // Diagnose that this identifier was undeclared, and retry the lookup during 605 // template instantiation. 606 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base) << &II 607 << RD; 608 } else { 609 // This is not a situation that we should recover from. 610 return ParsedType(); 611 } 612 613 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_None, NNS, &II); 614 615 // Build type location information. We synthesized the qualifier, so we have 616 // to build a fake NestedNameSpecifierLoc. 617 NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder NNSLocBuilder; 618 NNSLocBuilder.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 619 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = NNSLocBuilder.getWithLocInContext(Context); 620 621 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 622 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 623 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 624 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 625 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(QualifierLoc); 626 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 627 } 628 629 /// isTagName() - This method is called *for error recovery purposes only* 630 /// to determine if the specified name is a valid tag name ("struct foo"). If 631 /// so, this returns the TST for the tag corresponding to it (TST_enum, 632 /// TST_union, TST_struct, TST_interface, TST_class). This is used to diagnose 633 /// cases in C where the user forgot to specify the tag. 634 DeclSpec::TST Sema::isTagName(IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 635 // Do a tag name lookup in this scope. 636 LookupResult R(*this, &II, SourceLocation(), LookupTagName); 637 LookupName(R, S, false); 638 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 639 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found) 640 if (const TagDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 641 switch (TD->getTagKind()) { 642 case TTK_Struct: return DeclSpec::TST_struct; 643 case TTK_Interface: return DeclSpec::TST_interface; 644 case TTK_Union: return DeclSpec::TST_union; 645 case TTK_Class: return DeclSpec::TST_class; 646 case TTK_Enum: return DeclSpec::TST_enum; 647 } 648 } 649 650 return DeclSpec::TST_unspecified; 651 } 652 653 /// isMicrosoftMissingTypename - In Microsoft mode, within class scope, 654 /// if a CXXScopeSpec's type is equal to the type of one of the base classes 655 /// then downgrade the missing typename error to a warning. 656 /// This is needed for MSVC compatibility; Example: 657 /// @code 658 /// template<class T> class A { 659 /// public: 660 /// typedef int TYPE; 661 /// }; 662 /// template<class T> class B : public A<T> { 663 /// public: 664 /// A<T>::TYPE a; // no typename required because A<T> is a base class. 665 /// }; 666 /// @endcode 667 bool Sema::isMicrosoftMissingTypename(const CXXScopeSpec *SS, Scope *S) { 668 if (CurContext->isRecord()) { 669 if (SS->getScopeRep()->getKind() == NestedNameSpecifier::Super) 670 return true; 671 672 const Type *Ty = SS->getScopeRep()->getAsType(); 673 674 CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 675 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) 676 if (Ty && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(Ty, 1), Base.getType())) 677 return true; 678 return S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 679 } 680 return CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() || S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 681 } 682 683 void Sema::DiagnoseUnknownTypeName(IdentifierInfo *&II, 684 SourceLocation IILoc, 685 Scope *S, 686 CXXScopeSpec *SS, 687 ParsedType &SuggestedType, 688 bool IsTemplateName) { 689 // Don't report typename errors for editor placeholders. 690 if (II->isEditorPlaceholder()) 691 return; 692 // We don't have anything to suggest (yet). 693 SuggestedType = nullptr; 694 695 // There may have been a typo in the name of the type. Look up typo 696 // results, in case we have something that we can suggest. 697 TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/false, /*WantClass=*/false, 698 /*AllowTemplates=*/IsTemplateName, 699 /*AllowNonTemplates=*/!IsTemplateName); 700 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = 701 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(II, IILoc), LookupOrdinaryName, S, SS, 702 CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 703 // FIXME: Support error recovery for the template-name case. 704 bool CanRecover = !IsTemplateName; 705 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) { 706 // We corrected to a keyword. 707 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 708 PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest 709 : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) 710 << II); 711 II = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 712 } else { 713 // We found a similarly-named type or interface; suggest that. 714 if (!SS || !SS->isSet()) { 715 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 716 PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest 717 : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) 718 << II, CanRecover); 719 } else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) { 720 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 721 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 722 II->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 723 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 724 PDiag(IsTemplateName 725 ? diag::err_no_member_template_suggest 726 : diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest) 727 << II << DC << DroppedSpecifier << SS->getRange(), 728 CanRecover); 729 } else { 730 llvm_unreachable("could not have corrected a typo here"); 731 } 732 733 if (!CanRecover) 734 return; 735 736 CXXScopeSpec tmpSS; 737 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) 738 tmpSS.MakeTrivial(Context, Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier(), 739 SourceRange(IILoc)); 740 // FIXME: Support class template argument deduction here. 741 SuggestedType = 742 getTypeName(*Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), IILoc, S, 743 tmpSS.isSet() ? &tmpSS : SS, false, false, nullptr, 744 /*IsCtorOrDtorName=*/false, 745 /*WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo=*/true); 746 } 747 return; 748 } 749 750 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !IsTemplateName) { 751 // See if II is a class template that the user forgot to pass arguments to. 752 UnqualifiedId Name; 753 Name.setIdentifier(II, IILoc); 754 CXXScopeSpec EmptySS; 755 TemplateTy TemplateResult; 756 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 757 if (isTemplateName(S, SS ? *SS : EmptySS, /*hasTemplateKeyword=*/false, 758 Name, nullptr, true, TemplateResult, 759 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization) == TNK_Type_template) { 760 diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateResult.get(), IILoc); 761 return; 762 } 763 } 764 765 // FIXME: Should we move the logic that tries to recover from a missing tag 766 // (struct, union, enum) from Parser::ParseImplicitInt here, instead? 767 768 if (!SS || (!SS->isSet() && !SS->isInvalid())) 769 Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template 770 : diag::err_unknown_typename) 771 << II; 772 else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) 773 Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_member_template 774 : diag::err_typename_nested_not_found) 775 << II << DC << SS->getRange(); 776 else if (SS->isValid() && SS->getScopeRep()->containsErrors()) { 777 SuggestedType = 778 ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, *II, IILoc).get(); 779 } else if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 780 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing; 781 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isMicrosoftMissingTypename(SS, S)) 782 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing; 783 784 Diag(SS->getRange().getBegin(), DiagID) 785 << SS->getScopeRep() << II->getName() 786 << SourceRange(SS->getRange().getBegin(), IILoc) 787 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SS->getRange().getBegin(), "typename "); 788 SuggestedType = ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), 789 *SS, *II, IILoc).get(); 790 } else { 791 assert(SS && SS->isInvalid() && 792 "Invalid scope specifier has already been diagnosed"); 793 } 794 } 795 796 /// Determine whether the given result set contains either a type name 797 /// or 798 static bool isResultTypeOrTemplate(LookupResult &R, const Token &NextToken) { 799 bool CheckTemplate = R.getSema().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 800 NextToken.is(tok::less); 801 802 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), IEnd = R.end(); I != IEnd; ++I) { 803 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*I) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*I)) 804 return true; 805 806 if (CheckTemplate && isa<TemplateDecl>(*I)) 807 return true; 808 } 809 810 return false; 811 } 812 813 static bool isTagTypeWithMissingTag(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Result, 814 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 815 IdentifierInfo *&Name, 816 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 817 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupTagName); 818 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS); 819 if (TagDecl *Tag = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 820 StringRef FixItTagName; 821 switch (Tag->getTagKind()) { 822 case TTK_Class: 823 FixItTagName = "class "; 824 break; 825 826 case TTK_Enum: 827 FixItTagName = "enum "; 828 break; 829 830 case TTK_Struct: 831 FixItTagName = "struct "; 832 break; 833 834 case TTK_Interface: 835 FixItTagName = "__interface "; 836 break; 837 838 case TTK_Union: 839 FixItTagName = "union "; 840 break; 841 } 842 843 StringRef TagName = FixItTagName.drop_back(); 844 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_use_of_tag_name_without_tag) 845 << Name << TagName << SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 846 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, FixItTagName); 847 848 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Result.begin(), IEnd = Result.end(); 849 I != IEnd; ++I) 850 SemaRef.Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_decl_hiding_tag_type) 851 << Name << TagName; 852 853 // Replace lookup results with just the tag decl. 854 Result.clear(Sema::LookupTagName); 855 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS); 856 return true; 857 } 858 859 return false; 860 } 861 862 Sema::NameClassification Sema::ClassifyName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 863 IdentifierInfo *&Name, 864 SourceLocation NameLoc, 865 const Token &NextToken, 866 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC) { 867 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc); 868 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl(); 869 870 assert(NextToken.isNot(tok::coloncolon) && 871 "parse nested name specifiers before calling ClassifyName"); 872 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && SS.isSet() && 873 isCurrentClassName(*Name, S, &SS)) { 874 // Per [class.qual]p2, this names the constructors of SS, not the 875 // injected-class-name. We don't have a classification for that. 876 // There's not much point caching this result, since the parser 877 // will reject it later. 878 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 879 } 880 881 LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 882 LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS, !CurMethod); 883 884 if (SS.isInvalid()) 885 return NameClassification::Error(); 886 887 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 888 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 889 if (Result.empty() && SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 890 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 891 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, *Name, NameLoc)) 892 return TypeInBase; 893 } 894 895 // Perform lookup for Objective-C instance variables (including automatically 896 // synthesized instance variables), if we're in an Objective-C method. 897 // FIXME: This lookup really, really needs to be folded in to the normal 898 // unqualified lookup mechanism. 899 if (SS.isEmpty() && CurMethod && !isResultTypeOrTemplate(Result, NextToken)) { 900 DeclResult Ivar = LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Name); 901 if (Ivar.isInvalid()) 902 return NameClassification::Error(); 903 if (Ivar.isUsable()) 904 return NameClassification::NonType(cast<NamedDecl>(Ivar.get())); 905 906 // We defer builtin creation until after ivar lookup inside ObjC methods. 907 if (Result.empty()) 908 LookupBuiltin(Result); 909 } 910 911 bool SecondTry = false; 912 bool IsFilteredTemplateName = false; 913 914 Corrected: 915 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 916 case LookupResult::NotFound: 917 // If an unqualified-id is followed by a '(', then we have a function 918 // call. 919 if (SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)) { 920 // In C++, this is an ADL-only call. 921 // FIXME: Reference? 922 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 923 return NameClassification::UndeclaredNonType(); 924 925 // C90 6.3.2.2: 926 // If the expression that precedes the parenthesized argument list in a 927 // function call consists solely of an identifier, and if no 928 // declaration is visible for this identifier, the identifier is 929 // implicitly declared exactly as if, in the innermost block containing 930 // the function call, the declaration 931 // 932 // extern int identifier (); 933 // 934 // appeared. 935 // 936 // We also allow this in C99 as an extension. However, this is not 937 // allowed in all language modes as functions without prototypes may not 938 // be supported. 939 if (getLangOpts().implicitFunctionsAllowed()) { 940 if (NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *Name, S)) 941 return NameClassification::NonType(D); 942 } 943 } 944 945 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::less)) { 946 // In C++20 onwards, this could be an ADL-only call to a function 947 // template, and we're required to assume that this is a template name. 948 // 949 // FIXME: Find a way to still do typo correction in this case. 950 TemplateName Template = 951 Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName()); 952 return NameClassification::UndeclaredTemplate(Template); 953 } 954 955 // In C, we first see whether there is a tag type by the same name, in 956 // which case it's likely that the user just forgot to write "enum", 957 // "struct", or "union". 958 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !SecondTry && 959 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 960 break; 961 } 962 963 // Perform typo correction to determine if there is another name that is 964 // close to this name. 965 if (!SecondTry && CCC) { 966 SecondTry = true; 967 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = 968 CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Result.getLookupKind(), S, 969 &SS, *CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 970 unsigned UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest; 971 unsigned QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_suggest; 972 973 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = Corrected.getFoundDecl(); 974 NamedDecl *UnderlyingFirstDecl = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl(); 975 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 976 UnderlyingFirstDecl && isa<TemplateDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl)) { 977 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_template_suggest; 978 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_template_suggest; 979 } else if (UnderlyingFirstDecl && 980 (isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 981 isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 982 isa<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl))) { 983 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest; 984 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest; 985 } 986 987 if (SS.isEmpty()) { 988 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(UnqualifiedDiag) << Name); 989 } else {// FIXME: is this even reachable? Test it. 990 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 991 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 992 Name->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 993 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(QualifiedDiag) 994 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 995 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange()); 996 } 997 998 // Update the name, so that the caller has the new name. 999 Name = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 1000 1001 // Typo correction corrected to a keyword. 1002 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) 1003 return Name; 1004 1005 // Also update the LookupResult... 1006 // FIXME: This should probably go away at some point 1007 Result.clear(); 1008 Result.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection()); 1009 if (FirstDecl) 1010 Result.addDecl(FirstDecl); 1011 1012 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let 1013 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to 1014 // reference the ivar. 1015 // FIXME: This is a gross hack. 1016 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = Result.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) { 1017 DeclResult R = 1018 LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()); 1019 if (R.isInvalid()) 1020 return NameClassification::Error(); 1021 if (R.isUsable()) 1022 return NameClassification::NonType(Ivar); 1023 } 1024 1025 goto Corrected; 1026 } 1027 } 1028 1029 // We failed to correct; just fall through and let the parser deal with it. 1030 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1031 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 1032 1033 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: { 1034 // We performed name lookup into the current instantiation, and there were 1035 // dependent bases, so we treat this result the same way as any other 1036 // dependent nested-name-specifier. 1037 1038 // C++ [temp.res]p2: 1039 // A name used in a template declaration or definition and that is 1040 // dependent on a template-parameter is assumed not to name a type 1041 // unless the applicable name lookup finds a type name or the name is 1042 // qualified by the keyword typename. 1043 // 1044 // FIXME: If the next token is '<', we might want to ask the parser to 1045 // perform some heroics to see if we actually have a 1046 // template-argument-list, which would indicate a missing 'template' 1047 // keyword here. 1048 return NameClassification::DependentNonType(); 1049 } 1050 1051 case LookupResult::Found: 1052 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 1053 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 1054 break; 1055 1056 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 1057 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 1058 hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1059 /*AllowDependent=*/false)) { 1060 // C++ [temp.local]p3: 1061 // A lookup that finds an injected-class-name (10.2) can result in an 1062 // ambiguity in certain cases (for example, if it is found in more than 1063 // one base class). If all of the injected-class-names that are found 1064 // refer to specializations of the same class template, and if the name 1065 // is followed by a template-argument-list, the reference refers to the 1066 // class template itself and not a specialization thereof, and is not 1067 // ambiguous. 1068 // 1069 // This filtering can make an ambiguous result into an unambiguous one, 1070 // so try again after filtering out template names. 1071 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 1072 if (!Result.isAmbiguous()) { 1073 IsFilteredTemplateName = true; 1074 break; 1075 } 1076 } 1077 1078 // Diagnose the ambiguity and return an error. 1079 return NameClassification::Error(); 1080 } 1081 1082 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 1083 (IsFilteredTemplateName || 1084 hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames( 1085 Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1086 /*AllowDependent=*/false, 1087 /*AllowNonTemplateFunctions*/ SS.isEmpty() && 1088 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20))) { 1089 // C++ [temp.names]p3: 1090 // After name lookup (3.4) finds that a name is a template-name or that 1091 // an operator-function-id or a literal- operator-id refers to a set of 1092 // overloaded functions any member of which is a function template if 1093 // this is followed by a <, the < is always taken as the delimiter of a 1094 // template-argument-list and never as the less-than operator. 1095 // C++2a [temp.names]p2: 1096 // A name is also considered to refer to a template if it is an 1097 // unqualified-id followed by a < and name lookup finds either one 1098 // or more functions or finds nothing. 1099 if (!IsFilteredTemplateName) 1100 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 1101 1102 bool IsFunctionTemplate; 1103 bool IsVarTemplate; 1104 TemplateName Template; 1105 if (Result.end() - Result.begin() > 1) { 1106 IsFunctionTemplate = true; 1107 Template = Context.getOverloadedTemplateName(Result.begin(), 1108 Result.end()); 1109 } else if (!Result.empty()) { 1110 auto *TD = cast<TemplateDecl>(getAsTemplateNameDecl( 1111 *Result.begin(), /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1112 /*AllowDependent=*/false)); 1113 IsFunctionTemplate = isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD); 1114 IsVarTemplate = isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD); 1115 1116 UsingShadowDecl *FoundUsingShadow = 1117 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Result.begin()); 1118 assert(!FoundUsingShadow || 1119 TD == cast<TemplateDecl>(FoundUsingShadow->getTargetDecl())); 1120 Template = 1121 FoundUsingShadow ? TemplateName(FoundUsingShadow) : TemplateName(TD); 1122 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) 1123 Template = Context.getQualifiedTemplateName(SS.getScopeRep(), 1124 /*TemplateKeyword=*/false, 1125 Template); 1126 } else { 1127 // All results were non-template functions. This is a function template 1128 // name. 1129 IsFunctionTemplate = true; 1130 Template = Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName()); 1131 } 1132 1133 if (IsFunctionTemplate) { 1134 // Function templates always go through overload resolution, at which 1135 // point we'll perform the various checks (e.g., accessibility) we need 1136 // to based on which function we selected. 1137 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1138 1139 return NameClassification::FunctionTemplate(Template); 1140 } 1141 1142 return IsVarTemplate ? NameClassification::VarTemplate(Template) 1143 : NameClassification::TypeTemplate(Template); 1144 } 1145 1146 auto BuildTypeFor = [&](TypeDecl *Type, NamedDecl *Found) { 1147 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type); 1148 if (const auto *USD = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Found)) 1149 T = Context.getUsingType(USD, T); 1150 1151 if (SS.isEmpty()) // No elaborated type, trivial location info 1152 return ParsedType::make(T); 1153 1154 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 1155 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 1156 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, T); 1157 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 1158 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 1159 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 1160 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 1161 }; 1162 1163 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = (*Result.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl(); 1164 if (TypeDecl *Type = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(FirstDecl)) { 1165 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 1166 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Type->getLocation(), Type, /*OdrUse=*/false); 1167 return BuildTypeFor(Type, *Result.begin()); 1168 } 1169 1170 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(FirstDecl); 1171 if (!Class) { 1172 // FIXME: It's unfortunate that we don't have a Type node for handling this. 1173 if (ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl *Alias = 1174 dyn_cast<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1175 Class = Alias->getClassInterface(); 1176 } 1177 1178 if (Class) { 1179 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Class, NameLoc); 1180 1181 if (NextToken.is(tok::period)) { 1182 // Interface. <something> is parsed as a property reference expression. 1183 // Just return "unknown" as a fall-through for now. 1184 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1185 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 1186 } 1187 1188 QualType T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(Class); 1189 return ParsedType::make(T); 1190 } 1191 1192 if (isa<ConceptDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1193 return NameClassification::Concept( 1194 TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))); 1195 1196 if (auto *EmptyD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(FirstDecl)) { 1197 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(EmptyD, NameLoc); 1198 return NameClassification::Error(); 1199 } 1200 1201 // We can have a type template here if we're classifying a template argument. 1202 if (isa<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && 1203 !isa<VarTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1204 return NameClassification::TypeTemplate( 1205 TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))); 1206 1207 // Check for a tag type hidden by a non-type decl in a few cases where it 1208 // seems likely a type is wanted instead of the non-type that was found. 1209 bool NextIsOp = NextToken.isOneOf(tok::amp, tok::star); 1210 if ((NextToken.is(tok::identifier) || 1211 (NextIsOp && 1212 FirstDecl->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate())) && 1213 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 1214 TypeDecl *Type = Result.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 1215 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 1216 return BuildTypeFor(Type, *Result.begin()); 1217 } 1218 1219 // If we already know which single declaration is referenced, just annotate 1220 // that declaration directly. Defer resolving even non-overloaded class 1221 // member accesses, as we need to defer certain access checks until we know 1222 // the context. 1223 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)); 1224 if (Result.isSingleResult() && !ADL && !FirstDecl->isCXXClassMember()) 1225 return NameClassification::NonType(Result.getRepresentativeDecl()); 1226 1227 // Otherwise, this is an overload set that we will need to resolve later. 1228 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1229 return NameClassification::OverloadSet(UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create( 1230 Context, Result.getNamingClass(), SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 1231 Result.getLookupNameInfo(), ADL, Result.isOverloadedResult(), 1232 Result.begin(), Result.end())); 1233 } 1234 1235 ExprResult 1236 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsUndeclaredNonType(IdentifierInfo *Name, 1237 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 1238 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL-only call in C?"); 1239 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1240 LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1241 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, /*ADL=*/true); 1242 } 1243 1244 ExprResult 1245 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsDependentNonType(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1246 IdentifierInfo *Name, 1247 SourceLocation NameLoc, 1248 bool IsAddressOfOperand) { 1249 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc); 1250 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 1251 NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand, 1252 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 1253 } 1254 1255 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsNonType(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1256 NamedDecl *Found, 1257 SourceLocation NameLoc, 1258 const Token &NextToken) { 1259 if (getCurMethodDecl() && SS.isEmpty()) 1260 if (auto *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl())) 1261 return BuildIvarRefExpr(S, NameLoc, Ivar); 1262 1263 // Reconstruct the lookup result. 1264 LookupResult Result(*this, Found->getDeclName(), NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1265 Result.addDecl(Found); 1266 Result.resolveKind(); 1267 1268 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)); 1269 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, ADL); 1270 } 1271 1272 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsOverloadSet(Scope *S, Expr *E) { 1273 // For an implicit class member access, transform the result into a member 1274 // access expression if necessary. 1275 auto *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E); 1276 if ((*ULE->decls_begin())->isCXXClassMember()) { 1277 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1278 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 1279 1280 // Reconstruct the lookup result. 1281 LookupResult Result(*this, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 1282 LookupOrdinaryName); 1283 Result.setNamingClass(ULE->getNamingClass()); 1284 for (auto I = ULE->decls_begin(), E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 1285 Result.addDecl(*I, I.getAccess()); 1286 Result.resolveKind(); 1287 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, SourceLocation(), Result, 1288 nullptr, S); 1289 } 1290 1291 // Otherwise, this is already in the form we needed, and no further checks 1292 // are necessary. 1293 return ULE; 1294 } 1295 1296 Sema::TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics 1297 Sema::getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TemplateName Name) { 1298 auto *TD = Name.getAsTemplateDecl(); 1299 if (!TD) 1300 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate; 1301 if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1302 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::ClassTemplate; 1303 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1304 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::FunctionTemplate; 1305 if (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1306 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::VarTemplate; 1307 if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1308 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::AliasTemplate; 1309 if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(TD)) 1310 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::TemplateTemplateParam; 1311 if (isa<ConceptDecl>(TD)) 1312 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::Concept; 1313 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate; 1314 } 1315 1316 void Sema::PushDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1317 assert(DC->getLexicalParent() == CurContext && 1318 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1319 CurContext = DC; 1320 S->setEntity(DC); 1321 } 1322 1323 void Sema::PopDeclContext() { 1324 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1325 1326 CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent(); 1327 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1328 } 1329 1330 Sema::SkippedDefinitionContext Sema::ActOnTagStartSkippedDefinition(Scope *S, 1331 Decl *D) { 1332 // Unlike PushDeclContext, the context to which we return is not necessarily 1333 // the containing DC of TD, because the new context will be some pre-existing 1334 // TagDecl definition instead of a fresh one. 1335 auto Result = static_cast<SkippedDefinitionContext>(CurContext); 1336 CurContext = cast<TagDecl>(D)->getDefinition(); 1337 assert(CurContext && "skipping definition of undefined tag"); 1338 // Start lookups from the parent of the current context; we don't want to look 1339 // into the pre-existing complete definition. 1340 S->setEntity(CurContext->getLookupParent()); 1341 return Result; 1342 } 1343 1344 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishSkippedDefinition(SkippedDefinitionContext Context) { 1345 CurContext = static_cast<decltype(CurContext)>(Context); 1346 } 1347 1348 /// EnterDeclaratorContext - Used when we must lookup names in the context 1349 /// of a declarator's nested name specifier. 1350 /// 1351 void Sema::EnterDeclaratorContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1352 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p13: 1353 // A name used in the definition of a static data member of class 1354 // X (after the qualified-id of the static member) is looked up as 1355 // if the name was used in a member function of X. 1356 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p14: 1357 // If a variable member of a namespace is defined outside of the 1358 // scope of its namespace then any name used in the definition of 1359 // the variable member (after the declarator-id) is looked up as 1360 // if the definition of the variable member occurred in its 1361 // namespace. 1362 // Both of these imply that we should push a scope whose context 1363 // is the semantic context of the declaration. We can't use 1364 // PushDeclContext here because that context is not necessarily 1365 // lexically contained in the current context. Fortunately, 1366 // the containing scope should have the appropriate information. 1367 1368 assert(!S->getEntity() && "scope already has entity"); 1369 1370 #ifndef NDEBUG 1371 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1372 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1373 assert(Ancestor->getEntity() == CurContext && "ancestor context mismatch"); 1374 #endif 1375 1376 CurContext = DC; 1377 S->setEntity(DC); 1378 1379 if (S->getParent()->isTemplateParamScope()) { 1380 // Also set the corresponding entities for all immediately-enclosing 1381 // template parameter scopes. 1382 EnterTemplatedContext(S->getParent(), DC); 1383 } 1384 } 1385 1386 void Sema::ExitDeclaratorContext(Scope *S) { 1387 assert(S->getEntity() == CurContext && "Context imbalance!"); 1388 1389 // Switch back to the lexical context. The safety of this is 1390 // enforced by an assert in EnterDeclaratorContext. 1391 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1392 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1393 CurContext = Ancestor->getEntity(); 1394 1395 // We don't need to do anything with the scope, which is going to 1396 // disappear. 1397 } 1398 1399 void Sema::EnterTemplatedContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1400 assert(S->isTemplateParamScope() && 1401 "expected to be initializing a template parameter scope"); 1402 1403 // C++20 [temp.local]p7: 1404 // In the definition of a member of a class template that appears outside 1405 // of the class template definition, the name of a member of the class 1406 // template hides the name of a template-parameter of any enclosing class 1407 // templates (but not a template-parameter of the member if the member is a 1408 // class or function template). 1409 // C++20 [temp.local]p9: 1410 // In the definition of a class template or in the definition of a member 1411 // of such a template that appears outside of the template definition, for 1412 // each non-dependent base class (13.8.2.1), if the name of the base class 1413 // or the name of a member of the base class is the same as the name of a 1414 // template-parameter, the base class name or member name hides the 1415 // template-parameter name (6.4.10). 1416 // 1417 // This means that a template parameter scope should be searched immediately 1418 // after searching the DeclContext for which it is a template parameter 1419 // scope. For example, for 1420 // template<typename T> template<typename U> template<typename V> 1421 // void N::A<T>::B<U>::f(...) 1422 // we search V then B<U> (and base classes) then U then A<T> (and base 1423 // classes) then T then N then ::. 1424 unsigned ScopeDepth = getTemplateDepth(S); 1425 for (; S && S->isTemplateParamScope(); S = S->getParent(), --ScopeDepth) { 1426 DeclContext *SearchDCAfterScope = DC; 1427 for (; DC; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 1428 if (const TemplateParameterList *TPL = 1429 cast<Decl>(DC)->getDescribedTemplateParams()) { 1430 unsigned DCDepth = TPL->getDepth() + 1; 1431 if (DCDepth > ScopeDepth) 1432 continue; 1433 if (ScopeDepth == DCDepth) 1434 SearchDCAfterScope = DC = DC->getLookupParent(); 1435 break; 1436 } 1437 } 1438 S->setLookupEntity(SearchDCAfterScope); 1439 } 1440 } 1441 1442 void Sema::ActOnReenterFunctionContext(Scope* S, Decl *D) { 1443 // We assume that the caller has already called 1444 // ActOnReenterTemplateScope so getTemplatedDecl() works. 1445 FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction(); 1446 if (!FD) 1447 return; 1448 1449 // Same implementation as PushDeclContext, but enters the context 1450 // from the lexical parent, rather than the top-level class. 1451 assert(CurContext == FD->getLexicalParent() && 1452 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1453 CurContext = FD; 1454 S->setEntity(CurContext); 1455 1456 for (unsigned P = 0, NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); P < NumParams; ++P) { 1457 ParmVarDecl *Param = FD->getParamDecl(P); 1458 // If the parameter has an identifier, then add it to the scope 1459 if (Param->getIdentifier()) { 1460 S->AddDecl(Param); 1461 IdResolver.AddDecl(Param); 1462 } 1463 } 1464 } 1465 1466 void Sema::ActOnExitFunctionContext() { 1467 // Same implementation as PopDeclContext, but returns to the lexical parent, 1468 // rather than the top-level class. 1469 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1470 CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent(); 1471 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1472 } 1473 1474 /// Determine whether overloading is allowed for a new function 1475 /// declaration considering prior declarations of the same name. 1476 /// 1477 /// This routine determines whether overloading is possible, not 1478 /// whether a new declaration actually overloads a previous one. 1479 /// It will return true in C++ (where overloads are alway permitted) 1480 /// or, as a C extension, when either the new declaration or a 1481 /// previous one is declared with the 'overloadable' attribute. 1482 static bool AllowOverloadingOfFunction(const LookupResult &Previous, 1483 ASTContext &Context, 1484 const FunctionDecl *New) { 1485 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) 1486 return true; 1487 1488 // Multiversion function declarations are not overloads in the 1489 // usual sense of that term, but lookup will report that an 1490 // overload set was found if more than one multiversion function 1491 // declaration is present for the same name. It is therefore 1492 // inadequate to assume that some prior declaration(s) had 1493 // the overloadable attribute; checking is required. Since one 1494 // declaration is permitted to omit the attribute, it is necessary 1495 // to check at least two; hence the 'any_of' check below. Note that 1496 // the overloadable attribute is implicitly added to declarations 1497 // that were required to have it but did not. 1498 if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) { 1499 return llvm::any_of(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 1500 return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 1501 }); 1502 } else if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found) 1503 return Previous.getFoundDecl()->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 1504 1505 return false; 1506 } 1507 1508 /// Add this decl to the scope shadowed decl chains. 1509 void Sema::PushOnScopeChains(NamedDecl *D, Scope *S, bool AddToContext) { 1510 // Move up the scope chain until we find the nearest enclosing 1511 // non-transparent context. The declaration will be introduced into this 1512 // scope. 1513 while (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) 1514 S = S->getParent(); 1515 1516 // Add scoped declarations into their context, so that they can be 1517 // found later. Declarations without a context won't be inserted 1518 // into any context. 1519 if (AddToContext) 1520 CurContext->addDecl(D); 1521 1522 // Out-of-line definitions shouldn't be pushed into scope in C++, unless they 1523 // are function-local declarations. 1524 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D->isOutOfLine() && !S->getFnParent()) 1525 return; 1526 1527 // Template instantiations should also not be pushed into scope. 1528 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 1529 cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 1530 return; 1531 1532 // If this replaces anything in the current scope, 1533 IdentifierResolver::iterator I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()), 1534 IEnd = IdResolver.end(); 1535 for (; I != IEnd; ++I) { 1536 if (S->isDeclScope(*I) && D->declarationReplaces(*I)) { 1537 S->RemoveDecl(*I); 1538 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(*I); 1539 1540 // Should only need to replace one decl. 1541 break; 1542 } 1543 } 1544 1545 S->AddDecl(D); 1546 1547 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D) && !cast<LabelDecl>(D)->isGnuLocal()) { 1548 // Implicitly-generated labels may end up getting generated in an order that 1549 // isn't strictly lexical, which breaks name lookup. Be careful to insert 1550 // the label at the appropriate place in the identifier chain. 1551 for (I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()); I != IEnd; ++I) { 1552 DeclContext *IDC = (*I)->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 1553 if (IDC == CurContext) { 1554 if (!S->isDeclScope(*I)) 1555 continue; 1556 } else if (IDC->Encloses(CurContext)) 1557 break; 1558 } 1559 1560 IdResolver.InsertDeclAfter(I, D); 1561 } else { 1562 IdResolver.AddDecl(D); 1563 } 1564 warnOnReservedIdentifier(D); 1565 } 1566 1567 bool Sema::isDeclInScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1568 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1569 return IdResolver.isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace); 1570 } 1571 1572 Scope *Sema::getScopeForDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1573 DeclContext *TargetDC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 1574 do { 1575 if (DeclContext *ScopeDC = S->getEntity()) 1576 if (ScopeDC->getPrimaryContext() == TargetDC) 1577 return S; 1578 } while ((S = S->getParent())); 1579 1580 return nullptr; 1581 } 1582 1583 static bool isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *, 1584 DeclContext*, 1585 ASTContext&); 1586 1587 /// Filters out lookup results that don't fall within the given scope 1588 /// as determined by isDeclInScope. 1589 void Sema::FilterLookupForScope(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1590 bool ConsiderLinkage, 1591 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1592 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1593 while (F.hasNext()) { 1594 NamedDecl *D = F.next(); 1595 1596 if (isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace)) 1597 continue; 1598 1599 if (ConsiderLinkage && isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(D, Ctx, Context)) 1600 continue; 1601 1602 F.erase(); 1603 } 1604 1605 F.done(); 1606 } 1607 1608 /// We've determined that \p New is a redeclaration of \p Old. Check that they 1609 /// have compatible owning modules. 1610 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1611 // [module.interface]p7: 1612 // A declaration is attached to a module as follows: 1613 // - If the declaration is a non-dependent friend declaration that nominates a 1614 // function with a declarator-id that is a qualified-id or template-id or that 1615 // nominates a class other than with an elaborated-type-specifier with neither 1616 // a nested-name-specifier nor a simple-template-id, it is attached to the 1617 // module to which the friend is attached ([basic.link]). 1618 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && 1619 Old->getOwningModuleForLinkage() != New->getOwningModuleForLinkage()) { 1620 New->setLocalOwningModule(Old->getOwningModule()); 1621 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(New); 1622 return false; 1623 } 1624 1625 Module *NewM = New->getOwningModule(); 1626 Module *OldM = Old->getOwningModule(); 1627 1628 if (NewM && NewM->isPrivateModule()) 1629 NewM = NewM->Parent; 1630 if (OldM && OldM->isPrivateModule()) 1631 OldM = OldM->Parent; 1632 1633 if (NewM == OldM) 1634 return false; 1635 1636 // Partitions are part of the module, but a partition could import another 1637 // module, so verify that the PMIs agree. 1638 if (NewM && OldM && (NewM->isModulePartition() || OldM->isModulePartition())) 1639 return NewM->getPrimaryModuleInterfaceName() == 1640 OldM->getPrimaryModuleInterfaceName(); 1641 1642 bool NewIsModuleInterface = NewM && NewM->isModulePurview(); 1643 bool OldIsModuleInterface = OldM && OldM->isModulePurview(); 1644 if (NewIsModuleInterface || OldIsModuleInterface) { 1645 // C++ Modules TS [basic.def.odr] 6.2/6.7 [sic]: 1646 // if a declaration of D [...] appears in the purview of a module, all 1647 // other such declarations shall appear in the purview of the same module 1648 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_mismatched_owning_module) 1649 << New 1650 << NewIsModuleInterface 1651 << (NewIsModuleInterface ? NewM->getFullModuleName() : "") 1652 << OldIsModuleInterface 1653 << (OldIsModuleInterface ? OldM->getFullModuleName() : ""); 1654 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1655 New->setInvalidDecl(); 1656 return true; 1657 } 1658 1659 return false; 1660 } 1661 1662 // [module.interface]p6: 1663 // A redeclaration of an entity X is implicitly exported if X was introduced by 1664 // an exported declaration; otherwise it shall not be exported. 1665 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationExported(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1666 // [module.interface]p1: 1667 // An export-declaration shall inhabit a namespace scope. 1668 // 1669 // So it is meaningless to talk about redeclaration which is not at namespace 1670 // scope. 1671 if (!New->getLexicalDeclContext() 1672 ->getNonTransparentContext() 1673 ->isFileContext() || 1674 !Old->getLexicalDeclContext() 1675 ->getNonTransparentContext() 1676 ->isFileContext()) 1677 return false; 1678 1679 bool IsNewExported = New->isInExportDeclContext(); 1680 bool IsOldExported = Old->isInExportDeclContext(); 1681 1682 // It should be irrevelant if both of them are not exported. 1683 if (!IsNewExported && !IsOldExported) 1684 return false; 1685 1686 if (IsOldExported) 1687 return false; 1688 1689 assert(IsNewExported); 1690 1691 auto Lk = Old->getFormalLinkage(); 1692 int S = 0; 1693 if (Lk == Linkage::InternalLinkage) 1694 S = 1; 1695 else if (Lk == Linkage::ModuleLinkage) 1696 S = 2; 1697 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redeclaration_non_exported) << New << S; 1698 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1699 return true; 1700 } 1701 1702 // A wrapper function for checking the semantic restrictions of 1703 // a redeclaration within a module. 1704 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationInModule(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1705 if (CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, Old)) 1706 return true; 1707 1708 if (CheckRedeclarationExported(New, Old)) 1709 return true; 1710 1711 return false; 1712 } 1713 1714 // Check the redefinition in C++20 Modules. 1715 // 1716 // [basic.def.odr]p14: 1717 // For any definable item D with definitions in multiple translation units, 1718 // - if D is a non-inline non-templated function or variable, or 1719 // - if the definitions in different translation units do not satisfy the 1720 // following requirements, 1721 // the program is ill-formed; a diagnostic is required only if the definable 1722 // item is attached to a named module and a prior definition is reachable at 1723 // the point where a later definition occurs. 1724 // - Each such definition shall not be attached to a named module 1725 // ([module.unit]). 1726 // - Each such definition shall consist of the same sequence of tokens, ... 1727 // ... 1728 // 1729 // Return true if the redefinition is not allowed. Return false otherwise. 1730 bool Sema::IsRedefinitionInModule(const NamedDecl *New, 1731 const NamedDecl *Old) const { 1732 assert(getASTContext().isSameEntity(New, Old) && 1733 "New and Old are not the same definition, we should diagnostic it " 1734 "immediately instead of checking it."); 1735 assert(const_cast<Sema *>(this)->isReachable(New) && 1736 const_cast<Sema *>(this)->isReachable(Old) && 1737 "We shouldn't see unreachable definitions here."); 1738 1739 Module *NewM = New->getOwningModule(); 1740 Module *OldM = Old->getOwningModule(); 1741 1742 // We only checks for named modules here. The header like modules is skipped. 1743 // FIXME: This is not right if we import the header like modules in the module 1744 // purview. 1745 // 1746 // For example, assuming "header.h" provides definition for `D`. 1747 // ```C++ 1748 // //--- M.cppm 1749 // export module M; 1750 // import "header.h"; // or #include "header.h" but import it by clang modules 1751 // actually. 1752 // 1753 // //--- Use.cpp 1754 // import M; 1755 // import "header.h"; // or uses clang modules. 1756 // ``` 1757 // 1758 // In this case, `D` has multiple definitions in multiple TU (M.cppm and 1759 // Use.cpp) and `D` is attached to a named module `M`. The compiler should 1760 // reject it. But the current implementation couldn't detect the case since we 1761 // don't record the information about the importee modules. 1762 // 1763 // But this might not be painful in practice. Since the design of C++20 Named 1764 // Modules suggests us to use headers in global module fragment instead of 1765 // module purview. 1766 if (NewM && NewM->isHeaderLikeModule()) 1767 NewM = nullptr; 1768 if (OldM && OldM->isHeaderLikeModule()) 1769 OldM = nullptr; 1770 1771 if (!NewM && !OldM) 1772 return true; 1773 1774 // [basic.def.odr]p14.3 1775 // Each such definition shall not be attached to a named module 1776 // ([module.unit]). 1777 if ((NewM && NewM->isModulePurview()) || (OldM && OldM->isModulePurview())) 1778 return true; 1779 1780 // Then New and Old lives in the same TU if their share one same module unit. 1781 if (NewM) 1782 NewM = NewM->getTopLevelModule(); 1783 if (OldM) 1784 OldM = OldM->getTopLevelModule(); 1785 return OldM == NewM; 1786 } 1787 1788 static bool isUsingDecl(NamedDecl *D) { 1789 return isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) || 1790 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(D) || 1791 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(D); 1792 } 1793 1794 /// Removes using shadow declarations from the lookup results. 1795 static void RemoveUsingDecls(LookupResult &R) { 1796 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1797 while (F.hasNext()) 1798 if (isUsingDecl(F.next())) 1799 F.erase(); 1800 1801 F.done(); 1802 } 1803 1804 /// Check for this common pattern: 1805 /// @code 1806 /// class S { 1807 /// S(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1808 /// void operator=(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1809 /// }; 1810 /// @endcode 1811 static bool IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(const CXXMethodDecl *D) { 1812 // FIXME: Should check for private access too but access is set after we get 1813 // the decl here. 1814 if (D->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody()) 1815 return false; 1816 1817 if (const CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) 1818 return CD->isCopyConstructor(); 1819 return D->isCopyAssignmentOperator(); 1820 } 1821 1822 // We need this to handle 1823 // 1824 // typedef struct { 1825 // void *foo() { return 0; } 1826 // } A; 1827 // 1828 // When we see foo we don't know if after the typedef we will get 'A' or '*A' 1829 // for example. If 'A', foo will have external linkage. If we have '*A', 1830 // foo will have no linkage. Since we can't know until we get to the end 1831 // of the typedef, this function finds out if D might have non-external linkage. 1832 // Callers should verify at the end of the TU if it D has external linkage or 1833 // not. 1834 bool Sema::mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1835 const DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext(); 1836 while (!DC->isTranslationUnit()) { 1837 if (const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(DC)){ 1838 if (!RD->hasNameForLinkage()) 1839 return true; 1840 } 1841 DC = DC->getParent(); 1842 } 1843 1844 return !D->isExternallyVisible(); 1845 } 1846 1847 // FIXME: This needs to be refactored; some other isInMainFile users want 1848 // these semantics. 1849 static bool isMainFileLoc(const Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 1850 if (S.TUKind != TU_Complete) 1851 return false; 1852 return S.SourceMgr.isInMainFile(Loc); 1853 } 1854 1855 bool Sema::ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) const { 1856 assert(D); 1857 1858 if (D->isInvalidDecl() || D->isUsed() || D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1859 return false; 1860 1861 // Ignore all entities declared within templates, and out-of-line definitions 1862 // of members of class templates. 1863 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext() || 1864 D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 1865 return false; 1866 1867 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1868 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1869 return false; 1870 // A non-out-of-line declaration of a member specialization was implicitly 1871 // instantiated; it's the out-of-line declaration that we're interested in. 1872 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 1873 FD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !FD->isOutOfLine()) 1874 return false; 1875 1876 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 1877 if (MD->isVirtual() || IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(MD)) 1878 return false; 1879 } else { 1880 // 'static inline' functions are defined in headers; don't warn. 1881 if (FD->isInlined() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, FD->getLocation())) 1882 return false; 1883 } 1884 1885 if (FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() && 1886 Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(FD)) 1887 return false; 1888 } else if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1889 // Constants and utility variables are defined in headers with internal 1890 // linkage; don't warn. (Unlike functions, there isn't a convenient marker 1891 // like "inline".) 1892 if (!isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation())) 1893 return false; 1894 1895 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(VD)) 1896 return false; 1897 1898 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 1899 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1900 return false; 1901 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 1902 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 1903 VD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !VD->isOutOfLine()) 1904 return false; 1905 1906 if (VD->isInline() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation())) 1907 return false; 1908 } else { 1909 return false; 1910 } 1911 1912 // Only warn for unused decls internal to the translation unit. 1913 // FIXME: This seems like a bogus check; it suppresses -Wunused-function 1914 // for inline functions defined in the main source file, for instance. 1915 return mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(D); 1916 } 1917 1918 void Sema::MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1919 if (!D) 1920 return; 1921 1922 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1923 const FunctionDecl *First = FD->getFirstDecl(); 1924 if (FD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1925 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1926 } 1927 1928 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1929 const VarDecl *First = VD->getFirstDecl(); 1930 if (VD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1931 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1932 } 1933 1934 if (ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(D)) 1935 UnusedFileScopedDecls.push_back(D); 1936 } 1937 1938 static bool ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 1939 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) 1940 return false; 1941 1942 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) { 1943 // For a decomposition declaration, warn if none of the bindings are 1944 // referenced, instead of if the variable itself is referenced (which 1945 // it is, by the bindings' expressions). 1946 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) 1947 if (BD->isReferenced()) 1948 return false; 1949 } else if (!D->getDeclName()) { 1950 return false; 1951 } else if (D->isReferenced() || D->isUsed()) { 1952 return false; 1953 } 1954 1955 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || D->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>()) 1956 return false; 1957 1958 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 1959 return true; 1960 1961 // Except for labels, we only care about unused decls that are local to 1962 // functions. 1963 bool WithinFunction = D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod(); 1964 if (const auto *R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext())) 1965 // For dependent types, the diagnostic is deferred. 1966 WithinFunction = 1967 WithinFunction || (R->isLocalClass() && !R->isDependentType()); 1968 if (!WithinFunction) 1969 return false; 1970 1971 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) 1972 return true; 1973 1974 // White-list anything that isn't a local variable. 1975 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) || isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) || isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(D)) 1976 return false; 1977 1978 // Types of valid local variables should be complete, so this should succeed. 1979 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1980 1981 const Expr *Init = VD->getInit(); 1982 if (const auto *Cleanups = dyn_cast_or_null<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 1983 Init = Cleanups->getSubExpr(); 1984 1985 const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr(); 1986 1987 // Only look at the outermost level of typedef. 1988 if (const TypedefType *TT = Ty->getAs<TypedefType>()) { 1989 // Allow anything marked with __attribute__((unused)). 1990 if (TT->getDecl()->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1991 return false; 1992 } 1993 1994 // Warn for reference variables whose initializtion performs lifetime 1995 // extension. 1996 if (const auto *MTE = dyn_cast_or_null<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(Init)) { 1997 if (MTE->getExtendingDecl()) { 1998 Ty = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType().getTypePtr(); 1999 Init = MTE->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImplicitAsWritten(); 2000 } 2001 } 2002 2003 // If we failed to complete the type for some reason, or if the type is 2004 // dependent, don't diagnose the variable. 2005 if (Ty->isIncompleteType() || Ty->isDependentType()) 2006 return false; 2007 2008 // Look at the element type to ensure that the warning behaviour is 2009 // consistent for both scalars and arrays. 2010 Ty = Ty->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); 2011 2012 if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) { 2013 const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 2014 if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 2015 return false; 2016 2017 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 2018 if (!RD->hasTrivialDestructor() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>()) 2019 return false; 2020 2021 if (Init) { 2022 const CXXConstructExpr *Construct = 2023 dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Init); 2024 if (Construct && !Construct->isElidable()) { 2025 CXXConstructorDecl *CD = Construct->getConstructor(); 2026 if (!CD->isTrivial() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>() && 2027 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue())) 2028 return false; 2029 } 2030 2031 // Suppress the warning if we don't know how this is constructed, and 2032 // it could possibly be non-trivial constructor. 2033 if (Init->isTypeDependent()) { 2034 for (const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor : RD->ctors()) 2035 if (!Ctor->isTrivial()) 2036 return false; 2037 } 2038 2039 // Suppress the warning if the constructor is unresolved because 2040 // its arguments are dependent. 2041 if (isa<CXXUnresolvedConstructExpr>(Init)) 2042 return false; 2043 } 2044 } 2045 } 2046 2047 // TODO: __attribute__((unused)) templates? 2048 } 2049 2050 return true; 2051 } 2052 2053 static void GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D, ASTContext &Ctx, 2054 FixItHint &Hint) { 2055 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) { 2056 SourceLocation AfterColon = Lexer::findLocationAfterToken( 2057 D->getEndLoc(), tok::colon, Ctx.getSourceManager(), Ctx.getLangOpts(), 2058 true); 2059 if (AfterColon.isInvalid()) 2060 return; 2061 Hint = FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 2062 CharSourceRange::getCharRange(D->getBeginLoc(), AfterColon)); 2063 } 2064 } 2065 2066 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(const RecordDecl *D) { 2067 if (D->getTypeForDecl()->isDependentType()) 2068 return; 2069 2070 for (auto *TmpD : D->decls()) { 2071 if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(TmpD)) 2072 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(T); 2073 else if(const auto *R = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(TmpD)) 2074 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(R); 2075 } 2076 } 2077 2078 /// DiagnoseUnusedDecl - Emit warnings about declarations that are not used 2079 /// unless they are marked attr(unused). 2080 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 2081 if (!ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(D)) 2082 return; 2083 2084 if (auto *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 2085 // typedefs can be referenced later on, so the diagnostics are emitted 2086 // at end-of-translation-unit. 2087 UnusedLocalTypedefNameCandidates.insert(TD); 2088 return; 2089 } 2090 2091 FixItHint Hint; 2092 GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(D, Context, Hint); 2093 2094 unsigned DiagID; 2095 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && cast<VarDecl>(D)->isExceptionVariable()) 2096 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_exception_param; 2097 else if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 2098 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_label; 2099 else 2100 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_variable; 2101 2102 Diag(D->getLocation(), DiagID) << D << Hint; 2103 } 2104 2105 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(const VarDecl *VD) { 2106 // If it's not referenced, it can't be set. If it has the Cleanup attribute, 2107 // it's not really unused. 2108 if (!VD->isReferenced() || !VD->getDeclName() || VD->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || 2109 VD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>()) 2110 return; 2111 2112 const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr()->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); 2113 2114 if (Ty->isReferenceType() || Ty->isDependentType()) 2115 return; 2116 2117 if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) { 2118 const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 2119 if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 2120 return; 2121 // In C++, don't warn for record types that don't have WarnUnusedAttr, to 2122 // mimic gcc's behavior. 2123 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 2124 if (!RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>()) 2125 return; 2126 } 2127 } 2128 2129 // Don't warn about __block Objective-C pointer variables, as they might 2130 // be assigned in the block but not used elsewhere for the purpose of lifetime 2131 // extension. 2132 if (VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() && Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 2133 return; 2134 2135 // Don't warn about Objective-C pointer variables with precise lifetime 2136 // semantics; they can be used to ensure ARC releases the object at a known 2137 // time, which may mean assignment but no other references. 2138 if (VD->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>() && Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 2139 return; 2140 2141 auto iter = RefsMinusAssignments.find(VD); 2142 if (iter == RefsMinusAssignments.end()) 2143 return; 2144 2145 assert(iter->getSecond() >= 0 && 2146 "Found a negative number of references to a VarDecl"); 2147 if (iter->getSecond() != 0) 2148 return; 2149 unsigned DiagID = isa<ParmVarDecl>(VD) ? diag::warn_unused_but_set_parameter 2150 : diag::warn_unused_but_set_variable; 2151 Diag(VD->getLocation(), DiagID) << VD; 2152 } 2153 2154 static void CheckPoppedLabel(LabelDecl *L, Sema &S) { 2155 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto 2156 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it. Label fwd 2157 // definitions are indicated with a null substmt which is also not a resolved 2158 // MS inline assembly label name. 2159 bool Diagnose = false; 2160 if (L->isMSAsmLabel()) 2161 Diagnose = !L->isResolvedMSAsmLabel(); 2162 else 2163 Diagnose = L->getStmt() == nullptr; 2164 if (Diagnose) 2165 S.Diag(L->getLocation(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L; 2166 } 2167 2168 void Sema::ActOnPopScope(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *S) { 2169 S->applyNRVO(); 2170 2171 if (S->decl_empty()) return; 2172 assert((S->getFlags() & (Scope::DeclScope | Scope::TemplateParamScope)) && 2173 "Scope shouldn't contain decls!"); 2174 2175 for (auto *TmpD : S->decls()) { 2176 assert(TmpD && "This decl didn't get pushed??"); 2177 2178 assert(isa<NamedDecl>(TmpD) && "Decl isn't NamedDecl?"); 2179 NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(TmpD); 2180 2181 // Diagnose unused variables in this scope. 2182 if (!S->hasUnrecoverableErrorOccurred()) { 2183 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(D); 2184 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(D)) 2185 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(RD); 2186 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 2187 DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(VD); 2188 RefsMinusAssignments.erase(VD); 2189 } 2190 } 2191 2192 if (!D->getDeclName()) continue; 2193 2194 // If this was a forward reference to a label, verify it was defined. 2195 if (LabelDecl *LD = dyn_cast<LabelDecl>(D)) 2196 CheckPoppedLabel(LD, *this); 2197 2198 // Remove this name from our lexical scope, and warn on it if we haven't 2199 // already. 2200 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(D); 2201 auto ShadowI = ShadowingDecls.find(D); 2202 if (ShadowI != ShadowingDecls.end()) { 2203 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowI->second)) { 2204 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_ctor_parm_shadows_field) 2205 << D << FD << FD->getParent(); 2206 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2207 } 2208 ShadowingDecls.erase(ShadowI); 2209 } 2210 } 2211 } 2212 2213 /// Look for an Objective-C class in the translation unit. 2214 /// 2215 /// \param Id The name of the Objective-C class we're looking for. If 2216 /// typo-correction fixes this name, the Id will be updated 2217 /// to the fixed name. 2218 /// 2219 /// \param IdLoc The location of the name in the translation unit. 2220 /// 2221 /// \param DoTypoCorrection If true, this routine will attempt typo correction 2222 /// if there is no class with the given name. 2223 /// 2224 /// \returns The declaration of the named Objective-C class, or NULL if the 2225 /// class could not be found. 2226 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Sema::getObjCInterfaceDecl(IdentifierInfo *&Id, 2227 SourceLocation IdLoc, 2228 bool DoTypoCorrection) { 2229 // The third "scope" argument is 0 since we aren't enabling lazy built-in 2230 // creation from this context. 2231 NamedDecl *IDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 2232 2233 if (!IDecl && DoTypoCorrection) { 2234 // Perform typo correction at the given location, but only if we 2235 // find an Objective-C class name. 2236 DeclFilterCCC<ObjCInterfaceDecl> CCC{}; 2237 if (TypoCorrection C = 2238 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc), LookupOrdinaryName, 2239 TUScope, nullptr, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 2240 diagnoseTypo(C, PDiag(diag::err_undef_interface_suggest) << Id); 2241 IDecl = C.getCorrectionDeclAs<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(); 2242 Id = IDecl->getIdentifier(); 2243 } 2244 } 2245 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IDecl); 2246 // This routine must always return a class definition, if any. 2247 if (Def && Def->getDefinition()) 2248 Def = Def->getDefinition(); 2249 return Def; 2250 } 2251 2252 /// getNonFieldDeclScope - Retrieves the innermost scope, starting 2253 /// from S, where a non-field would be declared. This routine copes 2254 /// with the difference between C and C++ scoping rules in structs and 2255 /// unions. For example, the following code is well-formed in C but 2256 /// ill-formed in C++: 2257 /// @code 2258 /// struct S6 { 2259 /// enum { BAR } e; 2260 /// }; 2261 /// 2262 /// void test_S6() { 2263 /// struct S6 a; 2264 /// a.e = BAR; 2265 /// } 2266 /// @endcode 2267 /// For the declaration of BAR, this routine will return a different 2268 /// scope. The scope S will be the scope of the unnamed enumeration 2269 /// within S6. In C++, this routine will return the scope associated 2270 /// with S6, because the enumeration's scope is a transparent 2271 /// context but structures can contain non-field names. In C, this 2272 /// routine will return the translation unit scope, since the 2273 /// enumeration's scope is a transparent context and structures cannot 2274 /// contain non-field names. 2275 Scope *Sema::getNonFieldDeclScope(Scope *S) { 2276 while (((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 2277 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) || 2278 (S->isClassScope() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)) 2279 S = S->getParent(); 2280 return S; 2281 } 2282 2283 static StringRef getHeaderName(Builtin::Context &BuiltinInfo, unsigned ID, 2284 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error) { 2285 switch (Error) { 2286 case ASTContext::GE_None: 2287 return ""; 2288 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_type: 2289 return BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID); 2290 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio: 2291 return "stdio.h"; 2292 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp: 2293 return "setjmp.h"; 2294 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext: 2295 return "ucontext.h"; 2296 } 2297 llvm_unreachable("unhandled error kind"); 2298 } 2299 2300 FunctionDecl *Sema::CreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, QualType Type, 2301 unsigned ID, SourceLocation Loc) { 2302 DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 2303 2304 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2305 LinkageSpecDecl *CLinkageDecl = LinkageSpecDecl::Create( 2306 Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c, false); 2307 CLinkageDecl->setImplicit(); 2308 Parent->addDecl(CLinkageDecl); 2309 Parent = CLinkageDecl; 2310 } 2311 2312 FunctionDecl *New = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, II, Type, 2313 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_Extern, 2314 getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), 2315 false, Type->isFunctionProtoType()); 2316 New->setImplicit(); 2317 New->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ID)); 2318 2319 // Create Decl objects for each parameter, adding them to the 2320 // FunctionDecl. 2321 if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Type)) { 2322 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params; 2323 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 2324 ParmVarDecl *parm = ParmVarDecl::Create( 2325 Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr, 2326 FT->getParamType(i), /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 2327 parm->setScopeInfo(0, i); 2328 Params.push_back(parm); 2329 } 2330 New->setParams(Params); 2331 } 2332 2333 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(New); 2334 return New; 2335 } 2336 2337 /// LazilyCreateBuiltin - The specified Builtin-ID was first used at 2338 /// file scope. lazily create a decl for it. ForRedeclaration is true 2339 /// if we're creating this built-in in anticipation of redeclaring the 2340 /// built-in. 2341 NamedDecl *Sema::LazilyCreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, unsigned ID, 2342 Scope *S, bool ForRedeclaration, 2343 SourceLocation Loc) { 2344 LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, ID); 2345 2346 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 2347 QualType R = Context.GetBuiltinType(ID, Error); 2348 if (Error) { 2349 if (!ForRedeclaration) 2350 return nullptr; 2351 2352 // If we have a builtin without an associated type we should not emit a 2353 // warning when we were not able to find a type for it. 2354 if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_type || 2355 Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(ID)) 2356 return nullptr; 2357 2358 // If we could not find a type for setjmp it is because the jmp_buf type was 2359 // not defined prior to the setjmp declaration. 2360 if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp) { 2361 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_no_jmp_buf) 2362 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2363 return nullptr; 2364 } 2365 2366 // Generally, we emit a warning that the declaration requires the 2367 // appropriate header. 2368 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_requires_sysheader) 2369 << getHeaderName(Context.BuiltinInfo, ID, Error) 2370 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2371 return nullptr; 2372 } 2373 2374 if (!ForRedeclaration && 2375 (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(ID) || 2376 Context.BuiltinInfo.isHeaderDependentFunction(ID))) { 2377 Diag(Loc, LangOpts.C99 ? diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl_c99 2378 : diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl) 2379 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID) << R; 2380 if (const char *Header = Context.BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID)) 2381 Diag(Loc, diag::note_include_header_or_declare) 2382 << Header << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2383 } 2384 2385 if (R.isNull()) 2386 return nullptr; 2387 2388 FunctionDecl *New = CreateBuiltin(II, R, ID, Loc); 2389 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(New, S); 2390 2391 // TUScope is the translation-unit scope to insert this function into. 2392 // FIXME: This is hideous. We need to teach PushOnScopeChains to 2393 // relate Scopes to DeclContexts, and probably eliminate CurContext 2394 // entirely, but we're not there yet. 2395 DeclContext *SavedContext = CurContext; 2396 CurContext = New->getDeclContext(); 2397 PushOnScopeChains(New, TUScope); 2398 CurContext = SavedContext; 2399 return New; 2400 } 2401 2402 /// Typedef declarations don't have linkage, but they still denote the same 2403 /// entity if their types are the same. 2404 /// FIXME: This is notionally doing the same thing as ASTReaderDecl's 2405 /// isSameEntity. 2406 static void filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(Sema &S, 2407 TypedefNameDecl *Decl, 2408 LookupResult &Previous) { 2409 // This is only interesting when modules are enabled. 2410 if (!S.getLangOpts().Modules && !S.getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) 2411 return; 2412 2413 // Empty sets are uninteresting. 2414 if (Previous.empty()) 2415 return; 2416 2417 LookupResult::Filter Filter = Previous.makeFilter(); 2418 while (Filter.hasNext()) { 2419 NamedDecl *Old = Filter.next(); 2420 2421 // Non-hidden declarations are never ignored. 2422 if (S.isVisible(Old)) 2423 continue; 2424 2425 // Declarations of the same entity are not ignored, even if they have 2426 // different linkages. 2427 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2428 if (S.Context.hasSameType(OldTD->getUnderlyingType(), 2429 Decl->getUnderlyingType())) 2430 continue; 2431 2432 // If both declarations give a tag declaration a typedef name for linkage 2433 // purposes, then they declare the same entity. 2434 if (OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true) && 2435 Decl->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName()) 2436 continue; 2437 } 2438 2439 Filter.erase(); 2440 } 2441 2442 Filter.done(); 2443 } 2444 2445 bool Sema::isIncompatibleTypedef(TypeDecl *Old, TypedefNameDecl *New) { 2446 QualType OldType; 2447 if (TypedefNameDecl *OldTypedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 2448 OldType = OldTypedef->getUnderlyingType(); 2449 else 2450 OldType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Old); 2451 QualType NewType = New->getUnderlyingType(); 2452 2453 if (NewType->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 2454 // Must not redefine a typedef with a variably-modified type. 2455 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 2456 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_variably_modified_typedef) 2457 << Kind << NewType; 2458 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 2459 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2460 New->setInvalidDecl(); 2461 return true; 2462 } 2463 2464 if (OldType != NewType && 2465 !OldType->isDependentType() && 2466 !NewType->isDependentType() && 2467 !Context.hasSameType(OldType, NewType)) { 2468 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 2469 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_typedef) 2470 << Kind << NewType << OldType; 2471 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 2472 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2473 New->setInvalidDecl(); 2474 return true; 2475 } 2476 return false; 2477 } 2478 2479 /// MergeTypedefNameDecl - We just parsed a typedef 'New' which has the 2480 /// same name and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out 2481 /// how to resolve this situation, merging decls or emitting 2482 /// diagnostics as appropriate. If there was an error, set New to be invalid. 2483 /// 2484 void Sema::MergeTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *New, 2485 LookupResult &OldDecls) { 2486 // If the new decl is known invalid already, don't bother doing any 2487 // merging checks. 2488 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) return; 2489 2490 // Allow multiple definitions for ObjC built-in typedefs. 2491 // FIXME: Verify the underlying types are equivalent! 2492 if (getLangOpts().ObjC) { 2493 const IdentifierInfo *TypeID = New->getIdentifier(); 2494 switch (TypeID->getLength()) { 2495 default: break; 2496 case 2: 2497 { 2498 if (!TypeID->isStr("id")) 2499 break; 2500 QualType T = New->getUnderlyingType(); 2501 if (!T->isPointerType()) 2502 break; 2503 if (!T->isVoidPointerType()) { 2504 QualType PT = T->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 2505 if (!PT->isStructureType()) 2506 break; 2507 } 2508 Context.setObjCIdRedefinitionType(T); 2509 // Install the built-in type for 'id', ignoring the current definition. 2510 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCIdType().getTypePtr()); 2511 return; 2512 } 2513 case 5: 2514 if (!TypeID->isStr("Class")) 2515 break; 2516 Context.setObjCClassRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 2517 // Install the built-in type for 'Class', ignoring the current definition. 2518 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCClassType().getTypePtr()); 2519 return; 2520 case 3: 2521 if (!TypeID->isStr("SEL")) 2522 break; 2523 Context.setObjCSelRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 2524 // Install the built-in type for 'SEL', ignoring the current definition. 2525 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCSelType().getTypePtr()); 2526 return; 2527 } 2528 // Fall through - the typedef name was not a builtin type. 2529 } 2530 2531 // Verify the old decl was also a type. 2532 TypeDecl *Old = OldDecls.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 2533 if (!Old) { 2534 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 2535 << New->getDeclName(); 2536 2537 NamedDecl *OldD = OldDecls.getRepresentativeDecl(); 2538 if (OldD->getLocation().isValid()) 2539 notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation()); 2540 2541 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2542 } 2543 2544 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 2545 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 2546 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2547 2548 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2549 auto *OldTag = OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true); 2550 auto *NewTag = New->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(); 2551 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 2552 if (OldTag && NewTag && 2553 OldTag->getCanonicalDecl() != NewTag->getCanonicalDecl() && 2554 !hasVisibleDefinition(OldTag, &Hidden)) { 2555 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. Use it 2556 // instead of our tag. 2557 New->setTypeForDecl(OldTD->getTypeForDecl()); 2558 if (OldTD->isModed()) 2559 New->setModedTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo(), 2560 OldTD->getUnderlyingType()); 2561 else 2562 New->setTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo()); 2563 2564 // Make the old tag definition visible. 2565 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden); 2566 2567 // If this was an unscoped enumeration, yank all of its enumerators 2568 // out of the scope. 2569 if (isa<EnumDecl>(NewTag)) { 2570 Scope *EnumScope = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 2571 for (auto *D : NewTag->decls()) { 2572 auto *ED = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 2573 assert(EnumScope->isDeclScope(ED)); 2574 EnumScope->RemoveDecl(ED); 2575 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(ED); 2576 ED->getLexicalDeclContext()->removeDecl(ED); 2577 } 2578 } 2579 } 2580 } 2581 2582 // If the typedef types are not identical, reject them in all languages and 2583 // with any extensions enabled. 2584 if (isIncompatibleTypedef(Old, New)) 2585 return; 2586 2587 // The types match. Link up the redeclaration chain and merge attributes if 2588 // the old declaration was a typedef. 2589 if (TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2590 New->setPreviousDecl(Typedef); 2591 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 2592 } 2593 2594 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 2595 return; 2596 2597 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2598 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p2: 2599 // In a given non-class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to 2600 // redefine the name of any type declared in that scope to refer 2601 // to the type to which it already refers. 2602 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)) 2603 return; 2604 2605 // C++0x [dcl.typedef]p4: 2606 // In a given class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to redefine 2607 // any class-name declared in that scope that is not also a typedef-name 2608 // to refer to the type to which it already refers. 2609 // 2610 // This wording came in via DR424, which was a correction to the 2611 // wording in DR56, which accidentally banned code like: 2612 // 2613 // struct S { 2614 // typedef struct A { } A; 2615 // }; 2616 // 2617 // in the C++03 standard. We implement the C++0x semantics, which 2618 // allow the above but disallow 2619 // 2620 // struct S { 2621 // typedef int I; 2622 // typedef int I; 2623 // }; 2624 // 2625 // since that was the intent of DR56. 2626 if (!isa<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 2627 return; 2628 2629 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) 2630 << New->getDeclName(); 2631 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2632 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2633 } 2634 2635 // Modules always permit redefinition of typedefs, as does C11. 2636 if (getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().C11) 2637 return; 2638 2639 // If we have a redefinition of a typedef in C, emit a warning. This warning 2640 // is normally mapped to an error, but can be controlled with 2641 // -Wtypedef-redefinition. If either the original or the redefinition is 2642 // in a system header, don't emit this for compatibility with GCC. 2643 if (getDiagnostics().getSuppressSystemWarnings() && 2644 // Some standard types are defined implicitly in Clang (e.g. OpenCL). 2645 (Old->isImplicit() || 2646 Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Old->getLocation()) || 2647 Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(New->getLocation()))) 2648 return; 2649 2650 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_redefinition_of_typedef) 2651 << New->getDeclName(); 2652 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2653 } 2654 2655 /// DeclhasAttr - returns true if decl Declaration already has the target 2656 /// attribute. 2657 static bool DeclHasAttr(const Decl *D, const Attr *A) { 2658 const OwnershipAttr *OA = dyn_cast<OwnershipAttr>(A); 2659 const AnnotateAttr *Ann = dyn_cast<AnnotateAttr>(A); 2660 for (const auto *i : D->attrs()) 2661 if (i->getKind() == A->getKind()) { 2662 if (Ann) { 2663 if (Ann->getAnnotation() == cast<AnnotateAttr>(i)->getAnnotation()) 2664 return true; 2665 continue; 2666 } 2667 // FIXME: Don't hardcode this check 2668 if (OA && isa<OwnershipAttr>(i)) 2669 return OA->getOwnKind() == cast<OwnershipAttr>(i)->getOwnKind(); 2670 return true; 2671 } 2672 2673 return false; 2674 } 2675 2676 static bool isAttributeTargetADefinition(Decl *D) { 2677 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 2678 return VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(); 2679 if (TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2680 return TD->isCompleteDefinition() || TD->isBeingDefined(); 2681 return true; 2682 } 2683 2684 /// Merge alignment attributes from \p Old to \p New, taking into account the 2685 /// special semantics of C11's _Alignas specifier and C++11's alignas attribute. 2686 /// 2687 /// \return \c true if any attributes were added to \p New. 2688 static bool mergeAlignedAttrs(Sema &S, NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old) { 2689 // Look for alignas attributes on Old, and pick out whichever attribute 2690 // specifies the strictest alignment requirement. 2691 AlignedAttr *OldAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2692 AlignedAttr *OldStrictestAlignAttr = nullptr; 2693 unsigned OldAlign = 0; 2694 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2695 // FIXME: We have no way of representing inherited dependent alignments 2696 // in a case like: 2697 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(A) X; 2698 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(B) X {}; 2699 // For now, we just ignore any alignas attributes which are not on the 2700 // definition in such a case. 2701 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2702 return false; 2703 2704 if (I->isAlignas()) 2705 OldAlignasAttr = I; 2706 2707 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2708 if (Align > OldAlign) { 2709 OldAlign = Align; 2710 OldStrictestAlignAttr = I; 2711 } 2712 } 2713 2714 // Look for alignas attributes on New. 2715 AlignedAttr *NewAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2716 unsigned NewAlign = 0; 2717 for (auto *I : New->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2718 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2719 return false; 2720 2721 if (I->isAlignas()) 2722 NewAlignasAttr = I; 2723 2724 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2725 if (Align > NewAlign) 2726 NewAlign = Align; 2727 } 2728 2729 if (OldAlignasAttr && NewAlignasAttr && OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2730 // Both declarations have 'alignas' attributes. We require them to match. 2731 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6 and C11 6.7.5/7 both come close to saying this, but 2732 // fall short. (If two declarations both have alignas, they must both match 2733 // every definition, and so must match each other if there is a definition.) 2734 2735 // If either declaration only contains 'alignas(0)' specifiers, then it 2736 // specifies the natural alignment for the type. 2737 if (OldAlign == 0 || NewAlign == 0) { 2738 QualType Ty; 2739 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(New)) 2740 Ty = VD->getType(); 2741 else 2742 Ty = S.Context.getTagDeclType(cast<TagDecl>(New)); 2743 2744 if (OldAlign == 0) 2745 OldAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2746 if (NewAlign == 0) 2747 NewAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2748 } 2749 2750 if (OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2751 S.Diag(NewAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_mismatch) 2752 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(OldAlign).getQuantity() 2753 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(NewAlign).getQuantity(); 2754 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2755 } 2756 } 2757 2758 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && isAttributeTargetADefinition(New)) { 2759 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2760 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2761 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2762 // equivalent alignment. 2763 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2764 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2765 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2766 // have no alignment specifier. 2767 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2768 << OldAlignasAttr; 2769 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2770 << OldAlignasAttr; 2771 } 2772 2773 bool AnyAdded = false; 2774 2775 // Ensure we have an attribute representing the strictest alignment. 2776 if (OldAlign > NewAlign) { 2777 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldStrictestAlignAttr->clone(S.Context); 2778 Clone->setInherited(true); 2779 New->addAttr(Clone); 2780 AnyAdded = true; 2781 } 2782 2783 // Ensure we have an alignas attribute if the old declaration had one. 2784 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && 2785 !(AnyAdded && OldStrictestAlignAttr->isAlignas())) { 2786 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldAlignasAttr->clone(S.Context); 2787 Clone->setInherited(true); 2788 New->addAttr(Clone); 2789 AnyAdded = true; 2790 } 2791 2792 return AnyAdded; 2793 } 2794 2795 #define WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC 2796 #include "clang/Sema/AttrParsedAttrImpl.inc" 2797 #undef WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC 2798 2799 static bool mergeDeclAttribute(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, 2800 const InheritableAttr *Attr, 2801 Sema::AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) { 2802 // Diagnose any mutual exclusions between the attribute that we want to add 2803 // and attributes that already exist on the declaration. 2804 if (!DiagnoseMutualExclusions(S, D, Attr)) 2805 return false; 2806 2807 // This function copies an attribute Attr from a previous declaration to the 2808 // new declaration D if the new declaration doesn't itself have that attribute 2809 // yet or if that attribute allows duplicates. 2810 // If you're adding a new attribute that requires logic different from 2811 // "use explicit attribute on decl if present, else use attribute from 2812 // previous decl", for example if the attribute needs to be consistent 2813 // between redeclarations, you need to call a custom merge function here. 2814 InheritableAttr *NewAttr = nullptr; 2815 if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AvailabilityAttr>(Attr)) 2816 NewAttr = S.mergeAvailabilityAttr( 2817 D, *AA, AA->getPlatform(), AA->isImplicit(), AA->getIntroduced(), 2818 AA->getDeprecated(), AA->getObsoleted(), AA->getUnavailable(), 2819 AA->getMessage(), AA->getStrict(), AA->getReplacement(), AMK, 2820 AA->getPriority()); 2821 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<VisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2822 NewAttr = S.mergeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility()); 2823 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<TypeVisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2824 NewAttr = S.mergeTypeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility()); 2825 else if (const auto *ImportA = dyn_cast<DLLImportAttr>(Attr)) 2826 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLImportAttr(D, *ImportA); 2827 else if (const auto *ExportA = dyn_cast<DLLExportAttr>(Attr)) 2828 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLExportAttr(D, *ExportA); 2829 else if (const auto *EA = dyn_cast<ErrorAttr>(Attr)) 2830 NewAttr = S.mergeErrorAttr(D, *EA, EA->getUserDiagnostic()); 2831 else if (const auto *FA = dyn_cast<FormatAttr>(Attr)) 2832 NewAttr = S.mergeFormatAttr(D, *FA, FA->getType(), FA->getFormatIdx(), 2833 FA->getFirstArg()); 2834 else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<SectionAttr>(Attr)) 2835 NewAttr = S.mergeSectionAttr(D, *SA, SA->getName()); 2836 else if (const auto *CSA = dyn_cast<CodeSegAttr>(Attr)) 2837 NewAttr = S.mergeCodeSegAttr(D, *CSA, CSA->getName()); 2838 else if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast<MSInheritanceAttr>(Attr)) 2839 NewAttr = S.mergeMSInheritanceAttr(D, *IA, IA->getBestCase(), 2840 IA->getInheritanceModel()); 2841 else if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AlwaysInlineAttr>(Attr)) 2842 NewAttr = S.mergeAlwaysInlineAttr(D, *AA, 2843 &S.Context.Idents.get(AA->getSpelling())); 2844 else if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 2845 (isa<CUDAHostAttr>(Attr) || isa<CUDADeviceAttr>(Attr) || 2846 isa<CUDAGlobalAttr>(Attr))) { 2847 // CUDA target attributes are part of function signature for 2848 // overloading purposes and must not be merged. 2849 return false; 2850 } else if (const auto *MA = dyn_cast<MinSizeAttr>(Attr)) 2851 NewAttr = S.mergeMinSizeAttr(D, *MA); 2852 else if (const auto *SNA = dyn_cast<SwiftNameAttr>(Attr)) 2853 NewAttr = S.mergeSwiftNameAttr(D, *SNA, SNA->getName()); 2854 else if (const auto *OA = dyn_cast<OptimizeNoneAttr>(Attr)) 2855 NewAttr = S.mergeOptimizeNoneAttr(D, *OA); 2856 else if (const auto *InternalLinkageA = dyn_cast<InternalLinkageAttr>(Attr)) 2857 NewAttr = S.mergeInternalLinkageAttr(D, *InternalLinkageA); 2858 else if (isa<AlignedAttr>(Attr)) 2859 // AlignedAttrs are handled separately, because we need to handle all 2860 // such attributes on a declaration at the same time. 2861 NewAttr = nullptr; 2862 else if ((isa<DeprecatedAttr>(Attr) || isa<UnavailableAttr>(Attr)) && 2863 (AMK == Sema::AMK_Override || 2864 AMK == Sema::AMK_ProtocolImplementation || 2865 AMK == Sema::AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation)) 2866 NewAttr = nullptr; 2867 else if (const auto *UA = dyn_cast<UuidAttr>(Attr)) 2868 NewAttr = S.mergeUuidAttr(D, *UA, UA->getGuid(), UA->getGuidDecl()); 2869 else if (const auto *IMA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportModuleAttr>(Attr)) 2870 NewAttr = S.mergeImportModuleAttr(D, *IMA); 2871 else if (const auto *INA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportNameAttr>(Attr)) 2872 NewAttr = S.mergeImportNameAttr(D, *INA); 2873 else if (const auto *TCBA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBAttr>(Attr)) 2874 NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBAttr(D, *TCBA); 2875 else if (const auto *TCBLA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBLeafAttr>(Attr)) 2876 NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBLeafAttr(D, *TCBLA); 2877 else if (const auto *BTFA = dyn_cast<BTFDeclTagAttr>(Attr)) 2878 NewAttr = S.mergeBTFDeclTagAttr(D, *BTFA); 2879 else if (const auto *NT = dyn_cast<HLSLNumThreadsAttr>(Attr)) 2880 NewAttr = 2881 S.mergeHLSLNumThreadsAttr(D, *NT, NT->getX(), NT->getY(), NT->getZ()); 2882 else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<HLSLShaderAttr>(Attr)) 2883 NewAttr = S.mergeHLSLShaderAttr(D, *SA, SA->getType()); 2884 else if (Attr->shouldInheritEvenIfAlreadyPresent() || !DeclHasAttr(D, Attr)) 2885 NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(Attr->clone(S.Context)); 2886 2887 if (NewAttr) { 2888 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 2889 D->addAttr(NewAttr); 2890 if (isa<MSInheritanceAttr>(NewAttr)) 2891 S.Consumer.AssignInheritanceModel(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)); 2892 return true; 2893 } 2894 2895 return false; 2896 } 2897 2898 static const NamedDecl *getDefinition(const Decl *D) { 2899 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2900 return TD->getDefinition(); 2901 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 2902 const VarDecl *Def = VD->getDefinition(); 2903 if (Def) 2904 return Def; 2905 return VD->getActingDefinition(); 2906 } 2907 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2908 const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; 2909 if (FD->isDefined(Def, true)) 2910 return Def; 2911 } 2912 return nullptr; 2913 } 2914 2915 static bool hasAttribute(const Decl *D, attr::Kind Kind) { 2916 for (const auto *Attribute : D->attrs()) 2917 if (Attribute->getKind() == Kind) 2918 return true; 2919 return false; 2920 } 2921 2922 /// checkNewAttributesAfterDef - If we already have a definition, check that 2923 /// there are no new attributes in this declaration. 2924 static void checkNewAttributesAfterDef(Sema &S, Decl *New, const Decl *Old) { 2925 if (!New->hasAttrs()) 2926 return; 2927 2928 const NamedDecl *Def = getDefinition(Old); 2929 if (!Def || Def == New) 2930 return; 2931 2932 AttrVec &NewAttributes = New->getAttrs(); 2933 for (unsigned I = 0, E = NewAttributes.size(); I != E;) { 2934 const Attr *NewAttribute = NewAttributes[I]; 2935 2936 if (isa<AliasAttr>(NewAttribute) || isa<IFuncAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2937 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(New)) { 2938 Sema::SkipBodyInfo SkipBody; 2939 S.CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, cast<FunctionDecl>(Def), &SkipBody); 2940 2941 // If we're skipping this definition, drop the "alias" attribute. 2942 if (SkipBody.ShouldSkip) { 2943 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2944 --E; 2945 continue; 2946 } 2947 } else { 2948 VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(New); 2949 unsigned Diag = cast<VarDecl>(Def)->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == 2950 VarDecl::TentativeDefinition 2951 ? diag::err_alias_after_tentative 2952 : diag::err_redefinition; 2953 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), Diag) << VD->getDeclName(); 2954 if (Diag == diag::err_redefinition) 2955 S.notePreviousDefinition(Def, VD->getLocation()); 2956 else 2957 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2958 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 2959 } 2960 ++I; 2961 continue; 2962 } 2963 2964 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Def)) { 2965 // Tentative definitions are only interesting for the alias check above. 2966 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() != VarDecl::Definition) { 2967 ++I; 2968 continue; 2969 } 2970 } 2971 2972 if (hasAttribute(Def, NewAttribute->getKind())) { 2973 ++I; 2974 continue; // regular attr merging will take care of validating this. 2975 } 2976 2977 if (isa<C11NoReturnAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2978 // C's _Noreturn is allowed to be added to a function after it is defined. 2979 ++I; 2980 continue; 2981 } else if (isa<UuidAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2982 // msvc will allow a subsequent definition to add an uuid to a class 2983 ++I; 2984 continue; 2985 } else if (const AlignedAttr *AA = dyn_cast<AlignedAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2986 if (AA->isAlignas()) { 2987 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2988 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2989 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2990 // equivalent alignment. 2991 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2992 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2993 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2994 // have no alignment specifier. 2995 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2996 << AA; 2997 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2998 << AA; 2999 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 3000 --E; 3001 continue; 3002 } 3003 } else if (isa<LoaderUninitializedAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 3004 // If there is a C definition followed by a redeclaration with this 3005 // attribute then there are two different definitions. In C++, prefer the 3006 // standard diagnostics. 3007 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3008 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), 3009 diag::err_loader_uninitialized_redeclaration); 3010 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 3011 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 3012 --E; 3013 continue; 3014 } 3015 } else if (isa<SelectAnyAttr>(NewAttribute) && 3016 cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInline() && 3017 !cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInlineSpecified()) { 3018 // Don't warn about applying selectany to implicitly inline variables. 3019 // Older compilers and language modes would require the use of selectany 3020 // to make such variables inline, and it would have no effect if we 3021 // honored it. 3022 ++I; 3023 continue; 3024 } else if (isa<OMPDeclareVariantAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 3025 // We allow to add OMP[Begin]DeclareVariantAttr to be added to 3026 // declarations after defintions. 3027 ++I; 3028 continue; 3029 } 3030 3031 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), 3032 diag::warn_attribute_precede_definition); 3033 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 3034 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 3035 --E; 3036 } 3037 } 3038 3039 static void diagnoseMissingConstinit(Sema &S, const VarDecl *InitDecl, 3040 const ConstInitAttr *CIAttr, 3041 bool AttrBeforeInit) { 3042 SourceLocation InsertLoc = InitDecl->getInnerLocStart(); 3043 3044 // Figure out a good way to write this specifier on the old declaration. 3045 // FIXME: We should just use the spelling of CIAttr, but we don't preserve 3046 // enough of the attribute list spelling information to extract that without 3047 // heroics. 3048 std::string SuitableSpelling; 3049 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 3050 SuitableSpelling = std::string( 3051 S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(InsertLoc, {tok::kw_constinit})); 3052 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 3053 SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling( 3054 InsertLoc, {tok::l_square, tok::l_square, 3055 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("clang"), tok::coloncolon, 3056 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"), 3057 tok::r_square, tok::r_square})); 3058 if (SuitableSpelling.empty()) 3059 SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling( 3060 InsertLoc, {tok::kw___attribute, tok::l_paren, tok::r_paren, 3061 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"), 3062 tok::r_paren, tok::r_paren})); 3063 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 3064 SuitableSpelling = "constinit"; 3065 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 3066 SuitableSpelling = "[[clang::require_constant_initialization]]"; 3067 if (SuitableSpelling.empty()) 3068 SuitableSpelling = "__attribute__((require_constant_initialization))"; 3069 SuitableSpelling += " "; 3070 3071 if (AttrBeforeInit) { 3072 // extern constinit int a; 3073 // int a = 0; // error (missing 'constinit'), accepted as extension 3074 assert(CIAttr->isConstinit() && "should not diagnose this for attribute"); 3075 S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_constinit_missing) 3076 << InitDecl << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling); 3077 S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_specified_here); 3078 } else { 3079 // int a = 0; 3080 // constinit extern int a; // error (missing 'constinit') 3081 S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), 3082 CIAttr->isConstinit() ? diag::err_constinit_added_too_late 3083 : diag::warn_require_const_init_added_too_late) 3084 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SourceRange(CIAttr->getLocation())); 3085 S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_missing_here) 3086 << CIAttr->isConstinit() 3087 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling); 3088 } 3089 } 3090 3091 /// mergeDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the Old decl to the New one. 3092 void Sema::mergeDeclAttributes(NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old, 3093 AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) { 3094 if (UsedAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 3095 UsedAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context); 3096 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 3097 New->addAttr(NewAttr); 3098 } 3099 if (RetainAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) { 3100 RetainAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context); 3101 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 3102 New->addAttr(NewAttr); 3103 } 3104 3105 if (!Old->hasAttrs() && !New->hasAttrs()) 3106 return; 3107 3108 // [dcl.constinit]p1: 3109 // If the [constinit] specifier is applied to any declaration of a 3110 // variable, it shall be applied to the initializing declaration. 3111 const auto *OldConstInit = Old->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 3112 const auto *NewConstInit = New->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 3113 if (bool(OldConstInit) != bool(NewConstInit)) { 3114 const auto *OldVD = cast<VarDecl>(Old); 3115 auto *NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(New); 3116 3117 // Find the initializing declaration. Note that we might not have linked 3118 // the new declaration into the redeclaration chain yet. 3119 const VarDecl *InitDecl = OldVD->getInitializingDeclaration(); 3120 if (!InitDecl && 3121 (NewVD->hasInit() || NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition())) 3122 InitDecl = NewVD; 3123 3124 if (InitDecl == NewVD) { 3125 // This is the initializing declaration. If it would inherit 'constinit', 3126 // that's ill-formed. (Note that we do not apply this to the attribute 3127 // form). 3128 if (OldConstInit && OldConstInit->isConstinit()) 3129 diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, NewVD, OldConstInit, 3130 /*AttrBeforeInit=*/true); 3131 } else if (NewConstInit) { 3132 // This is the first time we've been told that this declaration should 3133 // have a constant initializer. If we already saw the initializing 3134 // declaration, this is too late. 3135 if (InitDecl && InitDecl != NewVD) { 3136 diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, InitDecl, NewConstInit, 3137 /*AttrBeforeInit=*/false); 3138 NewVD->dropAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 3139 } 3140 } 3141 } 3142 3143 // Attributes declared post-definition are currently ignored. 3144 checkNewAttributesAfterDef(*this, New, Old); 3145 3146 if (AsmLabelAttr *NewA = New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) { 3147 if (AsmLabelAttr *OldA = Old->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) { 3148 if (!OldA->isEquivalent(NewA)) { 3149 // This redeclaration changes __asm__ label. 3150 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_asm_label); 3151 Diag(OldA->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3152 } 3153 } else if (Old->isUsed()) { 3154 // This redeclaration adds an __asm__ label to a declaration that has 3155 // already been ODR-used. 3156 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_late_asm_label_name) 3157 << isa<FunctionDecl>(Old) << New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()->getRange(); 3158 } 3159 } 3160 3161 // Re-declaration cannot add abi_tag's. 3162 if (const auto *NewAbiTagAttr = New->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) { 3163 if (const auto *OldAbiTagAttr = Old->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) { 3164 for (const auto &NewTag : NewAbiTagAttr->tags()) { 3165 if (!llvm::is_contained(OldAbiTagAttr->tags(), NewTag)) { 3166 Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), 3167 diag::err_new_abi_tag_on_redeclaration) 3168 << NewTag; 3169 Diag(OldAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3170 } 3171 } 3172 } else { 3173 Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_abi_tag_on_redeclaration); 3174 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3175 } 3176 } 3177 3178 // This redeclaration adds a section attribute. 3179 if (New->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && !Old->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 3180 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(New)) { 3181 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly) { 3182 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_section_on_redeclaration); 3183 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3184 } 3185 } 3186 } 3187 3188 // Redeclaration adds code-seg attribute. 3189 const auto *NewCSA = New->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>(); 3190 if (NewCSA && !Old->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>() && 3191 !NewCSA->isImplicit() && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New)) { 3192 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_section) 3193 << 0 /*codeseg*/; 3194 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3195 } 3196 3197 if (!Old->hasAttrs()) 3198 return; 3199 3200 bool foundAny = New->hasAttrs(); 3201 3202 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is done before 3203 // we process them. 3204 if (!foundAny) New->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 3205 3206 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<InheritableAttr>()) { 3207 // Ignore deprecated/unavailable/availability attributes if requested. 3208 AvailabilityMergeKind LocalAMK = AMK_None; 3209 if (isa<DeprecatedAttr>(I) || 3210 isa<UnavailableAttr>(I) || 3211 isa<AvailabilityAttr>(I)) { 3212 switch (AMK) { 3213 case AMK_None: 3214 continue; 3215 3216 case AMK_Redeclaration: 3217 case AMK_Override: 3218 case AMK_ProtocolImplementation: 3219 case AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation: 3220 LocalAMK = AMK; 3221 break; 3222 } 3223 } 3224 3225 // Already handled. 3226 if (isa<UsedAttr>(I) || isa<RetainAttr>(I)) 3227 continue; 3228 3229 if (mergeDeclAttribute(*this, New, I, LocalAMK)) 3230 foundAny = true; 3231 } 3232 3233 if (mergeAlignedAttrs(*this, New, Old)) 3234 foundAny = true; 3235 3236 if (!foundAny) New->dropAttrs(); 3237 } 3238 3239 /// mergeParamDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the old parameter 3240 /// to the new one. 3241 static void mergeParamDeclAttributes(ParmVarDecl *newDecl, 3242 const ParmVarDecl *oldDecl, 3243 Sema &S) { 3244 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 3245 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 3246 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 3247 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 3248 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = newDecl->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 3249 if (CDA && !oldDecl->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 3250 S.Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 3251 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 3252 // Find the first declaration of the parameter. 3253 // FIXME: Should we build redeclaration chains for function parameters? 3254 const FunctionDecl *FirstFD = 3255 cast<FunctionDecl>(oldDecl->getDeclContext())->getFirstDecl(); 3256 const ParmVarDecl *FirstVD = 3257 FirstFD->getParamDecl(oldDecl->getFunctionScopeIndex()); 3258 S.Diag(FirstVD->getLocation(), 3259 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 3260 } 3261 3262 if (!oldDecl->hasAttrs()) 3263 return; 3264 3265 bool foundAny = newDecl->hasAttrs(); 3266 3267 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is 3268 // done before we process them. 3269 if (!foundAny) newDecl->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 3270 3271 for (const auto *I : oldDecl->specific_attrs<InheritableParamAttr>()) { 3272 if (!DeclHasAttr(newDecl, I)) { 3273 InheritableAttr *newAttr = 3274 cast<InheritableParamAttr>(I->clone(S.Context)); 3275 newAttr->setInherited(true); 3276 newDecl->addAttr(newAttr); 3277 foundAny = true; 3278 } 3279 } 3280 3281 if (!foundAny) newDecl->dropAttrs(); 3282 } 3283 3284 static bool EquivalentArrayTypes(QualType Old, QualType New, 3285 const ASTContext &Ctx) { 3286 3287 auto NoSizeInfo = [&Ctx](QualType Ty) { 3288 if (Ty->isIncompleteArrayType() || Ty->isPointerType()) 3289 return true; 3290 if (const auto *VAT = Ctx.getAsVariableArrayType(Ty)) 3291 return VAT->getSizeModifier() == ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier::Star; 3292 return false; 3293 }; 3294 3295 // `type[]` is equivalent to `type *` and `type[*]`. 3296 if (NoSizeInfo(Old) && NoSizeInfo(New)) 3297 return true; 3298 3299 // Don't try to compare VLA sizes, unless one of them has the star modifier. 3300 if (Old->isVariableArrayType() && New->isVariableArrayType()) { 3301 const auto *OldVAT = Ctx.getAsVariableArrayType(Old); 3302 const auto *NewVAT = Ctx.getAsVariableArrayType(New); 3303 if ((OldVAT->getSizeModifier() == ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier::Star) ^ 3304 (NewVAT->getSizeModifier() == ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier::Star)) 3305 return false; 3306 return true; 3307 } 3308 3309 // Only compare size, ignore Size modifiers and CVR. 3310 if (Old->isConstantArrayType() && New->isConstantArrayType()) { 3311 return Ctx.getAsConstantArrayType(Old)->getSize() == 3312 Ctx.getAsConstantArrayType(New)->getSize(); 3313 } 3314 3315 // Don't try to compare dependent sized array 3316 if (Old->isDependentSizedArrayType() && New->isDependentSizedArrayType()) { 3317 return true; 3318 } 3319 3320 return Old == New; 3321 } 3322 3323 static void mergeParamDeclTypes(ParmVarDecl *NewParam, 3324 const ParmVarDecl *OldParam, 3325 Sema &S) { 3326 if (auto Oldnullability = OldParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 3327 if (auto Newnullability = NewParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 3328 if (*Oldnullability != *Newnullability) { 3329 S.Diag(NewParam->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_nullability_attr) 3330 << DiagNullabilityKind( 3331 *Newnullability, 3332 ((NewParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 3333 != 0)) 3334 << DiagNullabilityKind( 3335 *Oldnullability, 3336 ((OldParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 3337 != 0)); 3338 S.Diag(OldParam->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3339 } 3340 } else { 3341 QualType NewT = NewParam->getType(); 3342 NewT = S.Context.getAttributedType( 3343 AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Oldnullability), 3344 NewT, NewT); 3345 NewParam->setType(NewT); 3346 } 3347 } 3348 const auto *OldParamDT = dyn_cast<DecayedType>(OldParam->getType()); 3349 const auto *NewParamDT = dyn_cast<DecayedType>(NewParam->getType()); 3350 if (OldParamDT && NewParamDT && 3351 OldParamDT->getPointeeType() == NewParamDT->getPointeeType()) { 3352 QualType OldParamOT = OldParamDT->getOriginalType(); 3353 QualType NewParamOT = NewParamDT->getOriginalType(); 3354 if (!EquivalentArrayTypes(OldParamOT, NewParamOT, S.getASTContext())) { 3355 S.Diag(NewParam->getLocation(), diag::warn_inconsistent_array_form) 3356 << NewParam << NewParamOT; 3357 S.Diag(OldParam->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration_as) 3358 << OldParamOT; 3359 } 3360 } 3361 } 3362 3363 namespace { 3364 3365 /// Used in MergeFunctionDecl to keep track of function parameters in 3366 /// C. 3367 struct GNUCompatibleParamWarning { 3368 ParmVarDecl *OldParm; 3369 ParmVarDecl *NewParm; 3370 QualType PromotedType; 3371 }; 3372 3373 } // end anonymous namespace 3374 3375 // Determine whether the previous declaration was a definition, implicit 3376 // declaration, or a declaration. 3377 template <typename T> 3378 static std::pair<diag::kind, SourceLocation> 3379 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(const T *Old, const T *New) { 3380 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3381 SourceLocation OldLocation = Old->getLocation(); 3382 if (Old->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 3383 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_definition; 3384 else if (Old->isImplicit()) { 3385 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_implicit_declaration; 3386 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Old)) { 3387 if (FD->getBuiltinID()) 3388 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration; 3389 } 3390 if (OldLocation.isInvalid()) 3391 OldLocation = New->getLocation(); 3392 } else 3393 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_declaration; 3394 return std::make_pair(PrevDiag, OldLocation); 3395 } 3396 3397 /// canRedefineFunction - checks if a function can be redefined. Currently, 3398 /// only extern inline functions can be redefined, and even then only in 3399 /// GNU89 mode. 3400 static bool canRedefineFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, 3401 const LangOptions& LangOpts) { 3402 return ((FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() || LangOpts.GNUInline) && 3403 !LangOpts.CPlusPlus && 3404 FD->isInlineSpecified() && 3405 FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern); 3406 } 3407 3408 const AttributedType *Sema::getCallingConvAttributedType(QualType T) const { 3409 const AttributedType *AT = T->getAs<AttributedType>(); 3410 while (AT && !AT->isCallingConv()) 3411 AT = AT->getModifiedType()->getAs<AttributedType>(); 3412 return AT; 3413 } 3414 3415 template <typename T> 3416 static bool haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(const T *Old, const T *New) { 3417 const DeclContext *DC = Old->getDeclContext(); 3418 if (DC->isRecord()) 3419 return false; 3420 3421 LanguageLinkage OldLinkage = Old->getLanguageLinkage(); 3422 if (OldLinkage == CXXLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCContext()) 3423 return true; 3424 if (OldLinkage == CLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCXXContext()) 3425 return true; 3426 return false; 3427 } 3428 3429 template<typename T> static bool isExternC(T *D) { return D->isExternC(); } 3430 static bool isExternC(VarTemplateDecl *) { return false; } 3431 static bool isExternC(FunctionTemplateDecl *) { return false; } 3432 3433 /// Check whether a redeclaration of an entity introduced by a 3434 /// using-declaration is valid, given that we know it's not an overload 3435 /// (nor a hidden tag declaration). 3436 template<typename ExpectedDecl> 3437 static bool checkUsingShadowRedecl(Sema &S, UsingShadowDecl *OldS, 3438 ExpectedDecl *New) { 3439 // C++11 [basic.scope.declarative]p4: 3440 // Given a set of declarations in a single declarative region, each of 3441 // which specifies the same unqualified name, 3442 // -- they shall all refer to the same entity, or all refer to functions 3443 // and function templates; or 3444 // -- exactly one declaration shall declare a class name or enumeration 3445 // name that is not a typedef name and the other declarations shall all 3446 // refer to the same variable or enumerator, or all refer to functions 3447 // and function templates; in this case the class name or enumeration 3448 // name is hidden (3.3.10). 3449 3450 // C++11 [namespace.udecl]p14: 3451 // If a function declaration in namespace scope or block scope has the 3452 // same name and the same parameter-type-list as a function introduced 3453 // by a using-declaration, and the declarations do not declare the same 3454 // function, the program is ill-formed. 3455 3456 auto *Old = dyn_cast<ExpectedDecl>(OldS->getTargetDecl()); 3457 if (Old && 3458 !Old->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 3459 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) && 3460 !(isExternC(Old) && isExternC(New))) 3461 Old = nullptr; 3462 3463 if (!Old) { 3464 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 3465 S.Diag(OldS->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl_target); 3466 S.Diag(OldS->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) << 0; 3467 return true; 3468 } 3469 return false; 3470 } 3471 3472 static bool hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(const FunctionDecl *A, 3473 const FunctionDecl *B) { 3474 assert(A->getNumParams() == B->getNumParams()); 3475 3476 auto AttrEq = [](const ParmVarDecl *A, const ParmVarDecl *B) { 3477 const auto *AttrA = A->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 3478 const auto *AttrB = B->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 3479 if (AttrA == AttrB) 3480 return true; 3481 return AttrA && AttrB && AttrA->getType() == AttrB->getType() && 3482 AttrA->isDynamic() == AttrB->isDynamic(); 3483 }; 3484 3485 return std::equal(A->param_begin(), A->param_end(), B->param_begin(), AttrEq); 3486 } 3487 3488 /// If necessary, adjust the semantic declaration context for a qualified 3489 /// declaration to name the correct inline namespace within the qualifier. 3490 static void adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(DeclaratorDecl *NewD, 3491 DeclaratorDecl *OldD) { 3492 // The only case where we need to update the DeclContext is when 3493 // redeclaration lookup for a qualified name finds a declaration 3494 // in an inline namespace within the context named by the qualifier: 3495 // 3496 // inline namespace N { int f(); } 3497 // int ::f(); // Sema DC needs adjusting from :: to N::. 3498 // 3499 // For unqualified declarations, the semantic context *can* change 3500 // along the redeclaration chain (for local extern declarations, 3501 // extern "C" declarations, and friend declarations in particular). 3502 if (!NewD->getQualifier()) 3503 return; 3504 3505 // NewD is probably already in the right context. 3506 auto *NamedDC = NewD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 3507 auto *SemaDC = OldD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 3508 if (NamedDC->Equals(SemaDC)) 3509 return; 3510 3511 assert((NamedDC->InEnclosingNamespaceSetOf(SemaDC) || 3512 NewD->isInvalidDecl() || OldD->isInvalidDecl()) && 3513 "unexpected context for redeclaration"); 3514 3515 auto *LexDC = NewD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 3516 auto FixSemaDC = [=](NamedDecl *D) { 3517 if (!D) 3518 return; 3519 D->setDeclContext(SemaDC); 3520 D->setLexicalDeclContext(LexDC); 3521 }; 3522 3523 FixSemaDC(NewD); 3524 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewD)) 3525 FixSemaDC(FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()); 3526 else if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewD)) 3527 FixSemaDC(VD->getDescribedVarTemplate()); 3528 } 3529 3530 /// MergeFunctionDecl - We just parsed a function 'New' from 3531 /// declarator D which has the same name and scope as a previous 3532 /// declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this situation, 3533 /// merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 3534 /// 3535 /// In C++, New and Old must be declarations that are not 3536 /// overloaded. Use IsOverload to determine whether New and Old are 3537 /// overloaded, and to select the Old declaration that New should be 3538 /// merged with. 3539 /// 3540 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 3541 bool Sema::MergeFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *New, NamedDecl *&OldD, Scope *S, 3542 bool MergeTypeWithOld, bool NewDeclIsDefn) { 3543 // Verify the old decl was also a function. 3544 FunctionDecl *Old = OldD->getAsFunction(); 3545 if (!Old) { 3546 if (UsingShadowDecl *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 3547 if (New->getFriendObjectKind()) { 3548 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_friend); 3549 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 3550 diag::note_using_decl_target); 3551 Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) 3552 << 0; 3553 return true; 3554 } 3555 3556 // Check whether the two declarations might declare the same function or 3557 // function template. 3558 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = 3559 New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 3560 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, 3561 NewTemplate)) 3562 return true; 3563 OldD = Old = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl()) 3564 ->getAsFunction(); 3565 } else { 3566 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 3567 return true; 3568 OldD = Old = cast<FunctionDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl()); 3569 } 3570 } else { 3571 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 3572 << New->getDeclName(); 3573 notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation()); 3574 return true; 3575 } 3576 } 3577 3578 // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new 3579 // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match. 3580 adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old); 3581 3582 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 3583 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 3584 return true; 3585 3586 // Disallow redeclaration of some builtins. 3587 if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(Old)) { 3588 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_redeclare) << Old->getDeclName(); 3589 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration) 3590 << Old << Old->getType(); 3591 return true; 3592 } 3593 3594 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3595 SourceLocation OldLocation; 3596 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 3597 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 3598 3599 // Don't complain about this if we're in GNU89 mode and the old function 3600 // is an extern inline function. 3601 // Don't complain about specializations. They are not supposed to have 3602 // storage classes. 3603 if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New) && !isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Old) && 3604 New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 3605 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage() && 3606 !New->getTemplateSpecializationInfo() && 3607 !canRedefineFunction(Old, getLangOpts())) { 3608 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 3609 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) << New; 3610 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3611 } else { 3612 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) << New; 3613 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3614 return true; 3615 } 3616 } 3617 3618 if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) 3619 if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) { 3620 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 3621 << ILA; 3622 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3623 New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>(); 3624 } 3625 3626 if (auto *EA = New->getAttr<ErrorAttr>()) { 3627 if (!Old->hasAttr<ErrorAttr>()) { 3628 Diag(EA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) << EA; 3629 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3630 New->dropAttr<ErrorAttr>(); 3631 } 3632 } 3633 3634 if (CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, Old)) 3635 return true; 3636 3637 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3638 bool OldOvl = Old->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3639 if (OldOvl != New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && !Old->isImplicit()) { 3640 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_overloadable_mismatch) 3641 << New << OldOvl; 3642 3643 // Try our best to find a decl that actually has the overloadable 3644 // attribute for the note. In most cases (e.g. programs with only one 3645 // broken declaration/definition), this won't matter. 3646 // 3647 // FIXME: We could do this if we juggled some extra state in 3648 // OverloadableAttr, rather than just removing it. 3649 const Decl *DiagOld = Old; 3650 if (OldOvl) { 3651 auto OldIter = llvm::find_if(Old->redecls(), [](const Decl *D) { 3652 const auto *A = D->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3653 return A && !A->isImplicit(); 3654 }); 3655 // If we've implicitly added *all* of the overloadable attrs to this 3656 // chain, emitting a "previous redecl" note is pointless. 3657 DiagOld = OldIter == Old->redecls_end() ? nullptr : *OldIter; 3658 } 3659 3660 if (DiagOld) 3661 Diag(DiagOld->getLocation(), 3662 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload) 3663 << OldOvl; 3664 3665 if (OldOvl) 3666 New->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 3667 else 3668 New->dropAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3669 } 3670 } 3671 3672 // If a function is first declared with a calling convention, but is later 3673 // declared or defined without one, all following decls assume the calling 3674 // convention of the first. 3675 // 3676 // It's OK if a function is first declared without a calling convention, 3677 // but is later declared or defined with the default calling convention. 3678 // 3679 // To test if either decl has an explicit calling convention, we look for 3680 // AttributedType sugar nodes on the type as written. If they are missing or 3681 // were canonicalized away, we assume the calling convention was implicit. 3682 // 3683 // Note also that we DO NOT return at this point, because we still have 3684 // other tests to run. 3685 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 3686 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3687 const FunctionType *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType); 3688 const FunctionType *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 3689 FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo(); 3690 FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo(); 3691 bool RequiresAdjustment = false; 3692 3693 if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) { 3694 FunctionDecl *First = Old->getFirstDecl(); 3695 const FunctionType *FT = 3696 First->getType().getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 3697 FunctionType::ExtInfo FI = FT->getExtInfo(); 3698 bool NewCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(New->getType()); 3699 if (!NewCCExplicit) { 3700 // Inherit the CC from the previous declaration if it was specified 3701 // there but not here. 3702 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC()); 3703 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3704 } else if (Old->getBuiltinID()) { 3705 // Builtin attribute isn't propagated to the new one yet at this point, 3706 // so we check if the old one is a builtin. 3707 3708 // Calling Conventions on a Builtin aren't really useful and setting a 3709 // default calling convention and cdecl'ing some builtin redeclarations is 3710 // common, so warn and ignore the calling convention on the redeclaration. 3711 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_cconv_unsupported) 3712 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 3713 << (int)CallingConventionIgnoredReason::BuiltinFunction; 3714 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC()); 3715 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3716 } else { 3717 // Calling conventions aren't compatible, so complain. 3718 bool FirstCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(First->getType()); 3719 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_cconv_change) 3720 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 3721 << !FirstCCExplicit 3722 << (!FirstCCExplicit ? "" : 3723 FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(FI.getCC())); 3724 3725 // Put the note on the first decl, since it is the one that matters. 3726 Diag(First->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3727 return true; 3728 } 3729 } 3730 3731 // FIXME: diagnose the other way around? 3732 if (OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && !NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 3733 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true); 3734 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3735 } 3736 3737 // Merge regparm attribute. 3738 if (OldTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() || 3739 OldTypeInfo.getRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getRegParm()) { 3740 if (NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm()) { 3741 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_regparm_mismatch) 3742 << NewType->getRegParmType() 3743 << OldType->getRegParmType(); 3744 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3745 return true; 3746 } 3747 3748 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withRegParm(OldTypeInfo.getRegParm()); 3749 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3750 } 3751 3752 // Merge ns_returns_retained attribute. 3753 if (OldTypeInfo.getProducesResult() != NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 3754 if (NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 3755 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) 3756 << "'ns_returns_retained'"; 3757 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3758 return true; 3759 } 3760 3761 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withProducesResult(true); 3762 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3763 } 3764 3765 if (OldTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() != 3766 NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) { 3767 if (NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) { 3768 AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr *Attr = 3769 New->getAttr<AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr>(); 3770 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) << Attr; 3771 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3772 return true; 3773 } 3774 3775 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoCallerSavedRegs(true); 3776 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3777 } 3778 3779 if (RequiresAdjustment) { 3780 const FunctionType *AdjustedType = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3781 AdjustedType = Context.adjustFunctionType(AdjustedType, NewTypeInfo); 3782 New->setType(QualType(AdjustedType, 0)); 3783 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3784 } 3785 3786 // If this redeclaration makes the function inline, we may need to add it to 3787 // UndefinedButUsed. 3788 if (!Old->isInlined() && New->isInlined() && 3789 !New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 3790 !getLangOpts().GNUInline && 3791 Old->isUsed(false) && 3792 !Old->isDefined() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 3793 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(), 3794 SourceLocation())); 3795 3796 // If this redeclaration makes it newly gnu_inline, we don't want to warn 3797 // about it. 3798 if (New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 3799 Old->isInlined() && !Old->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) { 3800 UndefinedButUsed.erase(Old->getCanonicalDecl()); 3801 } 3802 3803 // If pass_object_size params don't match up perfectly, this isn't a valid 3804 // redeclaration. 3805 if (Old->getNumParams() > 0 && Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams() && 3806 !hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(Old, New)) { 3807 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_pass_object_size_params) 3808 << New->getDeclName(); 3809 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3810 return true; 3811 } 3812 3813 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3814 // C++1z [over.load]p2 3815 // Certain function declarations cannot be overloaded: 3816 // -- Function declarations that differ only in the return type, 3817 // the exception specification, or both cannot be overloaded. 3818 3819 // Check the exception specifications match. This may recompute the type of 3820 // both Old and New if it resolved exception specifications, so grab the 3821 // types again after this. Because this updates the type, we do this before 3822 // any of the other checks below, which may update the "de facto" NewQType 3823 // but do not necessarily update the type of New. 3824 if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec(Old, New)) 3825 return true; 3826 OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 3827 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3828 3829 // Go back to the type source info to compare the declared return types, 3830 // per C++1y [dcl.type.auto]p13: 3831 // Redeclarations or specializations of a function or function template 3832 // with a declared return type that uses a placeholder type shall also 3833 // use that placeholder, not a deduced type. 3834 QualType OldDeclaredReturnType = Old->getDeclaredReturnType(); 3835 QualType NewDeclaredReturnType = New->getDeclaredReturnType(); 3836 if (!Context.hasSameType(OldDeclaredReturnType, NewDeclaredReturnType) && 3837 canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewDeclaredReturnType, 3838 OldDeclaredReturnType)) { 3839 QualType ResQT; 3840 if (NewDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 3841 OldDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 3842 // FIXME: This does the wrong thing for a deduced return type. 3843 ResQT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewQType, OldQType); 3844 if (ResQT.isNull()) { 3845 if (New->isCXXClassMember() && New->isOutOfLine()) 3846 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_def_does_not_match_ret_type) 3847 << New << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3848 else 3849 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_diff_return_type) 3850 << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3851 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType() 3852 << Old->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3853 return true; 3854 } 3855 else 3856 NewQType = ResQT; 3857 } 3858 3859 QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType(); 3860 QualType NewReturnType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType)->getReturnType(); 3861 if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) { 3862 // If this function has a deduced return type and has already been 3863 // defined, copy the deduced value from the old declaration. 3864 AutoType *OldAT = Old->getReturnType()->getContainedAutoType(); 3865 if (OldAT && OldAT->isDeduced()) { 3866 QualType DT = OldAT->getDeducedType(); 3867 if (DT.isNull()) { 3868 New->setType(SubstAutoTypeDependent(New->getType())); 3869 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(SubstAutoTypeDependent(NewQType)); 3870 } else { 3871 New->setType(SubstAutoType(New->getType(), DT)); 3872 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(SubstAutoType(NewQType, DT)); 3873 } 3874 } 3875 } 3876 3877 const CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 3878 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 3879 if (OldMethod && NewMethod) { 3880 // Preserve triviality. 3881 NewMethod->setTrivial(OldMethod->isTrivial()); 3882 3883 // MSVC allows explicit template specialization at class scope: 3884 // 2 CXXMethodDecls referring to the same function will be injected. 3885 // We don't want a redeclaration error. 3886 bool IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = 3887 OldMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 3888 NewMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization(); 3889 bool isFriend = NewMethod->getFriendObjectKind(); 3890 3891 if (!isFriend && NewMethod->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 3892 !IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 3893 // -- Member function declarations with the same name and the 3894 // same parameter types cannot be overloaded if any of them 3895 // is a static member function declaration. 3896 if (OldMethod->isStatic() != NewMethod->isStatic()) { 3897 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_static_nonstatic_member); 3898 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3899 return true; 3900 } 3901 3902 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 3903 // [...] A member shall not be declared twice in the 3904 // member-specification, except that a nested class or member 3905 // class template can be declared and then later defined. 3906 if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) { 3907 unsigned NewDiag; 3908 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(OldMethod)) 3909 NewDiag = diag::err_constructor_redeclared; 3910 else if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 3911 NewDiag = diag::err_destructor_redeclared; 3912 else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewMethod)) 3913 NewDiag = diag::err_conv_function_redeclared; 3914 else 3915 NewDiag = diag::err_member_redeclared; 3916 3917 Diag(New->getLocation(), NewDiag); 3918 } else { 3919 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_redeclared_in_instantiation) 3920 << New << New->getType(); 3921 } 3922 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3923 return true; 3924 3925 // Complain if this is an explicit declaration of a special 3926 // member that was initially declared implicitly. 3927 // 3928 // As an exception, it's okay to befriend such methods in order 3929 // to permit the implicit constructor/destructor/operator calls. 3930 } else if (OldMethod->isImplicit()) { 3931 if (isFriend) { 3932 NewMethod->setImplicit(); 3933 } else { 3934 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 3935 diag::err_definition_of_implicitly_declared_member) 3936 << New << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 3937 return true; 3938 } 3939 } else if (OldMethod->getFirstDecl()->isExplicitlyDefaulted() && !isFriend) { 3940 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 3941 diag::err_definition_of_explicitly_defaulted_member) 3942 << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 3943 return true; 3944 } 3945 } 3946 3947 // C++11 [dcl.attr.noreturn]p1: 3948 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the noreturn 3949 // attribute if any declaration of that function specifies the noreturn 3950 // attribute. 3951 if (const auto *NRA = New->getAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) 3952 if (!Old->hasAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) { 3953 Diag(NRA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 3954 << NRA; 3955 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3956 } 3957 3958 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 3959 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 3960 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 3961 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 3962 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = New->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 3963 if (CDA && !Old->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 3964 Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 3965 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 3966 Diag(Old->getFirstDecl()->getLocation(), 3967 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 3968 } 3969 3970 // (C++98 8.3.5p3): 3971 // All declarations for a function shall agree exactly in both the 3972 // return type and the parameter-type-list. 3973 // We also want to respect all the extended bits except noreturn. 3974 3975 // noreturn should now match unless the old type info didn't have it. 3976 QualType OldQTypeForComparison = OldQType; 3977 if (!OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 3978 auto *OldType = OldQType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3979 const FunctionType *OldTypeForComparison 3980 = Context.adjustFunctionType(OldType, OldTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true)); 3981 OldQTypeForComparison = QualType(OldTypeForComparison, 0); 3982 assert(OldQTypeForComparison.isCanonical()); 3983 } 3984 3985 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 3986 // As a special case, retain the language linkage from previous 3987 // declarations of a friend function as an extension. 3988 // 3989 // This liberal interpretation of C++ [class.friend]p3 matches GCC/MSVC 3990 // and is useful because there's otherwise no way to specify language 3991 // linkage within class scope. 3992 // 3993 // Check cautiously as the friend object kind isn't yet complete. 3994 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) { 3995 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_retained_language_linkage) << New; 3996 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3997 } else { 3998 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 3999 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4000 return true; 4001 } 4002 } 4003 4004 // If the function types are compatible, merge the declarations. Ignore the 4005 // exception specifier because it was already checked above in 4006 // CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec, and we don't want follow-on diagnostics 4007 // about incompatible types under -fms-compatibility. 4008 if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(OldQTypeForComparison, 4009 NewQType)) 4010 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 4011 4012 // If the types are imprecise (due to dependent constructs in friends or 4013 // local extern declarations), it's OK if they differ. We'll check again 4014 // during instantiation. 4015 if (!canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewQType, OldQType)) 4016 return false; 4017 4018 // Fall through for conflicting redeclarations and redefinitions. 4019 } 4020 4021 // C: Function types need to be compatible, not identical. This handles 4022 // duplicate function decls like "void f(int); void f(enum X);" properly. 4023 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4024 // C99 6.7.5.3p15: ...If one type has a parameter type list and the other 4025 // type is specified by a function definition that contains a (possibly 4026 // empty) identifier list, both shall agree in the number of parameters 4027 // and the type of each parameter shall be compatible with the type that 4028 // results from the application of default argument promotions to the 4029 // type of the corresponding identifier. ... 4030 // This cannot be handled by ASTContext::typesAreCompatible() because that 4031 // doesn't know whether the function type is for a definition or not when 4032 // eventually calling ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(). The only situation 4033 // we need to cover here is that the number of arguments agree as the 4034 // default argument promotion rules were already checked by 4035 // ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(). 4036 if (Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasWrittenPrototype() && NewDeclIsDefn && 4037 Old->getNumParams() != New->getNumParams() && !Old->isImplicit()) { 4038 if (Old->hasInheritedPrototype()) 4039 Old = Old->getCanonicalDecl(); 4040 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New; 4041 Diag(Old->getLocation(), PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 4042 return true; 4043 } 4044 4045 // If we are merging two functions where only one of them has a prototype, 4046 // we may have enough information to decide to issue a diagnostic that the 4047 // function without a protoype will change behavior in C2x. This handles 4048 // cases like: 4049 // void i(); void i(int j); 4050 // void i(int j); void i(); 4051 // void i(); void i(int j) {} 4052 // See ActOnFinishFunctionBody() for other cases of the behavior change 4053 // diagnostic. See GetFullTypeForDeclarator() for handling of a function 4054 // type without a prototype. 4055 if (New->hasWrittenPrototype() != Old->hasWrittenPrototype() && 4056 !New->isImplicit() && !Old->isImplicit()) { 4057 const FunctionDecl *WithProto, *WithoutProto; 4058 if (New->hasWrittenPrototype()) { 4059 WithProto = New; 4060 WithoutProto = Old; 4061 } else { 4062 WithProto = Old; 4063 WithoutProto = New; 4064 } 4065 4066 if (WithProto->getNumParams() != 0) { 4067 if (WithoutProto->getBuiltinID() == 0 && !WithoutProto->isImplicit()) { 4068 // The one without the prototype will be changing behavior in C2x, so 4069 // warn about that one so long as it's a user-visible declaration. 4070 bool IsWithoutProtoADef = false, IsWithProtoADef = false; 4071 if (WithoutProto == New) 4072 IsWithoutProtoADef = NewDeclIsDefn; 4073 else 4074 IsWithProtoADef = NewDeclIsDefn; 4075 Diag(WithoutProto->getLocation(), 4076 diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior) 4077 << IsWithoutProtoADef << (WithoutProto->getNumParams() ? 0 : 1) 4078 << (WithoutProto == Old) << IsWithProtoADef; 4079 4080 // The reason the one without the prototype will be changing behavior 4081 // is because of the one with the prototype, so note that so long as 4082 // it's a user-visible declaration. There is one exception to this: 4083 // when the new declaration is a definition without a prototype, the 4084 // old declaration with a prototype is not the cause of the issue, 4085 // and that does not need to be noted because the one with a 4086 // prototype will not change behavior in C2x. 4087 if (WithProto->getBuiltinID() == 0 && !WithProto->isImplicit() && 4088 !IsWithoutProtoADef) 4089 Diag(WithProto->getLocation(), diag::note_conflicting_prototype); 4090 } 4091 } 4092 } 4093 4094 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldQType, NewQType)) { 4095 const FunctionType *OldFuncType = OldQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 4096 const FunctionType *NewFuncType = NewQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 4097 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto = nullptr; 4098 if (MergeTypeWithOld && isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewFuncType) && 4099 (OldProto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldFuncType))) { 4100 // The old declaration provided a function prototype, but the 4101 // new declaration does not. Merge in the prototype. 4102 assert(!OldProto->hasExceptionSpec() && "Exception spec in C"); 4103 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ParamTypes(OldProto->param_types()); 4104 NewQType = 4105 Context.getFunctionType(NewFuncType->getReturnType(), ParamTypes, 4106 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo()); 4107 New->setType(NewQType); 4108 New->setHasInheritedPrototype(); 4109 4110 // Synthesize parameters with the same types. 4111 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params; 4112 for (const auto &ParamType : OldProto->param_types()) { 4113 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create( 4114 Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr, 4115 ParamType, /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 4116 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 4117 Param->setImplicit(); 4118 Params.push_back(Param); 4119 } 4120 4121 New->setParams(Params); 4122 } 4123 4124 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 4125 } 4126 } 4127 4128 // Check if the function types are compatible when pointer size address 4129 // spaces are ignored. 4130 if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringPtrSizes(OldQType, NewQType)) 4131 return false; 4132 4133 // GNU C permits a K&R definition to follow a prototype declaration 4134 // if the declared types of the parameters in the K&R definition 4135 // match the types in the prototype declaration, even when the 4136 // promoted types of the parameters from the K&R definition differ 4137 // from the types in the prototype. GCC then keeps the types from 4138 // the prototype. 4139 // 4140 // If a variadic prototype is followed by a non-variadic K&R definition, 4141 // the K&R definition becomes variadic. This is sort of an edge case, but 4142 // it's legal per the standard depending on how you read C99 6.7.5.3p15 and 4143 // C99 6.9.1p8. 4144 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4145 Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasPrototype() && 4146 New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>() && 4147 Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams()) { 4148 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ArgTypes; 4149 SmallVector<GNUCompatibleParamWarning, 16> Warnings; 4150 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto 4151 = Old->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4152 const FunctionProtoType *NewProto 4153 = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4154 4155 // Determine whether this is the GNU C extension. 4156 QualType MergedReturn = Context.mergeTypes(OldProto->getReturnType(), 4157 NewProto->getReturnType()); 4158 bool LooseCompatible = !MergedReturn.isNull(); 4159 for (unsigned Idx = 0, End = Old->getNumParams(); 4160 LooseCompatible && Idx != End; ++Idx) { 4161 ParmVarDecl *OldParm = Old->getParamDecl(Idx); 4162 ParmVarDecl *NewParm = New->getParamDecl(Idx); 4163 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 4164 NewProto->getParamType(Idx))) { 4165 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 4166 } else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 4167 NewParm->getType(), 4168 /*CompareUnqualified=*/true)) { 4169 GNUCompatibleParamWarning Warn = { OldParm, NewParm, 4170 NewProto->getParamType(Idx) }; 4171 Warnings.push_back(Warn); 4172 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 4173 } else 4174 LooseCompatible = false; 4175 } 4176 4177 if (LooseCompatible) { 4178 for (unsigned Warn = 0; Warn < Warnings.size(); ++Warn) { 4179 Diag(Warnings[Warn].NewParm->getLocation(), 4180 diag::ext_param_promoted_not_compatible_with_prototype) 4181 << Warnings[Warn].PromotedType 4182 << Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getType(); 4183 if (Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation().isValid()) 4184 Diag(Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation(), 4185 diag::note_previous_declaration); 4186 } 4187 4188 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 4189 New->setType(Context.getFunctionType(MergedReturn, ArgTypes, 4190 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo())); 4191 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 4192 } 4193 4194 // Fall through to diagnose conflicting types. 4195 } 4196 4197 // A function that has already been declared has been redeclared or 4198 // defined with a different type; show an appropriate diagnostic. 4199 4200 // If the previous declaration was an implicitly-generated builtin 4201 // declaration, then at the very least we should use a specialized note. 4202 unsigned BuiltinID; 4203 if (Old->isImplicit() && (BuiltinID = Old->getBuiltinID())) { 4204 // If it's actually a library-defined builtin function like 'malloc' 4205 // or 'printf', just warn about the incompatible redeclaration. 4206 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID)) { 4207 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_redecl_library_builtin) << New; 4208 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration) 4209 << Old << Old->getType(); 4210 return false; 4211 } 4212 4213 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration; 4214 } 4215 4216 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New->getDeclName(); 4217 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 4218 return true; 4219 } 4220 4221 /// Completes the merge of two function declarations that are 4222 /// known to be compatible. 4223 /// 4224 /// This routine handles the merging of attributes and other 4225 /// properties of function declarations from the old declaration to 4226 /// the new declaration, once we know that New is in fact a 4227 /// redeclaration of Old. 4228 /// 4229 /// \returns false 4230 bool Sema::MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 4231 Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 4232 // Merge the attributes 4233 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 4234 4235 // Merge "pure" flag. 4236 if (Old->isPure()) 4237 New->setPure(); 4238 4239 // Merge "used" flag. 4240 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 4241 New->setIsUsed(); 4242 4243 // Merge attributes from the parameters. These can mismatch with K&R 4244 // declarations. 4245 if (New->getNumParams() == Old->getNumParams()) 4246 for (unsigned i = 0, e = New->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 4247 ParmVarDecl *NewParam = New->getParamDecl(i); 4248 ParmVarDecl *OldParam = Old->getParamDecl(i); 4249 mergeParamDeclAttributes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 4250 mergeParamDeclTypes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 4251 } 4252 4253 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4254 return MergeCXXFunctionDecl(New, Old, S); 4255 4256 // Merge the function types so the we get the composite types for the return 4257 // and argument types. Per C11 6.2.7/4, only update the type if the old decl 4258 // was visible. 4259 QualType Merged = Context.mergeTypes(Old->getType(), New->getType()); 4260 if (!Merged.isNull() && MergeTypeWithOld) 4261 New->setType(Merged); 4262 4263 return false; 4264 } 4265 4266 void Sema::mergeObjCMethodDecls(ObjCMethodDecl *newMethod, 4267 ObjCMethodDecl *oldMethod) { 4268 // Merge the attributes, including deprecated/unavailable 4269 AvailabilityMergeKind MergeKind = 4270 isa<ObjCProtocolDecl>(oldMethod->getDeclContext()) 4271 ? (oldMethod->isOptional() ? AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation 4272 : AMK_ProtocolImplementation) 4273 : isa<ObjCImplDecl>(newMethod->getDeclContext()) ? AMK_Redeclaration 4274 : AMK_Override; 4275 4276 mergeDeclAttributes(newMethod, oldMethod, MergeKind); 4277 4278 // Merge attributes from the parameters. 4279 ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator oi = oldMethod->param_begin(), 4280 oe = oldMethod->param_end(); 4281 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator 4282 ni = newMethod->param_begin(), ne = newMethod->param_end(); 4283 ni != ne && oi != oe; ++ni, ++oi) 4284 mergeParamDeclAttributes(*ni, *oi, *this); 4285 4286 CheckObjCMethodOverride(newMethod, oldMethod); 4287 } 4288 4289 static void diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(Sema &S, VarDecl *New, VarDecl* Old) { 4290 assert(!S.Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())); 4291 4292 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() 4293 ? diag::err_redefinition_different_type 4294 : diag::err_redeclaration_different_type) 4295 << New->getDeclName() << New->getType() << Old->getType(); 4296 4297 diag::kind PrevDiag; 4298 SourceLocation OldLocation; 4299 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) 4300 = getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 4301 S.Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4302 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4303 } 4304 4305 /// MergeVarDeclTypes - We parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name and 4306 /// scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to merge their types, 4307 /// emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 4308 /// 4309 /// Declarations using the auto type specifier (C++ [decl.spec.auto]) call back 4310 /// to here in AddInitializerToDecl. We can't check them before the initializer 4311 /// is attached. 4312 void Sema::MergeVarDeclTypes(VarDecl *New, VarDecl *Old, 4313 bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 4314 if (New->isInvalidDecl() || Old->isInvalidDecl()) 4315 return; 4316 4317 QualType MergedT; 4318 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4319 if (New->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 4320 // We don't know what the new type is until the initializer is attached. 4321 return; 4322 } else if (Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())) { 4323 // These could still be something that needs exception specs checked. 4324 return MergeVarDeclExceptionSpecs(New, Old); 4325 } 4326 // C++ [basic.link]p10: 4327 // [...] the types specified by all declarations referring to a given 4328 // object or function shall be identical, except that declarations for an 4329 // array object can specify array types that differ by the presence or 4330 // absence of a major array bound (8.3.4). 4331 else if (Old->getType()->isArrayType() && New->getType()->isArrayType()) { 4332 const ArrayType *OldArray = Context.getAsArrayType(Old->getType()); 4333 const ArrayType *NewArray = Context.getAsArrayType(New->getType()); 4334 4335 // We are merging a variable declaration New into Old. If it has an array 4336 // bound, and that bound differs from Old's bound, we should diagnose the 4337 // mismatch. 4338 if (!NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && !NewArray->isDependentType()) { 4339 for (VarDecl *PrevVD = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); PrevVD; 4340 PrevVD = PrevVD->getPreviousDecl()) { 4341 QualType PrevVDTy = PrevVD->getType(); 4342 if (PrevVDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() || PrevVDTy->isDependentType()) 4343 continue; 4344 4345 if (!Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), PrevVDTy)) 4346 return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, PrevVD); 4347 } 4348 } 4349 4350 if (OldArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && NewArray->isArrayType()) { 4351 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 4352 NewArray->getElementType())) 4353 MergedT = New->getType(); 4354 } 4355 // FIXME: Check visibility. New is hidden but has a complete type. If New 4356 // has no array bound, it should not inherit one from Old, if Old is not 4357 // visible. 4358 else if (OldArray->isArrayType() && NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 4359 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 4360 NewArray->getElementType())) 4361 MergedT = Old->getType(); 4362 } 4363 } 4364 else if (New->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 4365 Old->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 4366 MergedT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(New->getType(), 4367 Old->getType()); 4368 } 4369 } else { 4370 // C 6.2.7p2: 4371 // All declarations that refer to the same object or function shall have 4372 // compatible type. 4373 MergedT = Context.mergeTypes(New->getType(), Old->getType()); 4374 } 4375 if (MergedT.isNull()) { 4376 // It's OK if we couldn't merge types if either type is dependent, for a 4377 // block-scope variable. In other cases (static data members of class 4378 // templates, variable templates, ...), we require the types to be 4379 // equivalent. 4380 // FIXME: The C++ standard doesn't say anything about this. 4381 if ((New->getType()->isDependentType() || 4382 Old->getType()->isDependentType()) && New->isLocalVarDecl()) { 4383 // If the old type was dependent, we can't merge with it, so the new type 4384 // becomes dependent for now. We'll reproduce the original type when we 4385 // instantiate the TypeSourceInfo for the variable. 4386 if (!New->getType()->isDependentType() && MergeTypeWithOld) 4387 New->setType(Context.DependentTy); 4388 return; 4389 } 4390 return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, Old); 4391 } 4392 4393 // Don't actually update the type on the new declaration if the old 4394 // declaration was an extern declaration in a different scope. 4395 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 4396 New->setType(MergedT); 4397 } 4398 4399 static bool mergeTypeWithPrevious(Sema &S, VarDecl *NewVD, VarDecl *OldVD, 4400 LookupResult &Previous) { 4401 // C11 6.2.7p4: 4402 // For an identifier with internal or external linkage declared 4403 // in a scope in which a prior declaration of that identifier is 4404 // visible, if the prior declaration specifies internal or 4405 // external linkage, the type of the identifier at the later 4406 // declaration becomes the composite type. 4407 // 4408 // If the variable isn't visible, we do not merge with its type. 4409 if (Previous.isShadowed()) 4410 return false; 4411 4412 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4413 // C++11 [dcl.array]p3: 4414 // If there is a preceding declaration of the entity in the same 4415 // scope in which the bound was specified, an omitted array bound 4416 // is taken to be the same as in that earlier declaration. 4417 return NewVD->isPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope() || 4418 (!OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && 4419 !NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 4420 } else { 4421 // If the old declaration was function-local, don't merge with its 4422 // type unless we're in the same function. 4423 return !OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() || 4424 OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext() == NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 4425 } 4426 } 4427 4428 /// MergeVarDecl - We just parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name 4429 /// and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this 4430 /// situation, merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 4431 /// 4432 /// Tentative definition rules (C99 6.9.2p2) are checked by 4433 /// FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. Unfortunately, we can't analyze tentative 4434 /// definitions here, since the initializer hasn't been attached. 4435 /// 4436 void Sema::MergeVarDecl(VarDecl *New, LookupResult &Previous) { 4437 // If the new decl is already invalid, don't do any other checking. 4438 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4439 return; 4440 4441 if (!shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Previous, New)) 4442 return; 4443 4444 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedVarTemplate(); 4445 4446 // Verify the old decl was also a variable or variable template. 4447 VarDecl *Old = nullptr; 4448 VarTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = nullptr; 4449 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) { 4450 if (NewTemplate) { 4451 OldTemplate = dyn_cast<VarTemplateDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 4452 Old = OldTemplate ? OldTemplate->getTemplatedDecl() : nullptr; 4453 4454 if (auto *Shadow = 4455 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 4456 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, NewTemplate)) 4457 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4458 } else { 4459 Old = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 4460 4461 if (auto *Shadow = 4462 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 4463 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 4464 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4465 } 4466 } 4467 if (!Old) { 4468 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 4469 << New->getDeclName(); 4470 notePreviousDefinition(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(), 4471 New->getLocation()); 4472 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4473 } 4474 4475 // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new 4476 // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match. 4477 adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old); 4478 4479 // Ensure the template parameters are compatible. 4480 if (NewTemplate && 4481 !TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 4482 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 4483 /*Complain=*/true, TPL_TemplateMatch)) 4484 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4485 4486 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 4487 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification [...] 4488 // 4489 // Here, we need only consider static data members. 4490 if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && !New->isOutOfLine()) { 4491 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_duplicate_member) 4492 << New->getIdentifier(); 4493 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4494 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4495 } 4496 4497 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 4498 // Warn if an already-declared variable is made a weak_import in a subsequent 4499 // declaration 4500 if (New->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>() && 4501 Old->getStorageClass() == SC_None && 4502 !Old->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>()) { 4503 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_weak_import) << New->getDeclName(); 4504 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4505 // Remove weak_import attribute on new declaration. 4506 New->dropAttr<WeakImportAttr>(); 4507 } 4508 4509 if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) 4510 if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) { 4511 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 4512 << ILA; 4513 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4514 New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>(); 4515 } 4516 4517 // Merge the types. 4518 VarDecl *MostRecent = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); 4519 if (MostRecent != Old) { 4520 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, MostRecent, 4521 mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, MostRecent, Previous)); 4522 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4523 return; 4524 } 4525 4526 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, Old, mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, Old, Previous)); 4527 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4528 return; 4529 4530 diag::kind PrevDiag; 4531 SourceLocation OldLocation; 4532 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 4533 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 4534 4535 // [dcl.stc]p8: Check if we have a non-static decl followed by a static. 4536 if (New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 4537 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 4538 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) { 4539 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 4540 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) 4541 << New->getDeclName(); 4542 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4543 } else { 4544 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) 4545 << New->getDeclName(); 4546 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4547 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4548 } 4549 } 4550 // C99 6.2.2p4: 4551 // For an identifier declared with the storage-class specifier 4552 // extern in a scope in which a prior declaration of that 4553 // identifier is visible,23) if the prior declaration specifies 4554 // internal or external linkage, the linkage of the identifier at 4555 // the later declaration is the same as the linkage specified at 4556 // the prior declaration. If no prior declaration is visible, or 4557 // if the prior declaration specifies no linkage, then the 4558 // identifier has external linkage. 4559 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && Old->hasLinkage()) 4560 /* Okay */; 4561 else if (New->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() != SC_Static && 4562 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 4563 Old->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 4564 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_static_static) << New->getDeclName(); 4565 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4566 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4567 } 4568 4569 // Check if extern is followed by non-extern and vice-versa. 4570 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && 4571 !Old->hasLinkage() && Old->isLocalVarDeclOrParm()) { 4572 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_non_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 4573 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4574 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4575 } 4576 if (Old->hasLinkage() && New->isLocalVarDeclOrParm() && 4577 !New->hasExternalStorage()) { 4578 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_extern_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 4579 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4580 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4581 } 4582 4583 if (CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, Old)) 4584 return; 4585 4586 // Variables with external linkage are analyzed in FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. 4587 4588 // FIXME: The test for external storage here seems wrong? We still 4589 // need to check for mismatches. 4590 if (!New->hasExternalStorage() && !New->isFileVarDecl() && 4591 // Don't complain about out-of-line definitions of static members. 4592 !(Old->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 4593 !New->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord())) { 4594 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New->getDeclName(); 4595 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4596 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4597 } 4598 4599 if (New->isInline() && !Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isInline()) { 4600 if (VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition()) { 4601 // C++1z [dcl.fcn.spec]p4: 4602 // If the definition of a variable appears in a translation unit before 4603 // its first declaration as inline, the program is ill-formed. 4604 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_inline_decl_follows_def) << New; 4605 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 4606 } 4607 } 4608 4609 // If this redeclaration makes the variable inline, we may need to add it to 4610 // UndefinedButUsed. 4611 if (!Old->isInline() && New->isInline() && Old->isUsed(false) && 4612 !Old->getDefinition() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 4613 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(), 4614 SourceLocation())); 4615 4616 if (New->getTLSKind() != Old->getTLSKind()) { 4617 if (!Old->getTLSKind()) { 4618 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_non_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 4619 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4620 } else if (!New->getTLSKind()) { 4621 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_thread_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 4622 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4623 } else { 4624 // Do not allow redeclaration to change the variable between requiring 4625 // static and dynamic initialization. 4626 // FIXME: GCC allows this, but uses the TLS keyword on the first 4627 // declaration to determine the kind. Do we need to be compatible here? 4628 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_thread_different_kind) 4629 << New->getDeclName() << (New->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Dynamic); 4630 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4631 } 4632 } 4633 4634 // C++ doesn't have tentative definitions, so go right ahead and check here. 4635 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4636 if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isInline() && 4637 Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isConstexpr()) { 4638 // This definition won't be a definition any more once it's been merged. 4639 Diag(New->getLocation(), 4640 diag::warn_deprecated_redundant_constexpr_static_def); 4641 } else if (New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::Definition) { 4642 VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition(); 4643 if (Def && checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, New)) 4644 return; 4645 } 4646 } 4647 4648 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 4649 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 4650 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4651 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4652 return; 4653 } 4654 4655 // Merge "used" flag. 4656 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 4657 New->setIsUsed(); 4658 4659 // Keep a chain of previous declarations. 4660 New->setPreviousDecl(Old); 4661 if (NewTemplate) 4662 NewTemplate->setPreviousDecl(OldTemplate); 4663 4664 // Inherit access appropriately. 4665 New->setAccess(Old->getAccess()); 4666 if (NewTemplate) 4667 NewTemplate->setAccess(New->getAccess()); 4668 4669 if (Old->isInline()) 4670 New->setImplicitlyInline(); 4671 } 4672 4673 void Sema::notePreviousDefinition(const NamedDecl *Old, SourceLocation New) { 4674 SourceManager &SrcMgr = getSourceManager(); 4675 auto FNewDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(New); 4676 auto FOldDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(Old->getLocation()); 4677 auto *FNew = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FNewDecLoc.first); 4678 auto *FOld = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FOldDecLoc.first); 4679 auto &HSI = PP.getHeaderSearchInfo(); 4680 StringRef HdrFilename = 4681 SrcMgr.getFilename(SrcMgr.getSpellingLoc(Old->getLocation())); 4682 4683 auto noteFromModuleOrInclude = [&](Module *Mod, 4684 SourceLocation IncLoc) -> bool { 4685 // Redefinition errors with modules are common with non modular mapped 4686 // headers, example: a non-modular header H in module A that also gets 4687 // included directly in a TU. Pointing twice to the same header/definition 4688 // is confusing, try to get better diagnostics when modules is on. 4689 if (IncLoc.isValid()) { 4690 if (Mod) { 4691 Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_modules_same_file) 4692 << HdrFilename.str() << Mod->getFullModuleName(); 4693 if (!Mod->DefinitionLoc.isInvalid()) 4694 Diag(Mod->DefinitionLoc, diag::note_defined_here) 4695 << Mod->getFullModuleName(); 4696 } else { 4697 Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_include_same_file) 4698 << HdrFilename.str(); 4699 } 4700 return true; 4701 } 4702 4703 return false; 4704 }; 4705 4706 // Is it the same file and same offset? Provide more information on why 4707 // this leads to a redefinition error. 4708 if (FNew == FOld && FNewDecLoc.second == FOldDecLoc.second) { 4709 SourceLocation OldIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FOldDecLoc.first); 4710 SourceLocation NewIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FNewDecLoc.first); 4711 bool EmittedDiag = 4712 noteFromModuleOrInclude(Old->getOwningModule(), OldIncLoc); 4713 EmittedDiag |= noteFromModuleOrInclude(getCurrentModule(), NewIncLoc); 4714 4715 // If the header has no guards, emit a note suggesting one. 4716 if (FOld && !HSI.isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(FOld)) 4717 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_use_ifdef_guards); 4718 4719 if (EmittedDiag) 4720 return; 4721 } 4722 4723 // Redefinition coming from different files or couldn't do better above. 4724 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 4725 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 4726 } 4727 4728 /// We've just determined that \p Old and \p New both appear to be definitions 4729 /// of the same variable. Either diagnose or fix the problem. 4730 bool Sema::checkVarDeclRedefinition(VarDecl *Old, VarDecl *New) { 4731 if (!hasVisibleDefinition(Old) && 4732 (New->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 4733 New->isInline() || 4734 New->getDescribedVarTemplate() || 4735 New->getNumTemplateParameterLists() || 4736 New->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())) { 4737 // The previous definition is hidden, and multiple definitions are 4738 // permitted (in separate TUs). Demote this to a declaration. 4739 New->demoteThisDefinitionToDeclaration(); 4740 4741 // Make the canonical definition visible. 4742 if (auto *OldTD = Old->getDescribedVarTemplate()) 4743 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(OldTD); 4744 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Old); 4745 return false; 4746 } else { 4747 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New; 4748 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 4749 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4750 return true; 4751 } 4752 } 4753 4754 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 4755 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. 4756 Decl *Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, 4757 DeclSpec &DS, 4758 const ParsedAttributesView &DeclAttrs, 4759 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) { 4760 return ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec( 4761 S, AS, DS, DeclAttrs, MultiTemplateParamsArg(), false, AnonRecord); 4762 } 4763 4764 // The MS ABI changed between VS2013 and VS2015 with regard to numbers used to 4765 // disambiguate entities defined in different scopes. 4766 // While the VS2015 ABI fixes potential miscompiles, it is also breaks 4767 // compatibility. 4768 // We will pick our mangling number depending on which version of MSVC is being 4769 // targeted. 4770 static unsigned getMSManglingNumber(const LangOptions &LO, Scope *S) { 4771 return LO.isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) 4772 ? S->getMSCurManglingNumber() 4773 : S->getMSLastManglingNumber(); 4774 } 4775 4776 void Sema::handleTagNumbering(const TagDecl *Tag, Scope *TagScope) { 4777 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4778 return; 4779 4780 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag->getParent())) { 4781 // If this tag is the direct child of a class, number it if 4782 // it is anonymous. 4783 if (!Tag->getName().empty() || Tag->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 4784 return; 4785 MangleNumberingContext &MCtx = 4786 Context.getManglingNumberContext(Tag->getParent()); 4787 Context.setManglingNumber( 4788 Tag, MCtx.getManglingNumber( 4789 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 4790 return; 4791 } 4792 4793 // If this tag isn't a direct child of a class, number it if it is local. 4794 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 4795 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 4796 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 4797 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Tag->getDeclContext()); 4798 if (MCtx) { 4799 Context.setManglingNumber( 4800 Tag, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 4801 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 4802 } 4803 } 4804 4805 namespace { 4806 struct NonCLikeKind { 4807 enum { 4808 None, 4809 BaseClass, 4810 DefaultMemberInit, 4811 Lambda, 4812 Friend, 4813 OtherMember, 4814 Invalid, 4815 } Kind = None; 4816 SourceRange Range; 4817 4818 explicit operator bool() { return Kind != None; } 4819 }; 4820 } 4821 4822 /// Determine whether a class is C-like, according to the rules of C++ 4823 /// [dcl.typedef] for anonymous classes with typedef names for linkage. 4824 static NonCLikeKind getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 4825 if (RD->isInvalidDecl()) 4826 return {NonCLikeKind::Invalid, {}}; 4827 4828 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1] 4829 // An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall not 4830 // 4831 // -- have any base classes 4832 if (RD->getNumBases()) 4833 return {NonCLikeKind::BaseClass, 4834 SourceRange(RD->bases_begin()->getBeginLoc(), 4835 RD->bases_end()[-1].getEndLoc())}; 4836 bool Invalid = false; 4837 for (Decl *D : RD->decls()) { 4838 // Don't complain about things we already diagnosed. 4839 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) { 4840 Invalid = true; 4841 continue; 4842 } 4843 4844 // -- have any [...] default member initializers 4845 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D)) { 4846 if (FD->hasInClassInitializer()) { 4847 auto *Init = FD->getInClassInitializer(); 4848 return {NonCLikeKind::DefaultMemberInit, 4849 Init ? Init->getSourceRange() : D->getSourceRange()}; 4850 } 4851 continue; 4852 } 4853 4854 // FIXME: We don't allow friend declarations. This violates the wording of 4855 // P1766, but not the intent. 4856 if (isa<FriendDecl>(D)) 4857 return {NonCLikeKind::Friend, D->getSourceRange()}; 4858 4859 // -- declare any members other than non-static data members, member 4860 // enumerations, or member classes, 4861 if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D) || 4862 isa<EnumDecl>(D)) 4863 continue; 4864 auto *MemberRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D); 4865 if (!MemberRD) { 4866 if (D->isImplicit()) 4867 continue; 4868 return {NonCLikeKind::OtherMember, D->getSourceRange()}; 4869 } 4870 4871 // -- contain a lambda-expression, 4872 if (MemberRD->isLambda()) 4873 return {NonCLikeKind::Lambda, MemberRD->getSourceRange()}; 4874 4875 // and all member classes shall also satisfy these requirements 4876 // (recursively). 4877 if (MemberRD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 4878 if (auto Kind = getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(MemberRD)) 4879 return Kind; 4880 } 4881 } 4882 4883 return {Invalid ? NonCLikeKind::Invalid : NonCLikeKind::None, {}}; 4884 } 4885 4886 void Sema::setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(TagDecl *TagFromDeclSpec, 4887 TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 4888 if (TagFromDeclSpec->isInvalidDecl()) 4889 return; 4890 4891 // Do nothing if the tag already has a name for linkage purposes. 4892 if (TagFromDeclSpec->hasNameForLinkage()) 4893 return; 4894 4895 // A well-formed anonymous tag must always be a TUK_Definition. 4896 assert(TagFromDeclSpec->isThisDeclarationADefinition()); 4897 4898 // The type must match the tag exactly; no qualifiers allowed. 4899 if (!Context.hasSameType(NewTD->getUnderlyingType(), 4900 Context.getTagDeclType(TagFromDeclSpec))) { 4901 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4902 Context.addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagFromDeclSpec, NewTD); 4903 return; 4904 } 4905 4906 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1, applied as DR] 4907 // An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall [be 4908 // C-like]. 4909 // 4910 // FIXME: Also diagnose if we've already computed the linkage. That ideally 4911 // shouldn't happen, but there are constructs that the language rule doesn't 4912 // disallow for which we can't reasonably avoid computing linkage early. 4913 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagFromDeclSpec); 4914 NonCLikeKind NonCLike = RD ? getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(RD) 4915 : NonCLikeKind(); 4916 bool ChangesLinkage = TagFromDeclSpec->hasLinkageBeenComputed(); 4917 if (NonCLike || ChangesLinkage) { 4918 if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::Invalid) 4919 return; 4920 4921 unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef; 4922 if (ChangesLinkage) { 4923 // If the linkage changes, we can't accept this as an extension. 4924 if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::None) 4925 DiagID = diag::err_typedef_changes_linkage; 4926 else 4927 DiagID = diag::err_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef; 4928 } 4929 4930 SourceLocation FixitLoc = 4931 getLocForEndOfToken(TagFromDeclSpec->getInnerLocStart()); 4932 llvm::SmallString<40> TextToInsert; 4933 TextToInsert += ' '; 4934 TextToInsert += NewTD->getIdentifier()->getName(); 4935 4936 Diag(FixitLoc, DiagID) 4937 << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD) 4938 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FixitLoc, TextToInsert); 4939 if (NonCLike.Kind != NonCLikeKind::None) { 4940 Diag(NonCLike.Range.getBegin(), diag::note_non_c_like_anon_struct) 4941 << NonCLike.Kind - 1 << NonCLike.Range; 4942 } 4943 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::note_typedef_for_linkage_here) 4944 << NewTD << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD); 4945 4946 if (ChangesLinkage) 4947 return; 4948 } 4949 4950 // Otherwise, set this as the anon-decl typedef for the tag. 4951 TagFromDeclSpec->setTypedefNameForAnonDecl(NewTD); 4952 } 4953 4954 static unsigned GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DeclSpec::TST T) { 4955 switch (T) { 4956 case DeclSpec::TST_class: 4957 return 0; 4958 case DeclSpec::TST_struct: 4959 return 1; 4960 case DeclSpec::TST_interface: 4961 return 2; 4962 case DeclSpec::TST_union: 4963 return 3; 4964 case DeclSpec::TST_enum: 4965 return 4; 4966 default: 4967 llvm_unreachable("unexpected type specifier"); 4968 } 4969 } 4970 4971 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 4972 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. It also accepts template 4973 /// parameters to cope with template friend declarations. 4974 Decl *Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, 4975 DeclSpec &DS, 4976 const ParsedAttributesView &DeclAttrs, 4977 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams, 4978 bool IsExplicitInstantiation, 4979 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) { 4980 Decl *TagD = nullptr; 4981 TagDecl *Tag = nullptr; 4982 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_class || 4983 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 4984 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 4985 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_union || 4986 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 4987 TagD = DS.getRepAsDecl(); 4988 4989 if (!TagD) // We probably had an error 4990 return nullptr; 4991 4992 // Note that the above type specs guarantee that the 4993 // type rep is a Decl, whereas in many of the others 4994 // it's a Type. 4995 if (isa<TagDecl>(TagD)) 4996 Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 4997 else if (ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TagD)) 4998 Tag = CTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 4999 } 5000 5001 if (Tag) { 5002 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 5003 Tag->setFreeStanding(); 5004 if (Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 5005 return Tag; 5006 } 5007 5008 if (unsigned TypeQuals = DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 5009 // Enforce C99 6.7.3p2: "Types other than pointer types derived from object 5010 // or incomplete types shall not be restrict-qualified." 5011 if (TypeQuals & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 5012 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 5013 diag::err_typecheck_invalid_restrict_not_pointer_noarg) 5014 << DS.getSourceRange(); 5015 } 5016 5017 if (DS.isInlineSpecified()) 5018 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 5019 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 5020 5021 if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) { 5022 // C++0x [dcl.constexpr]p1: constexpr can only be applied to declarations 5023 // and definitions of functions and variables. 5024 // C++2a [dcl.constexpr]p1: The consteval specifier shall be applied only to 5025 // the declaration of a function or function template 5026 if (Tag) 5027 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_tag) 5028 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) 5029 << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier()); 5030 else 5031 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 5032 << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier()); 5033 // Don't emit warnings after this error. 5034 return TagD; 5035 } 5036 5037 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 5038 5039 if (DS.isFriendSpecified()) { 5040 // If we're dealing with a decl but not a TagDecl, assume that 5041 // whatever routines created it handled the friendship aspect. 5042 if (TagD && !Tag) 5043 return nullptr; 5044 return ActOnFriendTypeDecl(S, DS, TemplateParams); 5045 } 5046 5047 const CXXScopeSpec &SS = DS.getTypeSpecScope(); 5048 bool IsExplicitSpecialization = 5049 !TemplateParams.empty() && TemplateParams.back()->size() == 0; 5050 if (Tag && SS.isNotEmpty() && !Tag->isCompleteDefinition() && 5051 !IsExplicitInstantiation && !IsExplicitSpecialization && 5052 !isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Tag)) { 5053 // Per C++ [dcl.type.elab]p1, a class declaration cannot have a 5054 // nested-name-specifier unless it is an explicit instantiation 5055 // or an explicit specialization. 5056 // 5057 // FIXME: We allow class template partial specializations here too, per the 5058 // obvious intent of DR1819. 5059 // 5060 // Per C++ [dcl.enum]p1, an opaque-enum-declaration can't either. 5061 Diag(SS.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_standalone_class_nested_name_specifier) 5062 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) << SS.getRange(); 5063 return nullptr; 5064 } 5065 5066 // Track whether this decl-specifier declares anything. 5067 bool DeclaresAnything = true; 5068 5069 // Handle anonymous struct definitions. 5070 if (RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(Tag)) { 5071 if (!Record->getDeclName() && Record->isCompleteDefinition() && 5072 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 5073 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 5074 Record->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) { 5075 // If CurContext is a DeclContext that can contain statements, 5076 // RecursiveASTVisitor won't visit the decls that 5077 // BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion() will put into CurContext. 5078 // Also store them here so that they can be part of the 5079 // DeclStmt that gets created in this case. 5080 // FIXME: Also return the IndirectFieldDecls created by 5081 // BuildAnonymousStructOr union, for the same reason? 5082 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 5083 AnonRecord = Record; 5084 return BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(S, DS, AS, Record, 5085 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 5086 } 5087 5088 DeclaresAnything = false; 5089 } 5090 } 5091 5092 // C11 6.7.2.1p2: 5093 // A struct-declaration that does not declare an anonymous structure or 5094 // anonymous union shall contain a struct-declarator-list. 5095 // 5096 // This rule also existed in C89 and C99; the grammar for struct-declaration 5097 // did not permit a struct-declaration without a struct-declarator-list. 5098 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && CurContext->isRecord() && 5099 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 5100 // Check for Microsoft C extension: anonymous struct/union member. 5101 // Handle 2 kinds of anonymous struct/union: 5102 // struct STRUCT; 5103 // union UNION; 5104 // and 5105 // STRUCT_TYPE; <- where STRUCT_TYPE is a typedef struct. 5106 // UNION_TYPE; <- where UNION_TYPE is a typedef union. 5107 if ((Tag && Tag->getDeclName()) || 5108 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_typename) { 5109 RecordDecl *Record = nullptr; 5110 if (Tag) 5111 Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag); 5112 else if (const RecordType *RT = 5113 DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsStructureType()) 5114 Record = RT->getDecl(); 5115 else if (const RecordType *UT = DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsUnionType()) 5116 Record = UT->getDecl(); 5117 5118 if (Record && getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 5119 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_ms_anonymous_record) 5120 << Record->isUnion() << DS.getSourceRange(); 5121 return BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(S, DS, Record); 5122 } 5123 5124 DeclaresAnything = false; 5125 } 5126 } 5127 5128 // Skip all the checks below if we have a type error. 5129 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_error || 5130 (TagD && TagD->isInvalidDecl())) 5131 return TagD; 5132 5133 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 5134 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5135 if (EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(Tag)) 5136 if (Enum->enumerator_begin() == Enum->enumerator_end() && 5137 !Enum->getIdentifier() && !Enum->isInvalidDecl()) 5138 DeclaresAnything = false; 5139 5140 if (!DS.isMissingDeclaratorOk()) { 5141 // Customize diagnostic for a typedef missing a name. 5142 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5143 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typedef_without_a_name) 5144 << DS.getSourceRange(); 5145 else 5146 DeclaresAnything = false; 5147 } 5148 5149 if (DS.isModulePrivateSpecified() && 5150 Tag && Tag->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 5151 Diag(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc(), diag::err_module_private_local_class) 5152 << Tag->getTagKind() 5153 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 5154 5155 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 5156 5157 // C 6.7/2: 5158 // A declaration [...] shall declare at least a declarator [...], a tag, 5159 // or the members of an enumeration. 5160 // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3: 5161 // [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an 5162 // unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more 5163 // names into the program, or shall redeclare a name introduced by a 5164 // previous declaration. 5165 if (!DeclaresAnything) { 5166 // In C, we allow this as a (popular) extension / bug. Don't bother 5167 // producing further diagnostics for redundant qualifiers after this. 5168 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), (IsExplicitInstantiation || !TemplateParams.empty()) 5169 ? diag::err_no_declarators 5170 : diag::ext_no_declarators) 5171 << DS.getSourceRange(); 5172 return TagD; 5173 } 5174 5175 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 5176 // If a storage-class-specifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, [...] the 5177 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 5178 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p1: 5179 // If a cv-qualifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, the 5180 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 5181 // 5182 // Spurious qualifiers here appear to be valid in C. 5183 unsigned DiagID = diag::warn_standalone_specifier; 5184 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5185 DiagID = diag::ext_standalone_specifier; 5186 5187 // Note that a linkage-specification sets a storage class, but 5188 // 'extern "C" struct foo;' is actually valid and not theoretically 5189 // useless. 5190 if (DeclSpec::SCS SCS = DS.getStorageClassSpec()) { 5191 if (SCS == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) 5192 // Since mutable is not a viable storage class specifier in C, there is 5193 // no reason to treat it as an extension. Instead, diagnose as an error. 5194 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 5195 else if (!DS.isExternInLinkageSpec() && SCS != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5196 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 5197 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(SCS); 5198 } 5199 5200 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 5201 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 5202 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 5203 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 5204 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 5205 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "const"; 5206 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 5207 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "volatile"; 5208 // Restrict is covered above. 5209 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 5210 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "_Atomic"; 5211 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned) 5212 Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "__unaligned"; 5213 } 5214 5215 // Warn about ignored type attributes, for example: 5216 // __attribute__((aligned)) struct A; 5217 // Attributes should be placed after tag to apply to type declaration. 5218 if (!DS.getAttributes().empty() || !DeclAttrs.empty()) { 5219 DeclSpec::TST TypeSpecType = DS.getTypeSpecType(); 5220 if (TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_class || 5221 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 5222 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 5223 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_union || 5224 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 5225 for (const ParsedAttr &AL : DS.getAttributes()) 5226 Diag(AL.getLoc(), diag::warn_declspec_attribute_ignored) 5227 << AL << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(TypeSpecType); 5228 for (const ParsedAttr &AL : DeclAttrs) 5229 Diag(AL.getLoc(), diag::warn_declspec_attribute_ignored) 5230 << AL << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(TypeSpecType); 5231 } 5232 } 5233 5234 return TagD; 5235 } 5236 5237 /// We are trying to inject an anonymous member into the given scope; 5238 /// check if there's an existing declaration that can't be overloaded. 5239 /// 5240 /// \return true if this is a forbidden redeclaration 5241 static bool CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(Sema &SemaRef, 5242 Scope *S, 5243 DeclContext *Owner, 5244 DeclarationName Name, 5245 SourceLocation NameLoc, 5246 bool IsUnion) { 5247 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupMemberName, 5248 Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 5249 if (!SemaRef.LookupName(R, S)) return false; 5250 5251 // Pick a representative declaration. 5252 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getRepresentativeDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 5253 assert(PrevDecl && "Expected a non-null Decl"); 5254 5255 if (!SemaRef.isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Owner, S)) 5256 return false; 5257 5258 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_anonymous_record_member_redecl) 5259 << IsUnion << Name; 5260 SemaRef.Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 5261 5262 return true; 5263 } 5264 5265 /// InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers - Inject the members of the 5266 /// anonymous struct or union AnonRecord into the owning context Owner 5267 /// and scope S. This routine will be invoked just after we realize 5268 /// that an unnamed union or struct is actually an anonymous union or 5269 /// struct, e.g., 5270 /// 5271 /// @code 5272 /// union { 5273 /// int i; 5274 /// float f; 5275 /// }; // InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers called here to inject i and 5276 /// // f into the surrounding scope.x 5277 /// @endcode 5278 /// 5279 /// This routine is recursive, injecting the names of nested anonymous 5280 /// structs/unions into the owning context and scope as well. 5281 static bool 5282 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, DeclContext *Owner, 5283 RecordDecl *AnonRecord, AccessSpecifier AS, 5284 SmallVectorImpl<NamedDecl *> &Chaining) { 5285 bool Invalid = false; 5286 5287 // Look every FieldDecl and IndirectFieldDecl with a name. 5288 for (auto *D : AnonRecord->decls()) { 5289 if ((isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D)) && 5290 cast<NamedDecl>(D)->getDeclName()) { 5291 ValueDecl *VD = cast<ValueDecl>(D); 5292 if (CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(SemaRef, S, Owner, VD->getDeclName(), 5293 VD->getLocation(), 5294 AnonRecord->isUnion())) { 5295 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5296 // The names of the members of an anonymous union shall be 5297 // distinct from the names of any other entity in the 5298 // scope in which the anonymous union is declared. 5299 Invalid = true; 5300 } else { 5301 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5302 // For the purpose of name lookup, after the anonymous union 5303 // definition, the members of the anonymous union are 5304 // considered to have been defined in the scope in which the 5305 // anonymous union is declared. 5306 unsigned OldChainingSize = Chaining.size(); 5307 if (IndirectFieldDecl *IF = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 5308 Chaining.append(IF->chain_begin(), IF->chain_end()); 5309 else 5310 Chaining.push_back(VD); 5311 5312 assert(Chaining.size() >= 2); 5313 NamedDecl **NamedChain = 5314 new (SemaRef.Context)NamedDecl*[Chaining.size()]; 5315 for (unsigned i = 0; i < Chaining.size(); i++) 5316 NamedChain[i] = Chaining[i]; 5317 5318 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectField = IndirectFieldDecl::Create( 5319 SemaRef.Context, Owner, VD->getLocation(), VD->getIdentifier(), 5320 VD->getType(), {NamedChain, Chaining.size()}); 5321 5322 for (const auto *Attr : VD->attrs()) 5323 IndirectField->addAttr(Attr->clone(SemaRef.Context)); 5324 5325 IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 5326 IndirectField->setImplicit(); 5327 SemaRef.PushOnScopeChains(IndirectField, S); 5328 5329 // That includes picking up the appropriate access specifier. 5330 if (AS != AS_none) IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 5331 5332 Chaining.resize(OldChainingSize); 5333 } 5334 } 5335 } 5336 5337 return Invalid; 5338 } 5339 5340 /// StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass - Maps a DeclSpec::SCS to 5341 /// a VarDecl::StorageClass. Any error reporting is up to the caller: 5342 /// illegal input values are mapped to SC_None. 5343 static StorageClass 5344 StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(const DeclSpec &DS) { 5345 DeclSpec::SCS StorageClassSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 5346 assert(StorageClassSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && 5347 "Parser allowed 'typedef' as storage class VarDecl."); 5348 switch (StorageClassSpec) { 5349 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: return SC_None; 5350 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 5351 if (DS.isExternInLinkageSpec()) 5352 return SC_None; 5353 return SC_Extern; 5354 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: return SC_Static; 5355 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: return SC_Auto; 5356 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: return SC_Register; 5357 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 5358 // Illegal SCSs map to None: error reporting is up to the caller. 5359 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: // Fall through. 5360 case DeclSpec::SCS_typedef: return SC_None; 5361 } 5362 llvm_unreachable("unknown storage class specifier"); 5363 } 5364 5365 static SourceLocation findDefaultInitializer(const CXXRecordDecl *Record) { 5366 assert(Record->hasInClassInitializer()); 5367 5368 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 5369 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(I); 5370 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 5371 FD = IFD->getAnonField(); 5372 if (FD && FD->hasInClassInitializer()) 5373 return FD->getLocation(); 5374 } 5375 5376 llvm_unreachable("couldn't find in-class initializer"); 5377 } 5378 5379 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 5380 SourceLocation DefaultInitLoc) { 5381 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 5382 return; 5383 5384 S.Diag(DefaultInitLoc, diag::err_multiple_mem_union_initialization); 5385 S.Diag(findDefaultInitializer(Parent), diag::note_previous_initializer) << 0; 5386 } 5387 5388 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 5389 CXXRecordDecl *AnonUnion) { 5390 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 5391 return; 5392 5393 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(S, Parent, findDefaultInitializer(AnonUnion)); 5394 } 5395 5396 /// BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion - Handle the declaration of an 5397 /// anonymous structure or union. Anonymous unions are a C++ feature 5398 /// (C++ [class.union]) and a C11 feature; anonymous structures 5399 /// are a C11 feature and GNU C++ extension. 5400 Decl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 5401 AccessSpecifier AS, 5402 RecordDecl *Record, 5403 const PrintingPolicy &Policy) { 5404 DeclContext *Owner = Record->getDeclContext(); 5405 5406 // Diagnose whether this anonymous struct/union is an extension. 5407 if (Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().C11) 5408 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_union); 5409 else if (!Record->isUnion() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5410 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_gnu_anonymous_struct); 5411 else if (!Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().C11) 5412 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_c11_anonymous_struct); 5413 5414 // C and C++ require different kinds of checks for anonymous 5415 // structs/unions. 5416 bool Invalid = false; 5417 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5418 const char *PrevSpec = nullptr; 5419 if (Record->isUnion()) { 5420 // C++ [class.union]p6: 5421 // C++17 [class.union.anon]p2: 5422 // Anonymous unions declared in a named namespace or in the 5423 // global namespace shall be declared static. 5424 unsigned DiagID; 5425 DeclContext *OwnerScope = Owner->getRedeclContext(); 5426 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static && 5427 (OwnerScope->isTranslationUnit() || 5428 (OwnerScope->isNamespace() && 5429 !cast<NamespaceDecl>(OwnerScope)->isAnonymousNamespace()))) { 5430 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_union_not_static) 5431 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Record->getLocation(), "static "); 5432 5433 // Recover by adding 'static'. 5434 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_static, SourceLocation(), 5435 PrevSpec, DiagID, Policy); 5436 } 5437 // C++ [class.union]p6: 5438 // A storage class is not allowed in a declaration of an 5439 // anonymous union in a class scope. 5440 else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified && 5441 isa<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 5442 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 5443 diag::err_anonymous_union_with_storage_spec) 5444 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 5445 5446 // Recover by removing the storage specifier. 5447 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified, 5448 SourceLocation(), 5449 PrevSpec, DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 5450 } 5451 } 5452 5453 // Ignore const/volatile/restrict qualifiers. 5454 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 5455 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 5456 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5457 << Record->isUnion() << "const" 5458 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstSpecLoc()); 5459 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 5460 Diag(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc(), 5461 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5462 << Record->isUnion() << "volatile" 5463 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc()); 5464 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 5465 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 5466 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5467 << Record->isUnion() << "restrict" 5468 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc()); 5469 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 5470 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), 5471 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5472 << Record->isUnion() << "_Atomic" 5473 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc()); 5474 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned) 5475 Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), 5476 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5477 << Record->isUnion() << "__unaligned" 5478 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc()); 5479 5480 DS.ClearTypeQualifiers(); 5481 } 5482 5483 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5484 // The member-specification of an anonymous union shall only 5485 // define non-static data members. [Note: nested types and 5486 // functions cannot be declared within an anonymous union. ] 5487 for (auto *Mem : Record->decls()) { 5488 // Ignore invalid declarations; we already diagnosed them. 5489 if (Mem->isInvalidDecl()) 5490 continue; 5491 5492 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Mem)) { 5493 // C++ [class.union]p3: 5494 // An anonymous union shall not have private or protected 5495 // members (clause 11). 5496 assert(FD->getAccess() != AS_none); 5497 if (FD->getAccess() != AS_public) { 5498 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_nonpublic_member) 5499 << Record->isUnion() << (FD->getAccess() == AS_protected); 5500 Invalid = true; 5501 } 5502 5503 // C++ [class.union]p1 5504 // An object of a class with a non-trivial constructor, a non-trivial 5505 // copy constructor, a non-trivial destructor, or a non-trivial copy 5506 // assignment operator cannot be a member of a union, nor can an 5507 // array of such objects. 5508 if (CheckNontrivialField(FD)) 5509 Invalid = true; 5510 } else if (Mem->isImplicit()) { 5511 // Any implicit members are fine. 5512 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(Mem) && Mem->getDeclContext() != Record) { 5513 // This is a type that showed up in an 5514 // elaborated-type-specifier inside the anonymous struct or 5515 // union, but which actually declares a type outside of the 5516 // anonymous struct or union. It's okay. 5517 } else if (auto *MemRecord = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Mem)) { 5518 if (!MemRecord->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() && 5519 MemRecord->getDeclName()) { 5520 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 5521 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 5522 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 5523 << Record->isUnion(); 5524 else { 5525 // This is a nested type declaration. 5526 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 5527 << Record->isUnion(); 5528 Invalid = true; 5529 } 5530 } else { 5531 // This is an anonymous type definition within another anonymous type. 5532 // This is a popular extension, provided by Plan9, MSVC and GCC, but 5533 // not part of standard C++. 5534 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), 5535 diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_anonymous_type) 5536 << Record->isUnion(); 5537 } 5538 } else if (isa<AccessSpecDecl>(Mem)) { 5539 // Any access specifier is fine. 5540 } else if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(Mem)) { 5541 // In C++1z, static_assert declarations are also fine. 5542 } else { 5543 // We have something that isn't a non-static data 5544 // member. Complain about it. 5545 unsigned DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_bad_member; 5546 if (isa<TypeDecl>(Mem)) 5547 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type; 5548 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Mem)) 5549 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_function; 5550 else if (isa<VarDecl>(Mem)) 5551 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_static; 5552 5553 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 5554 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && 5555 DK == diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 5556 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 5557 << Record->isUnion(); 5558 else { 5559 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), DK) << Record->isUnion(); 5560 Invalid = true; 5561 } 5562 } 5563 } 5564 5565 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 5566 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 5567 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 5568 if (cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)->hasInClassInitializer() && 5569 Owner->isRecord()) 5570 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Owner), 5571 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)); 5572 } 5573 5574 if (!Record->isUnion() && !Owner->isRecord()) { 5575 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_struct_not_member) 5576 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 5577 Invalid = true; 5578 } 5579 5580 // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3: 5581 // [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an 5582 // unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more 5583 // names into the program 5584 // C++ [class.mem]p2: 5585 // each such member-declaration shall either declare at least one member 5586 // name of the class or declare at least one unnamed bit-field 5587 // 5588 // For C this is an error even for a named struct, and is diagnosed elsewhere. 5589 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Record->field_empty()) 5590 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_no_declarators) << DS.getSourceRange(); 5591 5592 // Mock up a declarator. 5593 Declarator Dc(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::Member); 5594 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 5595 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct/union"); 5596 5597 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct/union. 5598 NamedDecl *Anon = nullptr; 5599 if (RecordDecl *OwningClass = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 5600 Anon = FieldDecl::Create( 5601 Context, OwningClass, DS.getBeginLoc(), Record->getLocation(), 5602 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, 5603 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 5604 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 5605 Anon->setAccess(AS); 5606 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, Anon, Dc); 5607 5608 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5609 FieldCollector->Add(cast<FieldDecl>(Anon)); 5610 } else { 5611 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 5612 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(DS); 5613 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 5614 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 5615 // an error here 5616 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 5617 Invalid = true; 5618 SC = SC_None; 5619 } 5620 5621 assert(DS.getAttributes().empty() && "No attribute expected"); 5622 Anon = VarDecl::Create(Context, Owner, DS.getBeginLoc(), 5623 Record->getLocation(), /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, 5624 Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, SC); 5625 5626 // Default-initialize the implicit variable. This initialization will be 5627 // trivial in almost all cases, except if a union member has an in-class 5628 // initializer: 5629 // union { int n = 0; }; 5630 ActOnUninitializedDecl(Anon); 5631 } 5632 Anon->setImplicit(); 5633 5634 // Mark this as an anonymous struct/union type. 5635 Record->setAnonymousStructOrUnion(true); 5636 5637 // Add the anonymous struct/union object to the current 5638 // context. We'll be referencing this object when we refer to one of 5639 // its members. 5640 Owner->addDecl(Anon); 5641 5642 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct/union into the owning 5643 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 5644 // purposes. 5645 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 5646 Chain.push_back(Anon); 5647 5648 if (InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, Owner, Record, AS, Chain)) 5649 Invalid = true; 5650 5651 if (VarDecl *NewVD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Anon)) { 5652 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 5653 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 5654 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 5655 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 5656 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext()); 5657 if (MCtx) { 5658 Context.setManglingNumber( 5659 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 5660 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 5661 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 5662 } 5663 } 5664 } 5665 5666 if (Invalid) 5667 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 5668 5669 return Anon; 5670 } 5671 5672 /// BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct - Handle the declaration of an 5673 /// Microsoft C anonymous structure. 5674 /// Ref: http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/z2cx9y4f.aspx 5675 /// Example: 5676 /// 5677 /// struct A { int a; }; 5678 /// struct B { struct A; int b; }; 5679 /// 5680 /// void foo() { 5681 /// B var; 5682 /// var.a = 3; 5683 /// } 5684 /// 5685 Decl *Sema::BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 5686 RecordDecl *Record) { 5687 assert(Record && "expected a record!"); 5688 5689 // Mock up a declarator. 5690 Declarator Dc(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::TypeName); 5691 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 5692 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct"); 5693 5694 auto *ParentDecl = cast<RecordDecl>(CurContext); 5695 QualType RecTy = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 5696 5697 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct. 5698 NamedDecl *Anon = 5699 FieldDecl::Create(Context, ParentDecl, DS.getBeginLoc(), DS.getBeginLoc(), 5700 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, RecTy, TInfo, 5701 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 5702 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 5703 Anon->setImplicit(); 5704 5705 // Add the anonymous struct object to the current context. 5706 CurContext->addDecl(Anon); 5707 5708 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct into the current 5709 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 5710 // purposes. 5711 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 5712 Chain.push_back(Anon); 5713 5714 RecordDecl *RecordDef = Record->getDefinition(); 5715 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Anon->getLocation(), RecTy, 5716 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless) || 5717 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, CurContext, RecordDef, 5718 AS_none, Chain)) { 5719 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 5720 ParentDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 5721 } 5722 5723 return Anon; 5724 } 5725 5726 /// GetNameForDeclarator - Determine the full declaration name for the 5727 /// given Declarator. 5728 DeclarationNameInfo Sema::GetNameForDeclarator(Declarator &D) { 5729 return GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(D.getName()); 5730 } 5731 5732 /// Retrieves the declaration name from a parsed unqualified-id. 5733 DeclarationNameInfo 5734 Sema::GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Name) { 5735 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo; 5736 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 5737 5738 switch (Name.getKind()) { 5739 5740 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: 5741 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier: 5742 NameInfo.setName(Name.Identifier); 5743 return NameInfo; 5744 5745 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: { 5746 // C++ [temp.deduct.guide]p3: 5747 // The simple-template-id shall name a class template specialization. 5748 // The template-name shall be the same identifier as the template-name 5749 // of the simple-template-id. 5750 // These together intend to imply that the template-name shall name a 5751 // class template. 5752 // FIXME: template<typename T> struct X {}; 5753 // template<typename T> using Y = X<T>; 5754 // Y(int) -> Y<int>; 5755 // satisfies these rules but does not name a class template. 5756 TemplateName TN = Name.TemplateName.get().get(); 5757 auto *Template = TN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 5758 if (!Template || !isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(Template)) { 5759 Diag(Name.StartLocation, 5760 diag::err_deduction_guide_name_not_class_template) 5761 << (int)getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TN) << TN; 5762 if (Template) 5763 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here); 5764 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5765 } 5766 5767 NameInfo.setName( 5768 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDeductionGuideName(Template)); 5769 return NameInfo; 5770 } 5771 5772 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId: 5773 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName( 5774 Name.OperatorFunctionId.Operator)); 5775 NameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange( 5776 Name.OperatorFunctionId.SymbolLocations[0], Name.EndLocation)); 5777 return NameInfo; 5778 5779 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId: 5780 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName( 5781 Name.Identifier)); 5782 NameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(Name.EndLocation); 5783 return NameInfo; 5784 5785 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: { 5786 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5787 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConversionFunctionId, &TInfo); 5788 if (Ty.isNull()) 5789 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5790 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConversionFunctionName( 5791 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5792 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5793 return NameInfo; 5794 } 5795 5796 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: { 5797 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5798 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConstructorName, &TInfo); 5799 if (Ty.isNull()) 5800 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5801 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 5802 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5803 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5804 return NameInfo; 5805 } 5806 5807 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: { 5808 // In well-formed code, we can only have a constructor 5809 // template-id that refers to the current context, so go there 5810 // to find the actual type being constructed. 5811 CXXRecordDecl *CurClass = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 5812 if (!CurClass || CurClass->getIdentifier() != Name.TemplateId->Name) 5813 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5814 5815 // Determine the type of the class being constructed. 5816 QualType CurClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(CurClass); 5817 5818 // FIXME: Check two things: that the template-id names the same type as 5819 // CurClassType, and that the template-id does not occur when the name 5820 // was qualified. 5821 5822 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 5823 Context.getCanonicalType(CurClassType))); 5824 // FIXME: should we retrieve TypeSourceInfo? 5825 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(nullptr); 5826 return NameInfo; 5827 } 5828 5829 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: { 5830 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5831 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.DestructorName, &TInfo); 5832 if (Ty.isNull()) 5833 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5834 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 5835 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5836 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5837 return NameInfo; 5838 } 5839 5840 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: { 5841 TemplateName TName = Name.TemplateId->Template.get(); 5842 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Name.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc; 5843 return Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc); 5844 } 5845 5846 } // switch (Name.getKind()) 5847 5848 llvm_unreachable("Unknown name kind"); 5849 } 5850 5851 static QualType getCoreType(QualType Ty) { 5852 do { 5853 if (Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isReferenceType()) 5854 Ty = Ty->getPointeeType(); 5855 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) 5856 Ty = Ty->castAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType(); 5857 else 5858 return Ty.withoutLocalFastQualifiers(); 5859 } while (true); 5860 } 5861 5862 /// hasSimilarParameters - Determine whether the C++ functions Declaration 5863 /// and Definition have "nearly" matching parameters. This heuristic is 5864 /// used to improve diagnostics in the case where an out-of-line function 5865 /// definition doesn't match any declaration within the class or namespace. 5866 /// Also sets Params to the list of indices to the parameters that differ 5867 /// between the declaration and the definition. If hasSimilarParameters 5868 /// returns true and Params is empty, then all of the parameters match. 5869 static bool hasSimilarParameters(ASTContext &Context, 5870 FunctionDecl *Declaration, 5871 FunctionDecl *Definition, 5872 SmallVectorImpl<unsigned> &Params) { 5873 Params.clear(); 5874 if (Declaration->param_size() != Definition->param_size()) 5875 return false; 5876 for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < Declaration->param_size(); ++Idx) { 5877 QualType DeclParamTy = Declaration->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 5878 QualType DefParamTy = Definition->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 5879 5880 // The parameter types are identical 5881 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DefParamTy, DeclParamTy)) 5882 continue; 5883 5884 QualType DeclParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DeclParamTy); 5885 QualType DefParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DefParamTy); 5886 const IdentifierInfo *DeclTyName = DeclParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 5887 const IdentifierInfo *DefTyName = DefParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 5888 5889 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DeclParamBaseTy, DefParamBaseTy) || 5890 (DeclTyName && DeclTyName == DefTyName)) 5891 Params.push_back(Idx); 5892 else // The two parameters aren't even close 5893 return false; 5894 } 5895 5896 return true; 5897 } 5898 5899 /// RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation - Checks whether the given 5900 /// declarator needs to be rebuilt in the current instantiation. 5901 /// Any bits of declarator which appear before the name are valid for 5902 /// consideration here. That's specifically the type in the decl spec 5903 /// and the base type in any member-pointer chunks. 5904 static bool RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(Sema &S, Declarator &D, 5905 DeclarationName Name) { 5906 // The types we specifically need to rebuild are: 5907 // - typenames, typeofs, and decltypes 5908 // - types which will become injected class names 5909 // Of course, we also need to rebuild any type referencing such a 5910 // type. It's safest to just say "dependent", but we call out a 5911 // few cases here. 5912 5913 DeclSpec &DS = D.getMutableDeclSpec(); 5914 switch (DS.getTypeSpecType()) { 5915 case DeclSpec::TST_typename: 5916 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofType: 5917 case DeclSpec::TST_underlyingType: 5918 case DeclSpec::TST_atomic: { 5919 // Grab the type from the parser. 5920 TypeSourceInfo *TSI = nullptr; 5921 QualType T = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TSI); 5922 if (T.isNull() || !T->isInstantiationDependentType()) break; 5923 5924 // Make sure there's a type source info. This isn't really much 5925 // of a waste; most dependent types should have type source info 5926 // attached already. 5927 if (!TSI) 5928 TSI = S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); 5929 5930 // Rebuild the type in the current instantiation. 5931 TSI = S.RebuildTypeInCurrentInstantiation(TSI, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name); 5932 if (!TSI) return true; 5933 5934 // Store the new type back in the decl spec. 5935 ParsedType LocType = S.CreateParsedType(TSI->getType(), TSI); 5936 DS.UpdateTypeRep(LocType); 5937 break; 5938 } 5939 5940 case DeclSpec::TST_decltype: 5941 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofExpr: { 5942 Expr *E = DS.getRepAsExpr(); 5943 ExprResult Result = S.RebuildExprInCurrentInstantiation(E); 5944 if (Result.isInvalid()) return true; 5945 DS.UpdateExprRep(Result.get()); 5946 break; 5947 } 5948 5949 default: 5950 // Nothing to do for these decl specs. 5951 break; 5952 } 5953 5954 // It doesn't matter what order we do this in. 5955 for (unsigned I = 0, E = D.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 5956 DeclaratorChunk &Chunk = D.getTypeObject(I); 5957 5958 // The only type information in the declarator which can come 5959 // before the declaration name is the base type of a member 5960 // pointer. 5961 if (Chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer) 5962 continue; 5963 5964 // Rebuild the scope specifier in-place. 5965 CXXScopeSpec &SS = Chunk.Mem.Scope(); 5966 if (S.RebuildNestedNameSpecifierInCurrentInstantiation(SS)) 5967 return true; 5968 } 5969 5970 return false; 5971 } 5972 5973 /// Returns true if the declaration is declared in a system header or from a 5974 /// system macro. 5975 static bool isFromSystemHeader(SourceManager &SM, const Decl *D) { 5976 return SM.isInSystemHeader(D->getLocation()) || 5977 SM.isInSystemMacro(D->getLocation()); 5978 } 5979 5980 void Sema::warnOnReservedIdentifier(const NamedDecl *D) { 5981 // Avoid warning twice on the same identifier, and don't warn on redeclaration 5982 // of system decl. 5983 if (D->getPreviousDecl() || D->isImplicit()) 5984 return; 5985 ReservedIdentifierStatus Status = D->isReserved(getLangOpts()); 5986 if (Status != ReservedIdentifierStatus::NotReserved && 5987 !isFromSystemHeader(Context.getSourceManager(), D)) { 5988 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_reserved_extern_symbol) 5989 << D << static_cast<int>(Status); 5990 } 5991 } 5992 5993 Decl *Sema::ActOnDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 5994 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration); 5995 5996 // Check if we are in an `omp begin/end declare variant` scope. Handle this 5997 // declaration only if the `bind_to_declaration` extension is set. 5998 SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> Bases; 5999 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && isInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope()) 6000 if (getOMPTraitInfoForSurroundingScope()->isExtensionActive(llvm::omp::TraitProperty:: 6001 implementation_extension_bind_to_declaration)) 6002 ActOnStartOfFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope( 6003 S, D, MultiTemplateParamsArg(), Bases); 6004 6005 Decl *Dcl = HandleDeclarator(S, D, MultiTemplateParamsArg()); 6006 6007 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer() && 6008 Dcl && Dcl->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 6009 Dcl->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 6010 6011 if (!Bases.empty()) 6012 ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope(Dcl, Bases); 6013 6014 return Dcl; 6015 } 6016 6017 /// DiagnoseClassNameShadow - Implement C++ [class.mem]p13: 6018 /// If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 6019 /// name different from T: 6020 /// - every static data member of class T; 6021 /// - every member function of class T 6022 /// - every member of class T that is itself a type; 6023 /// \returns true if the declaration name violates these rules. 6024 bool Sema::DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DeclContext *DC, 6025 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo) { 6026 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 6027 6028 CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 6029 while (Record && Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) 6030 Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getParent()); 6031 if (Record && Record->getIdentifier() && Record->getDeclName() == Name) { 6032 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_member_name_of_class) << Name; 6033 return true; 6034 } 6035 6036 return false; 6037 } 6038 6039 /// Diagnose a declaration whose declarator-id has the given 6040 /// nested-name-specifier. 6041 /// 6042 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 6043 /// 6044 /// \param DC The declaration context to which the nested-name-specifier 6045 /// resolves. 6046 /// 6047 /// \param Name The name of the entity being declared. 6048 /// 6049 /// \param Loc The location of the name of the entity being declared. 6050 /// 6051 /// \param IsTemplateId Whether the name is a (simple-)template-id, and thus 6052 /// we're declaring an explicit / partial specialization / instantiation. 6053 /// 6054 /// \returns true if we cannot safely recover from this error, false otherwise. 6055 bool Sema::diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(CXXScopeSpec &SS, DeclContext *DC, 6056 DeclarationName Name, 6057 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsTemplateId) { 6058 DeclContext *Cur = CurContext; 6059 while (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(Cur) || isa<CapturedDecl>(Cur)) 6060 Cur = Cur->getParent(); 6061 6062 // If the user provided a superfluous scope specifier that refers back to the 6063 // class in which the entity is already declared, diagnose and ignore it. 6064 // 6065 // class X { 6066 // void X::f(); 6067 // }; 6068 // 6069 // Note, it was once ill-formed to give redundant qualification in all 6070 // contexts, but that rule was removed by DR482. 6071 if (Cur->Equals(DC)) { 6072 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 6073 Diag(Loc, LangOpts.MicrosoftExt ? diag::warn_member_extra_qualification 6074 : diag::err_member_extra_qualification) 6075 << Name << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SS.getRange()); 6076 SS.clear(); 6077 } else { 6078 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_namespace_member_extra_qualification) << Name; 6079 } 6080 return false; 6081 } 6082 6083 // Check whether the qualifying scope encloses the scope of the original 6084 // declaration. For a template-id, we perform the checks in 6085 // CheckTemplateSpecializationScope. 6086 if (!Cur->Encloses(DC) && !IsTemplateId) { 6087 if (Cur->isRecord()) 6088 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 6089 << Name << SS.getRange(); 6090 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 6091 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_global_scope) 6092 << Name << SS.getRange(); 6093 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Cur)) 6094 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_function) 6095 << Name << SS.getRange(); 6096 else if (isa<BlockDecl>(Cur)) 6097 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_block) 6098 << Name << SS.getRange(); 6099 else if (isa<ExportDecl>(Cur)) { 6100 if (!isa<NamespaceDecl>(DC)) 6101 Diag(Loc, diag::err_export_non_namespace_scope_name) 6102 << Name << SS.getRange(); 6103 else 6104 // The cases that DC is not NamespaceDecl should be handled in 6105 // CheckRedeclarationExported. 6106 return false; 6107 } else 6108 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_scope) 6109 << Name << cast<NamedDecl>(Cur) << cast<NamedDecl>(DC) << SS.getRange(); 6110 6111 return true; 6112 } 6113 6114 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 6115 // Cannot qualify members within a class. 6116 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 6117 << Name << SS.getRange(); 6118 SS.clear(); 6119 6120 // C++ constructors and destructors with incorrect scopes can break 6121 // our AST invariants by having the wrong underlying types. If 6122 // that's the case, then drop this declaration entirely. 6123 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName || 6124 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) && 6125 !Context.hasSameType(Name.getCXXNameType(), 6126 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cur)))) 6127 return true; 6128 6129 return false; 6130 } 6131 6132 // C++11 [dcl.meaning]p1: 6133 // [...] "The nested-name-specifier of the qualified declarator-id shall 6134 // not begin with a decltype-specifer" 6135 NestedNameSpecifierLoc SpecLoc(SS.getScopeRep(), SS.location_data()); 6136 while (SpecLoc.getPrefix()) 6137 SpecLoc = SpecLoc.getPrefix(); 6138 if (isa_and_nonnull<DecltypeType>( 6139 SpecLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()->getAsType())) 6140 Diag(Loc, diag::err_decltype_in_declarator) 6141 << SpecLoc.getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 6142 6143 return false; 6144 } 6145 6146 NamedDecl *Sema::HandleDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 6147 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists) { 6148 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 6149 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 6150 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 6151 6152 // All of these full declarators require an identifier. If it doesn't have 6153 // one, the ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec action should be used. 6154 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 6155 return ActOnDecompositionDeclarator(S, D, TemplateParamLists); 6156 } else if (!Name) { 6157 if (!D.isInvalidType()) // Reject this if we think it is valid. 6158 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), diag::err_declarator_need_ident) 6159 << D.getDeclSpec().getSourceRange() << D.getSourceRange(); 6160 return nullptr; 6161 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(NameInfo, UPPC_DeclarationType)) 6162 return nullptr; 6163 6164 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 6165 // we find one that is. 6166 while ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0 || 6167 (S->getFlags() & Scope::TemplateParamScope) != 0) 6168 S = S->getParent(); 6169 6170 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 6171 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isInvalid()) 6172 D.setInvalidType(); 6173 else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6174 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 6175 UPPC_DeclarationQualifier)) 6176 return nullptr; 6177 6178 bool EnteringContext = !D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 6179 DC = computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), EnteringContext); 6180 if (!DC || isa<EnumDecl>(DC)) { 6181 // If we could not compute the declaration context, it's because the 6182 // declaration context is dependent but does not refer to a class, 6183 // class template, or class template partial specialization. Complain 6184 // and return early, to avoid the coming semantic disaster. 6185 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6186 diag::err_template_qualified_declarator_no_match) 6187 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep() 6188 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6189 return nullptr; 6190 } 6191 bool IsDependentContext = DC->isDependentContext(); 6192 6193 if (!IsDependentContext && 6194 RequireCompleteDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC)) 6195 return nullptr; 6196 6197 // If a class is incomplete, do not parse entities inside it. 6198 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC) && !cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->hasDefinition()) { 6199 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6200 diag::err_member_def_undefined_record) 6201 << Name << DC << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6202 return nullptr; 6203 } 6204 if (!D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) { 6205 if (diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration( 6206 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC, Name, D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6207 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId)) { 6208 if (DC->isRecord()) 6209 return nullptr; 6210 6211 D.setInvalidType(); 6212 } 6213 } 6214 6215 // Check whether we need to rebuild the type of the given 6216 // declaration in the current instantiation. 6217 if (EnteringContext && IsDependentContext && 6218 TemplateParamLists.size() != 0) { 6219 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 6220 if (RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(*this, D, Name)) 6221 D.setInvalidType(); 6222 } 6223 } 6224 6225 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 6226 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 6227 6228 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 6229 UPPC_DeclarationType)) 6230 D.setInvalidType(); 6231 6232 LookupResult Previous(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName, 6233 forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 6234 6235 // See if this is a redefinition of a variable in the same scope. 6236 if (!D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6237 bool IsLinkageLookup = false; 6238 bool CreateBuiltins = false; 6239 6240 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be a function 6241 // or object with linkage, then look for another declaration with 6242 // linkage (C99 6.2.2p4-5 and C++ [basic.link]p6). 6243 // 6244 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be declared with 6245 // external linkage in the translation unit, create any builtin with 6246 // the same name. 6247 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 6248 /* Do nothing*/; 6249 else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() && 6250 (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_extern || 6251 R->isFunctionType())) { 6252 IsLinkageLookup = true; 6253 CreateBuiltins = 6254 CurContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext()->isTranslationUnit(); 6255 } else if (CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 6256 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static) 6257 CreateBuiltins = true; 6258 6259 if (IsLinkageLookup) { 6260 Previous.clear(LookupRedeclarationWithLinkage); 6261 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(ForExternalRedeclaration); 6262 } 6263 6264 LookupName(Previous, S, CreateBuiltins); 6265 } else { // Something like "int foo::x;" 6266 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 6267 6268 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 6269 // When the declarator-id is qualified, the declaration shall refer to a 6270 // previously declared member of the class or namespace to which the 6271 // qualifier refers (or, in the case of a namespace, of an element of the 6272 // inline namespace set of that namespace (7.3.1)) or to a specialization 6273 // thereof; [...] 6274 // 6275 // Note that we already checked the context above, and that we do not have 6276 // enough information to make sure that Previous contains the declaration 6277 // we want to match. For example, given: 6278 // 6279 // class X { 6280 // void f(); 6281 // void f(float); 6282 // }; 6283 // 6284 // void X::f(int) { } // ill-formed 6285 // 6286 // In this case, Previous will point to the overload set 6287 // containing the two f's declared in X, but neither of them 6288 // matches. 6289 6290 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 6291 // [...] the member shall not merely have been introduced by a 6292 // using-declaration in the scope of the class or namespace nominated by 6293 // the nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 6294 RemoveUsingDecls(Previous); 6295 } 6296 6297 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 6298 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 6299 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 6300 if (!D.isInvalidType()) 6301 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6302 Previous.getFoundDecl()); 6303 6304 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 6305 Previous.clear(); 6306 } 6307 6308 if (!R->isFunctionType() && DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DC, NameInfo)) 6309 // Forget that the previous declaration is the injected-class-name. 6310 Previous.clear(); 6311 6312 // In C++, the previous declaration we find might be a tag type 6313 // (class or enum). In this case, the new declaration will hide the 6314 // tag type. Note that this applies to functions, function templates, and 6315 // variables, but not to typedefs (C++ [dcl.typedef]p4) or variable templates. 6316 if (Previous.isSingleTagDecl() && 6317 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && 6318 (TemplateParamLists.size() == 0 || R->isFunctionType())) 6319 Previous.clear(); 6320 6321 // Check that there are no default arguments other than in the parameters 6322 // of a function declaration (C++ only). 6323 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 6324 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 6325 6326 NamedDecl *New; 6327 6328 bool AddToScope = true; 6329 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 6330 if (TemplateParamLists.size()) { 6331 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_typedef); 6332 return nullptr; 6333 } 6334 6335 New = ActOnTypedefDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous); 6336 } else if (R->isFunctionType()) { 6337 New = ActOnFunctionDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, 6338 TemplateParamLists, 6339 AddToScope); 6340 } else { 6341 New = ActOnVariableDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, TemplateParamLists, 6342 AddToScope); 6343 } 6344 6345 if (!New) 6346 return nullptr; 6347 6348 // If this has an identifier and is not a function template specialization, 6349 // add it to the scope stack. 6350 if (New->getDeclName() && AddToScope) 6351 PushOnScopeChains(New, S); 6352 6353 if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext()) 6354 checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(nullptr, New); 6355 6356 return New; 6357 } 6358 6359 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 6360 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 6361 /// GCC compatibility). 6362 static QualType TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(QualType T, 6363 ASTContext &Context, 6364 bool &SizeIsNegative, 6365 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 6366 // This method tries to turn a variable array into a constant 6367 // array even when the size isn't an ICE. This is necessary 6368 // for compatibility with code that depends on gcc's buggy 6369 // constant expression folding, like struct {char x[(int)(char*)2];} 6370 SizeIsNegative = false; 6371 Oversized = 0; 6372 6373 if (T->isDependentType()) 6374 return QualType(); 6375 6376 QualifierCollector Qs; 6377 const Type *Ty = Qs.strip(T); 6378 6379 if (const PointerType* PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Ty)) { 6380 QualType Pointee = PTy->getPointeeType(); 6381 QualType FixedType = 6382 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Pointee, Context, SizeIsNegative, 6383 Oversized); 6384 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 6385 FixedType = Context.getPointerType(FixedType); 6386 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 6387 } 6388 if (const ParenType* PTy = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty)) { 6389 QualType Inner = PTy->getInnerType(); 6390 QualType FixedType = 6391 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Inner, Context, SizeIsNegative, 6392 Oversized); 6393 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 6394 FixedType = Context.getParenType(FixedType); 6395 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 6396 } 6397 6398 const VariableArrayType* VLATy = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(T); 6399 if (!VLATy) 6400 return QualType(); 6401 6402 QualType ElemTy = VLATy->getElementType(); 6403 if (ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 6404 ElemTy = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(ElemTy, Context, 6405 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6406 if (ElemTy.isNull()) 6407 return QualType(); 6408 } 6409 6410 Expr::EvalResult Result; 6411 if (!VLATy->getSizeExpr() || 6412 !VLATy->getSizeExpr()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) 6413 return QualType(); 6414 6415 llvm::APSInt Res = Result.Val.getInt(); 6416 6417 // Check whether the array size is negative. 6418 if (Res.isSigned() && Res.isNegative()) { 6419 SizeIsNegative = true; 6420 return QualType(); 6421 } 6422 6423 // Check whether the array is too large to be addressed. 6424 unsigned ActiveSizeBits = 6425 (!ElemTy->isDependentType() && !ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType() && 6426 !ElemTy->isIncompleteType() && !ElemTy->isUndeducedType()) 6427 ? ConstantArrayType::getNumAddressingBits(Context, ElemTy, Res) 6428 : Res.getActiveBits(); 6429 if (ActiveSizeBits > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) { 6430 Oversized = Res; 6431 return QualType(); 6432 } 6433 6434 QualType FoldedArrayType = Context.getConstantArrayType( 6435 ElemTy, Res, VLATy->getSizeExpr(), ArrayType::Normal, 0); 6436 return Qs.apply(Context, FoldedArrayType); 6437 } 6438 6439 static void 6440 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TypeLoc SrcTL, TypeLoc DstTL) { 6441 SrcTL = SrcTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 6442 DstTL = DstTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 6443 if (PointerTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<PointerTypeLoc>()) { 6444 PointerTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<PointerTypeLoc>(); 6445 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getPointeeLoc(), 6446 DstPTL.getPointeeLoc()); 6447 DstPTL.setStarLoc(SrcPTL.getStarLoc()); 6448 return; 6449 } 6450 if (ParenTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<ParenTypeLoc>()) { 6451 ParenTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<ParenTypeLoc>(); 6452 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getInnerLoc(), 6453 DstPTL.getInnerLoc()); 6454 DstPTL.setLParenLoc(SrcPTL.getLParenLoc()); 6455 DstPTL.setRParenLoc(SrcPTL.getRParenLoc()); 6456 return; 6457 } 6458 ArrayTypeLoc SrcATL = SrcTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 6459 ArrayTypeLoc DstATL = DstTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 6460 TypeLoc SrcElemTL = SrcATL.getElementLoc(); 6461 TypeLoc DstElemTL = DstATL.getElementLoc(); 6462 if (VariableArrayTypeLoc SrcElemATL = 6463 SrcElemTL.getAs<VariableArrayTypeLoc>()) { 6464 ConstantArrayTypeLoc DstElemATL = DstElemTL.castAs<ConstantArrayTypeLoc>(); 6465 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcElemATL, DstElemATL); 6466 } else { 6467 DstElemTL.initializeFullCopy(SrcElemTL); 6468 } 6469 DstATL.setLBracketLoc(SrcATL.getLBracketLoc()); 6470 DstATL.setSizeExpr(SrcATL.getSizeExpr()); 6471 DstATL.setRBracketLoc(SrcATL.getRBracketLoc()); 6472 } 6473 6474 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 6475 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 6476 /// GCC compatibility). 6477 static TypeSourceInfo* 6478 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 6479 ASTContext &Context, 6480 bool &SizeIsNegative, 6481 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 6482 QualType FixedTy 6483 = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(TInfo->getType(), Context, 6484 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6485 if (FixedTy.isNull()) 6486 return nullptr; 6487 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FixedTy); 6488 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TInfo->getTypeLoc(), 6489 FixedTInfo->getTypeLoc()); 6490 return FixedTInfo; 6491 } 6492 6493 /// Attempt to fold a variable-sized type to a constant-sized type, returning 6494 /// true if we were successful. 6495 bool Sema::tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TypeSourceInfo *&TInfo, 6496 QualType &T, SourceLocation Loc, 6497 unsigned FailedFoldDiagID) { 6498 bool SizeIsNegative; 6499 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 6500 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo( 6501 TInfo, Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6502 if (FixedTInfo) { 6503 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 6504 TInfo = FixedTInfo; 6505 T = FixedTInfo->getType(); 6506 return true; 6507 } 6508 6509 if (SizeIsNegative) 6510 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 6511 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 6512 Diag(Loc, diag::err_array_too_large) << toString(Oversized, 10); 6513 else if (FailedFoldDiagID) 6514 Diag(Loc, FailedFoldDiagID); 6515 return false; 6516 } 6517 6518 /// Register the given locally-scoped extern "C" declaration so 6519 /// that it can be found later for redeclarations. We include any extern "C" 6520 /// declaration that is not visible in the translation unit here, not just 6521 /// function-scope declarations. 6522 void 6523 Sema::RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S) { 6524 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 6525 ND->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 6526 // Don't need to track declarations in the TU in C. 6527 return; 6528 6529 // Note that we have a locally-scoped external with this name. 6530 Context.getExternCContextDecl()->makeDeclVisibleInContext(ND); 6531 } 6532 6533 NamedDecl *Sema::findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(DeclarationName Name) { 6534 // FIXME: We can have multiple results via __attribute__((overloadable)). 6535 auto Result = Context.getExternCContextDecl()->lookup(Name); 6536 return Result.empty() ? nullptr : *Result.begin(); 6537 } 6538 6539 /// Diagnose function specifiers on a declaration of an identifier that 6540 /// does not identify a function. 6541 void Sema::DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(const DeclSpec &DS) { 6542 // FIXME: We should probably indicate the identifier in question to avoid 6543 // confusion for constructs like "virtual int a(), b;" 6544 if (DS.isVirtualSpecified()) 6545 Diag(DS.getVirtualSpecLoc(), 6546 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 6547 6548 if (DS.hasExplicitSpecifier()) 6549 Diag(DS.getExplicitSpecLoc(), 6550 diag::err_explicit_non_function); 6551 6552 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) 6553 Diag(DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 6554 diag::err_noreturn_non_function); 6555 } 6556 6557 NamedDecl* 6558 Sema::ActOnTypedefDeclarator(Scope* S, Declarator& D, DeclContext* DC, 6559 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous) { 6560 // Typedef declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 6561 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6562 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_typedef_declarator) 6563 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6564 D.setInvalidType(); 6565 // Pretend we didn't see the scope specifier. 6566 DC = CurContext; 6567 Previous.clear(); 6568 } 6569 6570 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 6571 6572 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) 6573 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 6574 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 6575 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier()) 6576 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 6577 << 1 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 6578 6579 if (D.getName().Kind != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier) { 6580 if (D.getName().Kind == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName) 6581 Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, 6582 diag::err_deduction_guide_invalid_specifier) 6583 << "typedef"; 6584 else 6585 Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, diag::err_typedef_not_identifier) 6586 << D.getName().getSourceRange(); 6587 return nullptr; 6588 } 6589 6590 TypedefDecl *NewTD = ParseTypedefDecl(S, D, TInfo->getType(), TInfo); 6591 if (!NewTD) return nullptr; 6592 6593 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 6594 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewTD, D); 6595 6596 CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(S, NewTD); 6597 6598 bool Redeclaration = D.isRedeclaration(); 6599 NamedDecl *ND = ActOnTypedefNameDecl(S, DC, NewTD, Previous, Redeclaration); 6600 D.setRedeclaration(Redeclaration); 6601 return ND; 6602 } 6603 6604 void 6605 Sema::CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 6606 // C99 6.7.7p2: If a typedef name specifies a variably modified type 6607 // then it shall have block scope. 6608 // Note that variably modified types must be fixed before merging the decl so 6609 // that redeclarations will match. 6610 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = NewTD->getTypeSourceInfo(); 6611 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 6612 if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 6613 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 6614 6615 if (S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 6616 bool SizeIsNegative; 6617 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 6618 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = 6619 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TInfo, Context, 6620 SizeIsNegative, 6621 Oversized); 6622 if (FixedTInfo) { 6623 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 6624 NewTD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 6625 } else { 6626 if (SizeIsNegative) 6627 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 6628 else if (T->isVariableArrayType()) 6629 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope); 6630 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 6631 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_array_too_large) 6632 << toString(Oversized, 10); 6633 else 6634 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 6635 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 6636 } 6637 } 6638 } 6639 } 6640 6641 /// ActOnTypedefNameDecl - Perform semantic checking for a declaration which 6642 /// declares a typedef-name, either using the 'typedef' type specifier or via 6643 /// a C++0x [dcl.typedef]p2 alias-declaration: 'using T = A;'. 6644 NamedDecl* 6645 Sema::ActOnTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD, 6646 LookupResult &Previous, bool &Redeclaration) { 6647 6648 // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope. 6649 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(NewTD, Previous); 6650 6651 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. If the decl is 6652 // in an outer scope, it isn't the same thing. 6653 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, DC, S, /*ConsiderLinkage*/false, 6654 /*AllowInlineNamespace*/false); 6655 filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(*this, NewTD, Previous); 6656 if (!Previous.empty()) { 6657 Redeclaration = true; 6658 MergeTypedefNameDecl(S, NewTD, Previous); 6659 } else { 6660 inferGslPointerAttribute(NewTD); 6661 } 6662 6663 if (ShadowedDecl && !Redeclaration) 6664 CheckShadow(NewTD, ShadowedDecl, Previous); 6665 6666 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 6667 if (IdentifierInfo *II = NewTD->getIdentifier()) 6668 if (!NewTD->isInvalidDecl() && 6669 NewTD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 6670 if (II->isStr("FILE")) 6671 Context.setFILEDecl(NewTD); 6672 else if (II->isStr("jmp_buf")) 6673 Context.setjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 6674 else if (II->isStr("sigjmp_buf")) 6675 Context.setsigjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 6676 else if (II->isStr("ucontext_t")) 6677 Context.setucontext_tDecl(NewTD); 6678 } 6679 6680 return NewTD; 6681 } 6682 6683 /// Determines whether the given declaration is an out-of-scope 6684 /// previous declaration. 6685 /// 6686 /// This routine should be invoked when name lookup has found a 6687 /// previous declaration (PrevDecl) that is not in the scope where a 6688 /// new declaration by the same name is being introduced. If the new 6689 /// declaration occurs in a local scope, previous declarations with 6690 /// linkage may still be considered previous declarations (C99 6691 /// 6.2.2p4-5, C++ [basic.link]p6). 6692 /// 6693 /// \param PrevDecl the previous declaration found by name 6694 /// lookup 6695 /// 6696 /// \param DC the context in which the new declaration is being 6697 /// declared. 6698 /// 6699 /// \returns true if PrevDecl is an out-of-scope previous declaration 6700 /// for a new delcaration with the same name. 6701 static bool 6702 isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *PrevDecl, DeclContext *DC, 6703 ASTContext &Context) { 6704 if (!PrevDecl) 6705 return false; 6706 6707 if (!PrevDecl->hasLinkage()) 6708 return false; 6709 6710 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6711 // C++ [basic.link]p6: 6712 // If there is a visible declaration of an entity with linkage 6713 // having the same name and type, ignoring entities declared 6714 // outside the innermost enclosing namespace scope, the block 6715 // scope declaration declares that same entity and receives the 6716 // linkage of the previous declaration. 6717 DeclContext *OuterContext = DC->getRedeclContext(); 6718 if (!OuterContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 6719 // This rule only applies to block-scope declarations. 6720 return false; 6721 6722 DeclContext *PrevOuterContext = PrevDecl->getDeclContext(); 6723 if (PrevOuterContext->isRecord()) 6724 // We found a member function: ignore it. 6725 return false; 6726 6727 // Find the innermost enclosing namespace for the new and 6728 // previous declarations. 6729 OuterContext = OuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 6730 PrevOuterContext = PrevOuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 6731 6732 // The previous declaration is in a different namespace, so it 6733 // isn't the same function. 6734 if (!OuterContext->Equals(PrevOuterContext)) 6735 return false; 6736 } 6737 6738 return true; 6739 } 6740 6741 static void SetNestedNameSpecifier(Sema &S, DeclaratorDecl *DD, Declarator &D) { 6742 CXXScopeSpec &SS = D.getCXXScopeSpec(); 6743 if (!SS.isSet()) return; 6744 DD->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(S.Context)); 6745 } 6746 6747 bool Sema::inferObjCARCLifetime(ValueDecl *decl) { 6748 QualType type = decl->getType(); 6749 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = type.getObjCLifetime(); 6750 if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 6751 // Various kinds of declaration aren't allowed to be __autoreleasing. 6752 unsigned kind = -1U; 6753 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 6754 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 6755 kind = 0; // __block 6756 else if (!var->hasLocalStorage()) 6757 kind = 1; // global 6758 } else if (isa<ObjCIvarDecl>(decl)) { 6759 kind = 3; // ivar 6760 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(decl)) { 6761 kind = 2; // field 6762 } 6763 6764 if (kind != -1U) { 6765 Diag(decl->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_var) 6766 << kind; 6767 } 6768 } else if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_None) { 6769 // Try to infer lifetime. 6770 if (!type->isObjCLifetimeType()) 6771 return false; 6772 6773 lifetime = type->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 6774 type = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(type, lifetime); 6775 decl->setType(type); 6776 } 6777 6778 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 6779 // Thread-local variables cannot have lifetime. 6780 if (lifetime && lifetime != Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone && 6781 var->getTLSKind()) { 6782 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_thread_ownership) 6783 << var->getType(); 6784 return true; 6785 } 6786 } 6787 6788 return false; 6789 } 6790 6791 void Sema::deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(ValueDecl *Decl) { 6792 if (Decl->getType().hasAddressSpace()) 6793 return; 6794 if (Decl->getType()->isDependentType()) 6795 return; 6796 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) { 6797 QualType Type = Var->getType(); 6798 if (Type->isSamplerT() || Type->isVoidType()) 6799 return; 6800 LangAS ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_private; 6801 // OpenCL C v3.0 s6.7.8 - For OpenCL C 2.0 or with the 6802 // __opencl_c_program_scope_global_variables feature, the address space 6803 // for a variable at program scope or a static or extern variable inside 6804 // a function are inferred to be __global. 6805 if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts()) && 6806 Var->hasGlobalStorage()) 6807 ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_global; 6808 // If the original type from a decayed type is an array type and that array 6809 // type has no address space yet, deduce it now. 6810 if (auto DT = dyn_cast<DecayedType>(Type)) { 6811 auto OrigTy = DT->getOriginalType(); 6812 if (!OrigTy.hasAddressSpace() && OrigTy->isArrayType()) { 6813 // Add the address space to the original array type and then propagate 6814 // that to the element type through `getAsArrayType`. 6815 OrigTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(OrigTy, ImplAS); 6816 OrigTy = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy), 0); 6817 // Re-generate the decayed type. 6818 Type = Context.getDecayedType(OrigTy); 6819 } 6820 } 6821 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, ImplAS); 6822 // Apply any qualifiers (including address space) from the array type to 6823 // the element type. This implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of 6824 // an array type includes any type qualifiers, the element type is so 6825 // qualified, not the array type." 6826 if (Type->isArrayType()) 6827 Type = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(Type), 0); 6828 Decl->setType(Type); 6829 } 6830 } 6831 6832 static void checkAttributesAfterMerging(Sema &S, NamedDecl &ND) { 6833 // Ensure that an auto decl is deduced otherwise the checks below might cache 6834 // the wrong linkage. 6835 assert(S.ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(&ND) == 0); 6836 6837 // 'weak' only applies to declarations with external linkage. 6838 if (WeakAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakAttr>()) { 6839 if (!ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6840 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weak_static); 6841 ND.dropAttr<WeakAttr>(); 6842 } 6843 } 6844 if (WeakRefAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakRefAttr>()) { 6845 if (ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6846 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weakref_not_static); 6847 ND.dropAttr<WeakRefAttr>(); 6848 ND.dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 6849 } 6850 } 6851 6852 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND)) { 6853 if (VD->hasInit()) { 6854 if (const auto *Attr = VD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 6855 assert(VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 6856 !VD->isExternallyVisible() && "Broken AliasAttr handled late!"); 6857 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << VD << 0; 6858 VD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 6859 } 6860 } 6861 } 6862 6863 // 'selectany' only applies to externally visible variable declarations. 6864 // It does not apply to functions. 6865 if (SelectAnyAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) { 6866 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(ND) || !ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6867 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), 6868 diag::err_attribute_selectany_non_extern_data); 6869 ND.dropAttr<SelectAnyAttr>(); 6870 } 6871 } 6872 6873 if (const InheritableAttr *Attr = getDLLAttr(&ND)) { 6874 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND); 6875 bool IsAnonymousNS = false; 6876 bool IsMicrosoft = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft(); 6877 if (VD) { 6878 const NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(VD->getDeclContext()); 6879 while (NS && !IsAnonymousNS) { 6880 IsAnonymousNS = NS->isAnonymousNamespace(); 6881 NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(NS->getParent()); 6882 } 6883 } 6884 // dll attributes require external linkage. Static locals may have external 6885 // linkage but still cannot be explicitly imported or exported. 6886 // In Microsoft mode, a variable defined in anonymous namespace must have 6887 // external linkage in order to be exported. 6888 bool AnonNSInMicrosoftMode = IsAnonymousNS && IsMicrosoft; 6889 if ((ND.isExternallyVisible() && AnonNSInMicrosoftMode) || 6890 (!AnonNSInMicrosoftMode && 6891 (!ND.isExternallyVisible() || (VD && VD->isStaticLocal())))) { 6892 S.Diag(ND.getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_not_extern) 6893 << &ND << Attr; 6894 ND.setInvalidDecl(); 6895 } 6896 } 6897 6898 // Check the attributes on the function type, if any. 6899 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(&ND)) { 6900 // Don't declare this variable in the second operand of the for-statement; 6901 // GCC miscompiles that by ending its lifetime before evaluating the 6902 // third operand. See gcc.gnu.org/PR86769. 6903 AttributedTypeLoc ATL; 6904 for (TypeLoc TL = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc(); 6905 (ATL = TL.getAsAdjusted<AttributedTypeLoc>()); 6906 TL = ATL.getModifiedLoc()) { 6907 // The [[lifetimebound]] attribute can be applied to the implicit object 6908 // parameter of a non-static member function (other than a ctor or dtor) 6909 // by applying it to the function type. 6910 if (const auto *A = ATL.getAttrAs<LifetimeBoundAttr>()) { 6911 const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 6912 if (!MD || MD->isStatic()) { 6913 S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_no_object_param) 6914 << !MD << A->getRange(); 6915 } else if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) || isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) { 6916 S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_ctor_dtor) 6917 << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) << A->getRange(); 6918 } 6919 } 6920 } 6921 } 6922 } 6923 6924 static void checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(Sema &S, NamedDecl *OldDecl, 6925 NamedDecl *NewDecl, 6926 bool IsSpecialization, 6927 bool IsDefinition) { 6928 if (OldDecl->isInvalidDecl() || NewDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 6929 return; 6930 6931 bool IsTemplate = false; 6932 if (TemplateDecl *OldTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) { 6933 OldDecl = OldTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 6934 IsTemplate = true; 6935 if (!IsSpecialization) 6936 IsDefinition = false; 6937 } 6938 if (TemplateDecl *NewTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6939 NewDecl = NewTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 6940 IsTemplate = true; 6941 } 6942 6943 if (!OldDecl || !NewDecl) 6944 return; 6945 6946 const DLLImportAttr *OldImportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6947 const DLLExportAttr *OldExportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 6948 const DLLImportAttr *NewImportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6949 const DLLExportAttr *NewExportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 6950 6951 // dllimport and dllexport are inheritable attributes so we have to exclude 6952 // inherited attribute instances. 6953 bool HasNewAttr = (NewImportAttr && !NewImportAttr->isInherited()) || 6954 (NewExportAttr && !NewExportAttr->isInherited()); 6955 6956 // A redeclaration is not allowed to add a dllimport or dllexport attribute, 6957 // the only exception being explicit specializations. 6958 // Implicitly generated declarations are also excluded for now because there 6959 // is no other way to switch these to use dllimport or dllexport. 6960 bool AddsAttr = !(OldImportAttr || OldExportAttr) && HasNewAttr; 6961 6962 if (AddsAttr && !IsSpecialization && !OldDecl->isImplicit()) { 6963 // Allow with a warning for free functions and global variables. 6964 bool JustWarn = false; 6965 if (!OldDecl->isCXXClassMember()) { 6966 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(OldDecl); 6967 if (VD && !VD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) 6968 JustWarn = true; 6969 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl); 6970 if (FD && FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_NonTemplate) 6971 JustWarn = true; 6972 } 6973 6974 // We cannot change a declaration that's been used because IR has already 6975 // been emitted. Dllimported functions will still work though (modulo 6976 // address equality) as they can use the thunk. 6977 if (OldDecl->isUsed()) 6978 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl) || !NewImportAttr) 6979 JustWarn = false; 6980 6981 unsigned DiagID = JustWarn ? diag::warn_attribute_dll_redeclaration 6982 : diag::err_attribute_dll_redeclaration; 6983 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), DiagID) 6984 << NewDecl 6985 << (NewImportAttr ? (const Attr *)NewImportAttr : NewExportAttr); 6986 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6987 if (!JustWarn) { 6988 NewDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 6989 return; 6990 } 6991 } 6992 6993 // A redeclaration is not allowed to drop a dllimport attribute, the only 6994 // exceptions being inline function definitions (except for function 6995 // templates), local extern declarations, qualified friend declarations or 6996 // special MSVC extension: in the last case, the declaration is treated as if 6997 // it were marked dllexport. 6998 bool IsInline = false, IsStaticDataMember = false, IsQualifiedFriend = false; 6999 bool IsMicrosoftABI = S.Context.getTargetInfo().shouldDLLImportComdatSymbols(); 7000 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewDecl)) { 7001 // Ignore static data because out-of-line definitions are diagnosed 7002 // separately. 7003 IsStaticDataMember = VD->isStaticDataMember(); 7004 IsDefinition = VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(S.Context) != 7005 VarDecl::DeclarationOnly; 7006 } else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewDecl)) { 7007 IsInline = FD->isInlined(); 7008 IsQualifiedFriend = FD->getQualifier() && 7009 FD->getFriendObjectKind() == Decl::FOK_Declared; 7010 } 7011 7012 if (OldImportAttr && !HasNewAttr && 7013 (!IsInline || (IsMicrosoftABI && IsTemplate)) && !IsStaticDataMember && 7014 !NewDecl->isLocalExternDecl() && !IsQualifiedFriend) { 7015 if (IsMicrosoftABI && IsDefinition) { 7016 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 7017 diag::warn_redeclaration_without_import_attribute) 7018 << NewDecl; 7019 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 7020 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 7021 NewDecl->addAttr( 7022 DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(S.Context, NewImportAttr->getRange())); 7023 } else { 7024 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 7025 diag::warn_redeclaration_without_attribute_prev_attribute_ignored) 7026 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 7027 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 7028 S.Diag(OldImportAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_attribute); 7029 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 7030 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 7031 } 7032 } else if (IsInline && OldImportAttr && !IsMicrosoftABI) { 7033 // In MinGW, seeing a function declared inline drops the dllimport 7034 // attribute. 7035 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 7036 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 7037 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 7038 diag::warn_dllimport_dropped_from_inline_function) 7039 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 7040 } 7041 7042 // A specialization of a class template member function is processed here 7043 // since it's a redeclaration. If the parent class is dllexport, the 7044 // specialization inherits that attribute. This doesn't happen automatically 7045 // since the parent class isn't instantiated until later. 7046 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDecl)) { 7047 if (MD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_MemberSpecialization && 7048 !NewImportAttr && !NewExportAttr) { 7049 if (const DLLExportAttr *ParentExportAttr = 7050 MD->getParent()->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) { 7051 DLLExportAttr *NewAttr = ParentExportAttr->clone(S.Context); 7052 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 7053 NewDecl->addAttr(NewAttr); 7054 } 7055 } 7056 } 7057 } 7058 7059 /// Given that we are within the definition of the given function, 7060 /// will that definition behave like C99's 'inline', where the 7061 /// definition is discarded except for optimization purposes? 7062 static bool isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) { 7063 // Try to avoid calling GetGVALinkageForFunction. 7064 7065 // All cases of this require the 'inline' keyword. 7066 if (!FD->isInlined()) return false; 7067 7068 // This is only possible in C++ with the gnu_inline attribute. 7069 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) 7070 return false; 7071 7072 // Okay, go ahead and call the relatively-more-expensive function. 7073 return S.Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD) == GVA_AvailableExternally; 7074 } 7075 7076 /// Determine whether a variable is extern "C" prior to attaching 7077 /// an initializer. We can't just call isExternC() here, because that 7078 /// will also compute and cache whether the declaration is externally 7079 /// visible, which might change when we attach the initializer. 7080 /// 7081 /// This can only be used if the declaration is known to not be a 7082 /// redeclaration of an internal linkage declaration. 7083 /// 7084 /// For instance: 7085 /// 7086 /// auto x = []{}; 7087 /// 7088 /// Attaching the initializer here makes this declaration not externally 7089 /// visible, because its type has internal linkage. 7090 /// 7091 /// FIXME: This is a hack. 7092 template<typename T> 7093 static bool isIncompleteDeclExternC(Sema &S, const T *D) { 7094 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7095 // In C++, the overloadable attribute negates the effects of extern "C". 7096 if (!D->isInExternCContext() || D->template hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) 7097 return false; 7098 7099 // So do CUDA's host/device attributes. 7100 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && (D->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() || 7101 D->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>())) 7102 return false; 7103 } 7104 return D->isExternC(); 7105 } 7106 7107 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const VarDecl *VD) { 7108 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 7109 if (DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || 7110 isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC)) 7111 return VD->hasExternalStorage(); 7112 if (DC->isFileContext()) 7113 return true; 7114 if (DC->isRecord()) 7115 return false; 7116 if (isa<RequiresExprBodyDecl>(DC)) 7117 return false; 7118 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 7119 } 7120 7121 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 7122 const DeclContext *DC = FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 7123 if (DC->isFileContext() || DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || 7124 isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC)) 7125 return true; 7126 if (DC->isRecord()) 7127 return false; 7128 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 7129 } 7130 7131 static bool hasParsedAttr(Scope *S, const Declarator &PD, 7132 ParsedAttr::Kind Kind) { 7133 // Check decl attributes on the DeclSpec. 7134 if (PD.getDeclSpec().getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind)) 7135 return true; 7136 7137 // Walk the declarator structure, checking decl attributes that were in a type 7138 // position to the decl itself. 7139 for (unsigned I = 0, E = PD.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 7140 if (PD.getTypeObject(I).getAttrs().hasAttribute(Kind)) 7141 return true; 7142 } 7143 7144 // Finally, check attributes on the decl itself. 7145 return PD.getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind) || 7146 PD.getDeclarationAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind); 7147 } 7148 7149 /// Adjust the \c DeclContext for a function or variable that might be a 7150 /// function-local external declaration. 7151 bool Sema::adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DeclContext *&DC) { 7152 if (!DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 7153 return false; 7154 7155 // If this is a local extern function or variable declared within a function 7156 // template, don't add it into the enclosing namespace scope until it is 7157 // instantiated; it might have a dependent type right now. 7158 if (DC->isDependentContext()) 7159 return true; 7160 7161 // C++11 [basic.link]p7: 7162 // When a block scope declaration of an entity with linkage is not found to 7163 // refer to some other declaration, then that entity is a member of the 7164 // innermost enclosing namespace. 7165 // 7166 // Per C++11 [namespace.def]p6, the innermost enclosing namespace is a 7167 // semantically-enclosing namespace, not a lexically-enclosing one. 7168 while (!DC->isFileContext() && !isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(DC)) 7169 DC = DC->getParent(); 7170 return true; 7171 } 7172 7173 /// Returns true if given declaration has external C language linkage. 7174 static bool isDeclExternC(const Decl *D) { 7175 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) 7176 return FD->isExternC(); 7177 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 7178 return VD->isExternC(); 7179 7180 llvm_unreachable("Unknown type of decl!"); 7181 } 7182 7183 /// Returns true if there hasn't been any invalid type diagnosed. 7184 static bool diagnoseOpenCLTypes(Sema &Se, VarDecl *NewVD) { 7185 DeclContext *DC = NewVD->getDeclContext(); 7186 QualType R = NewVD->getType(); 7187 7188 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.b - Image type can only be used as a function argument. 7189 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.13.16.1 - Pipe type can only be used as a function 7190 // argument. 7191 if (R->isImageType() || R->isPipeType()) { 7192 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), 7193 diag::err_opencl_type_can_only_be_used_as_function_parameter) 7194 << R; 7195 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7196 return false; 7197 } 7198 7199 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r: 7200 // The event type cannot be used to declare a program scope variable. 7201 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.q: 7202 // The clk_event_t and reserve_id_t types cannot be declared in program 7203 // scope. 7204 if (NewVD->hasGlobalStorage() && !NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 7205 if (R->isReserveIDT() || R->isClkEventT() || R->isEventT()) { 7206 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), 7207 diag::err_invalid_type_for_program_scope_var) 7208 << R; 7209 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7210 return false; 7211 } 7212 } 7213 7214 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed. 7215 if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("__cl_clang_function_pointers", 7216 Se.getLangOpts())) { 7217 QualType NR = R.getCanonicalType(); 7218 while (NR->isPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() || 7219 NR->isReferenceType()) { 7220 if (NR->isFunctionPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() || 7221 NR->isFunctionReferenceType()) { 7222 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_pointer) 7223 << NR->isReferenceType(); 7224 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7225 return false; 7226 } 7227 NR = NR->getPointeeType(); 7228 } 7229 } 7230 7231 if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", 7232 Se.getLangOpts())) { 7233 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1: reject declaring variables of the half and 7234 // half array type (unless the cl_khr_fp16 extension is enabled). 7235 if (Se.Context.getBaseElementType(R)->isHalfType()) { 7236 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_half_declaration) << R; 7237 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7238 return false; 7239 } 7240 } 7241 7242 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r: 7243 // The event type cannot be used with the __local, __constant and __global 7244 // address space qualifiers. 7245 if (R->isEventT()) { 7246 if (R.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private) { 7247 Se.Diag(NewVD->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_event_t_addr_space_qual); 7248 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7249 return false; 7250 } 7251 } 7252 7253 if (R->isSamplerT()) { 7254 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.b p4: 7255 // The sampler type cannot be used with the __local and __global address 7256 // space qualifiers. 7257 if (R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local || 7258 R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) { 7259 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_wrong_sampler_addressspace); 7260 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7261 } 7262 7263 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.12.14.1: 7264 // A global sampler must be declared with either the constant address 7265 // space qualifier or with the const qualifier. 7266 if (DC->isTranslationUnit() && 7267 !(R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 7268 R.isConstQualified())) { 7269 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_nonconst_global_sampler); 7270 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7271 } 7272 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7273 return false; 7274 } 7275 7276 return true; 7277 } 7278 7279 template <typename AttrTy> 7280 static void copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl(Sema &S, Decl *D, const TypedefType *TT) { 7281 const TypedefNameDecl *TND = TT->getDecl(); 7282 if (const auto *Attribute = TND->getAttr<AttrTy>()) { 7283 AttrTy *Clone = Attribute->clone(S.Context); 7284 Clone->setInherited(true); 7285 D->addAttr(Clone); 7286 } 7287 } 7288 7289 NamedDecl *Sema::ActOnVariableDeclarator( 7290 Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 7291 LookupResult &Previous, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists, 7292 bool &AddToScope, ArrayRef<BindingDecl *> Bindings) { 7293 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 7294 DeclarationName Name = GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 7295 7296 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 7297 7298 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 7299 // Take the name of the first declarator as our name for diagnostic 7300 // purposes. 7301 auto &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator(); 7302 if (!Decomp.bindings().empty()) { 7303 II = Decomp.bindings()[0].Name; 7304 Name = II; 7305 } 7306 } else if (!II) { 7307 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_variable_name) << Name; 7308 return nullptr; 7309 } 7310 7311 7312 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec(); 7313 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(D.getDeclSpec()); 7314 7315 // dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as extern. We 7316 // have to change the storage class this early to get the right DeclContext. 7317 if (SC == SC_None && !DC->isRecord() && 7318 hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLImport) && 7319 !hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLExport)) 7320 SC = SC_Extern; 7321 7322 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 7323 bool IsLocalExternDecl = SC == SC_Extern && 7324 adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 7325 7326 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 7327 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 7328 // an error here 7329 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 7330 D.setInvalidType(); 7331 SC = SC_None; 7332 } 7333 7334 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_register && 7335 !D.getAsmLabel() && !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro( 7336 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc())) { 7337 // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated. 7338 // Suppress the warning in system macros, it's used in macros in some 7339 // popular C system headers, such as in glibc's htonl() macro. 7340 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7341 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class 7342 : diag::warn_deprecated_register) 7343 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7344 } 7345 7346 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 7347 7348 if (!DC->isRecord() && S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 7349 // C99 6.9p2: The storage-class specifiers auto and register shall not 7350 // appear in the declaration specifiers in an external declaration. 7351 // Global Register+Asm is a GNU extension we support. 7352 if (SC == SC_Auto || (SC == SC_Register && !D.getAsmLabel())) { 7353 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_sclass_fscope); 7354 D.setInvalidType(); 7355 } 7356 } 7357 7358 // If this variable has a VLA type and an initializer, try to 7359 // fold to a constant-sized type. This is otherwise invalid. 7360 if (D.hasInitializer() && R->isVariableArrayType()) 7361 tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TInfo, R, D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7362 /*DiagID=*/0); 7363 7364 bool IsMemberSpecialization = false; 7365 bool IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = false; 7366 bool IsPartialSpecialization = false; 7367 bool IsVariableTemplate = false; 7368 VarDecl *NewVD = nullptr; 7369 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = nullptr; 7370 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = nullptr; 7371 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7372 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7373 II, R, TInfo, SC); 7374 7375 if (R->getContainedDeducedType()) 7376 ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD); 7377 7378 if (D.isInvalidType()) 7379 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7380 7381 if (NewVD->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() && 7382 NewVD->hasLocalStorage()) 7383 checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewVD->getType(), NewVD->getLocation(), 7384 NTCUC_AutoVar, NTCUK_Destruct); 7385 } else { 7386 bool Invalid = false; 7387 7388 if (DC->isRecord() && !CurContext->isRecord()) { 7389 // This is an out-of-line definition of a static data member. 7390 switch (SC) { 7391 case SC_None: 7392 break; 7393 case SC_Static: 7394 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7395 diag::err_static_out_of_line) 7396 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7397 break; 7398 case SC_Auto: 7399 case SC_Register: 7400 case SC_Extern: 7401 // [dcl.stc] p2: The auto or register specifiers shall be applied only 7402 // to names of variables declared in a block or to function parameters. 7403 // [dcl.stc] p6: The extern specifier cannot be used in the declaration 7404 // of class members 7405 7406 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7407 diag::err_storage_class_for_static_member) 7408 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7409 break; 7410 case SC_PrivateExtern: 7411 llvm_unreachable("C storage class in c++!"); 7412 } 7413 } 7414 7415 if (SC == SC_Static && CurContext->isRecord()) { 7416 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 7417 // Walk up the enclosing DeclContexts to check for any that are 7418 // incompatible with static data members. 7419 const DeclContext *FunctionOrMethod = nullptr; 7420 const CXXRecordDecl *AnonStruct = nullptr; 7421 for (DeclContext *Ctxt = DC; Ctxt; Ctxt = Ctxt->getParent()) { 7422 if (Ctxt->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 7423 FunctionOrMethod = Ctxt; 7424 break; 7425 } 7426 const CXXRecordDecl *ParentDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Ctxt); 7427 if (ParentDecl && !ParentDecl->getDeclName()) { 7428 AnonStruct = ParentDecl; 7429 break; 7430 } 7431 } 7432 if (FunctionOrMethod) { 7433 // C++ [class.static.data]p5: A local class shall not have static data 7434 // members. 7435 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7436 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_local_class) 7437 << Name << RD->getDeclName() << RD->getTagKind(); 7438 } else if (AnonStruct) { 7439 // C++ [class.static.data]p4: Unnamed classes and classes contained 7440 // directly or indirectly within unnamed classes shall not contain 7441 // static data members. 7442 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7443 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_anon_struct) 7444 << Name << AnonStruct->getTagKind(); 7445 Invalid = true; 7446 } else if (RD->isUnion()) { 7447 // C++98 [class.union]p1: If a union contains a static data member, 7448 // the program is ill-formed. C++11 drops this restriction. 7449 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7450 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 7451 ? diag::warn_cxx98_compat_static_data_member_in_union 7452 : diag::ext_static_data_member_in_union) << Name; 7453 } 7454 } 7455 } 7456 7457 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 7458 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 7459 bool InvalidScope = false; 7460 TemplateParams = MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 7461 D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7462 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 7463 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId 7464 ? D.getName().TemplateId 7465 : nullptr, 7466 TemplateParamLists, 7467 /*never a friend*/ false, IsMemberSpecialization, InvalidScope); 7468 Invalid |= InvalidScope; 7469 7470 if (TemplateParams) { 7471 if (!TemplateParams->size() && 7472 D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 7473 // There is an extraneous 'template<>' for this variable. Complain 7474 // about it, but allow the declaration of the variable. 7475 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 7476 diag::err_template_variable_noparams) 7477 << II 7478 << SourceRange(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 7479 TemplateParams->getRAngleLoc()); 7480 TemplateParams = nullptr; 7481 } else { 7482 // Check that we can declare a template here. 7483 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 7484 return nullptr; 7485 7486 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 7487 // This is an explicit specialization or a partial specialization. 7488 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = true; 7489 IsPartialSpecialization = TemplateParams->size() > 0; 7490 } else { // if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) 7491 // This is a template declaration. 7492 IsVariableTemplate = true; 7493 7494 // Only C++1y supports variable templates (N3651). 7495 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7496 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 7497 ? diag::warn_cxx11_compat_variable_template 7498 : diag::ext_variable_template); 7499 } 7500 } 7501 } else { 7502 // Check that we can declare a member specialization here. 7503 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && IsMemberSpecialization && 7504 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back())) 7505 return nullptr; 7506 assert((Invalid || 7507 D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) && 7508 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 7509 } 7510 7511 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) { 7512 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = 7513 TemplateParamLists.size() > 0 7514 ? TemplateParamLists[0]->getTemplateLoc() 7515 : SourceLocation(); 7516 DeclResult Res = ActOnVarTemplateSpecialization( 7517 S, D, TInfo, TemplateKWLoc, TemplateParams, SC, 7518 IsPartialSpecialization); 7519 if (Res.isInvalid()) 7520 return nullptr; 7521 NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(Res.get()); 7522 AddToScope = false; 7523 } else if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 7524 NewVD = DecompositionDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 7525 D.getIdentifierLoc(), R, TInfo, SC, 7526 Bindings); 7527 } else 7528 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 7529 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, R, TInfo, SC); 7530 7531 // If this is supposed to be a variable template, create it as such. 7532 if (IsVariableTemplate) { 7533 NewTemplate = 7534 VarTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, 7535 TemplateParams, NewVD); 7536 NewVD->setDescribedVarTemplate(NewTemplate); 7537 } 7538 7539 // If this decl has an auto type in need of deduction, make a note of the 7540 // Decl so we can diagnose uses of it in its own initializer. 7541 if (R->getContainedDeducedType()) 7542 ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD); 7543 7544 if (D.isInvalidType() || Invalid) { 7545 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7546 if (NewTemplate) 7547 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7548 } 7549 7550 SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewVD, D); 7551 7552 // If we have any template parameter lists that don't directly belong to 7553 // the variable (matching the scope specifier), store them. 7554 unsigned VDTemplateParamLists = TemplateParams ? 1 : 0; 7555 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > VDTemplateParamLists) 7556 NewVD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo( 7557 Context, TemplateParamLists.drop_back(VDTemplateParamLists)); 7558 } 7559 7560 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) { 7561 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7562 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 7563 << 0; 7564 } else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 7565 // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope variable declaration. 7566 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7567 diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name 7568 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc()); 7569 } else { 7570 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7571 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::warn_cxx14_compat_inline_variable 7572 : diag::ext_inline_variable); 7573 NewVD->setInlineSpecified(); 7574 } 7575 } 7576 7577 // Set the lexical context. If the declarator has a C++ scope specifier, the 7578 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 7579 NewVD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7580 if (NewTemplate) 7581 NewTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7582 7583 if (IsLocalExternDecl) { 7584 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) 7585 for (auto *B : Bindings) 7586 B->setLocalExternDecl(); 7587 else 7588 NewVD->setLocalExternDecl(); 7589 } 7590 7591 bool EmitTLSUnsupportedError = false; 7592 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) { 7593 // C++11 [dcl.stc]p4: 7594 // When thread_local is applied to a variable of block scope the 7595 // storage-class-specifier static is implied if it does not appear 7596 // explicitly. 7597 // Core issue: 'static' is not implied if the variable is declared 7598 // 'extern'. 7599 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && 7600 (SCSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified || 7601 TSCS != DeclSpec::TSCS_thread_local || 7602 !DC->isFunctionOrMethod())) 7603 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7604 diag::err_thread_non_global) 7605 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 7606 else if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isTLSSupported()) { 7607 if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice || 7608 getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) { 7609 // Postpone error emission until we've collected attributes required to 7610 // figure out whether it's a host or device variable and whether the 7611 // error should be ignored. 7612 EmitTLSUnsupportedError = true; 7613 // We still need to mark the variable as TLS so it shows up in AST with 7614 // proper storage class for other tools to use even if we're not going 7615 // to emit any code for it. 7616 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 7617 } else 7618 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7619 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7620 } else 7621 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 7622 } 7623 7624 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()) { 7625 case ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified: 7626 break; 7627 7628 case ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval: 7629 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7630 diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 7631 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 7632 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 7633 7634 case ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr: 7635 NewVD->setConstexpr(true); 7636 // C++1z [dcl.spec.constexpr]p1: 7637 // A static data member declared with the constexpr specifier is 7638 // implicitly an inline variable. 7639 if (NewVD->isStaticDataMember() && 7640 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 || 7641 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())) 7642 NewVD->setImplicitlyInline(); 7643 break; 7644 7645 case ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit: 7646 if (!NewVD->hasGlobalStorage()) 7647 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7648 diag::err_constinit_local_variable); 7649 else 7650 NewVD->addAttr(ConstInitAttr::Create( 7651 Context, D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7652 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, ConstInitAttr::Keyword_constinit)); 7653 break; 7654 } 7655 7656 // C99 6.7.4p3 7657 // An inline definition of a function with external linkage shall 7658 // not contain a definition of a modifiable object with static or 7659 // thread storage duration... 7660 // We only apply this when the function is required to be defined 7661 // elsewhere, i.e. when the function is not 'extern inline'. Note 7662 // that a local variable with thread storage duration still has to 7663 // be marked 'static'. Also note that it's possible to get these 7664 // semantics in C++ using __attribute__((gnu_inline)). 7665 if (SC == SC_Static && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 7666 !NewVD->getType().isConstQualified()) { 7667 FunctionDecl *CurFD = getCurFunctionDecl(); 7668 if (CurFD && isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(*this, CurFD)) { 7669 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7670 diag::warn_static_local_in_extern_inline); 7671 MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(CurFD); 7672 } 7673 } 7674 7675 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 7676 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 7677 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 7678 << (IsPartialSpecialization ? 1 : 0) 7679 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7680 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7681 else if (IsMemberSpecialization) 7682 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 7683 << 2 7684 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7685 else if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage()) 7686 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 7687 << 0 << NewVD 7688 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 7689 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7690 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7691 else { 7692 NewVD->setModulePrivate(); 7693 if (NewTemplate) 7694 NewTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 7695 for (auto *B : Bindings) 7696 B->setModulePrivate(); 7697 } 7698 } 7699 7700 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7701 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(NewVD); 7702 7703 DeclSpec::TSCS TSC = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec(); 7704 if (TSC != TSCS_unspecified) { 7705 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7706 diag::err_opencl_unknown_type_specifier) 7707 << getLangOpts().getOpenCLVersionString() 7708 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSC) << 1; 7709 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7710 } 7711 } 7712 7713 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 7714 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewVD, D); 7715 7716 // FIXME: This is probably the wrong location to be doing this and we should 7717 // probably be doing this for more attributes (especially for function 7718 // pointer attributes such as format, warn_unused_result, etc.). Ideally 7719 // the code to copy attributes would be generated by TableGen. 7720 if (R->isFunctionPointerType()) 7721 if (const auto *TT = R->getAs<TypedefType>()) 7722 copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl<AllocSizeAttr>(*this, NewVD, TT); 7723 7724 if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice || 7725 getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) { 7726 if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError && 7727 ((getLangOpts().CUDA && DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) || 7728 (getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice && 7729 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::isDeclareTargetDeclaration(NewVD)))) 7730 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7731 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7732 7733 if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError && 7734 (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice || (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice))) 7735 targetDiag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7736 // CUDA B.2.5: "__shared__ and __constant__ variables have implied static 7737 // storage [duration]." 7738 if (SC == SC_None && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 7739 (NewVD->hasAttr<CUDASharedAttr>() || 7740 NewVD->hasAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>())) { 7741 NewVD->setStorageClass(SC_Static); 7742 } 7743 } 7744 7745 // Ensure that dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as 7746 // extern. The storage class is set above using parsed attributes. Now we can 7747 // check the VarDecl itself. 7748 assert(!NewVD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() || 7749 NewVD->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>()->isInherited() || 7750 NewVD->isStaticDataMember() || NewVD->getStorageClass() != SC_None); 7751 7752 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for variables of 7753 // retainable type. 7754 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewVD)) 7755 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7756 7757 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 7758 if (Expr *E = (Expr*)D.getAsmLabel()) { 7759 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 7760 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 7761 StringRef Label = SE->getString(); 7762 if (S->getFnParent() != nullptr) { 7763 switch (SC) { 7764 case SC_None: 7765 case SC_Auto: 7766 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_asm_label_on_auto_decl) << Label; 7767 break; 7768 case SC_Register: 7769 // Local Named register 7770 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isValidGCCRegisterName(Label) && 7771 DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), getCurFunctionDecl())) 7772 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 7773 break; 7774 case SC_Static: 7775 case SC_Extern: 7776 case SC_PrivateExtern: 7777 break; 7778 } 7779 } else if (SC == SC_Register) { 7780 // Global Named register 7781 if (DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) { 7782 const auto &TI = Context.getTargetInfo(); 7783 bool HasSizeMismatch; 7784 7785 if (!TI.isValidGCCRegisterName(Label)) 7786 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 7787 else if (!TI.validateGlobalRegisterVariable(Label, 7788 Context.getTypeSize(R), 7789 HasSizeMismatch)) 7790 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_invalid_global_var_reg) << Label; 7791 else if (HasSizeMismatch) 7792 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_register_size_mismatch) << Label; 7793 } 7794 7795 if (!R->isIntegralType(Context) && !R->isPointerType()) { 7796 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_asm_bad_register_type); 7797 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(true); 7798 } 7799 } 7800 7801 NewVD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, Label, 7802 /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, 7803 SE->getStrTokenLoc(0))); 7804 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) { 7805 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 7806 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewVD->getIdentifier()); 7807 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 7808 if (isDeclExternC(NewVD)) { 7809 NewVD->addAttr(I->second); 7810 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 7811 } else 7812 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 7813 << /*Variable*/1 << NewVD; 7814 } 7815 } 7816 7817 // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope. 7818 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = D.getCXXScopeSpec().isEmpty() 7819 ? getShadowedDeclaration(NewVD, Previous) 7820 : nullptr; 7821 7822 // Don't consider existing declarations that are in a different 7823 // scope and are out-of-semantic-context declarations (if the new 7824 // declaration has linkage). 7825 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewVD), 7826 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 7827 IsMemberSpecialization || 7828 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization); 7829 7830 // Check whether the previous declaration is in the same block scope. This 7831 // affects whether we merge types with it, per C++11 [dcl.array]p3. 7832 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 7833 NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) 7834 NewVD->setPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope( 7835 Previous.isSingleResult() && !Previous.isShadowed() && 7836 isDeclInScope(Previous.getFoundDecl(), OriginalDC, S, false)); 7837 7838 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7839 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 7840 } else { 7841 // If this is an explicit specialization of a static data member, check it. 7842 if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 7843 CheckMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous)) 7844 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7845 7846 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. 7847 if (!Previous.empty()) { 7848 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 7849 isa<FieldDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()) && 7850 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 7851 // The user tried to define a non-static data member 7852 // out-of-line (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 7853 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_nonstatic_member_out_of_line) 7854 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 7855 Previous.clear(); 7856 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7857 } 7858 } else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 7859 // No previous declaration in the qualifying scope. 7860 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 7861 << Name << computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), true) 7862 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 7863 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7864 } 7865 7866 if (!IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 7867 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 7868 7869 if (NewTemplate) { 7870 VarTemplateDecl *PrevVarTemplate = 7871 NewVD->getPreviousDecl() 7872 ? NewVD->getPreviousDecl()->getDescribedVarTemplate() 7873 : nullptr; 7874 7875 // Check the template parameter list of this declaration, possibly 7876 // merging in the template parameter list from the previous variable 7877 // template declaration. 7878 if (CheckTemplateParameterList( 7879 TemplateParams, 7880 PrevVarTemplate ? PrevVarTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 7881 : nullptr, 7882 (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && DC && DC->isRecord() && 7883 DC->isDependentContext()) 7884 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 7885 : TPC_VarTemplate)) 7886 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7887 7888 // If we are providing an explicit specialization of a static variable 7889 // template, make a note of that. 7890 if (PrevVarTemplate && 7891 PrevVarTemplate->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) 7892 PrevVarTemplate->setMemberSpecialization(); 7893 } 7894 } 7895 7896 // Diagnose shadowed variables iff this isn't a redeclaration. 7897 if (ShadowedDecl && !D.isRedeclaration()) 7898 CheckShadow(NewVD, ShadowedDecl, Previous); 7899 7900 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewVD); 7901 7902 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 7903 // the map of such variables. 7904 if (NewVD->isFirstDecl() && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 7905 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewVD)) 7906 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewVD, S); 7907 7908 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 7909 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 7910 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 7911 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 7912 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext()); 7913 if (MCtx) { 7914 Context.setManglingNumber( 7915 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 7916 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 7917 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 7918 } 7919 } 7920 7921 // Special handling of variable named 'main'. 7922 if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && Name.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("main") && 7923 NewVD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 7924 !getLangOpts().Freestanding && !NewVD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) { 7925 7926 // C++ [basic.start.main]p3 7927 // A program that declares a variable main at global scope is ill-formed. 7928 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 7929 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_main_global_variable); 7930 7931 // In C, and external-linkage variable named main results in undefined 7932 // behavior. 7933 else if (NewVD->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) 7934 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::warn_main_redefined); 7935 } 7936 7937 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 7938 NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 7939 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewVD, IsMemberSpecialization, 7940 D.isFunctionDefinition()); 7941 } 7942 7943 if (NewTemplate) { 7944 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7945 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7946 ActOnDocumentableDecl(NewTemplate); 7947 return NewTemplate; 7948 } 7949 7950 if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7951 CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous); 7952 7953 return NewVD; 7954 } 7955 7956 /// Enum describing the %select options in diag::warn_decl_shadow. 7957 enum ShadowedDeclKind { 7958 SDK_Local, 7959 SDK_Global, 7960 SDK_StaticMember, 7961 SDK_Field, 7962 SDK_Typedef, 7963 SDK_Using, 7964 SDK_StructuredBinding 7965 }; 7966 7967 /// Determine what kind of declaration we're shadowing. 7968 static ShadowedDeclKind computeShadowedDeclKind(const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl, 7969 const DeclContext *OldDC) { 7970 if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7971 return SDK_Using; 7972 else if (isa<TypedefDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7973 return SDK_Typedef; 7974 else if (isa<BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7975 return SDK_StructuredBinding; 7976 else if (isa<RecordDecl>(OldDC)) 7977 return isa<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? SDK_Field : SDK_StaticMember; 7978 7979 return OldDC->isFileContext() ? SDK_Global : SDK_Local; 7980 } 7981 7982 /// Return the location of the capture if the given lambda captures the given 7983 /// variable \p VD, or an invalid source location otherwise. 7984 static SourceLocation getCaptureLocation(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 7985 const VarDecl *VD) { 7986 for (const Capture &Capture : LSI->Captures) { 7987 if (Capture.isVariableCapture() && Capture.getVariable() == VD) 7988 return Capture.getLocation(); 7989 } 7990 return SourceLocation(); 7991 } 7992 7993 static bool shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(const DiagnosticsEngine &Diags, 7994 const LookupResult &R) { 7995 // Only diagnose if we're shadowing an unambiguous field or variable. 7996 if (R.getResultKind() != LookupResult::Found) 7997 return false; 7998 7999 // Return false if warning is ignored. 8000 return !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, R.getNameLoc()); 8001 } 8002 8003 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null 8004 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 8005 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const VarDecl *D, 8006 const LookupResult &R) { 8007 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 8008 return nullptr; 8009 8010 // Don't diagnose declarations at file scope. 8011 if (D->hasGlobalStorage()) 8012 return nullptr; 8013 8014 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 8015 return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl 8016 : nullptr; 8017 } 8018 8019 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given typedef \p D, or null 8020 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 8021 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const TypedefNameDecl *D, 8022 const LookupResult &R) { 8023 // Don't warn if typedef declaration is part of a class 8024 if (D->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) 8025 return nullptr; 8026 8027 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 8028 return nullptr; 8029 8030 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 8031 return isa<TypedefNameDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl : nullptr; 8032 } 8033 8034 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null 8035 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 8036 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const BindingDecl *D, 8037 const LookupResult &R) { 8038 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 8039 return nullptr; 8040 8041 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 8042 return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl 8043 : nullptr; 8044 } 8045 8046 /// Diagnose variable or built-in function shadowing. Implements 8047 /// -Wshadow. 8048 /// 8049 /// This method is called whenever a VarDecl is added to a "useful" 8050 /// scope. 8051 /// 8052 /// \param ShadowedDecl the declaration that is shadowed by the given variable 8053 /// \param R the lookup of the name 8054 /// 8055 void Sema::CheckShadow(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl, 8056 const LookupResult &R) { 8057 DeclContext *NewDC = D->getDeclContext(); 8058 8059 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) { 8060 // Fields are not shadowed by variables in C++ static methods. 8061 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) 8062 if (MD->isStatic()) 8063 return; 8064 8065 // Fields shadowed by constructor parameters are a special case. Usually 8066 // the constructor initializes the field with the parameter. 8067 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewDC)) 8068 if (const auto PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D)) { 8069 // Remember that this was shadowed so we can either warn about its 8070 // modification or its existence depending on warning settings. 8071 ShadowingDecls.insert({PVD->getCanonicalDecl(), FD}); 8072 return; 8073 } 8074 } 8075 8076 if (VarDecl *shadowedVar = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 8077 if (shadowedVar->isExternC()) { 8078 // For shadowing external vars, make sure that we point to the global 8079 // declaration, not a locally scoped extern declaration. 8080 for (auto I : shadowedVar->redecls()) 8081 if (I->isFileVarDecl()) { 8082 ShadowedDecl = I; 8083 break; 8084 } 8085 } 8086 8087 DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 8088 8089 unsigned WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow; 8090 SourceLocation CaptureLoc; 8091 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && isa<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl) && NewDC && 8092 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) { 8093 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewDC->getParent())) { 8094 if (RD->isLambda() && OldDC->Encloses(NewDC->getLexicalParent())) { 8095 if (RD->getLambdaCaptureDefault() == LCD_None) { 8096 // Try to avoid warnings for lambdas with an explicit capture list. 8097 const auto *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction()); 8098 // Warn only when the lambda captures the shadowed decl explicitly. 8099 CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)); 8100 if (CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 8101 WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local; 8102 } else { 8103 // Remember that this was shadowed so we can avoid the warning if the 8104 // shadowed decl isn't captured and the warning settings allow it. 8105 cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction()) 8106 ->ShadowingDecls.push_back( 8107 {cast<VarDecl>(D), cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)}); 8108 return; 8109 } 8110 } 8111 8112 if (cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)->hasLocalStorage()) { 8113 // A variable can't shadow a local variable in an enclosing scope, if 8114 // they are separated by a non-capturing declaration context. 8115 for (DeclContext *ParentDC = NewDC; 8116 ParentDC && !ParentDC->Equals(OldDC); 8117 ParentDC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(ParentDC)) { 8118 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions 8119 // can capture; other scopes don't. 8120 if (!isa<BlockDecl>(ParentDC) && !isa<CapturedDecl>(ParentDC) && 8121 !isLambdaCallOperator(ParentDC)) { 8122 return; 8123 } 8124 } 8125 } 8126 } 8127 } 8128 8129 // Only warn about certain kinds of shadowing for class members. 8130 if (NewDC && NewDC->isRecord()) { 8131 // In particular, don't warn about shadowing non-class members. 8132 if (!OldDC->isRecord()) 8133 return; 8134 8135 // TODO: should we warn about static data members shadowing 8136 // static data members from base classes? 8137 8138 // TODO: don't diagnose for inaccessible shadowed members. 8139 // This is hard to do perfectly because we might friend the 8140 // shadowing context, but that's just a false negative. 8141 } 8142 8143 8144 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName(); 8145 8146 // Emit warning and note. 8147 ShadowedDeclKind Kind = computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC); 8148 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), WarningDiag) << Name << Kind << OldDC; 8149 if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 8150 Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here) 8151 << Name << /*explicitly*/ 1; 8152 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 8153 } 8154 8155 /// Diagnose shadowing for variables shadowed in the lambda record \p LambdaRD 8156 /// when these variables are captured by the lambda. 8157 void Sema::DiagnoseShadowingLambdaDecls(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI) { 8158 for (const auto &Shadow : LSI->ShadowingDecls) { 8159 const VarDecl *ShadowedDecl = Shadow.ShadowedDecl; 8160 // Try to avoid the warning when the shadowed decl isn't captured. 8161 SourceLocation CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, ShadowedDecl); 8162 const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext(); 8163 Diag(Shadow.VD->getLocation(), CaptureLoc.isInvalid() 8164 ? diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local 8165 : diag::warn_decl_shadow) 8166 << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() 8167 << computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC) << OldDC; 8168 if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 8169 Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here) 8170 << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() << /*explicitly*/ 0; 8171 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 8172 } 8173 } 8174 8175 /// Check -Wshadow without the advantage of a previous lookup. 8176 void Sema::CheckShadow(Scope *S, VarDecl *D) { 8177 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, D->getLocation())) 8178 return; 8179 8180 LookupResult R(*this, D->getDeclName(), D->getLocation(), 8181 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 8182 LookupName(R, S); 8183 if (NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(D, R)) 8184 CheckShadow(D, ShadowedDecl, R); 8185 } 8186 8187 /// Check if 'E', which is an expression that is about to be modified, refers 8188 /// to a constructor parameter that shadows a field. 8189 void Sema::CheckShadowingDeclModification(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 8190 // Quickly ignore expressions that can't be shadowing ctor parameters. 8191 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || ShadowingDecls.empty()) 8192 return; 8193 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8194 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 8195 if (!DRE) 8196 return; 8197 const NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(DRE->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 8198 auto I = ShadowingDecls.find(D); 8199 if (I == ShadowingDecls.end()) 8200 return; 8201 const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = I->second; 8202 const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext(); 8203 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_modifying_shadowing_decl) << D << OldDC; 8204 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_var_declared_here) << D; 8205 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 8206 8207 // Avoid issuing multiple warnings about the same decl. 8208 ShadowingDecls.erase(I); 8209 } 8210 8211 /// Check for conflict between this global or extern "C" declaration and 8212 /// previous global or extern "C" declarations. This is only used in C++. 8213 template<typename T> 8214 static bool checkGlobalOrExternCConflict( 8215 Sema &S, const T *ND, bool IsGlobal, LookupResult &Previous) { 8216 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "only C++ has extern \"C\""); 8217 NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName()); 8218 8219 if (!Prev && IsGlobal && !isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 8220 // The common case: this global doesn't conflict with any extern "C" 8221 // declaration. 8222 return false; 8223 } 8224 8225 if (Prev) { 8226 if (!IsGlobal || isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 8227 // Both the old and new declarations have C language linkage. This is a 8228 // redeclaration. 8229 Previous.clear(); 8230 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 8231 return true; 8232 } 8233 8234 // This is a global, non-extern "C" declaration, and there is a previous 8235 // non-global extern "C" declaration. Diagnose if this is a variable 8236 // declaration. 8237 if (!isa<VarDecl>(ND)) 8238 return false; 8239 } else { 8240 // The declaration is extern "C". Check for any declaration in the 8241 // translation unit which might conflict. 8242 if (IsGlobal) { 8243 // We have already performed the lookup into the translation unit. 8244 IsGlobal = false; 8245 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 8246 I != E; ++I) { 8247 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 8248 Prev = *I; 8249 break; 8250 } 8251 } 8252 } else { 8253 DeclContext::lookup_result R = 8254 S.Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()->lookup(ND->getDeclName()); 8255 for (DeclContext::lookup_result::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); 8256 I != E; ++I) { 8257 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 8258 Prev = *I; 8259 break; 8260 } 8261 // FIXME: If we have any other entity with this name in global scope, 8262 // the declaration is ill-formed, but that is a defect: it breaks the 8263 // 'stat' hack, for instance. Only variables can have mangled name 8264 // clashes with extern "C" declarations, so only they deserve a 8265 // diagnostic. 8266 } 8267 } 8268 8269 if (!Prev) 8270 return false; 8271 } 8272 8273 // Use the first declaration's location to ensure we point at something which 8274 // is lexically inside an extern "C" linkage-spec. 8275 assert(Prev && "should have found a previous declaration to diagnose"); 8276 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Prev)) 8277 Prev = FD->getFirstDecl(); 8278 else 8279 Prev = cast<VarDecl>(Prev)->getFirstDecl(); 8280 8281 S.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_c_global_conflict) 8282 << IsGlobal << ND; 8283 S.Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_extern_c_global_conflict) 8284 << IsGlobal; 8285 return false; 8286 } 8287 8288 /// Apply special rules for handling extern "C" declarations. Returns \c true 8289 /// if we have found that this is a redeclaration of some prior entity. 8290 /// 8291 /// Per C++ [dcl.link]p6: 8292 /// Two declarations [for a function or variable] with C language linkage 8293 /// with the same name that appear in different scopes refer to the same 8294 /// [entity]. An entity with C language linkage shall not be declared with 8295 /// the same name as an entity in global scope. 8296 template<typename T> 8297 static bool checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(Sema &S, const T *ND, 8298 LookupResult &Previous) { 8299 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8300 // In C, when declaring a global variable, look for a corresponding 'extern' 8301 // variable declared in function scope. We don't need this in C++, because 8302 // we find local extern decls in the surrounding file-scope DeclContext. 8303 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 8304 if (NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName())) { 8305 Previous.clear(); 8306 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 8307 return true; 8308 } 8309 } 8310 return false; 8311 } 8312 8313 // A declaration in the translation unit can conflict with an extern "C" 8314 // declaration. 8315 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 8316 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/true, Previous); 8317 8318 // An extern "C" declaration can conflict with a declaration in the 8319 // translation unit or can be a redeclaration of an extern "C" declaration 8320 // in another scope. 8321 if (isIncompleteDeclExternC(S,ND)) 8322 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/false, Previous); 8323 8324 // Neither global nor extern "C": nothing to do. 8325 return false; 8326 } 8327 8328 void Sema::CheckVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *NewVD) { 8329 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 8330 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 8331 return; 8332 8333 QualType T = NewVD->getType(); 8334 8335 // Defer checking an 'auto' type until its initializer is attached. 8336 if (T->isUndeducedType()) 8337 return; 8338 8339 if (NewVD->hasAttrs()) 8340 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewVD); 8341 8342 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 8343 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 8344 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NewVD->getLocation(), "*"); 8345 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 8346 NewVD->setType(T); 8347 } 8348 8349 // Emit an error if an address space was applied to decl with local storage. 8350 // This includes arrays of objects with address space qualifiers, but not 8351 // automatic variables that point to other address spaces. 8352 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S5.1.2 8353 if (!getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && 8354 T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 8355 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 0; 8356 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8357 return; 8358 } 8359 8360 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 - The static qualifier is valid only in program 8361 // scope. 8362 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion == 120 && 8363 !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_clang_storage_class_specifiers", 8364 getLangOpts()) && 8365 NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 8366 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_static_function_scope); 8367 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8368 return; 8369 } 8370 8371 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 8372 if (!diagnoseOpenCLTypes(*this, NewVD)) 8373 return; 8374 8375 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The __block storage type is not supported. 8376 if (NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8377 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_block_storage_type); 8378 return; 8379 } 8380 8381 if (T->isBlockPointerType()) { 8382 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Any block declaration must be const qualified and 8383 // can't use 'extern' storage class. 8384 if (!T.isConstQualified()) { 8385 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration) 8386 << 0 /*const*/; 8387 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8388 return; 8389 } 8390 if (NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) { 8391 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_extern_block_declaration); 8392 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8393 return; 8394 } 8395 } 8396 8397 // FIXME: Adding local AS in C++ for OpenCL might make sense. 8398 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl() || NewVD->isStaticLocal() || 8399 NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) { 8400 if (!T->isSamplerT() && !T->isDependentType() && 8401 !(T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 8402 (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global && 8403 getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported( 8404 getLangOpts())))) { 8405 int Scope = NewVD->isStaticLocal() | NewVD->hasExternalStorage() << 1; 8406 if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts())) 8407 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space) 8408 << Scope << "global or constant"; 8409 else 8410 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space) 8411 << Scope << "constant"; 8412 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8413 return; 8414 } 8415 } else { 8416 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) { 8417 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8418 << 1 /*is any function*/ << "global"; 8419 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8420 return; 8421 } 8422 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 8423 T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) { 8424 FunctionDecl *FD = getCurFunctionDecl(); 8425 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: no local or constant variables 8426 // in functions. 8427 if (FD && !FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 8428 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) 8429 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8430 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "constant"; 8431 else 8432 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8433 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "local"; 8434 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8435 return; 8436 } 8437 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: local and constant variables must be 8438 // in the outermost scope of a kernel function. 8439 if (FD && FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 8440 if (!getCurScope()->isFunctionScope()) { 8441 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) 8442 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope) 8443 << "constant"; 8444 else 8445 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope) 8446 << "local"; 8447 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8448 return; 8449 } 8450 } 8451 } else if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private && 8452 // If we are parsing a template we didn't deduce an addr 8453 // space yet. 8454 T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 8455 // Do not allow other address spaces on automatic variable. 8456 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 1; 8457 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8458 return; 8459 } 8460 } 8461 } 8462 8463 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T.isObjCGCWeak() 8464 && !NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8465 if (getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC) 8466 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_gc_attribute_weak_on_local); 8467 else { 8468 assert(!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 8469 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_local); 8470 } 8471 } 8472 8473 bool isVM = T->isVariablyModifiedType(); 8474 if (isVM || NewVD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>() || 8475 NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 8476 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 8477 8478 if ((isVM && NewVD->hasLinkage()) || 8479 (T->isVariableArrayType() && NewVD->hasGlobalStorage())) { 8480 bool SizeIsNegative; 8481 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 8482 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo( 8483 NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 8484 QualType FixedT; 8485 if (FixedTInfo && T == NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()) 8486 FixedT = FixedTInfo->getType(); 8487 else if (FixedTInfo) { 8488 // Type and type-as-written are canonically different. We need to fix up 8489 // both types separately. 8490 FixedT = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(T, Context, SizeIsNegative, 8491 Oversized); 8492 } 8493 if ((!FixedTInfo || FixedT.isNull()) && T->isVariableArrayType()) { 8494 const VariableArrayType *VAT = Context.getAsVariableArrayType(T); 8495 // FIXME: This won't give the correct result for 8496 // int a[10][n]; 8497 SourceRange SizeRange = VAT->getSizeExpr()->getSourceRange(); 8498 8499 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 8500 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope) 8501 << SizeRange; 8502 else if (NewVD->isStaticLocal()) 8503 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_static_storage) 8504 << SizeRange; 8505 else 8506 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_extern_linkage) 8507 << SizeRange; 8508 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8509 return; 8510 } 8511 8512 if (!FixedTInfo) { 8513 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 8514 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 8515 else 8516 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_has_extern_linkage); 8517 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8518 return; 8519 } 8520 8521 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 8522 NewVD->setType(FixedT); 8523 NewVD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 8524 } 8525 8526 if (T->isVoidType()) { 8527 // C++98 [dcl.stc]p5: The extern specifier can be applied only to the names 8528 // of objects and functions. 8529 if (NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8530 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type) 8531 << T; 8532 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8533 return; 8534 } 8535 } 8536 8537 if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8538 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 8539 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8540 return; 8541 } 8542 8543 if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T->isSizelessType()) { 8544 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_sizeless_nonlocal) << T; 8545 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8546 return; 8547 } 8548 8549 if (isVM && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8550 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_vm); 8551 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8552 return; 8553 } 8554 8555 if (NewVD->isConstexpr() && !T->isDependentType() && 8556 RequireLiteralType(NewVD->getLocation(), T, 8557 diag::err_constexpr_var_non_literal)) { 8558 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8559 return; 8560 } 8561 8562 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as non-local variable types. 8563 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 8564 !NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && 8565 CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewVD->getLocation())) { 8566 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8567 return; 8568 } 8569 } 8570 8571 /// Perform semantic checking on a newly-created variable 8572 /// declaration. 8573 /// 8574 /// This routine performs all of the type-checking required for a 8575 /// variable declaration once it has been built. It is used both to 8576 /// check variables after they have been parsed and their declarators 8577 /// have been translated into a declaration, and to check variables 8578 /// that have been instantiated from a template. 8579 /// 8580 /// Sets NewVD->isInvalidDecl() if an error was encountered. 8581 /// 8582 /// Returns true if the variable declaration is a redeclaration. 8583 bool Sema::CheckVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *NewVD, LookupResult &Previous) { 8584 CheckVariableDeclarationType(NewVD); 8585 8586 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 8587 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 8588 return false; 8589 8590 // If we did not find anything by this name, look for a non-visible 8591 // extern "C" declaration with the same name. 8592 if (Previous.empty() && 8593 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewVD, Previous)) 8594 Previous.setShadowed(); 8595 8596 if (!Previous.empty()) { 8597 MergeVarDecl(NewVD, Previous); 8598 return true; 8599 } 8600 return false; 8601 } 8602 8603 /// AddOverriddenMethods - See if a method overrides any in the base classes, 8604 /// and if so, check that it's a valid override and remember it. 8605 bool Sema::AddOverriddenMethods(CXXRecordDecl *DC, CXXMethodDecl *MD) { 8606 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const CXXMethodDecl*, 4> Overridden; 8607 8608 // Look for methods in base classes that this method might override. 8609 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/false, 8610 /*DetectVirtual=*/false); 8611 auto VisitBase = [&] (const CXXBaseSpecifier *Specifier, CXXBasePath &Path) { 8612 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = Specifier->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 8613 DeclarationName Name = MD->getDeclName(); 8614 8615 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 8616 // We really want to find the base class destructor here. 8617 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(BaseRecord); 8618 CanQualType CT = Context.getCanonicalType(T); 8619 Name = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(CT); 8620 } 8621 8622 for (NamedDecl *BaseND : BaseRecord->lookup(Name)) { 8623 CXXMethodDecl *BaseMD = 8624 dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(BaseND->getCanonicalDecl()); 8625 if (!BaseMD || !BaseMD->isVirtual() || 8626 IsOverload(MD, BaseMD, /*UseMemberUsingDeclRules=*/false, 8627 /*ConsiderCudaAttrs=*/true, 8628 // C++2a [class.virtual]p2 does not consider requires 8629 // clauses when overriding. 8630 /*ConsiderRequiresClauses=*/false)) 8631 continue; 8632 8633 if (Overridden.insert(BaseMD).second) { 8634 MD->addOverriddenMethod(BaseMD); 8635 CheckOverridingFunctionReturnType(MD, BaseMD); 8636 CheckOverridingFunctionAttributes(MD, BaseMD); 8637 CheckOverridingFunctionExceptionSpec(MD, BaseMD); 8638 CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal(MD, BaseMD); 8639 } 8640 8641 // A method can only override one function from each base class. We 8642 // don't track indirectly overridden methods from bases of bases. 8643 return true; 8644 } 8645 8646 return false; 8647 }; 8648 8649 DC->lookupInBases(VisitBase, Paths); 8650 return !Overridden.empty(); 8651 } 8652 8653 namespace { 8654 // Struct for holding all of the extra arguments needed by 8655 // DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration to call Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator. 8656 struct ActOnFDArgs { 8657 Scope *S; 8658 Declarator &D; 8659 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists; 8660 bool AddToScope; 8661 }; 8662 } // end anonymous namespace 8663 8664 namespace { 8665 8666 // Callback to only accept typo corrections that have a non-zero edit distance. 8667 // Also only accept corrections that have the same parent decl. 8668 class DifferentNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 8669 public: 8670 DifferentNameValidatorCCC(ASTContext &Context, FunctionDecl *TypoFD, 8671 CXXRecordDecl *Parent) 8672 : Context(Context), OriginalFD(TypoFD), 8673 ExpectedParent(Parent ? Parent->getCanonicalDecl() : nullptr) {} 8674 8675 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 8676 if (candidate.getEditDistance() == 0) 8677 return false; 8678 8679 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 8680 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator CDecl = candidate.begin(), 8681 CDeclEnd = candidate.end(); 8682 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 8683 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 8684 8685 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 8686 hasSimilarParameters(Context, FD, OriginalFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8687 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 8688 CXXRecordDecl *Parent = MD->getParent(); 8689 if (Parent && Parent->getCanonicalDecl() == ExpectedParent) 8690 return true; 8691 } else if (!ExpectedParent) { 8692 return true; 8693 } 8694 } 8695 } 8696 8697 return false; 8698 } 8699 8700 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 8701 return std::make_unique<DifferentNameValidatorCCC>(*this); 8702 } 8703 8704 private: 8705 ASTContext &Context; 8706 FunctionDecl *OriginalFD; 8707 CXXRecordDecl *ExpectedParent; 8708 }; 8709 8710 } // end anonymous namespace 8711 8712 void Sema::MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(const NamedDecl *F) { 8713 TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.insert(F); 8714 } 8715 8716 /// Generate diagnostics for an invalid function redeclaration. 8717 /// 8718 /// This routine handles generating the diagnostic messages for an invalid 8719 /// function redeclaration, including finding possible similar declarations 8720 /// or performing typo correction if there are no previous declarations with 8721 /// the same name. 8722 /// 8723 /// Returns a NamedDecl iff typo correction was performed and substituting in 8724 /// the new declaration name does not cause new errors. 8725 static NamedDecl *DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 8726 Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Previous, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 8727 ActOnFDArgs &ExtraArgs, bool IsLocalFriend, Scope *S) { 8728 DeclarationName Name = NewFD->getDeclName(); 8729 DeclContext *NewDC = NewFD->getDeclContext(); 8730 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 8731 SmallVector<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned>, 1> NearMatches; 8732 TypoCorrection Correction; 8733 bool IsDefinition = ExtraArgs.D.isFunctionDefinition(); 8734 unsigned DiagMsg = 8735 IsLocalFriend ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend : 8736 NewFD->getFriendObjectKind() ? diag::err_qualified_friend_no_match : 8737 diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match; 8738 LookupResult Prev(SemaRef, Name, NewFD->getLocation(), 8739 IsLocalFriend ? Sema::LookupLocalFriendName 8740 : Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, 8741 Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 8742 8743 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8744 if (IsLocalFriend) 8745 SemaRef.LookupName(Prev, S); 8746 else 8747 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(Prev, NewDC); 8748 assert(!Prev.isAmbiguous() && 8749 "Cannot have an ambiguity in previous-declaration lookup"); 8750 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 8751 DifferentNameValidatorCCC CCC(SemaRef.Context, NewFD, 8752 MD ? MD->getParent() : nullptr); 8753 if (!Prev.empty()) { 8754 for (LookupResult::iterator Func = Prev.begin(), FuncEnd = Prev.end(); 8755 Func != FuncEnd; ++Func) { 8756 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*Func); 8757 if (FD && 8758 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8759 // Add 1 to the index so that 0 can mean the mismatch didn't 8760 // involve a parameter 8761 unsigned ParamNum = 8762 MismatchedParams.empty() ? 0 : MismatchedParams.front() + 1; 8763 NearMatches.push_back(std::make_pair(FD, ParamNum)); 8764 } 8765 } 8766 // If the qualified name lookup yielded nothing, try typo correction 8767 } else if ((Correction = SemaRef.CorrectTypo( 8768 Prev.getLookupNameInfo(), Prev.getLookupKind(), S, 8769 &ExtraArgs.D.getCXXScopeSpec(), CCC, Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery, 8770 IsLocalFriend ? nullptr : NewDC))) { 8771 // Set up everything for the call to ActOnFunctionDeclarator 8772 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), 8773 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8774 Previous.clear(); 8775 Previous.setLookupName(Correction.getCorrection()); 8776 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CDecl = Correction.begin(), 8777 CDeclEnd = Correction.end(); 8778 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 8779 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 8780 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 8781 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8782 Previous.addDecl(FD); 8783 } 8784 } 8785 bool wasRedeclaration = ExtraArgs.D.isRedeclaration(); 8786 8787 NamedDecl *Result; 8788 // Retry building the function declaration with the new previous 8789 // declarations, and with errors suppressed. 8790 { 8791 // Trap errors. 8792 Sema::SFINAETrap Trap(SemaRef); 8793 8794 // TODO: Refactor ActOnFunctionDeclarator so that we can call only the 8795 // pieces need to verify the typo-corrected C++ declaration and hopefully 8796 // eliminate the need for the parameter pack ExtraArgs. 8797 Result = SemaRef.ActOnFunctionDeclarator( 8798 ExtraArgs.S, ExtraArgs.D, 8799 Correction.getCorrectionDecl()->getDeclContext(), 8800 NewFD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Previous, ExtraArgs.TemplateParamLists, 8801 ExtraArgs.AddToScope); 8802 8803 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 8804 Result = nullptr; 8805 } 8806 8807 if (Result) { 8808 // Determine which correction we picked. 8809 Decl *Canonical = Result->getCanonicalDecl(); 8810 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 8811 I != E; ++I) 8812 if ((*I)->getCanonicalDecl() == Canonical) 8813 Correction.setCorrectionDecl(*I); 8814 8815 // Let Sema know about the correction. 8816 SemaRef.MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(Result); 8817 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo( 8818 Correction, 8819 SemaRef.PDiag(IsLocalFriend 8820 ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend_suggest 8821 : diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match_suggest) 8822 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition); 8823 return Result; 8824 } 8825 8826 // Pretend the typo correction never occurred 8827 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(), 8828 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8829 ExtraArgs.D.setRedeclaration(wasRedeclaration); 8830 Previous.clear(); 8831 Previous.setLookupName(Name); 8832 } 8833 8834 SemaRef.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagMsg) 8835 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition << NewFD->getLocation(); 8836 8837 bool NewFDisConst = false; 8838 if (CXXMethodDecl *NewMD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) 8839 NewFDisConst = NewMD->isConst(); 8840 8841 for (SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned> >::iterator 8842 NearMatch = NearMatches.begin(), NearMatchEnd = NearMatches.end(); 8843 NearMatch != NearMatchEnd; ++NearMatch) { 8844 FunctionDecl *FD = NearMatch->first; 8845 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 8846 bool FDisConst = MD && MD->isConst(); 8847 bool IsMember = MD || !IsLocalFriend; 8848 8849 // FIXME: These notes are poorly worded for the local friend case. 8850 if (unsigned Idx = NearMatch->second) { 8851 ParmVarDecl *FDParam = FD->getParamDecl(Idx-1); 8852 SourceLocation Loc = FDParam->getTypeSpecStartLoc(); 8853 if (Loc.isInvalid()) Loc = FD->getLocation(); 8854 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_param_match 8855 : diag::note_local_decl_close_param_match) 8856 << Idx << FDParam->getType() 8857 << NewFD->getParamDecl(Idx - 1)->getType(); 8858 } else if (FDisConst != NewFDisConst) { 8859 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_member_def_close_const_match) 8860 << NewFDisConst << FD->getSourceRange().getEnd() 8861 << (NewFDisConst 8862 ? FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ExtraArgs.D.getFunctionTypeInfo() 8863 .getConstQualifierLoc()) 8864 : FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ExtraArgs.D.getFunctionTypeInfo() 8865 .getRParenLoc() 8866 .getLocWithOffset(1), 8867 " const")); 8868 } else 8869 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 8870 IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_match 8871 : diag::note_local_decl_close_match); 8872 } 8873 return nullptr; 8874 } 8875 8876 static StorageClass getFunctionStorageClass(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D) { 8877 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec()) { 8878 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown storage class!"); 8879 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: 8880 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: 8881 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: 8882 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 8883 diag::err_typecheck_sclass_func); 8884 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs(); 8885 D.setInvalidType(); 8886 break; 8887 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: break; 8888 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 8889 if (D.getDeclSpec().isExternInLinkageSpec()) 8890 return SC_None; 8891 return SC_Extern; 8892 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: { 8893 if (SemaRef.CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 8894 // C99 6.7.1p5: 8895 // The declaration of an identifier for a function that has 8896 // block scope shall have no explicit storage-class specifier 8897 // other than extern 8898 // See also (C++ [dcl.stc]p4). 8899 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 8900 diag::err_static_block_func); 8901 break; 8902 } else 8903 return SC_Static; 8904 } 8905 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 8906 } 8907 8908 // No explicit storage class has already been returned 8909 return SC_None; 8910 } 8911 8912 static FunctionDecl *CreateNewFunctionDecl(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D, 8913 DeclContext *DC, QualType &R, 8914 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 8915 StorageClass SC, 8916 bool &IsVirtualOkay) { 8917 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameForDeclarator(D); 8918 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 8919 8920 FunctionDecl *NewFD = nullptr; 8921 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 8922 8923 if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8924 // Determine whether the function was written with a prototype. This is 8925 // true when: 8926 // - there is a prototype in the declarator, or 8927 // - the type R of the function is some kind of typedef or other non- 8928 // attributed reference to a type name (which eventually refers to a 8929 // function type). Note, we can't always look at the adjusted type to 8930 // check this case because attributes may cause a non-function 8931 // declarator to still have a function type. e.g., 8932 // typedef void func(int a); 8933 // __attribute__((noreturn)) func other_func; // This has a prototype 8934 bool HasPrototype = 8935 (D.isFunctionDeclarator() && D.getFunctionTypeInfo().hasPrototype) || 8936 (D.getDeclSpec().isTypeRep() && 8937 D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsType().get()->isFunctionProtoType()) || 8938 (!R->getAsAdjusted<FunctionType>() && R->isFunctionProtoType()); 8939 assert( 8940 (HasPrototype || !SemaRef.getLangOpts().requiresStrictPrototypes()) && 8941 "Strict prototypes are required"); 8942 8943 NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create( 8944 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC, 8945 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, HasPrototype, 8946 ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified, 8947 /*TrailingRequiresClause=*/nullptr); 8948 if (D.isInvalidType()) 8949 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8950 8951 return NewFD; 8952 } 8953 8954 ExplicitSpecifier ExplicitSpecifier = D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecifier(); 8955 8956 ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 8957 if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit) { 8958 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 8959 diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 8960 << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind); 8961 ConstexprKind = ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified; 8962 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearConstexprSpec(); 8963 } 8964 Expr *TrailingRequiresClause = D.getTrailingRequiresClause(); 8965 8966 // Check that the return type is not an abstract class type. 8967 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 8968 // the class has been completely parsed. 8969 if (!DC->isRecord() && 8970 SemaRef.RequireNonAbstractType( 8971 D.getIdentifierLoc(), R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), 8972 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, SemaRef.AbstractReturnType)) 8973 D.setInvalidType(); 8974 8975 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName) { 8976 // This is a C++ constructor declaration. 8977 assert(DC->isRecord() && 8978 "Constructors can only be declared in a member context"); 8979 8980 R = SemaRef.CheckConstructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8981 return CXXConstructorDecl::Create( 8982 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8983 TInfo, ExplicitSpecifier, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), 8984 isInline, /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind, 8985 InheritedConstructor(), TrailingRequiresClause); 8986 8987 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 8988 // This is a C++ destructor declaration. 8989 if (DC->isRecord()) { 8990 R = SemaRef.CheckDestructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8991 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 8992 CXXDestructorDecl *NewDD = CXXDestructorDecl::Create( 8993 SemaRef.Context, Record, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, 8994 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8995 /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind, 8996 TrailingRequiresClause); 8997 // User defined destructors start as not selected if the class definition is still 8998 // not done. 8999 if (Record->isBeingDefined()) 9000 NewDD->setIneligibleOrNotSelected(true); 9001 9002 // If the destructor needs an implicit exception specification, set it 9003 // now. FIXME: It'd be nice to be able to create the right type to start 9004 // with, but the type needs to reference the destructor declaration. 9005 if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 9006 SemaRef.AdjustDestructorExceptionSpec(NewDD); 9007 9008 IsVirtualOkay = true; 9009 return NewDD; 9010 9011 } else { 9012 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_destructor_not_member); 9013 D.setInvalidType(); 9014 9015 // Create a FunctionDecl to satisfy the function definition parsing 9016 // code path. 9017 return FunctionDecl::Create( 9018 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, R, 9019 TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 9020 /*hasPrototype=*/true, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause); 9021 } 9022 9023 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) { 9024 if (!DC->isRecord()) { 9025 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 9026 diag::err_conv_function_not_member); 9027 return nullptr; 9028 } 9029 9030 SemaRef.CheckConversionDeclarator(D, R, SC); 9031 if (D.isInvalidType()) 9032 return nullptr; 9033 9034 IsVirtualOkay = true; 9035 return CXXConversionDecl::Create( 9036 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 9037 TInfo, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 9038 ExplicitSpecifier, ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), 9039 TrailingRequiresClause); 9040 9041 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDeductionGuideName) { 9042 if (TrailingRequiresClause) 9043 SemaRef.Diag(TrailingRequiresClause->getBeginLoc(), 9044 diag::err_trailing_requires_clause_on_deduction_guide) 9045 << TrailingRequiresClause->getSourceRange(); 9046 SemaRef.CheckDeductionGuideDeclarator(D, R, SC); 9047 9048 return CXXDeductionGuideDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 9049 ExplicitSpecifier, NameInfo, R, TInfo, 9050 D.getEndLoc()); 9051 } else if (DC->isRecord()) { 9052 // If the name of the function is the same as the name of the record, 9053 // then this must be an invalid constructor that has a return type. 9054 // (The parser checks for a return type and makes the declarator a 9055 // constructor if it has no return type). 9056 if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && 9057 Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() == cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getIdentifier()){ 9058 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_constructor_return_type) 9059 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc()) 9060 << SourceRange(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9061 return nullptr; 9062 } 9063 9064 // This is a C++ method declaration. 9065 CXXMethodDecl *Ret = CXXMethodDecl::Create( 9066 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 9067 TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 9068 ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), TrailingRequiresClause); 9069 IsVirtualOkay = !Ret->isStatic(); 9070 return Ret; 9071 } else { 9072 bool isFriend = 9073 SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 9074 if (!isFriend && SemaRef.CurContext->isRecord()) 9075 return nullptr; 9076 9077 // Determine whether the function was written with a 9078 // prototype. This true when: 9079 // - we're in C++ (where every function has a prototype), 9080 return FunctionDecl::Create( 9081 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC, 9082 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 9083 true /*HasPrototype*/, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause); 9084 } 9085 } 9086 9087 enum OpenCLParamType { 9088 ValidKernelParam, 9089 PtrPtrKernelParam, 9090 PtrKernelParam, 9091 InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam, 9092 InvalidKernelParam, 9093 RecordKernelParam 9094 }; 9095 9096 static bool isOpenCLSizeDependentType(ASTContext &C, QualType Ty) { 9097 // Size dependent types are just typedefs to normal integer types 9098 // (e.g. unsigned long), so we cannot distinguish them from other typedefs to 9099 // integers other than by their names. 9100 StringRef SizeTypeNames[] = {"size_t", "intptr_t", "uintptr_t", "ptrdiff_t"}; 9101 9102 // Remove typedefs one by one until we reach a typedef 9103 // for a size dependent type. 9104 QualType DesugaredTy = Ty; 9105 do { 9106 ArrayRef<StringRef> Names(SizeTypeNames); 9107 auto Match = llvm::find(Names, DesugaredTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString()); 9108 if (Names.end() != Match) 9109 return true; 9110 9111 Ty = DesugaredTy; 9112 DesugaredTy = Ty.getSingleStepDesugaredType(C); 9113 } while (DesugaredTy != Ty); 9114 9115 return false; 9116 } 9117 9118 static OpenCLParamType getOpenCLKernelParameterType(Sema &S, QualType PT) { 9119 if (PT->isDependentType()) 9120 return InvalidKernelParam; 9121 9122 if (PT->isPointerType() || PT->isReferenceType()) { 9123 QualType PointeeType = PT->getPointeeType(); 9124 if (PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_generic || 9125 PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private || 9126 PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::Default) 9127 return InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam; 9128 9129 if (PointeeType->isPointerType()) { 9130 // This is a pointer to pointer parameter. 9131 // Recursively check inner type. 9132 OpenCLParamType ParamKind = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PointeeType); 9133 if (ParamKind == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam || 9134 ParamKind == InvalidKernelParam) 9135 return ParamKind; 9136 9137 return PtrPtrKernelParam; 9138 } 9139 9140 // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4: 9141 // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be: 9142 // Standard layout types for pointer parameters. The same applies to 9143 // reference if an implementation supports them in kernel parameters. 9144 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && 9145 !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 9146 "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) && 9147 !PointeeType->isAtomicType() && !PointeeType->isVoidType() && 9148 !PointeeType->isStandardLayoutType()) 9149 return InvalidKernelParam; 9150 9151 return PtrKernelParam; 9152 } 9153 9154 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k: 9155 // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the 9156 // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and 9157 // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be one 9158 // of these built-in scalar types. 9159 if (isOpenCLSizeDependentType(S.getASTContext(), PT)) 9160 return InvalidKernelParam; 9161 9162 if (PT->isImageType()) 9163 return PtrKernelParam; 9164 9165 if (PT->isBooleanType() || PT->isEventT() || PT->isReserveIDT()) 9166 return InvalidKernelParam; 9167 9168 // OpenCL extension spec v1.2 s9.5: 9169 // This extension adds support for half scalar and vector types as built-in 9170 // types that can be used for arithmetic operations, conversions etc. 9171 if (!S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", S.getLangOpts()) && 9172 PT->isHalfType()) 9173 return InvalidKernelParam; 9174 9175 // Look into an array argument to check if it has a forbidden type. 9176 if (PT->isArrayType()) { 9177 const Type *UnderlyingTy = PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType(); 9178 // Call ourself to check an underlying type of an array. Since the 9179 // getPointeeOrArrayElementType returns an innermost type which is not an 9180 // array, this recursive call only happens once. 9181 return getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QualType(UnderlyingTy, 0)); 9182 } 9183 9184 // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4: 9185 // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be: 9186 // Trivial and standard-layout types C++17 [basic.types] (plain old data 9187 // types) for parameters passed by value; 9188 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && 9189 !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 9190 "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) && 9191 !PT->isOpenCLSpecificType() && !PT.isPODType(S.Context)) 9192 return InvalidKernelParam; 9193 9194 if (PT->isRecordType()) 9195 return RecordKernelParam; 9196 9197 return ValidKernelParam; 9198 } 9199 9200 static void checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter( 9201 Sema &S, 9202 Declarator &D, 9203 ParmVarDecl *Param, 9204 llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<const Type *> &ValidTypes) { 9205 QualType PT = Param->getType(); 9206 9207 // Cache the valid types we encounter to avoid rechecking structs that are 9208 // used again 9209 if (ValidTypes.count(PT.getTypePtr())) 9210 return; 9211 9212 switch (getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PT)) { 9213 case PtrPtrKernelParam: 9214 // OpenCL v3.0 s6.11.a: 9215 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared as a pointer to a pointer 9216 // type. [...] This restriction only applies to OpenCL C 1.2 or below. 9217 if (S.getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() <= 120) { 9218 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_ptrptr_kernel_param); 9219 D.setInvalidType(); 9220 return; 9221 } 9222 9223 ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr()); 9224 return; 9225 9226 case InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam: 9227 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.5: 9228 // __kernel function arguments declared to be a pointer of a type can point 9229 // to one of the following address spaces only : __global, __local or 9230 // __constant. 9231 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_kernel_arg_address_space); 9232 D.setInvalidType(); 9233 return; 9234 9235 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k: 9236 // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the 9237 // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and 9238 // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be 9239 // one of these built-in scalar types. 9240 9241 case InvalidKernelParam: 9242 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 n: 9243 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared 9244 // of event_t type. 9245 // Do not diagnose half type since it is diagnosed as invalid argument 9246 // type for any function elsewhere. 9247 if (!PT->isHalfType()) { 9248 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 9249 9250 // Explain what typedefs are involved. 9251 const TypedefType *Typedef = nullptr; 9252 while ((Typedef = PT->getAs<TypedefType>())) { 9253 SourceLocation Loc = Typedef->getDecl()->getLocation(); 9254 // SourceLocation may be invalid for a built-in type. 9255 if (Loc.isValid()) 9256 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PT; 9257 PT = Typedef->desugar(); 9258 } 9259 } 9260 9261 D.setInvalidType(); 9262 return; 9263 9264 case PtrKernelParam: 9265 case ValidKernelParam: 9266 ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr()); 9267 return; 9268 9269 case RecordKernelParam: 9270 break; 9271 } 9272 9273 // Track nested structs we will inspect 9274 SmallVector<const Decl *, 4> VisitStack; 9275 9276 // Track where we are in the nested structs. Items will migrate from 9277 // VisitStack to HistoryStack as we do the DFS for bad field. 9278 SmallVector<const FieldDecl *, 4> HistoryStack; 9279 HistoryStack.push_back(nullptr); 9280 9281 // At this point we already handled everything except of a RecordType or 9282 // an ArrayType of a RecordType. 9283 assert((PT->isArrayType() || PT->isRecordType()) && "Unexpected type."); 9284 const RecordType *RecTy = 9285 PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 9286 const RecordDecl *OrigRecDecl = RecTy->getDecl(); 9287 9288 VisitStack.push_back(RecTy->getDecl()); 9289 assert(VisitStack.back() && "First decl null?"); 9290 9291 do { 9292 const Decl *Next = VisitStack.pop_back_val(); 9293 if (!Next) { 9294 assert(!HistoryStack.empty()); 9295 // Found a marker, we have gone up a level 9296 if (const FieldDecl *Hist = HistoryStack.pop_back_val()) 9297 ValidTypes.insert(Hist->getType().getTypePtr()); 9298 9299 continue; 9300 } 9301 9302 // Adds everything except the original parameter declaration (which is not a 9303 // field itself) to the history stack. 9304 const RecordDecl *RD; 9305 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Next)) { 9306 HistoryStack.push_back(Field); 9307 9308 QualType FieldTy = Field->getType(); 9309 // Other field types (known to be valid or invalid) are handled while we 9310 // walk around RecordDecl::fields(). 9311 assert((FieldTy->isArrayType() || FieldTy->isRecordType()) && 9312 "Unexpected type."); 9313 const Type *FieldRecTy = FieldTy->getPointeeOrArrayElementType(); 9314 9315 RD = FieldRecTy->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 9316 } else { 9317 RD = cast<RecordDecl>(Next); 9318 } 9319 9320 // Add a null marker so we know when we've gone back up a level 9321 VisitStack.push_back(nullptr); 9322 9323 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 9324 QualType QT = FD->getType(); 9325 9326 if (ValidTypes.count(QT.getTypePtr())) 9327 continue; 9328 9329 OpenCLParamType ParamType = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QT); 9330 if (ParamType == ValidKernelParam) 9331 continue; 9332 9333 if (ParamType == RecordKernelParam) { 9334 VisitStack.push_back(FD); 9335 continue; 9336 } 9337 9338 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.p: 9339 // Arguments to kernel functions that are declared to be a struct or union 9340 // do not allow OpenCL objects to be passed as elements of the struct or 9341 // union. 9342 if (ParamType == PtrKernelParam || ParamType == PtrPtrKernelParam || 9343 ParamType == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam) { 9344 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), 9345 diag::err_record_with_pointers_kernel_param) 9346 << PT->isUnionType() 9347 << PT; 9348 } else { 9349 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 9350 } 9351 9352 S.Diag(OrigRecDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 9353 << OrigRecDecl->getDeclName(); 9354 9355 // We have an error, now let's go back up through history and show where 9356 // the offending field came from 9357 for (ArrayRef<const FieldDecl *>::const_iterator 9358 I = HistoryStack.begin() + 1, 9359 E = HistoryStack.end(); 9360 I != E; ++I) { 9361 const FieldDecl *OuterField = *I; 9362 S.Diag(OuterField->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 9363 << OuterField->getType(); 9364 } 9365 9366 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_illegal_field_declared_here) 9367 << QT->isPointerType() 9368 << QT; 9369 D.setInvalidType(); 9370 return; 9371 } 9372 } while (!VisitStack.empty()); 9373 } 9374 9375 /// Find the DeclContext in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an 9376 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds 9377 /// nothing. 9378 static DeclContext *getTagInjectionContext(DeclContext *DC) { 9379 while (!DC->isFileContext() && !DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 9380 DC = DC->getParent(); 9381 return DC; 9382 } 9383 9384 /// Find the Scope in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an 9385 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds 9386 /// nothing. 9387 static Scope *getTagInjectionScope(Scope *S, const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 9388 while (S->isClassScope() || 9389 (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && 9390 S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) || 9391 ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 9392 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext())) 9393 S = S->getParent(); 9394 return S; 9395 } 9396 9397 /// Determine whether a declaration matches a known function in namespace std. 9398 static bool isStdBuiltin(ASTContext &Ctx, FunctionDecl *FD, 9399 unsigned BuiltinID) { 9400 switch (BuiltinID) { 9401 case Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo: 9402 // No type checking whatsoever. 9403 return Ctx.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft(); 9404 9405 case Builtin::BIaddressof: 9406 case Builtin::BI__addressof: 9407 case Builtin::BIforward: 9408 case Builtin::BImove: 9409 case Builtin::BImove_if_noexcept: 9410 case Builtin::BIas_const: { 9411 // Ensure that we don't treat the algorithm 9412 // OutputIt std::move(InputIt, InputIt, OutputIt) 9413 // as the builtin std::move. 9414 const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9415 return FPT->getNumParams() == 1 && !FPT->isVariadic(); 9416 } 9417 9418 default: 9419 return false; 9420 } 9421 } 9422 9423 NamedDecl* 9424 Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, 9425 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous, 9426 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamListsRef, 9427 bool &AddToScope) { 9428 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 9429 9430 assert(R->isFunctionType()); 9431 if (R.getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCmseNSCallAttr()) 9432 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_decl_cmse_ns_call); 9433 9434 SmallVector<TemplateParameterList *, 4> TemplateParamLists; 9435 llvm::append_range(TemplateParamLists, TemplateParamListsRef); 9436 if (TemplateParameterList *Invented = D.getInventedTemplateParameterList()) { 9437 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && 9438 Invented->getDepth() == TemplateParamLists.back()->getDepth()) 9439 TemplateParamLists.back() = Invented; 9440 else 9441 TemplateParamLists.push_back(Invented); 9442 } 9443 9444 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 9445 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 9446 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 9447 StorageClass SC = getFunctionStorageClass(*this, D); 9448 9449 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 9450 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 9451 diag::err_invalid_thread) 9452 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 9453 9454 if (D.isFirstDeclarationOfMember()) 9455 adjustMemberFunctionCC(R, D.isStaticMember(), D.isCtorOrDtor(), 9456 D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9457 9458 bool isFriend = false; 9459 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate = nullptr; 9460 bool isMemberSpecialization = false; 9461 bool isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 9462 9463 bool isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = false; 9464 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9465 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgs; 9466 9467 bool isVirtualOkay = false; 9468 9469 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 9470 bool IsLocalExternDecl = adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 9471 9472 FunctionDecl *NewFD = CreateNewFunctionDecl(*this, D, DC, R, TInfo, SC, 9473 isVirtualOkay); 9474 if (!NewFD) return nullptr; 9475 9476 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer()) 9477 NewFD->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 9478 9479 // Set the lexical context. If this is a function-scope declaration, or has a 9480 // C++ scope specifier, or is the object of a friend declaration, the lexical 9481 // context will be different from the semantic context. 9482 NewFD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 9483 9484 if (IsLocalExternDecl) 9485 NewFD->setLocalExternDecl(); 9486 9487 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9488 // The rules for implicit inlines changed in C++20 for methods and friends 9489 // with an in-class definition (when such a definition is not attached to 9490 // the global module). User-specified 'inline' overrides this (set when 9491 // the function decl is created above). 9492 // FIXME: We need a better way to separate C++ standard and clang modules. 9493 bool ImplicitInlineCXX20 = !getLangOpts().CPlusPlusModules || 9494 !NewFD->getOwningModule() || 9495 NewFD->getOwningModule()->isGlobalModule() || 9496 NewFD->getOwningModule()->isModuleMapModule(); 9497 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 9498 bool isVirtual = D.getDeclSpec().isVirtualSpecified(); 9499 bool hasExplicit = D.getDeclSpec().hasExplicitSpecifier(); 9500 isFriend = D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 9501 if (isFriend && !isInline && D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9502 // Pre-C++20 [class.friend]p5 9503 // A function can be defined in a friend declaration of a 9504 // class . . . . Such a function is implicitly inline. 9505 // Post C++20 [class.friend]p7 9506 // Such a function is implicitly an inline function if it is attached 9507 // to the global module. 9508 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(ImplicitInlineCXX20); 9509 } 9510 9511 // If this is a method defined in an __interface, and is not a constructor 9512 // or an overloaded operator, then set the pure flag (isVirtual will already 9513 // return true). 9514 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = 9515 dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) { 9516 if (Parent->isInterface() && cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)->isUserProvided()) 9517 NewFD->setPure(true); 9518 9519 // C++ [class.union]p2 9520 // A union can have member functions, but not virtual functions. 9521 if (isVirtual && Parent->isUnion()) { 9522 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_virtual_in_union); 9523 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9524 } 9525 if ((Parent->isClass() || Parent->isStruct()) && 9526 Parent->hasAttr<SYCLSpecialClassAttr>() && 9527 NewFD->getKind() == Decl::Kind::CXXMethod && NewFD->getIdentifier() && 9528 NewFD->getName() == "__init" && D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9529 if (auto *Def = Parent->getDefinition()) 9530 Def->setInitMethod(true); 9531 } 9532 } 9533 9534 SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewFD, D); 9535 isMemberSpecialization = false; 9536 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 9537 if (D.isInvalidType()) 9538 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9539 9540 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 9541 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 9542 bool Invalid = false; 9543 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 9544 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 9545 D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 9546 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 9547 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId 9548 ? D.getName().TemplateId 9549 : nullptr, 9550 TemplateParamLists, isFriend, isMemberSpecialization, 9551 Invalid); 9552 if (TemplateParams) { 9553 // Check that we can declare a template here. 9554 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 9555 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9556 9557 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 9558 // This is a function template 9559 9560 // A destructor cannot be a template. 9561 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 9562 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_template); 9563 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9564 } 9565 9566 // If we're adding a template to a dependent context, we may need to 9567 // rebuilding some of the types used within the template parameter list, 9568 // now that we know what the current instantiation is. 9569 if (DC->isDependentContext()) { 9570 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 9571 if (RebuildTemplateParamsInCurrentInstantiation(TemplateParams)) 9572 Invalid = true; 9573 } 9574 9575 FunctionTemplate = FunctionTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, 9576 NewFD->getLocation(), 9577 Name, TemplateParams, 9578 NewFD); 9579 FunctionTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 9580 NewFD->setDescribedFunctionTemplate(FunctionTemplate); 9581 9582 // For source fidelity, store the other template param lists. 9583 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 1) { 9584 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, 9585 ArrayRef<TemplateParameterList *>(TemplateParamLists) 9586 .drop_back(1)); 9587 } 9588 } else { 9589 // This is a function template specialization. 9590 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 9591 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 9592 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 9593 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists); 9594 9595 // C++0x [temp.expl.spec]p20 forbids "template<> friend void foo(int);". 9596 if (isFriend) { 9597 // We want to remove the "template<>", found here. 9598 SourceRange RemoveRange = TemplateParams->getSourceRange(); 9599 9600 // If we remove the template<> and the name is not a 9601 // template-id, we're actually silently creating a problem: 9602 // the friend declaration will refer to an untemplated decl, 9603 // and clearly the user wants a template specialization. So 9604 // we need to insert '<>' after the name. 9605 SourceLocation InsertLoc; 9606 if (D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 9607 InsertLoc = D.getName().getSourceRange().getEnd(); 9608 InsertLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(InsertLoc); 9609 } 9610 9611 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_spec_decl_friend) 9612 << Name << RemoveRange 9613 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(RemoveRange) 9614 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, "<>"); 9615 Invalid = true; 9616 } 9617 } 9618 } else { 9619 // Check that we can declare a template here. 9620 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization && 9621 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back())) 9622 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9623 9624 // All template param lists were matched against the scope specifier: 9625 // this is NOT (an explicit specialization of) a template. 9626 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 9627 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 9628 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists); 9629 } 9630 9631 if (Invalid) { 9632 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9633 if (FunctionTemplate) 9634 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 9635 } 9636 9637 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p5: 9638 // The virtual specifier shall only be used in declarations of 9639 // nonstatic class member functions that appear within a 9640 // member-specification of a class declaration; see 10.3. 9641 // 9642 if (isVirtual && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9643 if (!isVirtualOkay) { 9644 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9645 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 9646 } else if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 9647 // 'virtual' was specified outside of the class. 9648 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9649 diag::err_virtual_out_of_class) 9650 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 9651 } else if (NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 9652 // C++ [temp.mem]p3: 9653 // A member function template shall not be virtual. 9654 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9655 diag::err_virtual_member_function_template) 9656 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 9657 } else { 9658 // Okay: Add virtual to the method. 9659 NewFD->setVirtualAsWritten(true); 9660 } 9661 9662 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 9663 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) 9664 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_auto_fn_virtual); 9665 } 9666 9667 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 9668 (NewFD->isDependentContext() || 9669 (isFriend && CurContext->isDependentContext())) && 9670 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 9671 // If the function template is referenced directly (for instance, as a 9672 // member of the current instantiation), pretend it has a dependent type. 9673 // This is not really justified by the standard, but is the only sane 9674 // thing to do. 9675 // FIXME: For a friend function, we have not marked the function as being 9676 // a friend yet, so 'isDependentContext' on the FD doesn't work. 9677 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 9678 NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9679 QualType Result = SubstAutoTypeDependent(FPT->getReturnType()); 9680 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(Result, FPT->getParamTypes(), 9681 FPT->getExtProtoInfo())); 9682 } 9683 9684 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p3: 9685 // The inline specifier shall not appear on a block scope function 9686 // declaration. 9687 if (isInline && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9688 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 9689 // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope function declaration. 9690 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 9691 diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name 9692 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc()); 9693 } 9694 } 9695 9696 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p6: 9697 // The explicit specifier shall be used only in the declaration of a 9698 // constructor or conversion function within its class definition; 9699 // see 12.3.1 and 12.3.2. 9700 if (hasExplicit && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9701 !isa<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) { 9702 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 9703 // 'explicit' was specified outside of the class. 9704 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 9705 diag::err_explicit_out_of_class) 9706 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange()); 9707 } else if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD) && 9708 !isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) { 9709 // 'explicit' was specified on a function that wasn't a constructor 9710 // or conversion function. 9711 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 9712 diag::err_explicit_non_ctor_or_conv_function) 9713 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange()); 9714 } 9715 } 9716 9717 ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 9718 if (ConstexprKind != ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified) { 9719 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p2: constexpr functions and constexpr constructors 9720 // are implicitly inline. 9721 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9722 9723 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p3: functions declared constexpr are required to 9724 // be either constructors or to return a literal type. Therefore, 9725 // destructors cannot be declared constexpr. 9726 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD) && 9727 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 || 9728 ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval)) { 9729 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_dtor) 9730 << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind); 9731 NewFD->setConstexprKind(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 9732 ? ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified 9733 : ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr); 9734 } 9735 // C++20 [dcl.constexpr]p2: An allocation function, or a 9736 // deallocation function shall not be declared with the consteval 9737 // specifier. 9738 if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval && 9739 (NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_New || 9740 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_New || 9741 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete || 9742 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete)) { 9743 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 9744 diag::err_invalid_consteval_decl_kind) 9745 << NewFD; 9746 NewFD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr); 9747 } 9748 } 9749 9750 // If __module_private__ was specified, mark the function accordingly. 9751 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 9752 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9753 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc 9754 = D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc(); 9755 Diag(ModulePrivateLoc, diag::err_module_private_specialization) 9756 << 0 9757 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 9758 } else { 9759 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 9760 if (FunctionTemplate) 9761 FunctionTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 9762 } 9763 } 9764 9765 if (isFriend) { 9766 if (FunctionTemplate) { 9767 FunctionTemplate->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 9768 FunctionTemplate->setAccess(AS_public); 9769 } 9770 NewFD->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 9771 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 9772 } 9773 9774 // If a function is defined as defaulted or deleted, mark it as such now. 9775 // We'll do the relevant checks on defaulted / deleted functions later. 9776 switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) { 9777 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration: 9778 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition: 9779 break; 9780 9781 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted: 9782 NewFD->setDefaulted(); 9783 break; 9784 9785 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted: 9786 NewFD->setDeletedAsWritten(); 9787 break; 9788 } 9789 9790 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && DC == CurContext && 9791 D.isFunctionDefinition() && !isInline) { 9792 // Pre C++20 [class.mfct]p2: 9793 // A member function may be defined (8.4) in its class definition, in 9794 // which case it is an inline member function (7.1.2) 9795 // Post C++20 [class.mfct]p1: 9796 // If a member function is attached to the global module and is defined 9797 // in its class definition, it is inline. 9798 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(ImplicitInlineCXX20); 9799 } 9800 9801 if (SC == SC_Static && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && 9802 !CurContext->isRecord()) { 9803 // C++ [class.static]p1: 9804 // A data or function member of a class may be declared static 9805 // in a class definition, in which case it is a static member of 9806 // the class. 9807 9808 // Complain about the 'static' specifier if it's on an out-of-line 9809 // member function definition. 9810 9811 // MSVC permits the use of a 'static' storage specifier on an out-of-line 9812 // member function template declaration and class member template 9813 // declaration (MSVC versions before 2015), warn about this. 9814 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 9815 ((!getLangOpts().isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) && 9816 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getDescribedClassTemplate()) || 9817 (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())) 9818 ? diag::ext_static_out_of_line : diag::err_static_out_of_line) 9819 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9820 } 9821 9822 // C++11 [except.spec]p15: 9823 // A deallocation function with no exception-specification is treated 9824 // as if it were specified with noexcept(true). 9825 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9826 if ((Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete || 9827 Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete) && 9828 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && FPT && !FPT->hasExceptionSpec()) 9829 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType( 9830 FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), 9831 FPT->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(EST_BasicNoexcept))); 9832 } 9833 9834 // Filter out previous declarations that don't match the scope. 9835 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewFD), 9836 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 9837 isMemberSpecialization || 9838 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization); 9839 9840 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 9841 if (Expr *E = (Expr*) D.getAsmLabel()) { 9842 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 9843 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 9844 NewFD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, SE->getString(), 9845 /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, 9846 SE->getStrTokenLoc(0))); 9847 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) { 9848 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 9849 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewFD->getIdentifier()); 9850 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 9851 if (isDeclExternC(NewFD)) { 9852 NewFD->addAttr(I->second); 9853 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 9854 } else 9855 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 9856 << /*Variable*/0 << NewFD; 9857 } 9858 } 9859 9860 // Copy the parameter declarations from the declarator D to the function 9861 // declaration NewFD, if they are available. First scavenge them into Params. 9862 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 9863 unsigned FTIIdx; 9864 if (D.isFunctionDeclarator(FTIIdx)) { 9865 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getTypeObject(FTIIdx).Fun; 9866 9867 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs 9868 // function that takes no arguments, not a function that takes a 9869 // single void argument. 9870 // We let through "const void" here because Sema::GetTypeForDeclarator 9871 // already checks for that case. 9872 if (FTIHasNonVoidParameters(FTI) && FTI.Params[0].Param) { 9873 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumParams; i != e; ++i) { 9874 ParmVarDecl *Param = cast<ParmVarDecl>(FTI.Params[i].Param); 9875 assert(Param->getDeclContext() != NewFD && "Was set before ?"); 9876 Param->setDeclContext(NewFD); 9877 Params.push_back(Param); 9878 9879 if (Param->isInvalidDecl()) 9880 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9881 } 9882 } 9883 9884 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9885 // In C, find all the tag declarations from the prototype and move them 9886 // into the function DeclContext. Remove them from the surrounding tag 9887 // injection context of the function, which is typically but not always 9888 // the TU. 9889 DeclContext *PrototypeTagContext = 9890 getTagInjectionContext(NewFD->getLexicalDeclContext()); 9891 for (NamedDecl *NonParmDecl : FTI.getDeclsInPrototype()) { 9892 auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(NonParmDecl); 9893 9894 // We don't want to reparent enumerators. Look at their parent enum 9895 // instead. 9896 if (!TD) { 9897 if (auto *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(NonParmDecl)) 9898 TD = cast<EnumDecl>(ECD->getDeclContext()); 9899 } 9900 if (!TD) 9901 continue; 9902 DeclContext *TagDC = TD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 9903 if (!TagDC->containsDecl(TD)) 9904 continue; 9905 TagDC->removeDecl(TD); 9906 TD->setDeclContext(NewFD); 9907 NewFD->addDecl(TD); 9908 9909 // Preserve the lexical DeclContext if it is not the surrounding tag 9910 // injection context of the FD. In this example, the semantic context of 9911 // E will be f and the lexical context will be S, while both the 9912 // semantic and lexical contexts of S will be f: 9913 // void f(struct S { enum E { a } f; } s); 9914 if (TagDC != PrototypeTagContext) 9915 TD->setLexicalDeclContext(TagDC); 9916 } 9917 } 9918 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 9919 // When we're declaring a function with a typedef, typeof, etc as in the 9920 // following example, we'll need to synthesize (unnamed) 9921 // parameters for use in the declaration. 9922 // 9923 // @code 9924 // typedef void fn(int); 9925 // fn f; 9926 // @endcode 9927 9928 // Synthesize a parameter for each argument type. 9929 for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) { 9930 ParmVarDecl *Param = 9931 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(NewFD, D.getIdentifierLoc(), AI); 9932 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 9933 Params.push_back(Param); 9934 } 9935 } else { 9936 assert(R->isFunctionNoProtoType() && NewFD->getNumParams() == 0 && 9937 "Should not need args for typedef of non-prototype fn"); 9938 } 9939 9940 // Finally, we know we have the right number of parameters, install them. 9941 NewFD->setParams(Params); 9942 9943 if (D.getDeclSpec().isNoreturnSpecified()) 9944 NewFD->addAttr(C11NoReturnAttr::Create(Context, 9945 D.getDeclSpec().getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 9946 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword)); 9947 9948 // Functions returning a variably modified type violate C99 6.7.5.2p2 9949 // because all functions have linkage. 9950 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9951 NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 9952 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_func_decl); 9953 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9954 } 9955 9956 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section text' is active 9957 if (PragmaClangTextSection.Valid && D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9958 !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) 9959 NewFD->addAttr(PragmaClangTextSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9960 Context, PragmaClangTextSection.SectionName, 9961 PragmaClangTextSection.PragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 9962 9963 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if #pragma code_seg is active. 9964 if (CodeSegStack.CurrentValue && D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9965 !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 9966 NewFD->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9967 Context, CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 9968 CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, 9969 SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate)); 9970 if (UnifySection(CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 9971 ASTContext::PSF_Implicit | ASTContext::PSF_Execute | 9972 ASTContext::PSF_Read, 9973 NewFD)) 9974 NewFD->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 9975 } 9976 9977 // Apply an implicit CodeSegAttr from class declspec or 9978 // apply an implicit SectionAttr from #pragma code_seg if active. 9979 if (!NewFD->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 9980 if (Attr *SAttr = getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(NewFD, 9981 D.isFunctionDefinition())) { 9982 NewFD->addAttr(SAttr); 9983 } 9984 } 9985 9986 // Handle attributes. 9987 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewFD, D); 9988 9989 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 9990 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5: Using an address space qualifier in a function return 9991 // type declaration will generate a compilation error. 9992 LangAS AddressSpace = NewFD->getReturnType().getAddressSpace(); 9993 if (AddressSpace != LangAS::Default) { 9994 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9995 diag::err_opencl_return_value_with_address_space); 9996 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9997 } 9998 } 9999 10000 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10001 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 10002 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 10003 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 10004 10005 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 10006 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 10007 10008 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10009 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 10010 isMemberSpecialization, 10011 D.isFunctionDefinition())); 10012 else if (!Previous.empty()) 10013 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 10014 D.setRedeclaration(true); 10015 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 10016 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 10017 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 10018 10019 // Diagnose no-prototype function declarations with calling conventions that 10020 // don't support variadic calls. Only do this in C and do it after merging 10021 // possibly prototyped redeclarations. 10022 const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 10023 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT) && !D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 10024 CallingConv CC = FT->getExtInfo().getCC(); 10025 if (!supportsVariadicCall(CC)) { 10026 // Windows system headers sometimes accidentally use stdcall without 10027 // (void) parameters, so we relax this to a warning. 10028 int DiagID = 10029 CC == CC_X86StdCall ? diag::warn_cconv_knr : diag::err_cconv_knr; 10030 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagID) 10031 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC); 10032 } 10033 } 10034 10035 if (NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 10036 NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 10037 checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewFD->getReturnType(), 10038 NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(), 10039 NTCUC_FunctionReturn, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy); 10040 } else { 10041 // C++11 [replacement.functions]p3: 10042 // The program's definitions shall not be specified as inline. 10043 // 10044 // N.B. We diagnose declarations instead of definitions per LWG issue 2340. 10045 // 10046 // Suppress the diagnostic if the function is __attribute__((used)), since 10047 // that forces an external definition to be emitted. 10048 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified() && 10049 NewFD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction() && 10050 !NewFD->hasAttr<UsedAttr>()) 10051 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 10052 diag::ext_operator_new_delete_declared_inline) 10053 << NewFD->getDeclName(); 10054 10055 // If the declarator is a template-id, translate the parser's template 10056 // argument list into our AST format. 10057 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 10058 TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId = D.getName().TemplateId; 10059 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(TemplateId->LAngleLoc); 10060 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 10061 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), 10062 TemplateId->NumArgs); 10063 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, 10064 TemplateArgs); 10065 10066 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 10067 10068 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 10069 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 10070 } else if (FunctionTemplate) { 10071 // Function template with explicit template arguments. 10072 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_template_partial_spec) 10073 << SourceRange(TemplateId->LAngleLoc, TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 10074 10075 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 10076 } else { 10077 assert((isFunctionTemplateSpecialization || 10078 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) && 10079 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 10080 // "friend void foo<>(int);" is an implicit specialization decl. 10081 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 10082 } 10083 } else if (isFriend && isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 10084 // This combination is only possible in a recovery case; the user 10085 // wrote something like: 10086 // template <> friend void foo(int); 10087 // which we're recovering from as if the user had written: 10088 // friend void foo<>(int); 10089 // Go ahead and fake up a template id. 10090 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 10091 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 10092 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 10093 } 10094 10095 // We do not add HD attributes to specializations here because 10096 // they may have different constexpr-ness compared to their 10097 // templates and, after maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs() is applied, 10098 // may end up with different effective targets. Instead, a 10099 // specialization inherits its target attributes from its template 10100 // in the CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization() call below. 10101 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) 10102 maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs(NewFD, Previous); 10103 10104 // If it's a friend (and only if it's a friend), it's possible 10105 // that either the specialized function type or the specialized 10106 // template is dependent, and therefore matching will fail. In 10107 // this case, don't check the specialization yet. 10108 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && isFriend && 10109 (NewFD->getType()->isDependentType() || DC->isDependentContext() || 10110 TemplateSpecializationType::anyInstantiationDependentTemplateArguments( 10111 TemplateArgs.arguments()))) { 10112 assert(HasExplicitTemplateArgs && 10113 "friend function specialization without template args"); 10114 if (CheckDependentFunctionTemplateSpecialization(NewFD, TemplateArgs, 10115 Previous)) 10116 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10117 } else if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 10118 if (CurContext->isDependentContext() && CurContext->isRecord() 10119 && !isFriend) { 10120 isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = true; 10121 } else if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 10122 CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 10123 NewFD, (HasExplicitTemplateArgs ? &TemplateArgs : nullptr), 10124 Previous)) 10125 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10126 10127 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 10128 // A storage-class-specifier shall not be specified in an explicit 10129 // specialization (14.7.3) 10130 FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *Info = 10131 NewFD->getTemplateSpecializationInfo(); 10132 if (Info && SC != SC_None) { 10133 if (SC != Info->getTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl()->getStorageClass()) 10134 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 10135 diag::err_explicit_specialization_inconsistent_storage_class) 10136 << SC 10137 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 10138 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 10139 10140 else 10141 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 10142 diag::ext_explicit_specialization_storage_class) 10143 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 10144 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 10145 } 10146 } else if (isMemberSpecialization && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 10147 if (CheckMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous)) 10148 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10149 } 10150 10151 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 10152 if (!isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 10153 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 10154 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 10155 10156 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 10157 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 10158 10159 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10160 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 10161 isMemberSpecialization, 10162 D.isFunctionDefinition())); 10163 else if (!Previous.empty()) 10164 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 10165 D.setRedeclaration(true); 10166 } 10167 10168 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 10169 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 10170 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 10171 10172 NamedDecl *PrincipalDecl = (FunctionTemplate 10173 ? cast<NamedDecl>(FunctionTemplate) 10174 : NewFD); 10175 10176 if (isFriend && NewFD->getPreviousDecl()) { 10177 AccessSpecifier Access = AS_public; 10178 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10179 Access = NewFD->getPreviousDecl()->getAccess(); 10180 10181 NewFD->setAccess(Access); 10182 if (FunctionTemplate) FunctionTemplate->setAccess(Access); 10183 } 10184 10185 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && !DC->isRecord() && 10186 PrincipalDecl->isInIdentifierNamespace(Decl::IDNS_Ordinary)) 10187 PrincipalDecl->setNonMemberOperator(); 10188 10189 // If we have a function template, check the template parameter 10190 // list. This will check and merge default template arguments. 10191 if (FunctionTemplate) { 10192 FunctionTemplateDecl *PrevTemplate = 10193 FunctionTemplate->getPreviousDecl(); 10194 CheckTemplateParameterList(FunctionTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 10195 PrevTemplate ? PrevTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 10196 : nullptr, 10197 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified() 10198 ? (D.isFunctionDefinition() 10199 ? TPC_FriendFunctionTemplateDefinition 10200 : TPC_FriendFunctionTemplate) 10201 : (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && 10202 DC && DC->isRecord() && 10203 DC->isDependentContext()) 10204 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 10205 : TPC_FunctionTemplate); 10206 } 10207 10208 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 10209 // Ignore all the rest of this. 10210 } else if (!D.isRedeclaration()) { 10211 struct ActOnFDArgs ExtraArgs = { S, D, TemplateParamLists, 10212 AddToScope }; 10213 // Fake up an access specifier if it's supposed to be a class member. 10214 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) 10215 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 10216 10217 // Qualified decls generally require a previous declaration. 10218 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 10219 // ...with the major exception of templated-scope or 10220 // dependent-scope friend declarations. 10221 10222 // TODO: we currently also suppress this check in dependent 10223 // contexts because (1) the parameter depth will be off when 10224 // matching friend templates and (2) we might actually be 10225 // selecting a friend based on a dependent factor. But there 10226 // are situations where these conditions don't apply and we 10227 // can actually do this check immediately. 10228 // 10229 // Unless the scope is dependent, it's always an error if qualified 10230 // redeclaration lookup found nothing at all. Diagnose that now; 10231 // nothing will diagnose that error later. 10232 if (isFriend && 10233 (D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep()->isDependent() || 10234 (!Previous.empty() && CurContext->isDependentContext()))) { 10235 // ignore these 10236 } else if (NewFD->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || 10237 NewFD->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()) { 10238 // ignore this, we allow the redeclaration behavior here to create new 10239 // versions of the function. 10240 } else { 10241 // The user tried to provide an out-of-line definition for a 10242 // function that is a member of a class or namespace, but there 10243 // was no such member function declared (C++ [class.mfct]p2, 10244 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p2). For example: 10245 // 10246 // class X { 10247 // void f() const; 10248 // }; 10249 // 10250 // void X::f() { } // ill-formed 10251 // 10252 // Complain about this problem, and attempt to suggest close 10253 // matches (e.g., those that differ only in cv-qualifiers and 10254 // whether the parameter types are references). 10255 10256 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 10257 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, false, nullptr)) { 10258 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 10259 return Result; 10260 } 10261 } 10262 10263 // Unqualified local friend declarations are required to resolve 10264 // to something. 10265 } else if (isFriend && cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)->isLocalClass()) { 10266 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 10267 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, true, S)) { 10268 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 10269 return Result; 10270 } 10271 } 10272 } else if (!D.isFunctionDefinition() && 10273 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && NewFD->isOutOfLine() && 10274 !isFriend && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && 10275 !isMemberSpecialization) { 10276 // An out-of-line member function declaration must also be a 10277 // definition (C++ [class.mfct]p2). 10278 // Note that this is not the case for explicit specializations of 10279 // function templates or member functions of class templates, per 10280 // C++ [temp.expl.spec]p2. We also allow these declarations as an 10281 // extension for compatibility with old SWIG code which likes to 10282 // generate them. 10283 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::ext_out_of_line_declaration) 10284 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 10285 } 10286 } 10287 10288 // If this is the first declaration of a library builtin function, add 10289 // attributes as appropriate. 10290 if (!D.isRedeclaration()) { 10291 if (IdentifierInfo *II = Previous.getLookupName().getAsIdentifierInfo()) { 10292 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) { 10293 bool InStdNamespace = Context.BuiltinInfo.isInStdNamespace(BuiltinID); 10294 if (!InStdNamespace && 10295 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext()) { 10296 if (NewFD->getLanguageLinkage() == CLanguageLinkage) { 10297 // Validate the type matches unless this builtin is specified as 10298 // matching regardless of its declared type. 10299 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(BuiltinID)) { 10300 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 10301 } else { 10302 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 10303 LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, BuiltinID); 10304 QualType BuiltinType = Context.GetBuiltinType(BuiltinID, Error); 10305 10306 if (!Error && !BuiltinType.isNull() && 10307 Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec( 10308 NewFD->getType(), BuiltinType)) 10309 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 10310 } 10311 } 10312 } else if (InStdNamespace && NewFD->isInStdNamespace() && 10313 isStdBuiltin(Context, NewFD, BuiltinID)) { 10314 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 10315 } 10316 } 10317 } 10318 } 10319 10320 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewFD); 10321 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *NewFD); 10322 10323 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(NewFD); 10324 10325 if (NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && 10326 !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 10327 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 10328 diag::err_attribute_overloadable_no_prototype) 10329 << NewFD; 10330 10331 // Turn this into a variadic function with no parameters. 10332 const auto *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 10333 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI( 10334 Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(true, false)); 10335 EPI.Variadic = true; 10336 EPI.ExtInfo = FT->getExtInfo(); 10337 10338 QualType R = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), None, EPI); 10339 NewFD->setType(R); 10340 } 10341 10342 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 10343 // member, set the visibility of this function. 10344 if (!DC->isRecord() && NewFD->isExternallyVisible()) 10345 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(NewFD); 10346 10347 // If there's a #pragma clang arc_cf_code_audited in scope, consider 10348 // marking the function. 10349 AddCFAuditedAttribute(NewFD); 10350 10351 // If this is a function definition, check if we have to apply any 10352 // attributes (i.e. optnone and no_builtin) due to a pragma. 10353 if (D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 10354 AddRangeBasedOptnone(NewFD); 10355 AddImplicitMSFunctionNoBuiltinAttr(NewFD); 10356 AddSectionMSAllocText(NewFD); 10357 ModifyFnAttributesMSPragmaOptimize(NewFD); 10358 } 10359 10360 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 10361 // the map of such variables. 10362 if (NewFD->isFirstDecl() && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 10363 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewFD)) 10364 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewFD, S); 10365 10366 // Set this FunctionDecl's range up to the right paren. 10367 NewFD->setRangeEnd(D.getSourceRange().getEnd()); 10368 10369 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 10370 NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 10371 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewFD, 10372 isMemberSpecialization || 10373 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization, 10374 D.isFunctionDefinition()); 10375 } 10376 10377 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 10378 IdentifierInfo *II = NewFD->getIdentifier(); 10379 if (II && II->isStr(getCudaConfigureFuncName()) && 10380 !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 10381 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 10382 if (!R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType()->isScalarType()) 10383 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_config_scalar_return) 10384 << getCudaConfigureFuncName(); 10385 Context.setcudaConfigureCallDecl(NewFD); 10386 } 10387 10388 // Variadic functions, other than a *declaration* of printf, are not allowed 10389 // in device-side CUDA code, unless someone passed 10390 // -fcuda-allow-variadic-functions. 10391 if (!getLangOpts().CUDAAllowVariadicFunctions && NewFD->isVariadic() && 10392 (NewFD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() || 10393 NewFD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) && 10394 !(II && II->isStr("printf") && NewFD->isExternC() && 10395 !D.isFunctionDefinition())) { 10396 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_variadic_device_fn); 10397 } 10398 } 10399 10400 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(NewFD); 10401 10402 10403 10404 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewFD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 10405 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 static is invalid for kernel functions. 10406 if (SC == SC_Static) { 10407 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_static_kernel); 10408 D.setInvalidType(); 10409 } 10410 10411 // OpenCL v1.2, s6.9 -- Kernels can only have return type void. 10412 if (!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) { 10413 SourceRange RTRange = NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 10414 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_expected_kernel_void_return_type) 10415 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "void") 10416 : FixItHint()); 10417 D.setInvalidType(); 10418 } 10419 10420 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const Type *, 16> ValidTypes; 10421 for (auto Param : NewFD->parameters()) 10422 checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter(*this, D, Param, ValidTypes); 10423 10424 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) { 10425 if (DC->isRecord()) { 10426 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_method_kernel); 10427 D.setInvalidType(); 10428 } 10429 if (FunctionTemplate) { 10430 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_kernel); 10431 D.setInvalidType(); 10432 } 10433 } 10434 } 10435 10436 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10437 if (FunctionTemplate) { 10438 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10439 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 10440 return FunctionTemplate; 10441 } 10442 10443 if (isMemberSpecialization && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10444 CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous); 10445 } 10446 10447 for (const ParmVarDecl *Param : NewFD->parameters()) { 10448 QualType PT = Param->getType(); 10449 10450 // OpenCL 2.0 pipe restrictions forbids pipe packet types to be non-value 10451 // types. 10452 if (getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() >= 200) { 10453 if(const PipeType *PipeTy = PT->getAs<PipeType>()) { 10454 QualType ElemTy = PipeTy->getElementType(); 10455 if (ElemTy->isReferenceType() || ElemTy->isPointerType()) { 10456 Diag(Param->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_reference_pipe_type ); 10457 D.setInvalidType(); 10458 } 10459 } 10460 } 10461 } 10462 10463 // Here we have an function template explicit specialization at class scope. 10464 // The actual specialization will be postponed to template instatiation 10465 // time via the ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl node. 10466 if (isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 10467 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl *NewSpec = 10468 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl::Create( 10469 Context, CurContext, NewFD->getLocation(), 10470 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD), 10471 HasExplicitTemplateArgs, TemplateArgs); 10472 CurContext->addDecl(NewSpec); 10473 AddToScope = false; 10474 } 10475 10476 // Diagnose availability attributes. Availability cannot be used on functions 10477 // that are run during load/unload. 10478 if (const auto *attr = NewFD->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()) { 10479 if (NewFD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>()) { 10480 Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer) 10481 << 1; 10482 NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>(); 10483 } 10484 if (NewFD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>()) { 10485 Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer) 10486 << 2; 10487 NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>(); 10488 } 10489 } 10490 10491 // Diagnose no_builtin attribute on function declaration that are not a 10492 // definition. 10493 // FIXME: We should really be doing this in 10494 // SemaDeclAttr.cpp::handleNoBuiltinAttr, unfortunately we only have access to 10495 // the FunctionDecl and at this point of the code 10496 // FunctionDecl::isThisDeclarationADefinition() which always returns `false` 10497 // because Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef has not been called yet. 10498 if (const auto *NBA = NewFD->getAttr<NoBuiltinAttr>()) 10499 switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) { 10500 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted: 10501 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted: 10502 Diag(NBA->getLocation(), 10503 diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_defaulted_deleted_function) 10504 << NBA->getSpelling(); 10505 break; 10506 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration: 10507 Diag(NBA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_non_definition) 10508 << NBA->getSpelling(); 10509 break; 10510 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition: 10511 break; 10512 } 10513 10514 return NewFD; 10515 } 10516 10517 /// Return a CodeSegAttr from a containing class. The Microsoft docs say 10518 /// when __declspec(code_seg) "is applied to a class, all member functions of 10519 /// the class and nested classes -- this includes compiler-generated special 10520 /// member functions -- are put in the specified segment." 10521 /// The actual behavior is a little more complicated. The Microsoft compiler 10522 /// won't check outer classes if there is an active value from #pragma code_seg. 10523 /// The CodeSeg is always applied from the direct parent but only from outer 10524 /// classes when the #pragma code_seg stack is empty. See: 10525 /// https://reviews.llvm.org/D22931, the Microsoft feedback page is no longer 10526 /// available since MS has removed the page. 10527 static Attr *getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10528 const auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 10529 if (!Method) 10530 return nullptr; 10531 const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = Method->getParent(); 10532 if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 10533 Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext()); 10534 NewAttr->setImplicit(true); 10535 return NewAttr; 10536 } 10537 10538 // The Microsoft compiler won't check outer classes for the CodeSeg 10539 // when the #pragma code_seg stack is active. 10540 if (S.CodeSegStack.CurrentValue) 10541 return nullptr; 10542 10543 while ((Parent = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Parent->getParent()))) { 10544 if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 10545 Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext()); 10546 NewAttr->setImplicit(true); 10547 return NewAttr; 10548 } 10549 } 10550 return nullptr; 10551 } 10552 10553 /// Returns an implicit CodeSegAttr if a __declspec(code_seg) is found on a 10554 /// containing class. Otherwise it will return implicit SectionAttr if the 10555 /// function is a definition and there is an active value on CodeSegStack 10556 /// (from the current #pragma code-seg value). 10557 /// 10558 /// \param FD Function being declared. 10559 /// \param IsDefinition Whether it is a definition or just a declarartion. 10560 /// \returns A CodeSegAttr or SectionAttr to apply to the function or 10561 /// nullptr if no attribute should be added. 10562 Attr *Sema::getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, 10563 bool IsDefinition) { 10564 if (Attr *A = getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(*this, FD)) 10565 return A; 10566 if (!FD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && IsDefinition && 10567 CodeSegStack.CurrentValue) 10568 return SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 10569 getASTContext(), CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 10570 CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, 10571 SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate); 10572 return nullptr; 10573 } 10574 10575 /// Determines if we can perform a correct type check for \p D as a 10576 /// redeclaration of \p PrevDecl. If not, we can generally still perform a 10577 /// best-effort check. 10578 /// 10579 /// \param NewD The new declaration. 10580 /// \param OldD The old declaration. 10581 /// \param NewT The portion of the type of the new declaration to check. 10582 /// \param OldT The portion of the type of the old declaration to check. 10583 bool Sema::canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(ValueDecl *NewD, ValueDecl *OldD, 10584 QualType NewT, QualType OldT) { 10585 if (!NewD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 10586 return true; 10587 10588 // For dependently-typed local extern declarations and friends, we can't 10589 // perform a correct type check in general until instantiation: 10590 // 10591 // int f(); 10592 // template<typename T> void g() { T f(); } 10593 // 10594 // (valid if g() is only instantiated with T = int). 10595 if (NewT->isDependentType() && 10596 (NewD->isLocalExternDecl() || NewD->getFriendObjectKind())) 10597 return false; 10598 10599 // Similarly, if the previous declaration was a dependent local extern 10600 // declaration, we don't really know its type yet. 10601 if (OldT->isDependentType() && OldD->isLocalExternDecl()) 10602 return false; 10603 10604 return true; 10605 } 10606 10607 /// Checks if the new declaration declared in dependent context must be 10608 /// put in the same redeclaration chain as the specified declaration. 10609 /// 10610 /// \param D Declaration that is checked. 10611 /// \param PrevDecl Previous declaration found with proper lookup method for the 10612 /// same declaration name. 10613 /// \returns True if D must be added to the redeclaration chain which PrevDecl 10614 /// belongs to. 10615 /// 10616 bool Sema::shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(Decl *D, Decl *PrevDecl) { 10617 if (!D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 10618 return true; 10619 10620 // Don't chain dependent friend function definitions until instantiation, to 10621 // permit cases like 10622 // 10623 // void func(); 10624 // template<typename T> class C1 { friend void func() {} }; 10625 // template<typename T> class C2 { friend void func() {} }; 10626 // 10627 // ... which is valid if only one of C1 and C2 is ever instantiated. 10628 // 10629 // FIXME: This need only apply to function definitions. For now, we proxy 10630 // this by checking for a file-scope function. We do not want this to apply 10631 // to friend declarations nominating member functions, because that gets in 10632 // the way of access checks. 10633 if (D->getFriendObjectKind() && D->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 10634 return false; 10635 10636 auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D); 10637 auto *PrevVD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl); 10638 return !VD || !PrevVD || 10639 canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(VD, PrevVD, VD->getType(), 10640 PrevVD->getType()); 10641 } 10642 10643 /// Check the target attribute of the function for MultiVersion 10644 /// validity. 10645 /// 10646 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10647 static bool CheckMultiVersionValue(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10648 const auto *TA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10649 assert(TA && "MultiVersion Candidate requires a target attribute"); 10650 ParsedTargetAttr ParseInfo = TA->parse(); 10651 const TargetInfo &TargetInfo = S.Context.getTargetInfo(); 10652 enum ErrType { Feature = 0, Architecture = 1 }; 10653 10654 if (!ParseInfo.Architecture.empty() && 10655 !TargetInfo.validateCpuIs(ParseInfo.Architecture)) { 10656 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10657 << Architecture << ParseInfo.Architecture; 10658 return true; 10659 } 10660 10661 for (const auto &Feat : ParseInfo.Features) { 10662 auto BareFeat = StringRef{Feat}.substr(1); 10663 if (Feat[0] == '-') { 10664 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10665 << Feature << ("no-" + BareFeat).str(); 10666 return true; 10667 } 10668 10669 if (!TargetInfo.validateCpuSupports(BareFeat) || 10670 !TargetInfo.isValidFeatureName(BareFeat)) { 10671 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10672 << Feature << BareFeat; 10673 return true; 10674 } 10675 } 10676 return false; 10677 } 10678 10679 // Provide a white-list of attributes that are allowed to be combined with 10680 // multiversion functions. 10681 static bool AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(attr::Kind Kind, 10682 MultiVersionKind MVKind) { 10683 // Note: this list/diagnosis must match the list in 10684 // checkMultiversionAttributesAllSame. 10685 switch (Kind) { 10686 default: 10687 return false; 10688 case attr::Used: 10689 return MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target; 10690 case attr::NonNull: 10691 case attr::NoThrow: 10692 return true; 10693 } 10694 } 10695 10696 static bool checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(Sema &S, 10697 const FunctionDecl *FD, 10698 const FunctionDecl *CausedFD, 10699 MultiVersionKind MVKind) { 10700 const auto Diagnose = [FD, CausedFD, MVKind](Sema &S, const Attr *A) { 10701 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_disallowed_other_attr) 10702 << static_cast<unsigned>(MVKind) << A; 10703 if (CausedFD) 10704 S.Diag(CausedFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10705 return true; 10706 }; 10707 10708 for (const Attr *A : FD->attrs()) { 10709 switch (A->getKind()) { 10710 case attr::CPUDispatch: 10711 case attr::CPUSpecific: 10712 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10713 MVKind != MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) 10714 return Diagnose(S, A); 10715 break; 10716 case attr::Target: 10717 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::Target) 10718 return Diagnose(S, A); 10719 break; 10720 case attr::TargetClones: 10721 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::TargetClones) 10722 return Diagnose(S, A); 10723 break; 10724 default: 10725 if (!AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(A->getKind(), MVKind)) 10726 return Diagnose(S, A); 10727 break; 10728 } 10729 } 10730 return false; 10731 } 10732 10733 bool Sema::areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible( 10734 const FunctionDecl *OldFD, const FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10735 const PartialDiagnostic &NoProtoDiagID, 10736 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoteCausedDiagIDAt, 10737 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoSupportDiagIDAt, 10738 const PartialDiagnosticAt &DiffDiagIDAt, bool TemplatesSupported, 10739 bool ConstexprSupported, bool CLinkageMayDiffer) { 10740 enum DoesntSupport { 10741 FuncTemplates = 0, 10742 VirtFuncs = 1, 10743 DeducedReturn = 2, 10744 Constructors = 3, 10745 Destructors = 4, 10746 DeletedFuncs = 5, 10747 DefaultedFuncs = 6, 10748 ConstexprFuncs = 7, 10749 ConstevalFuncs = 8, 10750 Lambda = 9, 10751 }; 10752 enum Different { 10753 CallingConv = 0, 10754 ReturnType = 1, 10755 ConstexprSpec = 2, 10756 InlineSpec = 3, 10757 Linkage = 4, 10758 LanguageLinkage = 5, 10759 }; 10760 10761 if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && OldFD && 10762 !OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 10763 Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID); 10764 Diag(NoteCausedDiagIDAt.first, NoteCausedDiagIDAt.second); 10765 return true; 10766 } 10767 10768 if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && 10769 !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 10770 return Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID); 10771 10772 if (!TemplatesSupported && 10773 NewFD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate) 10774 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10775 << FuncTemplates; 10776 10777 if (const auto *NewCXXFD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 10778 if (NewCXXFD->isVirtual()) 10779 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10780 << VirtFuncs; 10781 10782 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewCXXFD)) 10783 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10784 << Constructors; 10785 10786 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewCXXFD)) 10787 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10788 << Destructors; 10789 } 10790 10791 if (NewFD->isDeleted()) 10792 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10793 << DeletedFuncs; 10794 10795 if (NewFD->isDefaulted()) 10796 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10797 << DefaultedFuncs; 10798 10799 if (!ConstexprSupported && NewFD->isConstexpr()) 10800 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10801 << (NewFD->isConsteval() ? ConstevalFuncs : ConstexprFuncs); 10802 10803 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(NewFD->getType()); 10804 const auto *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 10805 QualType NewReturnType = NewType->getReturnType(); 10806 10807 if (NewReturnType->isUndeducedType()) 10808 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10809 << DeducedReturn; 10810 10811 // Ensure the return type is identical. 10812 if (OldFD) { 10813 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(OldFD->getType()); 10814 const auto *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType); 10815 FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo(); 10816 FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo(); 10817 10818 if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 10819 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << CallingConv; 10820 10821 QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType(); 10822 10823 if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) 10824 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ReturnType; 10825 10826 if (OldFD->getConstexprKind() != NewFD->getConstexprKind()) 10827 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ConstexprSpec; 10828 10829 if (OldFD->isInlineSpecified() != NewFD->isInlineSpecified()) 10830 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << InlineSpec; 10831 10832 if (OldFD->getFormalLinkage() != NewFD->getFormalLinkage()) 10833 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << Linkage; 10834 10835 if (!CLinkageMayDiffer && OldFD->isExternC() != NewFD->isExternC()) 10836 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << LanguageLinkage; 10837 10838 if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec( 10839 OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), OldFD->getLocation(), 10840 NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), NewFD->getLocation())) 10841 return true; 10842 } 10843 return false; 10844 } 10845 10846 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *OldFD, 10847 const FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10848 bool CausesMV, 10849 MultiVersionKind MVKind) { 10850 if (!S.getASTContext().getTargetInfo().supportsMultiVersioning()) { 10851 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_supported); 10852 if (OldFD) 10853 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10854 return true; 10855 } 10856 10857 bool IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVKind = 10858 MVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch || 10859 MVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific; 10860 10861 if (CausesMV && OldFD && 10862 checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVKind)) 10863 return true; 10864 10865 if (checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, NewFD, nullptr, MVKind)) 10866 return true; 10867 10868 // Only allow transition to MultiVersion if it hasn't been used. 10869 if (OldFD && CausesMV && OldFD->isUsed(false)) 10870 return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used); 10871 10872 return S.areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible( 10873 OldFD, NewFD, S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_noproto), 10874 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10875 S.PDiag(diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here)), 10876 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10877 S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_doesnt_support) 10878 << static_cast<unsigned>(MVKind)), 10879 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10880 S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_diff)), 10881 /*TemplatesSupported=*/false, 10882 /*ConstexprSupported=*/!IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVKind, 10883 /*CLinkageMayDiffer=*/false); 10884 } 10885 10886 /// Check the validity of a multiversion function declaration that is the 10887 /// first of its kind. Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself. 10888 /// 10889 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 10890 /// 10891 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10892 static bool CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, 10893 MultiVersionKind MVKind, 10894 const TargetAttr *TA) { 10895 assert(MVKind != MultiVersionKind::None && 10896 "Function lacks multiversion attribute"); 10897 10898 // Target only causes MV if it is default, otherwise this is a normal 10899 // function. 10900 if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && !TA->isDefaultVersion()) 10901 return false; 10902 10903 if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && CheckMultiVersionValue(S, FD)) { 10904 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10905 return true; 10906 } 10907 10908 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, nullptr, FD, true, MVKind)) { 10909 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10910 return true; 10911 } 10912 10913 FD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10914 return false; 10915 } 10916 10917 static bool PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10918 for (const Decl *D = FD->getPreviousDecl(); D; D = D->getPreviousDecl()) { 10919 if (D->getAsFunction()->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::None) 10920 return true; 10921 } 10922 10923 return false; 10924 } 10925 10926 static bool CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning( 10927 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, const TargetAttr *NewTA, 10928 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, LookupResult &Previous) { 10929 const auto *OldTA = OldFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10930 ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed = NewTA->parse(); 10931 // Sort order doesn't matter, it just needs to be consistent. 10932 llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features); 10933 10934 // If the old decl is NOT MultiVersioned yet, and we don't cause that 10935 // to change, this is a simple redeclaration. 10936 if (!NewTA->isDefaultVersion() && 10937 (!OldTA || OldTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr())) 10938 return false; 10939 10940 // Otherwise, this decl causes MultiVersioning. 10941 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, true, 10942 MultiVersionKind::Target)) { 10943 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10944 return true; 10945 } 10946 10947 if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) { 10948 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10949 return true; 10950 } 10951 10952 // If this is 'default', permit the forward declaration. 10953 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && !OldTA && NewTA->isDefaultVersion()) { 10954 Redeclaration = true; 10955 OldDecl = OldFD; 10956 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10957 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10958 return false; 10959 } 10960 10961 if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, OldFD)) { 10962 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10963 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10964 return true; 10965 } 10966 10967 ParsedTargetAttr OldParsed = OldTA->parse(std::less<std::string>()); 10968 10969 if (OldParsed == NewParsed) { 10970 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate); 10971 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10972 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10973 return true; 10974 } 10975 10976 for (const auto *FD : OldFD->redecls()) { 10977 const auto *CurTA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10978 // We allow forward declarations before ANY multiversioning attributes, but 10979 // nothing after the fact. 10980 if (PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(FD) && 10981 (!CurTA || CurTA->isInherited())) { 10982 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl) 10983 << 0; 10984 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10985 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10986 return true; 10987 } 10988 } 10989 10990 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10991 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10992 Redeclaration = false; 10993 OldDecl = nullptr; 10994 Previous.clear(); 10995 return false; 10996 } 10997 10998 static bool MultiVersionTypesCompatible(MultiVersionKind Old, 10999 MultiVersionKind New) { 11000 if (Old == New || Old == MultiVersionKind::None || 11001 New == MultiVersionKind::None) 11002 return true; 11003 11004 return (Old == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 11005 New == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) || 11006 (Old == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific && 11007 New == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch); 11008 } 11009 11010 /// Check the validity of a new function declaration being added to an existing 11011 /// multiversioned declaration collection. 11012 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl( 11013 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 11014 MultiVersionKind NewMVKind, const TargetAttr *NewTA, 11015 const CPUDispatchAttr *NewCPUDisp, const CPUSpecificAttr *NewCPUSpec, 11016 const TargetClonesAttr *NewClones, bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, 11017 LookupResult &Previous) { 11018 11019 MultiVersionKind OldMVKind = OldFD->getMultiVersionKind(); 11020 // Disallow mixing of multiversioning types. 11021 if (!MultiVersionTypesCompatible(OldMVKind, NewMVKind)) { 11022 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_types_mixed); 11023 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 11024 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11025 return true; 11026 } 11027 11028 ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed; 11029 if (NewTA) { 11030 NewParsed = NewTA->parse(); 11031 llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features); 11032 } 11033 11034 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 11035 S.CurContext->isRecord() && !NewFD->getFriendObjectKind(); 11036 11037 bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks = 11038 AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, S.Context, NewFD); 11039 11040 // Next, check ALL non-overloads to see if this is a redeclaration of a 11041 // previous member of the MultiVersion set. 11042 for (NamedDecl *ND : Previous) { 11043 FunctionDecl *CurFD = ND->getAsFunction(); 11044 if (!CurFD) 11045 continue; 11046 if (MayNeedOverloadableChecks && 11047 S.IsOverload(NewFD, CurFD, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) 11048 continue; 11049 11050 switch (NewMVKind) { 11051 case MultiVersionKind::None: 11052 assert(OldMVKind == MultiVersionKind::TargetClones && 11053 "Only target_clones can be omitted in subsequent declarations"); 11054 break; 11055 case MultiVersionKind::Target: { 11056 const auto *CurTA = CurFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 11057 if (CurTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr()) { 11058 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11059 Redeclaration = true; 11060 OldDecl = ND; 11061 return false; 11062 } 11063 11064 ParsedTargetAttr CurParsed = CurTA->parse(std::less<std::string>()); 11065 if (CurParsed == NewParsed) { 11066 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate); 11067 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 11068 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11069 return true; 11070 } 11071 break; 11072 } 11073 case MultiVersionKind::TargetClones: { 11074 const auto *CurClones = CurFD->getAttr<TargetClonesAttr>(); 11075 Redeclaration = true; 11076 OldDecl = CurFD; 11077 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11078 11079 if (CurClones && NewClones && 11080 (CurClones->featuresStrs_size() != NewClones->featuresStrs_size() || 11081 !std::equal(CurClones->featuresStrs_begin(), 11082 CurClones->featuresStrs_end(), 11083 NewClones->featuresStrs_begin()))) { 11084 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_target_clone_doesnt_match); 11085 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 11086 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11087 return true; 11088 } 11089 11090 return false; 11091 } 11092 case MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific: 11093 case MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch: { 11094 const auto *CurCPUSpec = CurFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 11095 const auto *CurCPUDisp = CurFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 11096 // Handle CPUDispatch/CPUSpecific versions. 11097 // Only 1 CPUDispatch function is allowed, this will make it go through 11098 // the redeclaration errors. 11099 if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 11100 CurFD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>()) { 11101 if (CurCPUDisp->cpus_size() == NewCPUDisp->cpus_size() && 11102 std::equal( 11103 CurCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), CurCPUDisp->cpus_end(), 11104 NewCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), 11105 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) { 11106 return Cur->getName() == New->getName(); 11107 })) { 11108 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11109 Redeclaration = true; 11110 OldDecl = ND; 11111 return false; 11112 } 11113 11114 // If the declarations don't match, this is an error condition. 11115 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_dispatch_mismatch); 11116 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 11117 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11118 return true; 11119 } 11120 if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific && CurCPUSpec) { 11121 if (CurCPUSpec->cpus_size() == NewCPUSpec->cpus_size() && 11122 std::equal( 11123 CurCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), CurCPUSpec->cpus_end(), 11124 NewCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), 11125 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) { 11126 return Cur->getName() == New->getName(); 11127 })) { 11128 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11129 Redeclaration = true; 11130 OldDecl = ND; 11131 return false; 11132 } 11133 11134 // Only 1 version of CPUSpecific is allowed for each CPU. 11135 for (const IdentifierInfo *CurII : CurCPUSpec->cpus()) { 11136 for (const IdentifierInfo *NewII : NewCPUSpec->cpus()) { 11137 if (CurII == NewII) { 11138 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_specific_multiple_defs) 11139 << NewII; 11140 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 11141 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11142 return true; 11143 } 11144 } 11145 } 11146 } 11147 break; 11148 } 11149 } 11150 } 11151 11152 // Else, this is simply a non-redecl case. Checking the 'value' is only 11153 // necessary in the Target case, since The CPUSpecific/Dispatch cases are 11154 // handled in the attribute adding step. 11155 if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && 11156 CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) { 11157 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11158 return true; 11159 } 11160 11161 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, 11162 !OldFD->isMultiVersion(), NewMVKind)) { 11163 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11164 return true; 11165 } 11166 11167 // Permit forward declarations in the case where these two are compatible. 11168 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) { 11169 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11170 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11171 Redeclaration = true; 11172 OldDecl = OldFD; 11173 return false; 11174 } 11175 11176 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11177 Redeclaration = false; 11178 OldDecl = nullptr; 11179 Previous.clear(); 11180 return false; 11181 } 11182 11183 /// Check the validity of a mulitversion function declaration. 11184 /// Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself. 11185 /// 11186 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 11187 /// 11188 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 11189 static bool CheckMultiVersionFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 11190 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, 11191 LookupResult &Previous) { 11192 const auto *NewTA = NewFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 11193 const auto *NewCPUDisp = NewFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 11194 const auto *NewCPUSpec = NewFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 11195 const auto *NewClones = NewFD->getAttr<TargetClonesAttr>(); 11196 MultiVersionKind MVKind = NewFD->getMultiVersionKind(); 11197 11198 // Main isn't allowed to become a multiversion function, however it IS 11199 // permitted to have 'main' be marked with the 'target' optimization hint. 11200 if (NewFD->isMain()) { 11201 if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::None && 11202 !(MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && !NewTA->isDefaultVersion())) { 11203 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_allowed_on_main); 11204 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11205 return true; 11206 } 11207 return false; 11208 } 11209 11210 if (!OldDecl || !OldDecl->getAsFunction() || 11211 OldDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() != 11212 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) { 11213 // If there's no previous declaration, AND this isn't attempting to cause 11214 // multiversioning, this isn't an error condition. 11215 if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None) 11216 return false; 11217 return CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(S, NewFD, MVKind, NewTA); 11218 } 11219 11220 FunctionDecl *OldFD = OldDecl->getAsFunction(); 11221 11222 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None) 11223 return false; 11224 11225 // Multiversioned redeclarations aren't allowed to omit the attribute, except 11226 // for target_clones. 11227 if (OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None && 11228 OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::TargetClones) { 11229 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl) 11230 << (OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::Target); 11231 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11232 return true; 11233 } 11234 11235 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) { 11236 switch (MVKind) { 11237 case MultiVersionKind::Target: 11238 return CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning(S, OldFD, NewFD, NewTA, 11239 Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous); 11240 case MultiVersionKind::TargetClones: 11241 if (OldFD->isUsed(false)) { 11242 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11243 return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used); 11244 } 11245 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 11246 break; 11247 case MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch: 11248 case MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific: 11249 case MultiVersionKind::None: 11250 break; 11251 } 11252 } 11253 11254 // At this point, we have a multiversion function decl (in OldFD) AND an 11255 // appropriate attribute in the current function decl. Resolve that these are 11256 // still compatible with previous declarations. 11257 return CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVKind, NewTA, 11258 NewCPUDisp, NewCPUSpec, NewClones, 11259 Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous); 11260 } 11261 11262 /// Perform semantic checking of a new function declaration. 11263 /// 11264 /// Performs semantic analysis of the new function declaration 11265 /// NewFD. This routine performs all semantic checking that does not 11266 /// require the actual declarator involved in the declaration, and is 11267 /// used both for the declaration of functions as they are parsed 11268 /// (called via ActOnDeclarator) and for the declaration of functions 11269 /// that have been instantiated via C++ template instantiation (called 11270 /// via InstantiateDecl). 11271 /// 11272 /// \param IsMemberSpecialization whether this new function declaration is 11273 /// a member specialization (that replaces any definition provided by the 11274 /// previous declaration). 11275 /// 11276 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 11277 /// 11278 /// \returns true if the function declaration is a redeclaration. 11279 bool Sema::CheckFunctionDeclaration(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 11280 LookupResult &Previous, 11281 bool IsMemberSpecialization, 11282 bool DeclIsDefn) { 11283 assert(!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && 11284 "Variably modified return types are not handled here"); 11285 11286 // Determine whether the type of this function should be merged with 11287 // a previous visible declaration. This never happens for functions in C++, 11288 // and always happens in C if the previous declaration was visible. 11289 bool MergeTypeWithPrevious = !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 11290 !Previous.isShadowed(); 11291 11292 bool Redeclaration = false; 11293 NamedDecl *OldDecl = nullptr; 11294 bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks = false; 11295 11296 // Merge or overload the declaration with an existing declaration of 11297 // the same name, if appropriate. 11298 if (!Previous.empty()) { 11299 // Determine whether NewFD is an overload of PrevDecl or 11300 // a declaration that requires merging. If it's an overload, 11301 // there's no more work to do here; we'll just add the new 11302 // function to the scope. 11303 if (!AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, Context, NewFD)) { 11304 NamedDecl *Candidate = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 11305 if (shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Candidate, NewFD)) { 11306 Redeclaration = true; 11307 OldDecl = Candidate; 11308 } 11309 } else { 11310 MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true; 11311 switch (CheckOverload(S, NewFD, Previous, OldDecl, 11312 /*NewIsUsingDecl*/ false)) { 11313 case Ovl_Match: 11314 Redeclaration = true; 11315 break; 11316 11317 case Ovl_NonFunction: 11318 Redeclaration = true; 11319 break; 11320 11321 case Ovl_Overload: 11322 Redeclaration = false; 11323 break; 11324 } 11325 } 11326 } 11327 11328 // Check for a previous extern "C" declaration with this name. 11329 if (!Redeclaration && 11330 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewFD, Previous)) { 11331 if (!Previous.empty()) { 11332 // This is an extern "C" declaration with the same name as a previous 11333 // declaration, and thus redeclares that entity... 11334 Redeclaration = true; 11335 OldDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 11336 MergeTypeWithPrevious = false; 11337 11338 // ... except in the presence of __attribute__((overloadable)). 11339 if (OldDecl->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() || 11340 NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 11341 if (IsOverload(NewFD, cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl), false)) { 11342 MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true; 11343 Redeclaration = false; 11344 OldDecl = nullptr; 11345 } 11346 } 11347 } 11348 } 11349 11350 if (CheckMultiVersionFunction(*this, NewFD, Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous)) 11351 return Redeclaration; 11352 11353 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function return types. 11354 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 11355 CheckPPCMMAType(NewFD->getReturnType(), NewFD->getLocation())) { 11356 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11357 } 11358 11359 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p8: 11360 // A constexpr specifier for a non-static member function that is not 11361 // a constructor declares that member function to be const. 11362 // 11363 // This needs to be delayed until we know whether this is an out-of-line 11364 // definition of a static member function. 11365 // 11366 // This rule is not present in C++1y, so we produce a backwards 11367 // compatibility warning whenever it happens in C++11. 11368 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 11369 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && MD && MD->isConstexpr() && 11370 !MD->isStatic() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) && 11371 !isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) && !MD->getMethodQualifiers().hasConst()) { 11372 CXXMethodDecl *OldMD = nullptr; 11373 if (OldDecl) 11374 OldMD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(OldDecl->getAsFunction()); 11375 if (!OldMD || !OldMD->isStatic()) { 11376 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 11377 MD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11378 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 11379 EPI.TypeQuals.addConst(); 11380 MD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), 11381 FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI)); 11382 11383 // Warn that we did this, if we're not performing template instantiation. 11384 // In that case, we'll have warned already when the template was defined. 11385 if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) { 11386 SourceLocation AddConstLoc; 11387 if (FunctionTypeLoc FTL = MD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc() 11388 .IgnoreParens().getAs<FunctionTypeLoc>()) 11389 AddConstLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(FTL.getRParenLoc()); 11390 11391 Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::warn_cxx14_compat_constexpr_not_const) 11392 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(AddConstLoc, " const"); 11393 } 11394 } 11395 } 11396 11397 if (Redeclaration) { 11398 // NewFD and OldDecl represent declarations that need to be 11399 // merged. 11400 if (MergeFunctionDecl(NewFD, OldDecl, S, MergeTypeWithPrevious, 11401 DeclIsDefn)) { 11402 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11403 return Redeclaration; 11404 } 11405 11406 Previous.clear(); 11407 Previous.addDecl(OldDecl); 11408 11409 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplateDecl = 11410 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) { 11411 auto *OldFD = OldTemplateDecl->getTemplatedDecl(); 11412 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplateDecl 11413 = NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 11414 assert(NewTemplateDecl && "Template/non-template mismatch"); 11415 11416 // The call to MergeFunctionDecl above may have created some state in 11417 // NewTemplateDecl that needs to be merged with OldTemplateDecl before we 11418 // can add it as a redeclaration. 11419 NewTemplateDecl->mergePrevDecl(OldTemplateDecl); 11420 11421 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD); 11422 if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) { 11423 NewFD->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 11424 NewTemplateDecl->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 11425 } 11426 11427 // If this is an explicit specialization of a member that is a function 11428 // template, mark it as a member specialization. 11429 if (IsMemberSpecialization && 11430 NewTemplateDecl->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) { 11431 NewTemplateDecl->setMemberSpecialization(); 11432 assert(OldTemplateDecl->isMemberSpecialization()); 11433 // Explicit specializations of a member template do not inherit deleted 11434 // status from the parent member template that they are specializing. 11435 if (OldFD->isDeleted()) { 11436 // FIXME: This assert will not hold in the presence of modules. 11437 assert(OldFD->getCanonicalDecl() == OldFD); 11438 // FIXME: We need an update record for this AST mutation. 11439 OldFD->setDeletedAsWritten(false); 11440 } 11441 } 11442 11443 } else { 11444 if (shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(NewFD, OldDecl)) { 11445 auto *OldFD = cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl); 11446 // This needs to happen first so that 'inline' propagates. 11447 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD); 11448 if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) 11449 NewFD->setAccess(OldFD->getAccess()); 11450 } 11451 } 11452 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && MayNeedOverloadableChecks && 11453 !NewFD->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 11454 assert((Previous.empty() || 11455 llvm::any_of(Previous, 11456 [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 11457 return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 11458 })) && 11459 "Non-redecls shouldn't happen without overloadable present"); 11460 11461 auto OtherUnmarkedIter = llvm::find_if(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 11462 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND); 11463 return FD && !FD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 11464 }); 11465 11466 if (OtherUnmarkedIter != Previous.end()) { 11467 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 11468 diag::err_attribute_overloadable_multiple_unmarked_overloads); 11469 Diag((*OtherUnmarkedIter)->getLocation(), 11470 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload) 11471 << false; 11472 11473 NewFD->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 11474 } 11475 } 11476 11477 if (LangOpts.OpenMP) 11478 ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPAssumeScope(NewFD); 11479 11480 // Semantic checking for this function declaration (in isolation). 11481 11482 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11483 // C++-specific checks. 11484 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 11485 CheckConstructor(Constructor); 11486 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 11487 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 11488 CXXRecordDecl *Record = Destructor->getParent(); 11489 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 11490 11491 // FIXME: Shouldn't we be able to perform this check even when the class 11492 // type is dependent? Both gcc and edg can handle that. 11493 if (!ClassType->isDependentType()) { 11494 DeclarationName Name 11495 = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 11496 Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType)); 11497 if (NewFD->getDeclName() != Name) { 11498 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_name); 11499 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11500 return Redeclaration; 11501 } 11502 } 11503 } else if (auto *Guide = dyn_cast<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) { 11504 if (auto *TD = Guide->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 11505 CheckDeductionGuideTemplate(TD); 11506 11507 // A deduction guide is not on the list of entities that can be 11508 // explicitly specialized. 11509 if (Guide->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization) 11510 Diag(Guide->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_deduction_guide_specialized) 11511 << /*explicit specialization*/ 1; 11512 } 11513 11514 // Find any virtual functions that this function overrides. 11515 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 11516 if (!Method->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 11517 !Method->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 11518 Method->isCanonicalDecl()) { 11519 AddOverriddenMethods(Method->getParent(), Method); 11520 } 11521 if (Method->isVirtual() && NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) 11522 // C++2a [class.virtual]p6 11523 // A virtual method shall not have a requires-clause. 11524 Diag(NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()->getBeginLoc(), 11525 diag::err_constrained_virtual_method); 11526 11527 if (Method->isStatic()) 11528 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionType(Method); 11529 } 11530 11531 // C++20: dcl.decl.general p4: 11532 // The optional requires-clause ([temp.pre]) in an init-declarator or 11533 // member-declarator shall be present only if the declarator declares a 11534 // templated function ([dcl.fct]). 11535 if (Expr *TRC = NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 11536 if (!NewFD->isTemplated() && !NewFD->isTemplateInstantiation()) 11537 Diag(TRC->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_constrained_non_templated_function); 11538 } 11539 11540 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) 11541 ActOnConversionDeclarator(Conversion); 11542 11543 // Extra checking for C++ overloaded operators (C++ [over.oper]). 11544 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && 11545 CheckOverloadedOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 11546 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11547 return Redeclaration; 11548 } 11549 11550 // Extra checking for C++0x literal operators (C++0x [over.literal]). 11551 if (NewFD->getLiteralIdentifier() && 11552 CheckLiteralOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 11553 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11554 return Redeclaration; 11555 } 11556 11557 // In C++, check default arguments now that we have merged decls. Unless 11558 // the lexical context is the class, because in this case this is done 11559 // during delayed parsing anyway. 11560 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) 11561 CheckCXXDefaultArguments(NewFD); 11562 11563 // If this function is declared as being extern "C", then check to see if 11564 // the function returns a UDT (class, struct, or union type) that is not C 11565 // compatible, and if it does, warn the user. 11566 // But, issue any diagnostic on the first declaration only. 11567 if (Previous.empty() && NewFD->isExternC()) { 11568 QualType R = NewFD->getReturnType(); 11569 if (R->isIncompleteType() && !R->isVoidType()) 11570 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt_incomplete) 11571 << NewFD << R; 11572 else if (!R.isPODType(Context) && !R->isVoidType() && 11573 !R->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 11574 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt) << NewFD << R; 11575 } 11576 11577 // C++1z [dcl.fct]p6: 11578 // [...] whether the function has a non-throwing exception-specification 11579 // [is] part of the function type 11580 // 11581 // This results in an ABI break between C++14 and C++17 for functions whose 11582 // declared type includes an exception-specification in a parameter or 11583 // return type. (Exception specifications on the function itself are OK in 11584 // most cases, and exception specifications are not permitted in most other 11585 // contexts where they could make it into a mangling.) 11586 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !NewFD->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 11587 auto HasNoexcept = [&](QualType T) -> bool { 11588 // Strip off declarator chunks that could be between us and a function 11589 // type. We don't need to look far, exception specifications are very 11590 // restricted prior to C++17. 11591 if (auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11592 T = RT->getPointeeType(); 11593 else if (T->isAnyPointerType()) 11594 T = T->getPointeeType(); 11595 else if (auto *MPT = T->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 11596 T = MPT->getPointeeType(); 11597 if (auto *FPT = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 11598 if (FPT->isNothrow()) 11599 return true; 11600 return false; 11601 }; 11602 11603 auto *FPT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11604 bool AnyNoexcept = HasNoexcept(FPT->getReturnType()); 11605 for (QualType T : FPT->param_types()) 11606 AnyNoexcept |= HasNoexcept(T); 11607 if (AnyNoexcept) 11608 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 11609 diag::warn_cxx17_compat_exception_spec_in_signature) 11610 << NewFD; 11611 } 11612 11613 if (!Redeclaration && LangOpts.CUDA) 11614 checkCUDATargetOverload(NewFD, Previous); 11615 } 11616 return Redeclaration; 11617 } 11618 11619 void Sema::CheckMain(FunctionDecl* FD, const DeclSpec& DS) { 11620 // C++11 [basic.start.main]p3: 11621 // A program that [...] declares main to be inline, static or 11622 // constexpr is ill-formed. 11623 // C11 6.7.4p4: In a hosted environment, no function specifier(s) shall 11624 // appear in a declaration of main. 11625 // static main is not an error under C99, but we should warn about it. 11626 // We accept _Noreturn main as an extension. 11627 if (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) 11628 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 11629 ? diag::err_static_main : diag::warn_static_main) 11630 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 11631 if (FD->isInlineSpecified()) 11632 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_main) 11633 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getInlineSpecLoc()); 11634 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) { 11635 SourceLocation NoreturnLoc = DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(); 11636 SourceRange NoreturnRange(NoreturnLoc, getLocForEndOfToken(NoreturnLoc)); 11637 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::ext_noreturn_main); 11638 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::note_main_remove_noreturn) 11639 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(NoreturnRange); 11640 } 11641 if (FD->isConstexpr()) { 11642 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_main) 11643 << FD->isConsteval() 11644 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc()); 11645 FD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified); 11646 } 11647 11648 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 11649 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_no_main) 11650 << FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>(); 11651 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11652 return; 11653 } 11654 11655 // Functions named main in hlsl are default entries, but don't have specific 11656 // signatures they are required to conform to. 11657 if (getLangOpts().HLSL) 11658 return; 11659 11660 QualType T = FD->getType(); 11661 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 11662 const FunctionType* FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 11663 11664 // Set default calling convention for main() 11665 if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) { 11666 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C)); 11667 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11668 T = Context.getCanonicalType(FD->getType()); 11669 } 11670 11671 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11672 // In C with GNU extensions we allow main() to have non-integer return 11673 // type, but we should warn about the extension, and we disable the 11674 // implicit-return-zero rule. 11675 11676 // GCC in C mode accepts qualified 'int'. 11677 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 11678 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11679 else { 11680 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::ext_main_returns_nonint); 11681 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11682 if (RTRange.isValid()) 11683 Diag(RTRange.getBegin(), diag::note_main_change_return_type) 11684 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int"); 11685 } 11686 } else { 11687 // In C and C++, main magically returns 0 if you fall off the end; 11688 // set the flag which tells us that. 11689 // This is C++ [basic.start.main]p5 and C99 5.1.2.2.3. 11690 11691 // All the standards say that main() should return 'int'. 11692 if (Context.hasSameType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 11693 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11694 else { 11695 // Otherwise, this is just a flat-out error. 11696 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11697 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_main_returns_nonint) 11698 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int") 11699 : FixItHint()); 11700 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11701 } 11702 } 11703 11704 // Treat protoless main() as nullary. 11705 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT)) return; 11706 11707 const FunctionProtoType* FTP = cast<const FunctionProtoType>(FT); 11708 unsigned nparams = FTP->getNumParams(); 11709 assert(FD->getNumParams() == nparams); 11710 11711 bool HasExtraParameters = (nparams > 3); 11712 11713 if (FTP->isVariadic()) { 11714 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variadic_main); 11715 // FIXME: if we had information about the location of the ellipsis, we 11716 // could add a FixIt hint to remove it as a parameter. 11717 } 11718 11719 // Darwin passes an undocumented fourth argument of type char**. If 11720 // other platforms start sprouting these, the logic below will start 11721 // getting shifty. 11722 if (nparams == 4 && Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) 11723 HasExtraParameters = false; 11724 11725 if (HasExtraParameters) { 11726 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_surplus_args) << nparams; 11727 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11728 nparams = 3; 11729 } 11730 11731 // FIXME: a lot of the following diagnostics would be improved 11732 // if we had some location information about types. 11733 11734 QualType CharPP = 11735 Context.getPointerType(Context.getPointerType(Context.CharTy)); 11736 QualType Expected[] = { Context.IntTy, CharPP, CharPP, CharPP }; 11737 11738 for (unsigned i = 0; i < nparams; ++i) { 11739 QualType AT = FTP->getParamType(i); 11740 11741 bool mismatch = true; 11742 11743 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(AT, Expected[i])) 11744 mismatch = false; 11745 else if (Expected[i] == CharPP) { 11746 // As an extension, the following forms are okay: 11747 // char const ** 11748 // char const * const * 11749 // char * const * 11750 11751 QualifierCollector qs; 11752 const PointerType* PT; 11753 if ((PT = qs.strip(AT)->getAs<PointerType>()) && 11754 (PT = qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType())->getAs<PointerType>()) && 11755 Context.hasSameType(QualType(qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType()), 0), 11756 Context.CharTy)) { 11757 qs.removeConst(); 11758 mismatch = !qs.empty(); 11759 } 11760 } 11761 11762 if (mismatch) { 11763 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_arg_wrong) << i << Expected[i]; 11764 // TODO: suggest replacing given type with expected type 11765 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11766 } 11767 } 11768 11769 if (nparams == 1 && !FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 11770 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_main_one_arg); 11771 } 11772 11773 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 11774 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 11775 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11776 } 11777 } 11778 11779 static bool isDefaultStdCall(FunctionDecl *FD, Sema &S) { 11780 11781 // Default calling convention for main and wmain is __cdecl 11782 if (FD->getName() == "main" || FD->getName() == "wmain") 11783 return false; 11784 11785 // Default calling convention for MinGW is __cdecl 11786 const llvm::Triple &T = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 11787 if (T.isWindowsGNUEnvironment()) 11788 return false; 11789 11790 // Default calling convention for WinMain, wWinMain and DllMain 11791 // is __stdcall on 32 bit Windows 11792 if (T.isOSWindows() && T.getArch() == llvm::Triple::x86) 11793 return true; 11794 11795 return false; 11796 } 11797 11798 void Sema::CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(FunctionDecl *FD) { 11799 QualType T = FD->getType(); 11800 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 11801 const FunctionType *FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 11802 11803 // Set an implicit return of 'zero' if the function can return some integral, 11804 // enumeration, pointer or nullptr type. 11805 if (FT->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() || 11806 FT->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() || 11807 FT->getReturnType()->isNullPtrType()) 11808 // DllMain is exempt because a return value of zero means it failed. 11809 if (FD->getName() != "DllMain") 11810 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11811 11812 // Explicity specified calling conventions are applied to MSVC entry points 11813 if (!hasExplicitCallingConv(T)) { 11814 if (isDefaultStdCall(FD, *this)) { 11815 if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_X86StdCall) { 11816 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType( 11817 FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_X86StdCall)); 11818 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11819 } 11820 } else if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) { 11821 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, 11822 FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C)); 11823 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11824 } 11825 } 11826 11827 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 11828 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 11829 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11830 } 11831 } 11832 11833 bool Sema::CheckForConstantInitializer(Expr *Init, QualType DclT) { 11834 // FIXME: Need strict checking. In C89, we need to check for 11835 // any assignment, increment, decrement, function-calls, or 11836 // commas outside of a sizeof. In C99, it's the same list, 11837 // except that the aforementioned are allowed in unevaluated 11838 // expressions. Everything else falls under the 11839 // "may accept other forms of constant expressions" exception. 11840 // 11841 // Regular C++ code will not end up here (exceptions: language extensions, 11842 // OpenCL C++ etc), so the constant expression rules there don't matter. 11843 if (Init->isValueDependent()) { 11844 assert(Init->containsErrors() && 11845 "Dependent code should only occur in error-recovery path."); 11846 return true; 11847 } 11848 const Expr *Culprit; 11849 if (Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) 11850 return false; 11851 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_init_element_not_constant) 11852 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 11853 return true; 11854 } 11855 11856 namespace { 11857 // Visits an initialization expression to see if OrigDecl is evaluated in 11858 // its own initialization and throws a warning if it does. 11859 class SelfReferenceChecker 11860 : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> { 11861 Sema &S; 11862 Decl *OrigDecl; 11863 bool isRecordType; 11864 bool isPODType; 11865 bool isReferenceType; 11866 11867 bool isInitList; 11868 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> InitFieldIndex; 11869 11870 public: 11871 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> Inherited; 11872 11873 SelfReferenceChecker(Sema &S, Decl *OrigDecl) : Inherited(S.Context), 11874 S(S), OrigDecl(OrigDecl) { 11875 isPODType = false; 11876 isRecordType = false; 11877 isReferenceType = false; 11878 isInitList = false; 11879 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(OrigDecl)) { 11880 isPODType = VD->getType().isPODType(S.Context); 11881 isRecordType = VD->getType()->isRecordType(); 11882 isReferenceType = VD->getType()->isReferenceType(); 11883 } 11884 } 11885 11886 // For most expressions, just call the visitor. For initializer lists, 11887 // track the index of the field being initialized since fields are 11888 // initialized in order allowing use of previously initialized fields. 11889 void CheckExpr(Expr *E) { 11890 InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(E); 11891 if (!InitList) { 11892 Visit(E); 11893 return; 11894 } 11895 11896 // Track and increment the index here. 11897 isInitList = true; 11898 InitFieldIndex.push_back(0); 11899 for (auto Child : InitList->children()) { 11900 CheckExpr(cast<Expr>(Child)); 11901 ++InitFieldIndex.back(); 11902 } 11903 InitFieldIndex.pop_back(); 11904 } 11905 11906 // Returns true if MemberExpr is checked and no further checking is needed. 11907 // Returns false if additional checking is required. 11908 bool CheckInitListMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E, bool CheckReference) { 11909 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Fields; 11910 Expr *Base = E; 11911 bool ReferenceField = false; 11912 11913 // Get the field members used. 11914 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11915 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 11916 if (!FD) 11917 return false; 11918 Fields.push_back(FD); 11919 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 11920 ReferenceField = true; 11921 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11922 } 11923 11924 // Keep checking only if the base Decl is the same. 11925 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base); 11926 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl() != OrigDecl) 11927 return false; 11928 11929 // A reference field can be bound to an unininitialized field. 11930 if (CheckReference && !ReferenceField) 11931 return true; 11932 11933 // Convert FieldDecls to their index number. 11934 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> UsedFieldIndex; 11935 for (const FieldDecl *I : llvm::reverse(Fields)) 11936 UsedFieldIndex.push_back(I->getFieldIndex()); 11937 11938 // See if a warning is needed by checking the first difference in index 11939 // numbers. If field being used has index less than the field being 11940 // initialized, then the use is safe. 11941 for (auto UsedIter = UsedFieldIndex.begin(), 11942 UsedEnd = UsedFieldIndex.end(), 11943 OrigIter = InitFieldIndex.begin(), 11944 OrigEnd = InitFieldIndex.end(); 11945 UsedIter != UsedEnd && OrigIter != OrigEnd; ++UsedIter, ++OrigIter) { 11946 if (*UsedIter < *OrigIter) 11947 return true; 11948 if (*UsedIter > *OrigIter) 11949 break; 11950 } 11951 11952 // TODO: Add a different warning which will print the field names. 11953 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11954 return true; 11955 } 11956 11957 // For most expressions, the cast is directly above the DeclRefExpr. 11958 // For conditional operators, the cast can be outside the conditional 11959 // operator if both expressions are DeclRefExpr's. 11960 void HandleValue(Expr *E) { 11961 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 11962 if (DeclRefExpr* DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 11963 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11964 return; 11965 } 11966 11967 if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(E)) { 11968 Visit(CO->getCond()); 11969 HandleValue(CO->getTrueExpr()); 11970 HandleValue(CO->getFalseExpr()); 11971 return; 11972 } 11973 11974 if (BinaryConditionalOperator *BCO = 11975 dyn_cast<BinaryConditionalOperator>(E)) { 11976 Visit(BCO->getCond()); 11977 HandleValue(BCO->getFalseExpr()); 11978 return; 11979 } 11980 11981 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OVE = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(E)) { 11982 HandleValue(OVE->getSourceExpr()); 11983 return; 11984 } 11985 11986 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 11987 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) { 11988 Visit(BO->getLHS()); 11989 HandleValue(BO->getRHS()); 11990 return; 11991 } 11992 } 11993 11994 if (isa<MemberExpr>(E)) { 11995 if (isInitList) { 11996 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(cast<MemberExpr>(E), 11997 false /*CheckReference*/)) 11998 return; 11999 } 12000 12001 Expr *Base = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 12002 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 12003 // Check for static member variables and don't warn on them. 12004 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 12005 return; 12006 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 12007 } 12008 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) 12009 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 12010 return; 12011 } 12012 12013 Visit(E); 12014 } 12015 12016 // Reference types not handled in HandleValue are handled here since all 12017 // uses of references are bad, not just r-value uses. 12018 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 12019 if (isReferenceType) 12020 HandleDeclRefExpr(E); 12021 } 12022 12023 void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 12024 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) { 12025 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 12026 return; 12027 } 12028 12029 Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E); 12030 } 12031 12032 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 12033 if (isInitList) { 12034 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(E, true /*CheckReference*/)) 12035 return; 12036 } 12037 12038 // Don't warn on arrays since they can be treated as pointers. 12039 if (E->getType()->canDecayToPointerType()) return; 12040 12041 // Warn when a non-static method call is followed by non-static member 12042 // field accesses, which is followed by a DeclRefExpr. 12043 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl()); 12044 bool Warn = (MD && !MD->isStatic()); 12045 Expr *Base = E->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 12046 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 12047 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 12048 Warn = false; 12049 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 12050 } 12051 12052 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) { 12053 if (Warn) 12054 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 12055 return; 12056 } 12057 12058 // The base of a MemberExpr is not a MemberExpr or a DeclRefExpr. 12059 // Visit that expression. 12060 Visit(Base); 12061 } 12062 12063 void VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(CXXOperatorCallExpr *E) { 12064 Expr *Callee = E->getCallee(); 12065 12066 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Callee)) 12067 return Inherited::VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(E); 12068 12069 Visit(Callee); 12070 for (auto Arg: E->arguments()) 12071 HandleValue(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 12072 } 12073 12074 void VisitUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) { 12075 // For POD record types, addresses of its own members are well-defined. 12076 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && isRecordType && 12077 isa<MemberExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) { 12078 if (!isPODType) 12079 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 12080 return; 12081 } 12082 12083 if (E->isIncrementDecrementOp()) { 12084 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 12085 return; 12086 } 12087 12088 Inherited::VisitUnaryOperator(E); 12089 } 12090 12091 void VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {} 12092 12093 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) { 12094 if (E->getConstructor()->isCopyConstructor()) { 12095 Expr *ArgExpr = E->getArg(0); 12096 if (InitListExpr *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(ArgExpr)) 12097 if (ILE->getNumInits() == 1) 12098 ArgExpr = ILE->getInit(0); 12099 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(ArgExpr)) 12100 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_NoOp) 12101 ArgExpr = ICE->getSubExpr(); 12102 HandleValue(ArgExpr); 12103 return; 12104 } 12105 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E); 12106 } 12107 12108 void VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) { 12109 // Treat std::move as a use. 12110 if (E->isCallToStdMove()) { 12111 HandleValue(E->getArg(0)); 12112 return; 12113 } 12114 12115 Inherited::VisitCallExpr(E); 12116 } 12117 12118 void VisitBinaryOperator(BinaryOperator *E) { 12119 if (E->isCompoundAssignmentOp()) { 12120 HandleValue(E->getLHS()); 12121 Visit(E->getRHS()); 12122 return; 12123 } 12124 12125 Inherited::VisitBinaryOperator(E); 12126 } 12127 12128 // A custom visitor for BinaryConditionalOperator is needed because the 12129 // regular visitor would check the condition and true expression separately 12130 // but both point to the same place giving duplicate diagnostics. 12131 void VisitBinaryConditionalOperator(BinaryConditionalOperator *E) { 12132 Visit(E->getCond()); 12133 Visit(E->getFalseExpr()); 12134 } 12135 12136 void HandleDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *DRE) { 12137 Decl* ReferenceDecl = DRE->getDecl(); 12138 if (OrigDecl != ReferenceDecl) return; 12139 unsigned diag; 12140 if (isReferenceType) { 12141 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_reference_init; 12142 } else if (cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->isStaticLocal()) { 12143 diag = diag::warn_static_self_reference_in_init; 12144 } else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 12145 isa<NamespaceDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 12146 DRE->getDecl()->getType()->isRecordType()) { 12147 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_init; 12148 } else { 12149 // Local variables will be handled by the CFG analysis. 12150 return; 12151 } 12152 12153 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(DRE->getBeginLoc(), DRE, 12154 S.PDiag(diag) 12155 << DRE->getDecl() << OrigDecl->getLocation() 12156 << DRE->getSourceRange()); 12157 } 12158 }; 12159 12160 /// CheckSelfReference - Warns if OrigDecl is used in expression E. 12161 static void CheckSelfReference(Sema &S, Decl* OrigDecl, Expr *E, 12162 bool DirectInit) { 12163 // Parameters arguments are occassionially constructed with itself, 12164 // for instance, in recursive functions. Skip them. 12165 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(OrigDecl)) 12166 return; 12167 12168 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 12169 12170 // Skip checking T a = a where T is not a record or reference type. 12171 // Doing so is a way to silence uninitialized warnings. 12172 if (!DirectInit && !cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->getType()->isRecordType()) 12173 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) 12174 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) 12175 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(ICE->getSubExpr())) 12176 if (DRE->getDecl() == OrigDecl) 12177 return; 12178 12179 SelfReferenceChecker(S, OrigDecl).CheckExpr(E); 12180 } 12181 } // end anonymous namespace 12182 12183 namespace { 12184 // Simple wrapper to add the name of a variable or (if no variable is 12185 // available) a DeclarationName into a diagnostic. 12186 struct VarDeclOrName { 12187 VarDecl *VDecl; 12188 DeclarationName Name; 12189 12190 friend const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder & 12191 operator<<(const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder &Diag, VarDeclOrName VN) { 12192 return VN.VDecl ? Diag << VN.VDecl : Diag << VN.Name; 12193 } 12194 }; 12195 } // end anonymous namespace 12196 12197 QualType Sema::deduceVarTypeFromInitializer(VarDecl *VDecl, 12198 DeclarationName Name, QualType Type, 12199 TypeSourceInfo *TSI, 12200 SourceRange Range, bool DirectInit, 12201 Expr *Init) { 12202 bool IsInitCapture = !VDecl; 12203 assert((!VDecl || !VDecl->isInitCapture()) && 12204 "init captures are expected to be deduced prior to initialization"); 12205 12206 VarDeclOrName VN{VDecl, Name}; 12207 12208 DeducedType *Deduced = Type->getContainedDeducedType(); 12209 assert(Deduced && "deduceVarTypeFromInitializer for non-deduced type"); 12210 12211 // C++11 [dcl.spec.auto]p3 12212 if (!Init) { 12213 assert(VDecl && "no init for init capture deduction?"); 12214 12215 // Except for class argument deduction, and then for an initializing 12216 // declaration only, i.e. no static at class scope or extern. 12217 if (!isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced) || 12218 VDecl->hasExternalStorage() || 12219 VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) { 12220 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_var_requires_init) 12221 << VDecl->getDeclName() << Type; 12222 return QualType(); 12223 } 12224 } 12225 12226 ArrayRef<Expr*> DeduceInits; 12227 if (Init) 12228 DeduceInits = Init; 12229 12230 if (DirectInit) { 12231 if (auto *PL = dyn_cast_or_null<ParenListExpr>(Init)) 12232 DeduceInits = PL->exprs(); 12233 } 12234 12235 if (isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced)) { 12236 assert(VDecl && "non-auto type for init capture deduction?"); 12237 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl); 12238 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit( 12239 VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init); 12240 // FIXME: Initialization should not be taking a mutable list of inits. 12241 SmallVector<Expr*, 8> InitsCopy(DeduceInits.begin(), DeduceInits.end()); 12242 return DeduceTemplateSpecializationFromInitializer(TSI, Entity, Kind, 12243 InitsCopy); 12244 } 12245 12246 if (DirectInit) { 12247 if (auto *IL = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) 12248 DeduceInits = IL->inits(); 12249 } 12250 12251 // Deduction only works if we have exactly one source expression. 12252 if (DeduceInits.empty()) { 12253 // It isn't possible to write this directly, but it is possible to 12254 // end up in this situation with "auto x(some_pack...);" 12255 Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture 12256 ? diag::err_init_capture_no_expression 12257 : diag::err_auto_var_init_no_expression) 12258 << VN << Type << Range; 12259 return QualType(); 12260 } 12261 12262 if (DeduceInits.size() > 1) { 12263 Diag(DeduceInits[1]->getBeginLoc(), 12264 IsInitCapture ? diag::err_init_capture_multiple_expressions 12265 : diag::err_auto_var_init_multiple_expressions) 12266 << VN << Type << Range; 12267 return QualType(); 12268 } 12269 12270 Expr *DeduceInit = DeduceInits[0]; 12271 if (DirectInit && isa<InitListExpr>(DeduceInit)) { 12272 Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture 12273 ? diag::err_init_capture_paren_braces 12274 : diag::err_auto_var_init_paren_braces) 12275 << isa<InitListExpr>(Init) << VN << Type << Range; 12276 return QualType(); 12277 } 12278 12279 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger. 12280 bool DefaultedAnyToId = false; 12281 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && 12282 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && !IsInitCapture) { 12283 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 12284 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12285 return QualType(); 12286 } 12287 Init = Result.get(); 12288 DefaultedAnyToId = true; 12289 } 12290 12291 // C++ [dcl.decomp]p1: 12292 // If the assignment-expression [...] has array type A and no ref-qualifier 12293 // is present, e has type cv A 12294 if (VDecl && isa<DecompositionDecl>(VDecl) && 12295 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, Context.getAutoDeductType()) && 12296 DeduceInit->getType()->isConstantArrayType()) 12297 return Context.getQualifiedType(DeduceInit->getType(), 12298 Type.getQualifiers()); 12299 12300 QualType DeducedType; 12301 if (DeduceAutoType(TSI, DeduceInit, DeducedType) == DAR_Failed) { 12302 if (!IsInitCapture) 12303 DiagnoseAutoDeductionFailure(VDecl, DeduceInit); 12304 else if (isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) 12305 Diag(Range.getBegin(), 12306 diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure_from_init_list) 12307 << VN 12308 << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType() 12309 : DeduceInit->getType()) 12310 << DeduceInit->getSourceRange(); 12311 else 12312 Diag(Range.getBegin(), diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure) 12313 << VN << TSI->getType() 12314 << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType() 12315 : DeduceInit->getType()) 12316 << DeduceInit->getSourceRange(); 12317 } 12318 12319 // Warn if we deduced 'id'. 'auto' usually implies type-safety, but using 12320 // 'id' instead of a specific object type prevents most of our usual 12321 // checks. 12322 // We only want to warn outside of template instantiations, though: 12323 // inside a template, the 'id' could have come from a parameter. 12324 if (!inTemplateInstantiation() && !DefaultedAnyToId && !IsInitCapture && 12325 !DeducedType.isNull() && DeducedType->isObjCIdType()) { 12326 SourceLocation Loc = TSI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 12327 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_auto_var_is_id) << VN << Range; 12328 } 12329 12330 return DeducedType; 12331 } 12332 12333 bool Sema::DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *VDecl, bool DirectInit, 12334 Expr *Init) { 12335 assert(!Init || !Init->containsErrors()); 12336 QualType DeducedType = deduceVarTypeFromInitializer( 12337 VDecl, VDecl->getDeclName(), VDecl->getType(), VDecl->getTypeSourceInfo(), 12338 VDecl->getSourceRange(), DirectInit, Init); 12339 if (DeducedType.isNull()) { 12340 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12341 return true; 12342 } 12343 12344 VDecl->setType(DeducedType); 12345 assert(VDecl->isLinkageValid()); 12346 12347 // In ARC, infer lifetime. 12348 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(VDecl)) 12349 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12350 12351 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 12352 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(VDecl); 12353 12354 // If this is a redeclaration, check that the type we just deduced matches 12355 // the previously declared type. 12356 if (VarDecl *Old = VDecl->getPreviousDecl()) { 12357 // We never need to merge the type, because we cannot form an incomplete 12358 // array of auto, nor deduce such a type. 12359 MergeVarDeclTypes(VDecl, Old, /*MergeTypeWithPrevious*/ false); 12360 } 12361 12362 // Check the deduced type is valid for a variable declaration. 12363 CheckVariableDeclarationType(VDecl); 12364 return VDecl->isInvalidDecl(); 12365 } 12366 12367 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(const Expr *Init, 12368 SourceLocation Loc) { 12369 if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 12370 Init = EWC->getSubExpr(); 12371 12372 if (auto *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Init)) 12373 Init = CE->getSubExpr(); 12374 12375 QualType InitType = Init->getType(); 12376 assert((InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12377 InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) && 12378 "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C struct"); 12379 if (auto *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) { 12380 for (auto I : ILE->inits()) { 12381 if (!I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() && 12382 !I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 12383 continue; 12384 SourceLocation SL = I->getExprLoc(); 12385 checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(I, SL.isValid() ? SL : Loc); 12386 } 12387 return; 12388 } 12389 12390 if (isa<ImplicitValueInitExpr>(Init)) { 12391 if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 12392 checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, 12393 NTCUK_Init); 12394 } else { 12395 // Assume all other explicit initializers involving copying some existing 12396 // object. 12397 // TODO: ignore any explicit initializers where we can guarantee 12398 // copy-elision. 12399 if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 12400 checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_CopyInit, NTCUK_Copy); 12401 } 12402 } 12403 12404 namespace { 12405 12406 bool shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(const FieldDecl *FD) { 12407 // Ignore unavailable fields. A field can be marked as unavailable explicitly 12408 // in the source code or implicitly by the compiler if it is in a union 12409 // defined in a system header and has non-trivial ObjC ownership 12410 // qualifications. We don't want those fields to participate in determining 12411 // whether the containing union is non-trivial. 12412 return FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>(); 12413 } 12414 12415 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor 12416 : DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor, 12417 void> { 12418 using Super = 12419 DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor, 12420 void>; 12421 12422 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor( 12423 QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12424 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S) 12425 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12426 12427 void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveDefaultInitializeKind PDIK, QualType QT, 12428 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12429 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12430 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12431 InNonTrivialUnion); 12432 return Super::visitWithKind(PDIK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12433 } 12434 12435 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12436 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12437 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12438 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12439 << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName(); 12440 } 12441 12442 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12443 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12444 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12445 << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName(); 12446 } 12447 12448 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12449 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12450 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12451 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12452 bool IsUnion = false; 12453 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12454 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12455 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12456 << 0 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12457 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12458 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12459 } 12460 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12461 } 12462 12463 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12464 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12465 << 0 << 0 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12466 12467 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12468 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12469 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12470 } 12471 12472 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12473 12474 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12475 // non-trivial C union. 12476 QualType OrigTy; 12477 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12478 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12479 Sema &S; 12480 }; 12481 12482 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor 12483 : DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void> { 12484 using Super = 12485 DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void>; 12486 12487 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor( 12488 QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12489 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S) 12490 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12491 12492 void visitWithKind(QualType::DestructionKind DK, QualType QT, 12493 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12494 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12495 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12496 InNonTrivialUnion); 12497 return Super::visitWithKind(DK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12498 } 12499 12500 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12501 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12502 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12503 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12504 << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName(); 12505 } 12506 12507 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12508 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12509 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12510 << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName(); 12511 } 12512 12513 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12514 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12515 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12516 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12517 bool IsUnion = false; 12518 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12519 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12520 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12521 << 1 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12522 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12523 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12524 } 12525 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12526 } 12527 12528 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12529 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12530 << 0 << 1 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12531 12532 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12533 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12534 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12535 } 12536 12537 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12538 void visitCXXDestructor(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12539 bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12540 12541 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12542 // non-trivial C union. 12543 QualType OrigTy; 12544 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12545 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12546 Sema &S; 12547 }; 12548 12549 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor 12550 : CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void> { 12551 using Super = CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void>; 12552 12553 DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12554 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, 12555 Sema &S) 12556 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12557 12558 void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT, 12559 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12560 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12561 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12562 InNonTrivialUnion); 12563 return Super::visitWithKind(PCK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12564 } 12565 12566 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12567 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12568 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12569 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12570 << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName(); 12571 } 12572 12573 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12574 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12575 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12576 << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName(); 12577 } 12578 12579 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12580 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12581 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12582 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12583 bool IsUnion = false; 12584 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12585 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12586 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12587 << 2 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12588 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12589 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12590 } 12591 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12592 } 12593 12594 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12595 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12596 << 0 << 2 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12597 12598 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12599 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12600 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12601 } 12602 12603 void preVisit(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT, 12604 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12605 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12606 void visitVolatileTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12607 bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12608 12609 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12610 // non-trivial C union. 12611 QualType OrigTy; 12612 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12613 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12614 Sema &S; 12615 }; 12616 12617 } // namespace 12618 12619 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnion(QualType QT, SourceLocation Loc, 12620 NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, 12621 unsigned NonTrivialKind) { 12622 assert((QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12623 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 12624 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) && 12625 "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C union"); 12626 12627 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Init) && 12628 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 12629 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12630 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12631 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Destruct) && 12632 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion()) 12633 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12634 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12635 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Copy) && QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 12636 DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12637 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12638 } 12639 12640 /// AddInitializerToDecl - Adds the initializer Init to the 12641 /// declaration dcl. If DirectInit is true, this is C++ direct 12642 /// initialization rather than copy initialization. 12643 void Sema::AddInitializerToDecl(Decl *RealDecl, Expr *Init, bool DirectInit) { 12644 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore 12645 // the initializer. 12646 if (!RealDecl || RealDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12647 CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(RealDecl)); 12648 return; 12649 } 12650 12651 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(RealDecl)) { 12652 // Pure-specifiers are handled in ActOnPureSpecifier. 12653 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::err_member_function_initialization) 12654 << Method->getDeclName() << Init->getSourceRange(); 12655 Method->setInvalidDecl(); 12656 return; 12657 } 12658 12659 VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl); 12660 if (!VDecl) { 12661 assert(!isa<FieldDecl>(RealDecl) && "field init shouldn't get here"); 12662 Diag(RealDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_illegal_initializer); 12663 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12664 return; 12665 } 12666 12667 // C++11 [decl.spec.auto]p6. Deduce the type which 'auto' stands in for. 12668 if (VDecl->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 12669 // Attempt typo correction early so that the type of the init expression can 12670 // be deduced based on the chosen correction if the original init contains a 12671 // TypoExpr. 12672 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, VDecl); 12673 if (!Res.isUsable()) { 12674 // There are unresolved typos in Init, just drop them. 12675 // FIXME: improve the recovery strategy to preserve the Init. 12676 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12677 return; 12678 } 12679 if (Res.get()->containsErrors()) { 12680 // Invalidate the decl as we don't know the type for recovery-expr yet. 12681 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12682 VDecl->setInit(Res.get()); 12683 return; 12684 } 12685 Init = Res.get(); 12686 12687 if (DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VDecl, DirectInit, Init)) 12688 return; 12689 } 12690 12691 // dllimport cannot be used on variable definitions. 12692 if (VDecl->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) { 12693 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_data_definition); 12694 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12695 return; 12696 } 12697 12698 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl() && VDecl->hasExternalStorage()) { 12699 // C99 6.7.8p5. C++ has no such restriction, but that is a defect. 12700 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_block_extern_cant_init); 12701 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12702 return; 12703 } 12704 12705 if (!VDecl->getType()->isDependentType()) { 12706 // A definition must end up with a complete type, which means it must be 12707 // complete with the restriction that an array type might be completed by 12708 // the initializer; note that later code assumes this restriction. 12709 QualType BaseDeclType = VDecl->getType(); 12710 if (const ArrayType *Array = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(BaseDeclType)) 12711 BaseDeclType = Array->getElementType(); 12712 if (RequireCompleteType(VDecl->getLocation(), BaseDeclType, 12713 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12714 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12715 return; 12716 } 12717 12718 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 12719 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), 12720 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12721 AbstractVariableType)) 12722 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12723 } 12724 12725 // If adding the initializer will turn this declaration into a definition, 12726 // and we already have a definition for this variable, diagnose or otherwise 12727 // handle the situation. 12728 if (VarDecl *Def = VDecl->getDefinition()) 12729 if (Def != VDecl && 12730 (!VDecl->isStaticDataMember() || VDecl->isOutOfLine()) && 12731 !VDecl->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition() && 12732 checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, VDecl)) 12733 return; 12734 12735 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12736 // C++ [class.static.data]p4 12737 // If a static data member is of const integral or const 12738 // enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 12739 // specify a constant-initializer which shall be an integral 12740 // constant expression (5.19). In that case, the member can appear 12741 // in integral constant expressions. The member shall still be 12742 // defined in a namespace scope if it is used in the program and the 12743 // namespace scope definition shall not contain an initializer. 12744 // 12745 // We already performed a redefinition check above, but for static 12746 // data members we also need to check whether there was an in-class 12747 // declaration with an initializer. 12748 if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->hasInit()) { 12749 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_static_data_member_reinitialization) 12750 << VDecl->getDeclName(); 12751 Diag(VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->getInit()->getExprLoc(), 12752 diag::note_previous_initializer) 12753 << 0; 12754 return; 12755 } 12756 12757 if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage()) 12758 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 12759 12760 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Init, UPPC_Initializer)) { 12761 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12762 return; 12763 } 12764 } 12765 12766 // OpenCL 1.1 6.5.2: "Variables allocated in the __local address space inside 12767 // a kernel function cannot be initialized." 12768 if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) { 12769 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_local_cant_init); 12770 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12771 return; 12772 } 12773 12774 // The LoaderUninitialized attribute acts as a definition (of undef). 12775 if (VDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) { 12776 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_cant_init); 12777 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12778 return; 12779 } 12780 12781 // Get the decls type and save a reference for later, since 12782 // CheckInitializerTypes may change it. 12783 QualType DclT = VDecl->getType(), SavT = DclT; 12784 12785 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger 12786 // and we are assigning it to a variable of Objective-C pointer type. 12787 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && DclT->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 12788 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 12789 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 12790 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12791 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12792 return; 12793 } 12794 Init = Result.get(); 12795 } 12796 12797 // Perform the initialization. 12798 ParenListExpr *CXXDirectInit = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(Init); 12799 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12800 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl); 12801 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit( 12802 VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init); 12803 12804 MultiExprArg Args = Init; 12805 if (CXXDirectInit) 12806 Args = MultiExprArg(CXXDirectInit->getExprs(), 12807 CXXDirectInit->getNumExprs()); 12808 12809 // Try to correct any TypoExprs in the initialization arguments. 12810 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < Args.size(); ++Idx) { 12811 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr( 12812 Args[Idx], VDecl, /*RecoverUncorrectedTypos=*/true, 12813 [this, Entity, Kind](Expr *E) { 12814 InitializationSequence Init(*this, Entity, Kind, MultiExprArg(E)); 12815 return Init.Failed() ? ExprError() : E; 12816 }); 12817 if (Res.isInvalid()) { 12818 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12819 } else if (Res.get() != Args[Idx]) { 12820 Args[Idx] = Res.get(); 12821 } 12822 } 12823 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 12824 return; 12825 12826 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, 12827 /*TopLevelOfInitList=*/false, 12828 /*TreatUnavailableAsInvalid=*/false); 12829 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, &DclT); 12830 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12831 // If the provided initializer fails to initialize the var decl, 12832 // we attach a recovery expr for better recovery. 12833 auto RecoveryExpr = 12834 CreateRecoveryExpr(Init->getBeginLoc(), Init->getEndLoc(), Args); 12835 if (RecoveryExpr.get()) 12836 VDecl->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get()); 12837 return; 12838 } 12839 12840 Init = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 12841 } 12842 12843 // Check for self-references within variable initializers. 12844 // Variables declared within a function/method body (except for references) 12845 // are handled by a dataflow analysis. 12846 // This is undefined behavior in C++, but valid in C. 12847 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 12848 if (!VDecl->hasLocalStorage() || VDecl->getType()->isRecordType() || 12849 VDecl->getType()->isReferenceType()) 12850 CheckSelfReference(*this, RealDecl, Init, DirectInit); 12851 12852 // If the type changed, it means we had an incomplete type that was 12853 // completed by the initializer. For example: 12854 // int ary[] = { 1, 3, 5 }; 12855 // "ary" transitions from an IncompleteArrayType to a ConstantArrayType. 12856 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl() && (DclT != SavT)) 12857 VDecl->setType(DclT); 12858 12859 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12860 checkUnsafeAssigns(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), Init); 12861 12862 if (VDecl->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 12863 checkRetainCycles(VDecl, Init); 12864 12865 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable. 12866 // Although this code can still have problems: 12867 // id x = self.weakProp; 12868 // id y = self.weakProp; 12869 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate 12870 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if 12871 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive. 12872 if (FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction()) 12873 if ((VDecl->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 12874 VDecl->getType().isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) && 12875 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, 12876 Init->getBeginLoc())) 12877 FSI->markSafeWeakUse(Init); 12878 } 12879 12880 // The initialization is usually a full-expression. 12881 // 12882 // FIXME: If this is a braced initialization of an aggregate, it is not 12883 // an expression, and each individual field initializer is a separate 12884 // full-expression. For instance, in: 12885 // 12886 // struct Temp { ~Temp(); }; 12887 // struct S { S(Temp); }; 12888 // struct T { S a, b; } t = { Temp(), Temp() } 12889 // 12890 // we should destroy the first Temp before constructing the second. 12891 ExprResult Result = 12892 ActOnFinishFullExpr(Init, VDecl->getLocation(), 12893 /*DiscardedValue*/ false, VDecl->isConstexpr()); 12894 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12895 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12896 return; 12897 } 12898 Init = Result.get(); 12899 12900 // Attach the initializer to the decl. 12901 VDecl->setInit(Init); 12902 12903 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl()) { 12904 // Don't check the initializer if the declaration is malformed. 12905 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12906 // do nothing 12907 12908 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.5.3: __constant locals must be constant-initialized. 12909 // This is true even in C++ for OpenCL. 12910 } else if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) { 12911 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12912 12913 // Otherwise, C++ does not restrict the initializer. 12914 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12915 // do nothing 12916 12917 // C99 6.7.8p4: All the expressions in an initializer for an object that has 12918 // static storage duration shall be constant expressions or string literals. 12919 } else if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 12920 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12921 12922 // C89 is stricter than C99 for aggregate initializers. 12923 // C89 6.5.7p3: All the expressions [...] in an initializer list 12924 // for an object that has aggregate or union type shall be 12925 // constant expressions. 12926 } else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && VDecl->getType()->isAggregateType() && 12927 isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) { 12928 const Expr *Culprit; 12929 if (!Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) { 12930 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), 12931 diag::ext_aggregate_init_not_constant) 12932 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 12933 } 12934 } 12935 12936 if (auto *E = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 12937 if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) 12938 if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage()) 12939 BE->getBlockDecl()->setCanAvoidCopyToHeap(); 12940 } else if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && !VDecl->isInline() && 12941 VDecl->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord()) { 12942 // This is an in-class initialization for a static data member, e.g., 12943 // 12944 // struct S { 12945 // static const int value = 17; 12946 // }; 12947 12948 // C++ [class.mem]p4: 12949 // A member-declarator can contain a constant-initializer only 12950 // if it declares a static member (9.4) of const integral or 12951 // const enumeration type, see 9.4.2. 12952 // 12953 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: 12954 // If a non-volatile non-inline const static data member is of integral 12955 // or enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 12956 // specify a brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause 12957 // that is an assignment-expression is a constant expression. A static 12958 // data member of literal type can be declared in the class definition 12959 // with the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify a 12960 // brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause that is 12961 // an assignment-expression is a constant expression. 12962 12963 // Do nothing on dependent types. 12964 if (DclT->isDependentType()) { 12965 12966 // Allow any 'static constexpr' members, whether or not they are of literal 12967 // type. We separately check that every constexpr variable is of literal 12968 // type. 12969 } else if (VDecl->isConstexpr()) { 12970 12971 // Require constness. 12972 } else if (!DclT.isConstQualified()) { 12973 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_const) 12974 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12975 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12976 12977 // We allow integer constant expressions in all cases. 12978 } else if (DclT->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 12979 // Check whether the expression is a constant expression. 12980 SourceLocation Loc; 12981 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT.isVolatileQualified()) 12982 // In C++11, a non-constexpr const static data member with an 12983 // in-class initializer cannot be volatile. 12984 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_volatile); 12985 else if (Init->isValueDependent()) 12986 ; // Nothing to check. 12987 else if (Init->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context, &Loc)) 12988 ; // Ok, it's an ICE! 12989 else if (Init->getType()->isScopedEnumeralType() && 12990 Init->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Context)) 12991 ; // Ok, it is a scoped-enum constant expression. 12992 else if (Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 12993 // If we can constant fold the initializer through heroics, accept it, 12994 // but report this as a use of an extension for -pedantic. 12995 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12996 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12997 } else { 12998 // Otherwise, this is some crazy unknown case. Report the issue at the 12999 // location provided by the isIntegerConstantExpr failed check. 13000 Diag(Loc, diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 13001 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13002 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 13003 } 13004 13005 // We allow foldable floating-point constants as an extension. 13006 } else if (DclT->isFloatingType()) { // also permits complex, which is ok 13007 // In C++98, this is a GNU extension. In C++11, it is not, but we support 13008 // it anyway and provide a fixit to add the 'constexpr'. 13009 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 13010 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), 13011 diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 13012 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 13013 Diag(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), 13014 diag::note_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 13015 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr "); 13016 } else { 13017 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type) 13018 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 13019 13020 if (!Init->isValueDependent() && !Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 13021 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 13022 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13023 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 13024 } 13025 } 13026 13027 // Suggest adding 'constexpr' in C++11 for literal types. 13028 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT->isLiteralType(Context)) { 13029 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_literal_type) 13030 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange() 13031 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr "); 13032 VDecl->setConstexpr(true); 13033 13034 } else { 13035 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_bad_type) 13036 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 13037 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 13038 } 13039 } else if (VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) { 13040 // In C, extern is typically used to avoid tentative definitions when 13041 // declaring variables in headers, but adding an intializer makes it a 13042 // definition. This is somewhat confusing, so GCC and Clang both warn on it. 13043 // In C++, extern is often used to give implictly static const variables 13044 // external linkage, so don't warn in that case. If selectany is present, 13045 // this might be header code intended for C and C++ inclusion, so apply the 13046 // C++ rules. 13047 if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern && 13048 ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->hasAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) || 13049 !Context.getBaseElementType(VDecl->getType()).isConstQualified()) && 13050 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->isExternC()) && 13051 !isTemplateInstantiation(VDecl->getTemplateSpecializationKind())) 13052 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_extern_init); 13053 13054 // In Microsoft C++ mode, a const variable defined in namespace scope has 13055 // external linkage by default if the variable is declared with 13056 // __declspec(dllexport). 13057 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() && 13058 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->getType().isConstQualified() && 13059 VDecl->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>() && VDecl->getDefinition()) 13060 VDecl->setStorageClass(SC_Extern); 13061 13062 // C99 6.7.8p4. All file scoped initializers need to be constant. 13063 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 13064 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 13065 } 13066 13067 QualType InitType = Init->getType(); 13068 if (!InitType.isNull() && 13069 (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 13070 InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())) 13071 checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(Init, Init->getExprLoc()); 13072 13073 // We will represent direct-initialization similarly to copy-initialization: 13074 // int x(1); -as-> int x = 1; 13075 // ClassType x(a,b,c); -as-> ClassType x = ClassType(a,b,c); 13076 // 13077 // Clients that want to distinguish between the two forms, can check for 13078 // direct initializer using VarDecl::getInitStyle(). 13079 // A major benefit is that clients that don't particularly care about which 13080 // exactly form was it (like the CodeGen) can handle both cases without 13081 // special case code. 13082 13083 // C++ 8.5p11: 13084 // The form of initialization (using parentheses or '=') is generally 13085 // insignificant, but does matter when the entity being initialized has a 13086 // class type. 13087 if (CXXDirectInit) { 13088 assert(DirectInit && "Call-style initializer must be direct init."); 13089 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 13090 } else if (DirectInit) { 13091 // This must be list-initialization. No other way is direct-initialization. 13092 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::ListInit); 13093 } 13094 13095 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && 13096 (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice || !LangOpts.OMPTargetTriples.empty()) && 13097 VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) 13098 DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(VDecl); 13099 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VDecl); 13100 } 13101 13102 /// ActOnInitializerError - Given that there was an error parsing an 13103 /// initializer for the given declaration, try to at least re-establish 13104 /// invariants such as whether a variable's type is either dependent or 13105 /// complete. 13106 void Sema::ActOnInitializerError(Decl *D) { 13107 // Our main concern here is re-establishing invariants like "a 13108 // variable's type is either dependent or complete". 13109 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) return; 13110 13111 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 13112 if (!VD) return; 13113 13114 // Bindings are not usable if we can't make sense of the initializer. 13115 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) 13116 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) 13117 BD->setInvalidDecl(); 13118 13119 // Auto types are meaningless if we can't make sense of the initializer. 13120 if (VD->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 13121 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13122 return; 13123 } 13124 13125 QualType Ty = VD->getType(); 13126 if (Ty->isDependentType()) return; 13127 13128 // Require a complete type. 13129 if (RequireCompleteType(VD->getLocation(), 13130 Context.getBaseElementType(Ty), 13131 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 13132 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13133 return; 13134 } 13135 13136 // Require a non-abstract type. 13137 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VD->getLocation(), Ty, 13138 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 13139 AbstractVariableType)) { 13140 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13141 return; 13142 } 13143 13144 // Don't bother complaining about constructors or destructors, 13145 // though. 13146 } 13147 13148 void Sema::ActOnUninitializedDecl(Decl *RealDecl) { 13149 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore it. 13150 if (!RealDecl) 13151 return; 13152 13153 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl)) { 13154 QualType Type = Var->getType(); 13155 13156 // C++1z [dcl.dcl]p1 grammar implies that an initializer is mandatory. 13157 if (isa<DecompositionDecl>(RealDecl)) { 13158 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_decomp_decl_requires_init) << Var; 13159 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13160 return; 13161 } 13162 13163 if (Type->isUndeducedType() && 13164 DeduceVariableDeclarationType(Var, false, nullptr)) 13165 return; 13166 13167 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: A static data member can be declared with 13168 // the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify 13169 // a brace-or-equal-initializer. 13170 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p1: The constexpr specifier shall be applied only to 13171 // the definition of a variable [...] or the declaration of a static data 13172 // member. 13173 if (Var->isConstexpr() && !Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13174 !Var->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition()) { 13175 if (Var->isStaticDataMember()) { 13176 // C++1z removes the relevant rule; the in-class declaration is always 13177 // a definition there. 13178 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && 13179 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 13180 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 13181 diag::err_constexpr_static_mem_var_requires_init) 13182 << Var; 13183 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13184 return; 13185 } 13186 } else { 13187 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr_var_decl); 13188 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13189 return; 13190 } 13191 } 13192 13193 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: variables declared in the constant address space must 13194 // be initialized. 13195 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13196 Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant && 13197 Var->getStorageClass() != SC_Extern && !Var->getInit()) { 13198 bool HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = false; 13199 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 13200 for (auto *Ctor : RD->ctors()) { 13201 if (Ctor->isConstexpr() && Ctor->getNumParams() == 0 && 13202 Ctor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace() == 13203 LangAS::opencl_constant) { 13204 HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = true; 13205 } 13206 } 13207 } 13208 if (!HasConstExprDefaultConstructor) { 13209 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_constant_no_init); 13210 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13211 return; 13212 } 13213 } 13214 13215 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && RealDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) { 13216 if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) { 13217 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_extern_decl) 13218 << Var; 13219 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13220 return; 13221 } 13222 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Var->getType(), 13223 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 13224 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13225 return; 13226 } 13227 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 13228 if (!RD->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) { 13229 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_trivial_ctor); 13230 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13231 return; 13232 } 13233 } 13234 // The declaration is unitialized, no need for further checks. 13235 return; 13236 } 13237 13238 VarDecl::DefinitionKind DefKind = Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition(); 13239 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && DefKind != VarDecl::DeclarationOnly && 13240 Var->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 13241 checkNonTrivialCUnion(Var->getType(), Var->getLocation(), 13242 NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, NTCUK_Init); 13243 13244 13245 switch (DefKind) { 13246 case VarDecl::Definition: 13247 if (!Var->isStaticDataMember() || !Var->getAnyInitializer()) 13248 break; 13249 13250 // We have an out-of-line definition of a static data member 13251 // that has an in-class initializer, so we type-check this like 13252 // a declaration. 13253 // 13254 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 13255 13256 case VarDecl::DeclarationOnly: 13257 // It's only a declaration. 13258 13259 // Block scope. C99 6.7p7: If an identifier for an object is 13260 // declared with no linkage (C99 6.2.2p6), the type for the 13261 // object shall be complete. 13262 if (!Type->isDependentType() && Var->isLocalVarDecl() && 13263 !Var->hasLinkage() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13264 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13265 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) 13266 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13267 13268 // Make sure that the type is not abstract. 13269 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13270 RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13271 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 13272 AbstractVariableType)) 13273 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13274 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 13275 Var->getStorageClass() == SC_PrivateExtern) { 13276 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::warn_private_extern); 13277 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_private_extern); 13278 } 13279 13280 if (Context.getTargetInfo().allowDebugInfoForExternalRef() && 13281 !Var->isInvalidDecl() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13282 ExternalDeclarations.push_back(Var); 13283 13284 return; 13285 13286 case VarDecl::TentativeDefinition: 13287 // File scope. C99 6.9.2p2: A declaration of an identifier for an 13288 // object that has file scope without an initializer, and without a 13289 // storage-class specifier or with the storage-class specifier "static", 13290 // constitutes a tentative definition. Note: A tentative definition with 13291 // external linkage is valid (C99 6.2.2p5). 13292 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) { 13293 if (const IncompleteArrayType *ArrayT 13294 = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(Type)) { 13295 if (RequireCompleteSizedType( 13296 Var->getLocation(), ArrayT->getElementType(), 13297 diag::err_array_incomplete_or_sizeless_type)) 13298 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13299 } else if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 13300 // C99 6.9.2p3: If the declaration of an identifier for an object is 13301 // a tentative definition and has internal linkage (C99 6.2.2p3), the 13302 // declared type shall not be an incomplete type. 13303 // NOTE: code such as the following 13304 // static struct s; 13305 // struct s { int a; }; 13306 // is accepted by gcc. Hence here we issue a warning instead of 13307 // an error and we do not invalidate the static declaration. 13308 // NOTE: to avoid multiple warnings, only check the first declaration. 13309 if (Var->isFirstDecl()) 13310 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13311 diag::ext_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type); 13312 } 13313 } 13314 13315 // Record the tentative definition; we're done. 13316 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) 13317 TentativeDefinitions.push_back(Var); 13318 return; 13319 } 13320 13321 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 13322 // definitions with incomplete array type. 13323 if (Type->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 13324 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 13325 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_array_needs_initializer); 13326 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13327 return; 13328 } 13329 13330 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 13331 // definitions with reference type. 13332 if (Type->isReferenceType()) { 13333 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_reference_var_requires_init) 13334 << Var << SourceRange(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation()); 13335 return; 13336 } 13337 13338 // Do not attempt to type-check the default initializer for a 13339 // variable with dependent type. 13340 if (Type->isDependentType()) 13341 return; 13342 13343 if (Var->isInvalidDecl()) 13344 return; 13345 13346 if (!Var->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 13347 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), 13348 Context.getBaseElementType(Type), 13349 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 13350 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13351 return; 13352 } 13353 } else { 13354 return; 13355 } 13356 13357 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 13358 if (RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 13359 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 13360 AbstractVariableType)) { 13361 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 13362 return; 13363 } 13364 13365 // Check for jumps past the implicit initializer. C++0x 13366 // clarifies that this applies to a "variable with automatic 13367 // storage duration", not a "local variable". 13368 // C++11 [stmt.dcl]p3 13369 // A program that jumps from a point where a variable with automatic 13370 // storage duration is not in scope to a point where it is in scope is 13371 // ill-formed unless the variable has scalar type, class type with a 13372 // trivial default constructor and a trivial destructor, a cv-qualified 13373 // version of one of these types, or an array of one of the preceding 13374 // types and is declared without an initializer. 13375 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Var->hasLocalStorage()) { 13376 if (const RecordType *Record 13377 = Context.getBaseElementType(Type)->getAs<RecordType>()) { 13378 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl()); 13379 // Mark the function (if we're in one) for further checking even if the 13380 // looser rules of C++11 do not require such checks, so that we can 13381 // diagnose incompatibilities with C++98. 13382 if (!CXXRecord->isPOD()) 13383 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13384 } 13385 } 13386 // In OpenCL, we can't initialize objects in the __local address space, 13387 // even implicitly, so don't synthesize an implicit initializer. 13388 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 13389 Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) 13390 return; 13391 // C++03 [dcl.init]p9: 13392 // If no initializer is specified for an object, and the 13393 // object is of (possibly cv-qualified) non-POD class type (or 13394 // array thereof), the object shall be default-initialized; if 13395 // the object is of const-qualified type, the underlying class 13396 // type shall have a user-declared default 13397 // constructor. Otherwise, if no initializer is specified for 13398 // a non- static object, the object and its subobjects, if 13399 // any, have an indeterminate initial value); if the object 13400 // or any of its subobjects are of const-qualified type, the 13401 // program is ill-formed. 13402 // C++0x [dcl.init]p11: 13403 // If no initializer is specified for an object, the object is 13404 // default-initialized; [...]. 13405 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(Var); 13406 InitializationKind Kind 13407 = InitializationKind::CreateDefault(Var->getLocation()); 13408 13409 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 13410 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 13411 13412 if (Init.get()) { 13413 Var->setInit(MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Init.get())); 13414 // This is important for template substitution. 13415 Var->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 13416 } else if (Init.isInvalid()) { 13417 // If default-init fails, attach a recovery-expr initializer to track 13418 // that initialization was attempted and failed. 13419 auto RecoveryExpr = 13420 CreateRecoveryExpr(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation(), {}); 13421 if (RecoveryExpr.get()) 13422 Var->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get()); 13423 } 13424 13425 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(Var); 13426 } 13427 } 13428 13429 void Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeDecl(Decl *D) { 13430 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Ignore it. 13431 if (!D) 13432 return; 13433 13434 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 13435 if (!VD) { 13436 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::err_for_range_decl_must_be_var); 13437 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13438 return; 13439 } 13440 13441 VD->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 13442 13443 // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier. 13444 int Error = -1; 13445 switch (VD->getStorageClass()) { 13446 case SC_None: 13447 break; 13448 case SC_Extern: 13449 Error = 0; 13450 break; 13451 case SC_Static: 13452 Error = 1; 13453 break; 13454 case SC_PrivateExtern: 13455 Error = 2; 13456 break; 13457 case SC_Auto: 13458 Error = 3; 13459 break; 13460 case SC_Register: 13461 Error = 4; 13462 break; 13463 } 13464 13465 // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier con't. 13466 switch (VD->getTSCSpec()) { 13467 case TSCS_thread_local: 13468 Error = 6; 13469 break; 13470 case TSCS___thread: 13471 case TSCS__Thread_local: 13472 case TSCS_unspecified: 13473 break; 13474 } 13475 13476 if (Error != -1) { 13477 Diag(VD->getOuterLocStart(), diag::err_for_range_storage_class) 13478 << VD << Error; 13479 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13480 } 13481 } 13482 13483 StmtResult Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeIdentifier(Scope *S, SourceLocation IdentLoc, 13484 IdentifierInfo *Ident, 13485 ParsedAttributes &Attrs) { 13486 // C++1y [stmt.iter]p1: 13487 // A range-based for statement of the form 13488 // for ( for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 13489 // is equivalent to 13490 // for ( auto&& for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 13491 DeclSpec DS(Attrs.getPool().getFactory()); 13492 13493 const char *PrevSpec; 13494 unsigned DiagID; 13495 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_auto, IdentLoc, PrevSpec, DiagID, 13496 getPrintingPolicy()); 13497 13498 Declarator D(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::ForInit); 13499 D.SetIdentifier(Ident, IdentLoc); 13500 D.takeAttributes(Attrs); 13501 13502 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getReference(0, IdentLoc, /*lvalue*/ false), 13503 IdentLoc); 13504 Decl *Var = ActOnDeclarator(S, D); 13505 cast<VarDecl>(Var)->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 13506 FinalizeDeclaration(Var); 13507 return ActOnDeclStmt(FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(S, DS, Var), IdentLoc, 13508 Attrs.Range.getEnd().isValid() ? Attrs.Range.getEnd() 13509 : IdentLoc); 13510 } 13511 13512 void Sema::CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *var) { 13513 if (var->isInvalidDecl()) return; 13514 13515 MaybeAddCUDAConstantAttr(var); 13516 13517 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 13518 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Every block variable declaration must have an 13519 // initialiser 13520 if (var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()->isBlockPointerType() && 13521 !var->hasInit()) { 13522 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration) 13523 << 1 /*Init*/; 13524 var->setInvalidDecl(); 13525 return; 13526 } 13527 } 13528 13529 // In Objective-C, don't allow jumps past the implicit initialization of a 13530 // local retaining variable. 13531 if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 13532 var->hasLocalStorage()) { 13533 switch (var->getType().getObjCLifetime()) { 13534 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: 13535 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone: 13536 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing: 13537 break; 13538 13539 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak: 13540 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong: 13541 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13542 break; 13543 } 13544 } 13545 13546 if (var->hasLocalStorage() && 13547 var->getType().isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct) 13548 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13549 13550 // Warn about externally-visible variables being defined without a 13551 // prior declaration. We only want to do this for global 13552 // declarations, but we also specifically need to avoid doing it for 13553 // class members because the linkage of an anonymous class can 13554 // change if it's later given a typedef name. 13555 if (var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13556 var->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && 13557 var->isExternallyVisible() && var->hasLinkage() && 13558 !var->isInline() && !var->getDescribedVarTemplate() && 13559 !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(var) && 13560 !isTemplateInstantiation(var->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) && 13561 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations, 13562 var->getLocation())) { 13563 // Find a previous declaration that's not a definition. 13564 VarDecl *prev = var->getPreviousDecl(); 13565 while (prev && prev->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 13566 prev = prev->getPreviousDecl(); 13567 13568 if (!prev) { 13569 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations) << var; 13570 Diag(var->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage) 13571 << /* variable */ 0; 13572 } 13573 } 13574 13575 // Cache the result of checking for constant initialization. 13576 Optional<bool> CacheHasConstInit; 13577 const Expr *CacheCulprit = nullptr; 13578 auto checkConstInit = [&]() mutable { 13579 if (!CacheHasConstInit) 13580 CacheHasConstInit = var->getInit()->isConstantInitializer( 13581 Context, var->getType()->isReferenceType(), &CacheCulprit); 13582 return *CacheHasConstInit; 13583 }; 13584 13585 if (var->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Static) { 13586 if (var->getType().isDestructedType()) { 13587 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.term]p3: 13588 // The type of an object with thread storage duration shall not 13589 // have a non-trivial destructor. 13590 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_nontrivial_dtor); 13591 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 13592 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 13593 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && var->hasInit()) { 13594 if (!checkConstInit()) { 13595 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.init]p4: 13596 // An object of thread storage duration shall not require dynamic 13597 // initialization. 13598 // FIXME: Need strict checking here. 13599 Diag(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_thread_dynamic_init) 13600 << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange(); 13601 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 13602 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 13603 } 13604 } 13605 } 13606 13607 13608 if (!var->getType()->isStructureType() && var->hasInit() && 13609 isa<InitListExpr>(var->getInit())) { 13610 const auto *ILE = cast<InitListExpr>(var->getInit()); 13611 unsigned NumInits = ILE->getNumInits(); 13612 if (NumInits > 2) 13613 for (unsigned I = 0; I < NumInits; ++I) { 13614 const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(I); 13615 if (!Init) 13616 break; 13617 const auto *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts()); 13618 if (!SL) 13619 break; 13620 13621 unsigned NumConcat = SL->getNumConcatenated(); 13622 // Diagnose missing comma in string array initialization. 13623 // Do not warn when all the elements in the initializer are concatenated 13624 // together. Do not warn for macros too. 13625 if (NumConcat == 2 && !SL->getBeginLoc().isMacroID()) { 13626 bool OnlyOneMissingComma = true; 13627 for (unsigned J = I + 1; J < NumInits; ++J) { 13628 const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(J); 13629 if (!Init) 13630 break; 13631 const auto *SLJ = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts()); 13632 if (!SLJ || SLJ->getNumConcatenated() > 1) { 13633 OnlyOneMissingComma = false; 13634 break; 13635 } 13636 } 13637 13638 if (OnlyOneMissingComma) { 13639 SmallVector<FixItHint, 1> Hints; 13640 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumConcat - 1; ++i) 13641 Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 13642 PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SL->getStrTokenLoc(i)), ",")); 13643 13644 Diag(SL->getStrTokenLoc(1), 13645 diag::warn_concatenated_literal_array_init) 13646 << Hints; 13647 Diag(SL->getBeginLoc(), 13648 diag::note_concatenated_string_literal_silence); 13649 } 13650 // In any case, stop now. 13651 break; 13652 } 13653 } 13654 } 13655 13656 13657 QualType type = var->getType(); 13658 13659 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 13660 getCurFunction()->addByrefBlockVar(var); 13661 13662 Expr *Init = var->getInit(); 13663 bool GlobalStorage = var->hasGlobalStorage(); 13664 bool IsGlobal = GlobalStorage && !var->isStaticLocal(); 13665 QualType baseType = Context.getBaseElementType(type); 13666 bool HasConstInit = true; 13667 13668 // Check whether the initializer is sufficiently constant. 13669 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !type->isDependentType() && Init && 13670 !Init->isValueDependent() && 13671 (GlobalStorage || var->isConstexpr() || 13672 var->mightBeUsableInConstantExpressions(Context))) { 13673 // If this variable might have a constant initializer or might be usable in 13674 // constant expressions, check whether or not it actually is now. We can't 13675 // do this lazily, because the result might depend on things that change 13676 // later, such as which constexpr functions happen to be defined. 13677 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 13678 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 13679 // Prior to C++11, in contexts where a constant initializer is required, 13680 // the set of valid constant initializers is described by syntactic rules 13681 // in [expr.const]p2-6. 13682 // FIXME: Stricter checking for these rules would be useful for constinit / 13683 // -Wglobal-constructors. 13684 HasConstInit = checkConstInit(); 13685 13686 // Compute and cache the constant value, and remember that we have a 13687 // constant initializer. 13688 if (HasConstInit) { 13689 (void)var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes); 13690 Notes.clear(); 13691 } else if (CacheCulprit) { 13692 Notes.emplace_back(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), 13693 PDiag(diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)); 13694 Notes.back().second << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange(); 13695 } 13696 } else { 13697 // Evaluate the initializer to see if it's a constant initializer. 13698 HasConstInit = var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes); 13699 } 13700 13701 if (HasConstInit) { 13702 // FIXME: Consider replacing the initializer with a ConstantExpr. 13703 } else if (var->isConstexpr()) { 13704 SourceLocation DiagLoc = var->getLocation(); 13705 // If the note doesn't add any useful information other than a source 13706 // location, fold it into the primary diagnostic. 13707 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 13708 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 13709 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first; 13710 Notes.clear(); 13711 } 13712 Diag(DiagLoc, diag::err_constexpr_var_requires_const_init) 13713 << var << Init->getSourceRange(); 13714 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I) 13715 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 13716 } else if (GlobalStorage && var->hasAttr<ConstInitAttr>()) { 13717 auto *Attr = var->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 13718 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_require_constant_init_failed) 13719 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13720 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_required_constant_init_here) 13721 << Attr->getRange() << Attr->isConstinit(); 13722 for (auto &it : Notes) 13723 Diag(it.first, it.second); 13724 } else if (IsGlobal && 13725 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_global_constructor, 13726 var->getLocation())) { 13727 // Warn about globals which don't have a constant initializer. Don't 13728 // warn about globals with a non-trivial destructor because we already 13729 // warned about them. 13730 CXXRecordDecl *RD = baseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 13731 if (!(RD && !RD->hasTrivialDestructor())) { 13732 // checkConstInit() here permits trivial default initialization even in 13733 // C++11 onwards, where such an initializer is not a constant initializer 13734 // but nonetheless doesn't require a global constructor. 13735 if (!checkConstInit()) 13736 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_global_constructor) 13737 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13738 } 13739 } 13740 } 13741 13742 // Apply section attributes and pragmas to global variables. 13743 if (GlobalStorage && var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13744 !inTemplateInstantiation()) { 13745 PragmaStack<StringLiteral *> *Stack = nullptr; 13746 int SectionFlags = ASTContext::PSF_Read; 13747 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) { 13748 if (HasConstInit) 13749 Stack = &ConstSegStack; 13750 else { 13751 Stack = &BSSSegStack; 13752 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13753 } 13754 } else if (var->hasInit() && HasConstInit) { 13755 Stack = &DataSegStack; 13756 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13757 } else { 13758 Stack = &BSSSegStack; 13759 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13760 } 13761 if (const SectionAttr *SA = var->getAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 13762 if (SA->getSyntax() == AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Declspec) 13763 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit; 13764 UnifySection(SA->getName(), SectionFlags, var); 13765 } else if (Stack->CurrentValue) { 13766 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit; 13767 auto SectionName = Stack->CurrentValue->getString(); 13768 var->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13769 Context, SectionName, Stack->CurrentPragmaLocation, 13770 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate)); 13771 if (UnifySection(SectionName, SectionFlags, var)) 13772 var->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 13773 } 13774 13775 // Apply the init_seg attribute if this has an initializer. If the 13776 // initializer turns out to not be dynamic, we'll end up ignoring this 13777 // attribute. 13778 if (CurInitSeg && var->getInit()) 13779 var->addAttr(InitSegAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, CurInitSeg->getString(), 13780 CurInitSegLoc, 13781 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13782 } 13783 13784 // All the following checks are C++ only. 13785 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13786 // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the 13787 // current module. 13788 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty()) 13789 Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var); 13790 return; 13791 } 13792 13793 // Require the destructor. 13794 if (!type->isDependentType()) 13795 if (const RecordType *recordType = baseType->getAs<RecordType>()) 13796 FinalizeVarWithDestructor(var, recordType); 13797 13798 // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the current 13799 // module. 13800 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty()) 13801 Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var); 13802 13803 // Build the bindings if this is a structured binding declaration. 13804 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(var)) 13805 CheckCompleteDecompositionDeclaration(DD); 13806 } 13807 13808 /// Check if VD needs to be dllexport/dllimport due to being in a 13809 /// dllexport/import function. 13810 void Sema::CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VarDecl *VD) { 13811 assert(VD->isStaticLocal()); 13812 13813 auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13814 13815 // Find outermost function when VD is in lambda function. 13816 while (FD && !getDLLAttr(FD) && 13817 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>() && 13818 !FD->hasAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13819 FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(FD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13820 } 13821 13822 if (!FD) 13823 return; 13824 13825 // Static locals inherit dll attributes from their function. 13826 if (Attr *A = getDLLAttr(FD)) { 13827 auto *NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(A->clone(getASTContext())); 13828 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13829 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13830 } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13831 auto *NewAttr = DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A); 13832 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13833 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13834 13835 // Export this function to enforce exporting this static variable even 13836 // if it is not used in this compilation unit. 13837 if (!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 13838 FD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13839 13840 } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13841 auto *NewAttr = DLLImportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A); 13842 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13843 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13844 } 13845 } 13846 13847 /// FinalizeDeclaration - called by ParseDeclarationAfterDeclarator to perform 13848 /// any semantic actions necessary after any initializer has been attached. 13849 void Sema::FinalizeDeclaration(Decl *ThisDecl) { 13850 // Note that we are no longer parsing the initializer for this declaration. 13851 ParsingInitForAutoVars.erase(ThisDecl); 13852 13853 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(ThisDecl); 13854 if (!VD) 13855 return; 13856 13857 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section bss|data|rodata' is active 13858 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13859 !inTemplateInstantiation() && !VD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 13860 if (PragmaClangBSSSection.Valid) 13861 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangBSSSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13862 Context, PragmaClangBSSSection.SectionName, 13863 PragmaClangBSSSection.PragmaLocation, 13864 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13865 if (PragmaClangDataSection.Valid) 13866 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangDataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13867 Context, PragmaClangDataSection.SectionName, 13868 PragmaClangDataSection.PragmaLocation, 13869 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13870 if (PragmaClangRodataSection.Valid) 13871 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRodataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13872 Context, PragmaClangRodataSection.SectionName, 13873 PragmaClangRodataSection.PragmaLocation, 13874 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13875 if (PragmaClangRelroSection.Valid) 13876 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRelroSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13877 Context, PragmaClangRelroSection.SectionName, 13878 PragmaClangRelroSection.PragmaLocation, 13879 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13880 } 13881 13882 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(ThisDecl)) { 13883 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) { 13884 FinalizeDeclaration(BD); 13885 } 13886 } 13887 13888 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *VD); 13889 13890 // Perform TLS alignment check here after attributes attached to the variable 13891 // which may affect the alignment have been processed. Only perform the check 13892 // if the target has a maximum TLS alignment (zero means no constraints). 13893 if (unsigned MaxAlign = Context.getTargetInfo().getMaxTLSAlign()) { 13894 // Protect the check so that it's not performed on dependent types and 13895 // dependent alignments (we can't determine the alignment in that case). 13896 if (VD->getTLSKind() && !VD->hasDependentAlignment()) { 13897 CharUnits MaxAlignChars = Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(MaxAlign); 13898 if (Context.getDeclAlign(VD) > MaxAlignChars) { 13899 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_tls_var_aligned_over_maximum) 13900 << (unsigned)Context.getDeclAlign(VD).getQuantity() << VD 13901 << (unsigned)MaxAlignChars.getQuantity(); 13902 } 13903 } 13904 } 13905 13906 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) 13907 CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VD); 13908 13909 // Perform check for initializers of device-side global variables. 13910 // CUDA allows empty constructors as initializers (see E.2.3.1, CUDA 13911 // 7.5). We must also apply the same checks to all __shared__ 13912 // variables whether they are local or not. CUDA also allows 13913 // constant initializers for __constant__ and __device__ variables. 13914 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 13915 checkAllowedCUDAInitializer(VD); 13916 13917 // Grab the dllimport or dllexport attribute off of the VarDecl. 13918 const InheritableAttr *DLLAttr = getDLLAttr(VD); 13919 13920 // Imported static data members cannot be defined out-of-line. 13921 if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast_or_null<DLLImportAttr>(DLLAttr)) { 13922 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isOutOfLine() && 13923 VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13924 // We allow definitions of dllimport class template static data members 13925 // with a warning. 13926 CXXRecordDecl *Context = 13927 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VD->getFirstDecl()->getDeclContext()); 13928 bool IsClassTemplateMember = 13929 isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Context) || 13930 Context->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 13931 13932 Diag(VD->getLocation(), 13933 IsClassTemplateMember 13934 ? diag::warn_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition 13935 : diag::err_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition); 13936 Diag(IA->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 13937 if (!IsClassTemplateMember) 13938 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13939 } 13940 } 13941 13942 // dllimport/dllexport variables cannot be thread local, their TLS index 13943 // isn't exported with the variable. 13944 if (DLLAttr && VD->getTLSKind()) { 13945 auto *F = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13946 if (F && getDLLAttr(F)) { 13947 assert(VD->isStaticLocal()); 13948 // But if this is a static local in a dlimport/dllexport function, the 13949 // function will never be inlined, which means the var would never be 13950 // imported, so having it marked import/export is safe. 13951 } else { 13952 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_thread_local) << VD 13953 << DLLAttr; 13954 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13955 } 13956 } 13957 13958 if (UsedAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 13959 if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13960 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition) 13961 << Attr; 13962 VD->dropAttr<UsedAttr>(); 13963 } 13964 } 13965 if (RetainAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) { 13966 if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13967 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition) 13968 << Attr; 13969 VD->dropAttr<RetainAttr>(); 13970 } 13971 } 13972 13973 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext(); 13974 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 13975 // member, set the visibility of this variable. 13976 if (DC->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && VD->isExternallyVisible()) 13977 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(VD); 13978 13979 // FIXME: Warn on unused var template partial specializations. 13980 if (VD->isFileVarDecl() && !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD)) 13981 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(VD); 13982 13983 // Now we have parsed the initializer and can update the table of magic 13984 // tag values. 13985 if (!VD->hasAttr<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>() || 13986 !VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 13987 return; 13988 13989 for (const auto *I : ThisDecl->specific_attrs<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>()) { 13990 const Expr *MagicValueExpr = VD->getInit(); 13991 if (!MagicValueExpr) { 13992 continue; 13993 } 13994 Optional<llvm::APSInt> MagicValueInt; 13995 if (!(MagicValueInt = MagicValueExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) { 13996 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 13997 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_not_ice) 13998 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 13999 continue; 14000 } 14001 if (MagicValueInt->getActiveBits() > 64) { 14002 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 14003 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_too_large) 14004 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 14005 continue; 14006 } 14007 uint64_t MagicValue = MagicValueInt->getZExtValue(); 14008 RegisterTypeTagForDatatype(I->getArgumentKind(), 14009 MagicValue, 14010 I->getMatchingCType(), 14011 I->getLayoutCompatible(), 14012 I->getMustBeNull()); 14013 } 14014 } 14015 14016 static bool hasDeducedAuto(DeclaratorDecl *DD) { 14017 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DD); 14018 return VD && !VD->getType()->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType(); 14019 } 14020 14021 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(Scope *S, const DeclSpec &DS, 14022 ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 14023 SmallVector<Decl*, 8> Decls; 14024 14025 if (DS.isTypeSpecOwned()) 14026 Decls.push_back(DS.getRepAsDecl()); 14027 14028 DeclaratorDecl *FirstDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr; 14029 DecompositionDecl *FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr; 14030 bool DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = false; 14031 DeclaratorDecl *FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = nullptr; 14032 bool DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = false; 14033 14034 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) { 14035 if (Decl *D = Group[i]) { 14036 // For declarators, there are some additional syntactic-ish checks we need 14037 // to perform. 14038 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DeclaratorDecl>(D)) { 14039 if (!FirstDeclaratorInGroup) 14040 FirstDeclaratorInGroup = DD; 14041 if (!FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup) 14042 FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D); 14043 if (!FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && DS.hasAutoTypeSpec() && 14044 !hasDeducedAuto(DD)) 14045 FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = DD; 14046 14047 if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup != DD) { 14048 // A decomposition declaration cannot be combined with any other 14049 // declaration in the same group. 14050 if (FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup && !DiagnosedMultipleDecomps) { 14051 Diag(FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup->getLocation(), 14052 diag::err_decomp_decl_not_alone) 14053 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange() 14054 << DD->getSourceRange(); 14055 DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = true; 14056 } 14057 14058 // A declarator that uses 'auto' in any way other than to declare a 14059 // variable with a deduced type cannot be combined with any other 14060 // declarator in the same group. 14061 if (FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && !DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto) { 14062 Diag(FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getLocation(), 14063 diag::err_auto_non_deduced_not_alone) 14064 << FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getType() 14065 ->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType() 14066 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange() 14067 << DD->getSourceRange(); 14068 DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = true; 14069 } 14070 } 14071 } 14072 14073 Decls.push_back(D); 14074 } 14075 } 14076 14077 if (DeclSpec::isDeclRep(DS.getTypeSpecType())) { 14078 if (TagDecl *Tag = dyn_cast_or_null<TagDecl>(DS.getRepAsDecl())) { 14079 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 14080 if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup && !Tag->hasNameForLinkage() && 14081 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 14082 Context.addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(Tag, FirstDeclaratorInGroup); 14083 } 14084 } 14085 14086 return BuildDeclaratorGroup(Decls); 14087 } 14088 14089 /// BuildDeclaratorGroup - convert a list of declarations into a declaration 14090 /// group, performing any necessary semantic checking. 14091 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy 14092 Sema::BuildDeclaratorGroup(MutableArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 14093 // C++14 [dcl.spec.auto]p7: (DR1347) 14094 // If the type that replaces the placeholder type is not the same in each 14095 // deduction, the program is ill-formed. 14096 if (Group.size() > 1) { 14097 QualType Deduced; 14098 VarDecl *DeducedDecl = nullptr; 14099 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) { 14100 VarDecl *D = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Group[i]); 14101 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) 14102 break; 14103 DeducedType *DT = D->getType()->getContainedDeducedType(); 14104 if (!DT || DT->getDeducedType().isNull()) 14105 continue; 14106 if (Deduced.isNull()) { 14107 Deduced = DT->getDeducedType(); 14108 DeducedDecl = D; 14109 } else if (!Context.hasSameType(DT->getDeducedType(), Deduced)) { 14110 auto *AT = dyn_cast<AutoType>(DT); 14111 auto Dia = Diag(D->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 14112 diag::err_auto_different_deductions) 14113 << (AT ? (unsigned)AT->getKeyword() : 3) << Deduced 14114 << DeducedDecl->getDeclName() << DT->getDeducedType() 14115 << D->getDeclName(); 14116 if (DeducedDecl->hasInit()) 14117 Dia << DeducedDecl->getInit()->getSourceRange(); 14118 if (D->getInit()) 14119 Dia << D->getInit()->getSourceRange(); 14120 D->setInvalidDecl(); 14121 break; 14122 } 14123 } 14124 } 14125 14126 ActOnDocumentableDecls(Group); 14127 14128 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make( 14129 DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group.data(), Group.size())); 14130 } 14131 14132 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecl(Decl *D) { 14133 ActOnDocumentableDecls(D); 14134 } 14135 14136 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecls(ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 14137 // Don't parse the comment if Doxygen diagnostics are ignored. 14138 if (Group.empty() || !Group[0]) 14139 return; 14140 14141 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_doc_param_not_found, 14142 Group[0]->getLocation()) && 14143 Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_unknown_comment_command_name, 14144 Group[0]->getLocation())) 14145 return; 14146 14147 if (Group.size() >= 2) { 14148 // This is a decl group. Normally it will contain only declarations 14149 // produced from declarator list. But in case we have any definitions or 14150 // additional declaration references: 14151 // 'typedef struct S {} S;' 14152 // 'typedef struct S *S;' 14153 // 'struct S *pS;' 14154 // FinalizeDeclaratorGroup adds these as separate declarations. 14155 Decl *MaybeTagDecl = Group[0]; 14156 if (MaybeTagDecl && isa<TagDecl>(MaybeTagDecl)) { 14157 Group = Group.slice(1); 14158 } 14159 } 14160 14161 // FIMXE: We assume every Decl in the group is in the same file. 14162 // This is false when preprocessor constructs the group from decls in 14163 // different files (e. g. macros or #include). 14164 Context.attachCommentsToJustParsedDecls(Group, &getPreprocessor()); 14165 } 14166 14167 /// Common checks for a parameter-declaration that should apply to both function 14168 /// parameters and non-type template parameters. 14169 void Sema::CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 14170 // Check that there are no default arguments inside the type of this 14171 // parameter. 14172 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 14173 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 14174 14175 // Parameter declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 14176 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 14177 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_param_declarator) 14178 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 14179 } 14180 14181 // [dcl.meaning]p1: An unqualified-id occurring in a declarator-id shall be a 14182 // simple identifier except [...irrelevant cases...]. 14183 switch (D.getName().getKind()) { 14184 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier: 14185 break; 14186 14187 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId: 14188 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: 14189 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId: 14190 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: 14191 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: 14192 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: 14193 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: 14194 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name) 14195 << GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 14196 break; 14197 14198 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: 14199 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: 14200 // GetNameForDeclarator would not produce a useful name in this case. 14201 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name_template_id); 14202 break; 14203 } 14204 } 14205 14206 /// ActOnParamDeclarator - Called from Parser::ParseFunctionDeclarator() 14207 /// to introduce parameters into function prototype scope. 14208 Decl *Sema::ActOnParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 14209 const DeclSpec &DS = D.getDeclSpec(); 14210 14211 // Verify C99 6.7.5.3p2: The only SCS allowed is 'register'. 14212 14213 // C++03 [dcl.stc]p2 also permits 'auto'. 14214 StorageClass SC = SC_None; 14215 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_register) { 14216 SC = SC_Register; 14217 // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated. 14218 // In C++17, it is not allowed, but we tolerate it as an extension. 14219 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 14220 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 14221 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class 14222 : diag::warn_deprecated_register) 14223 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 14224 } 14225 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 14226 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_auto) { 14227 SC = SC_Auto; 14228 } else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 14229 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 14230 diag::err_invalid_storage_class_in_func_decl); 14231 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs(); 14232 } 14233 14234 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 14235 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_thread) 14236 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 14237 if (DS.isInlineSpecified()) 14238 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 14239 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 14240 if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) 14241 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 14242 << 0 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 14243 14244 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 14245 14246 CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(S, D); 14247 14248 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 14249 QualType parmDeclType = TInfo->getType(); 14250 14251 // Check for redeclaration of parameters, e.g. int foo(int x, int x); 14252 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 14253 if (II) { 14254 LookupResult R(*this, II, D.getIdentifierLoc(), LookupOrdinaryName, 14255 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 14256 LookupName(R, S); 14257 if (R.isSingleResult()) { 14258 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 14259 if (PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 14260 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 14261 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 14262 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 14263 PrevDecl = nullptr; 14264 } else if (S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 14265 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_param_redefinition) << II; 14266 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 14267 14268 // Recover by removing the name 14269 II = nullptr; 14270 D.SetIdentifier(nullptr, D.getIdentifierLoc()); 14271 D.setInvalidType(true); 14272 } 14273 } 14274 } 14275 14276 // Temporarily put parameter variables in the translation unit, not 14277 // the enclosing context. This prevents them from accidentally 14278 // looking like class members in C++. 14279 ParmVarDecl *New = 14280 CheckParameter(Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(), D.getBeginLoc(), 14281 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, parmDeclType, TInfo, SC); 14282 14283 if (D.isInvalidType()) 14284 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14285 14286 assert(S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()); 14287 assert(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() >= 1); 14288 New->setScopeInfo(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() - 1, 14289 S->getNextFunctionPrototypeIndex()); 14290 14291 // Add the parameter declaration into this scope. 14292 S->AddDecl(New); 14293 if (II) 14294 IdResolver.AddDecl(New); 14295 14296 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, New, D); 14297 14298 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 14299 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 14300 << 1 << New << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 14301 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 14302 14303 if (New->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 14304 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 14305 } 14306 14307 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 14308 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(New); 14309 14310 return New; 14311 } 14312 14313 /// Synthesizes a variable for a parameter arising from a 14314 /// typedef. 14315 ParmVarDecl *Sema::BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(DeclContext *DC, 14316 SourceLocation Loc, 14317 QualType T) { 14318 /* FIXME: setting StartLoc == Loc. 14319 Would it be worth to modify callers so as to provide proper source 14320 location for the unnamed parameters, embedding the parameter's type? */ 14321 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, Loc, Loc, nullptr, 14322 T, Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc), 14323 SC_None, nullptr); 14324 Param->setImplicit(); 14325 return Param; 14326 } 14327 14328 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedParameters(ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters) { 14329 // Don't diagnose unused-parameter errors in template instantiations; we 14330 // will already have done so in the template itself. 14331 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) 14332 return; 14333 14334 for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) { 14335 if (!Parameter->isReferenced() && Parameter->getDeclName() && 14336 !Parameter->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) { 14337 Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_unused_parameter) 14338 << Parameter->getDeclName(); 14339 } 14340 } 14341 } 14342 14343 void Sema::DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue( 14344 ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters, QualType ReturnTy, NamedDecl *D) { 14345 if (LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy == 0) // No check. 14346 return; 14347 14348 // Warn if the return value is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 14349 // threshold. 14350 if (!ReturnTy->isDependentType() && ReturnTy.isPODType(Context)) { 14351 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ReturnTy).getQuantity(); 14352 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 14353 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_size) << D << Size; 14354 } 14355 14356 // Warn if any parameter is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 14357 // threshold. 14358 for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) { 14359 QualType T = Parameter->getType(); 14360 if (T->isDependentType() || !T.isPODType(Context)) 14361 continue; 14362 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(T).getQuantity(); 14363 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 14364 Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_parameter_size) 14365 << Parameter << Size; 14366 } 14367 } 14368 14369 ParmVarDecl *Sema::CheckParameter(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc, 14370 SourceLocation NameLoc, IdentifierInfo *Name, 14371 QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo, 14372 StorageClass SC) { 14373 // In ARC, infer a lifetime qualifier for appropriate parameter types. 14374 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 14375 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None && 14376 T->isObjCLifetimeType()) { 14377 14378 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime; 14379 14380 // Special cases for arrays: 14381 // - if it's const, use __unsafe_unretained 14382 // - otherwise, it's an error 14383 if (T->isArrayType()) { 14384 if (!T.isConstQualified()) { 14385 if (DelayedDiagnostics.shouldDelayDiagnostics()) 14386 DelayedDiagnostics.add( 14387 sema::DelayedDiagnostic::makeForbiddenType( 14388 NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership, T, false)); 14389 else 14390 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership) 14391 << TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 14392 } 14393 lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone; 14394 } else { 14395 lifetime = T->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 14396 } 14397 T = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(T, lifetime); 14398 } 14399 14400 ParmVarDecl *New = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, StartLoc, NameLoc, Name, 14401 Context.getAdjustedParameterType(T), 14402 TSInfo, SC, nullptr); 14403 14404 // Make a note if we created a new pack in the scope of a lambda, so that 14405 // we know that references to that pack must also be expanded within the 14406 // lambda scope. 14407 if (New->isParameterPack()) 14408 if (auto *LSI = getEnclosingLambda()) 14409 LSI->LocalPacks.push_back(New); 14410 14411 if (New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 14412 New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 14413 checkNonTrivialCUnion(New->getType(), New->getLocation(), 14414 NTCUC_FunctionParam, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy); 14415 14416 // Parameters can not be abstract class types. 14417 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 14418 // the class has been completely parsed. 14419 if (!CurContext->isRecord() && 14420 RequireNonAbstractType(NameLoc, T, diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 14421 AbstractParamType)) 14422 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14423 14424 // Parameter declarators cannot be interface types. All ObjC objects are 14425 // passed by reference. 14426 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 14427 SourceLocation TypeEndLoc = 14428 getLocForEndOfToken(TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getEndLoc()); 14429 Diag(NameLoc, 14430 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 1 << T 14431 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(TypeEndLoc, "*"); 14432 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 14433 New->setType(T); 14434 } 14435 14436 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S6.7.3: "The type of an object with automatic storage 14437 // duration shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier." 14438 // Since all parameters have automatic store duration, they can not have 14439 // an address space. 14440 if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default && 14441 // OpenCL allows function arguments declared to be an array of a type 14442 // to be qualified with an address space. 14443 !(getLangOpts().OpenCL && 14444 (T->isArrayType() || T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private))) { 14445 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arg_with_address_space); 14446 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14447 } 14448 14449 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function argument types. 14450 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 14451 CheckPPCMMAType(New->getOriginalType(), New->getLocation())) { 14452 New->setInvalidDecl(); 14453 } 14454 14455 return New; 14456 } 14457 14458 void Sema::ActOnFinishKNRParamDeclarations(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 14459 SourceLocation LocAfterDecls) { 14460 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getFunctionTypeInfo(); 14461 14462 // C99 6.9.1p6 "If a declarator includes an identifier list, each declaration 14463 // in the declaration list shall have at least one declarator, those 14464 // declarators shall only declare identifiers from the identifier list, and 14465 // every identifier in the identifier list shall be declared. 14466 // 14467 // C89 3.7.1p5 "If a declarator includes an identifier list, only the 14468 // identifiers it names shall be declared in the declaration list." 14469 // 14470 // This is why we only diagnose in C99 and later. Note, the other conditions 14471 // listed are checked elsewhere. 14472 if (!FTI.hasPrototype) { 14473 for (int i = FTI.NumParams; i != 0; /* decrement in loop */) { 14474 --i; 14475 if (FTI.Params[i].Param == nullptr) { 14476 if (getLangOpts().C99) { 14477 SmallString<256> Code; 14478 llvm::raw_svector_ostream(Code) 14479 << " int " << FTI.Params[i].Ident->getName() << ";\n"; 14480 Diag(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, diag::ext_param_not_declared) 14481 << FTI.Params[i].Ident 14482 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LocAfterDecls, Code); 14483 } 14484 14485 // Implicitly declare the argument as type 'int' for lack of a better 14486 // type. 14487 AttributeFactory attrs; 14488 DeclSpec DS(attrs); 14489 const char* PrevSpec; // unused 14490 unsigned DiagID; // unused 14491 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, PrevSpec, 14492 DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 14493 // Use the identifier location for the type source range. 14494 DS.SetRangeStart(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14495 DS.SetRangeEnd(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14496 Declarator ParamD(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), 14497 DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeList); 14498 ParamD.SetIdentifier(FTI.Params[i].Ident, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14499 FTI.Params[i].Param = ActOnParamDeclarator(S, ParamD); 14500 } 14501 } 14502 } 14503 } 14504 14505 Decl * 14506 Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Declarator &D, 14507 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, 14508 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody, FnBodyKind BodyKind) { 14509 assert(getCurFunctionDecl() == nullptr && "Function parsing confused"); 14510 assert(D.isFunctionDeclarator() && "Not a function declarator!"); 14511 Scope *ParentScope = FnBodyScope->getParent(); 14512 14513 // Check if we are in an `omp begin/end declare variant` scope. If we are, and 14514 // we define a non-templated function definition, we will create a declaration 14515 // instead (=BaseFD), and emit the definition with a mangled name afterwards. 14516 // The base function declaration will have the equivalent of an `omp declare 14517 // variant` annotation which specifies the mangled definition as a 14518 // specialization function under the OpenMP context defined as part of the 14519 // `omp begin declare variant`. 14520 SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> Bases; 14521 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && isInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope()) 14522 ActOnStartOfFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope( 14523 ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists, Bases); 14524 14525 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition); 14526 Decl *DP = HandleDeclarator(ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists); 14527 Decl *Dcl = ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(FnBodyScope, DP, SkipBody, BodyKind); 14528 14529 if (!Bases.empty()) 14530 ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope(Dcl, Bases); 14531 14532 return Dcl; 14533 } 14534 14535 void Sema::ActOnFinishInlineFunctionDef(FunctionDecl *D) { 14536 Consumer.HandleInlineFunctionDefinition(D); 14537 } 14538 14539 static bool 14540 ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(const FunctionDecl *FD, 14541 const FunctionDecl *&PossiblePrototype) { 14542 // Don't warn about invalid declarations. 14543 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 14544 return false; 14545 14546 // Or declarations that aren't global. 14547 if (!FD->isGlobal()) 14548 return false; 14549 14550 // Don't warn about C++ member functions. 14551 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 14552 return false; 14553 14554 // Don't warn about 'main'. 14555 if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) 14556 if (IdentifierInfo *II = FD->getIdentifier()) 14557 if (II->isStr("main") || II->isStr("efi_main")) 14558 return false; 14559 14560 // Don't warn about inline functions. 14561 if (FD->isInlined()) 14562 return false; 14563 14564 // Don't warn about function templates. 14565 if (FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 14566 return false; 14567 14568 // Don't warn about function template specializations. 14569 if (FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 14570 return false; 14571 14572 // Don't warn for OpenCL kernels. 14573 if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) 14574 return false; 14575 14576 // Don't warn on explicitly deleted functions. 14577 if (FD->isDeleted()) 14578 return false; 14579 14580 // Don't warn on implicitly local functions (such as having local-typed 14581 // parameters). 14582 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible()) 14583 return false; 14584 14585 for (const FunctionDecl *Prev = FD->getPreviousDecl(); 14586 Prev; Prev = Prev->getPreviousDecl()) { 14587 // Ignore any declarations that occur in function or method 14588 // scope, because they aren't visible from the header. 14589 if (Prev->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 14590 continue; 14591 14592 PossiblePrototype = Prev; 14593 return Prev->getType()->isFunctionNoProtoType(); 14594 } 14595 14596 return true; 14597 } 14598 14599 void 14600 Sema::CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FunctionDecl *FD, 14601 const FunctionDecl *EffectiveDefinition, 14602 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 14603 const FunctionDecl *Definition = EffectiveDefinition; 14604 if (!Definition && 14605 !FD->isDefined(Definition, /*CheckForPendingFriendDefinition*/ true)) 14606 return; 14607 14608 if (Definition->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) { 14609 if (FunctionDecl *OrigDef = Definition->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) { 14610 if (FunctionDecl *OrigFD = FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) { 14611 // A merged copy of the same function, instantiated as a member of 14612 // the same class, is OK. 14613 if (declaresSameEntity(OrigFD, OrigDef) && 14614 declaresSameEntity(cast<Decl>(Definition->getLexicalDeclContext()), 14615 cast<Decl>(FD->getLexicalDeclContext()))) 14616 return; 14617 } 14618 } 14619 } 14620 14621 if (canRedefineFunction(Definition, getLangOpts())) 14622 return; 14623 14624 // Don't emit an error when this is redefinition of a typo-corrected 14625 // definition. 14626 if (TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.count(Definition)) 14627 return; 14628 14629 // If we don't have a visible definition of the function, and it's inline or 14630 // a template, skip the new definition. 14631 if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Definition) && 14632 (Definition->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 14633 Definition->isInlined() || 14634 Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() || 14635 Definition->getNumTemplateParameterLists())) { 14636 SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true; 14637 SkipBody->Previous = const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition); 14638 if (auto *TD = Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 14639 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(TD); 14640 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition)); 14641 return; 14642 } 14643 14644 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && Definition->isInlineSpecified() && 14645 Definition->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) 14646 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_extern_inline) 14647 << FD << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 14648 else 14649 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << FD; 14650 14651 Diag(Definition->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 14652 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14653 } 14654 14655 static void RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator, 14656 Sema &S) { 14657 CXXRecordDecl *const LambdaClass = CallOperator->getParent(); 14658 14659 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.PushLambdaScope(); 14660 LSI->CallOperator = CallOperator; 14661 LSI->Lambda = LambdaClass; 14662 LSI->ReturnType = CallOperator->getReturnType(); 14663 const LambdaCaptureDefault LCD = LambdaClass->getLambdaCaptureDefault(); 14664 14665 if (LCD == LCD_None) 14666 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None; 14667 else if (LCD == LCD_ByCopy) 14668 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByval; 14669 else if (LCD == LCD_ByRef) 14670 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref; 14671 DeclarationNameInfo DNI = CallOperator->getNameInfo(); 14672 14673 LSI->IntroducerRange = DNI.getCXXOperatorNameRange(); 14674 LSI->Mutable = !CallOperator->isConst(); 14675 14676 // Add the captures to the LSI so they can be noted as already 14677 // captured within tryCaptureVar. 14678 auto I = LambdaClass->field_begin(); 14679 for (const auto &C : LambdaClass->captures()) { 14680 if (C.capturesVariable()) { 14681 VarDecl *VD = C.getCapturedVar(); 14682 if (VD->isInitCapture()) 14683 S.CurrentInstantiationScope->InstantiatedLocal(VD, VD); 14684 const bool ByRef = C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_ByRef; 14685 LSI->addCapture(VD, /*IsBlock*/false, ByRef, 14686 /*RefersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture*/true, C.getLocation(), 14687 /*EllipsisLoc*/C.isPackExpansion() 14688 ? C.getEllipsisLoc() : SourceLocation(), 14689 I->getType(), /*Invalid*/false); 14690 14691 } else if (C.capturesThis()) { 14692 LSI->addThisCapture(/*Nested*/ false, C.getLocation(), I->getType(), 14693 C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_StarThis); 14694 } else { 14695 LSI->addVLATypeCapture(C.getLocation(), I->getCapturedVLAType(), 14696 I->getType()); 14697 } 14698 ++I; 14699 } 14700 } 14701 14702 Decl *Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Decl *D, 14703 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody, 14704 FnBodyKind BodyKind) { 14705 if (!D) { 14706 // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Push on a fake scope 14707 // anyway so we can try to parse the function body. 14708 PushFunctionScope(); 14709 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 14710 return D; 14711 } 14712 14713 FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr; 14714 14715 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 14716 FD = FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 14717 else 14718 FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 14719 14720 // Do not push if it is a lambda because one is already pushed when building 14721 // the lambda in ActOnStartOfLambdaDefinition(). 14722 if (!isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) 14723 PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 14724 FD->isConsteval() ? ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated 14725 : ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 14726 14727 // Check for defining attributes before the check for redefinition. 14728 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 14729 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 0; 14730 FD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 14731 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14732 } 14733 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<IFuncAttr>()) { 14734 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 1; 14735 FD->dropAttr<IFuncAttr>(); 14736 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14737 } 14738 14739 if (auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) { 14740 if (Ctor->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 14741 Ctor->isDefaultConstructor() && 14742 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 14743 // If this is an MS ABI dllexport default constructor, instantiate any 14744 // default arguments. 14745 InstantiateDefaultCtorDefaultArgs(Ctor); 14746 } 14747 } 14748 14749 // See if this is a redefinition. If 'will have body' (or similar) is already 14750 // set, then these checks were already performed when it was set. 14751 if (!FD->willHaveBody() && !FD->isLateTemplateParsed() && 14752 !FD->isThisDeclarationInstantiatedFromAFriendDefinition()) { 14753 CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, nullptr, SkipBody); 14754 14755 // If we're skipping the body, we're done. Don't enter the scope. 14756 if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) 14757 return D; 14758 } 14759 14760 // Mark this function as "will have a body eventually". This lets users to 14761 // call e.g. isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible while we're still parsing 14762 // this function. 14763 FD->setWillHaveBody(); 14764 14765 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator, push 14766 // a LambdaScopeInfo onto the function stack. But use the information 14767 // that's already been calculated (ActOnLambdaExpr) to prime the current 14768 // LambdaScopeInfo. 14769 // When the template operator is being specialized, the LambdaScopeInfo, 14770 // has to be properly restored so that tryCaptureVariable doesn't try 14771 // and capture any new variables. In addition when calculating potential 14772 // captures during transformation of nested lambdas, it is necessary to 14773 // have the LSI properly restored. 14774 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(FD)) { 14775 assert(inTemplateInstantiation() && 14776 "There should be an active template instantiation on the stack " 14777 "when instantiating a generic lambda!"); 14778 RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D), *this); 14779 } else { 14780 // Enter a new function scope 14781 PushFunctionScope(); 14782 } 14783 14784 // Builtin functions cannot be defined. 14785 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 14786 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID) && 14787 !Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedRuntimeFunction(BuiltinID)) { 14788 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_definition) << FD; 14789 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14790 } 14791 } 14792 14793 // The return type of a function definition must be complete (C99 6.9.1p3), 14794 // unless the function is deleted (C++ specifc, C++ [dcl.fct.def.general]p2) 14795 QualType ResultType = FD->getReturnType(); 14796 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && !ResultType->isVoidType() && 14797 !FD->isInvalidDecl() && BodyKind != FnBodyKind::Delete && 14798 RequireCompleteType(FD->getLocation(), ResultType, 14799 diag::err_func_def_incomplete_result)) 14800 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14801 14802 if (FnBodyScope) 14803 PushDeclContext(FnBodyScope, FD); 14804 14805 // Check the validity of our function parameters 14806 if (BodyKind != FnBodyKind::Delete) 14807 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(FD->parameters(), 14808 /*CheckParameterNames=*/true); 14809 14810 // Add non-parameter declarations already in the function to the current 14811 // scope. 14812 if (FnBodyScope) { 14813 for (Decl *NPD : FD->decls()) { 14814 auto *NonParmDecl = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(NPD); 14815 if (!NonParmDecl) 14816 continue; 14817 assert(!isa<ParmVarDecl>(NonParmDecl) && 14818 "parameters should not be in newly created FD yet"); 14819 14820 // If the decl has a name, make it accessible in the current scope. 14821 if (NonParmDecl->getDeclName()) 14822 PushOnScopeChains(NonParmDecl, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 14823 14824 // Similarly, dive into enums and fish their constants out, making them 14825 // accessible in this scope. 14826 if (auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(NonParmDecl)) { 14827 for (auto *EI : ED->enumerators()) 14828 PushOnScopeChains(EI, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 14829 } 14830 } 14831 } 14832 14833 // Introduce our parameters into the function scope 14834 for (auto Param : FD->parameters()) { 14835 Param->setOwningFunction(FD); 14836 14837 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 14838 if (Param->getIdentifier() && FnBodyScope) { 14839 CheckShadow(FnBodyScope, Param); 14840 14841 PushOnScopeChains(Param, FnBodyScope); 14842 } 14843 } 14844 14845 // Ensure that the function's exception specification is instantiated. 14846 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 14847 ResolveExceptionSpec(D->getLocation(), FPT); 14848 14849 // dllimport cannot be applied to non-inline function definitions. 14850 if (FD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !FD->isInlined() && 14851 !FD->isTemplateInstantiation()) { 14852 assert(!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()); 14853 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_function_definition); 14854 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14855 return D; 14856 } 14857 // We want to attach documentation to original Decl (which might be 14858 // a function template). 14859 ActOnDocumentableDecl(D); 14860 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 14861 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl && 14862 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCImplementation) 14863 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_function_def_in_objc_container); 14864 14865 return D; 14866 } 14867 14868 /// Given the set of return statements within a function body, 14869 /// compute the variables that are subject to the named return value 14870 /// optimization. 14871 /// 14872 /// Each of the variables that is subject to the named return value 14873 /// optimization will be marked as NRVO variables in the AST, and any 14874 /// return statement that has a marked NRVO variable as its NRVO candidate can 14875 /// use the named return value optimization. 14876 /// 14877 /// This function applies a very simplistic algorithm for NRVO: if every return 14878 /// statement in the scope of a variable has the same NRVO candidate, that 14879 /// candidate is an NRVO variable. 14880 void Sema::computeNRVO(Stmt *Body, FunctionScopeInfo *Scope) { 14881 ReturnStmt **Returns = Scope->Returns.data(); 14882 14883 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Scope->Returns.size(); I != E; ++I) { 14884 if (const VarDecl *NRVOCandidate = Returns[I]->getNRVOCandidate()) { 14885 if (!NRVOCandidate->isNRVOVariable()) 14886 Returns[I]->setNRVOCandidate(nullptr); 14887 } 14888 } 14889 } 14890 14891 bool Sema::canDelayFunctionBody(const Declarator &D) { 14892 // We can't delay parsing the body of a constexpr function template (yet). 14893 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier()) 14894 return false; 14895 14896 // We can't delay parsing the body of a function template with a deduced 14897 // return type (yet). 14898 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasAutoTypeSpec()) { 14899 // If the placeholder introduces a non-deduced trailing return type, 14900 // we can still delay parsing it. 14901 if (D.getNumTypeObjects()) { 14902 const auto &Outer = D.getTypeObject(D.getNumTypeObjects() - 1); 14903 if (Outer.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function && 14904 Outer.Fun.hasTrailingReturnType()) { 14905 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Outer.Fun.getTrailingReturnType()); 14906 return Ty.isNull() || !Ty->isUndeducedType(); 14907 } 14908 } 14909 return false; 14910 } 14911 14912 return true; 14913 } 14914 14915 bool Sema::canSkipFunctionBody(Decl *D) { 14916 // We cannot skip the body of a function (or function template) which is 14917 // constexpr, since we may need to evaluate its body in order to parse the 14918 // rest of the file. 14919 // We cannot skip the body of a function with an undeduced return type, 14920 // because any callers of that function need to know the type. 14921 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction()) { 14922 if (FD->isConstexpr()) 14923 return false; 14924 // We can't simply call Type::isUndeducedType here, because inside template 14925 // auto can be deduced to a dependent type, which is not considered 14926 // "undeduced". 14927 if (FD->getReturnType()->getContainedDeducedType()) 14928 return false; 14929 } 14930 return Consumer.shouldSkipFunctionBody(D); 14931 } 14932 14933 Decl *Sema::ActOnSkippedFunctionBody(Decl *Decl) { 14934 if (!Decl) 14935 return nullptr; 14936 if (FunctionDecl *FD = Decl->getAsFunction()) 14937 FD->setHasSkippedBody(); 14938 else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(Decl)) 14939 MD->setHasSkippedBody(); 14940 return Decl; 14941 } 14942 14943 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *D, Stmt *BodyArg) { 14944 return ActOnFinishFunctionBody(D, BodyArg, false); 14945 } 14946 14947 /// RAII object that pops an ExpressionEvaluationContext when exiting a function 14948 /// body. 14949 class ExitFunctionBodyRAII { 14950 public: 14951 ExitFunctionBodyRAII(Sema &S, bool IsLambda) : S(S), IsLambda(IsLambda) {} 14952 ~ExitFunctionBodyRAII() { 14953 if (!IsLambda) 14954 S.PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 14955 } 14956 14957 private: 14958 Sema &S; 14959 bool IsLambda = false; 14960 }; 14961 14962 static void diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(Sema &S) { 14963 llvm::DenseMap<const BlockDecl *, bool> EscapeInfo; 14964 14965 auto IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock = [&](const BlockDecl *BD) { 14966 if (EscapeInfo.count(BD)) 14967 return EscapeInfo[BD]; 14968 14969 bool R = false; 14970 const BlockDecl *CurBD = BD; 14971 14972 do { 14973 R = !CurBD->doesNotEscape(); 14974 if (R) 14975 break; 14976 CurBD = CurBD->getParent()->getInnermostBlockDecl(); 14977 } while (CurBD); 14978 14979 return EscapeInfo[BD] = R; 14980 }; 14981 14982 // If the location where 'self' is implicitly retained is inside a escaping 14983 // block, emit a diagnostic. 14984 for (const std::pair<SourceLocation, const BlockDecl *> &P : 14985 S.ImplicitlyRetainedSelfLocs) 14986 if (IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock(P.second)) 14987 S.Diag(P.first, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self) 14988 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(P.first, "self->"); 14989 } 14990 14991 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *dcl, Stmt *Body, 14992 bool IsInstantiation) { 14993 FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction(); 14994 FunctionDecl *FD = dcl ? dcl->getAsFunction() : nullptr; 14995 14996 if (FSI->UsesFPIntrin && FD && !FD->hasAttr<StrictFPAttr>()) 14997 FD->addAttr(StrictFPAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 14998 14999 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy(); 15000 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy *ActivePolicy = nullptr; 15001 15002 if (getLangOpts().Coroutines && FSI->isCoroutine()) 15003 CheckCompletedCoroutineBody(FD, Body); 15004 15005 { 15006 // Do not call PopExpressionEvaluationContext() if it is a lambda because 15007 // one is already popped when finishing the lambda in BuildLambdaExpr(). 15008 // This is meant to pop the context added in ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(). 15009 ExitFunctionBodyRAII ExitRAII(*this, isLambdaCallOperator(FD)); 15010 15011 if (FD) { 15012 FD->setBody(Body); 15013 FD->setWillHaveBody(false); 15014 15015 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 15016 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && Body && !FD->isDependentContext() && 15017 FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 15018 // For a function with a deduced result type to return void, 15019 // the result type as written must be 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)', 15020 // possibly cv-qualified or constrained, but not ref-qualified. 15021 if (!FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>()) { 15022 Diag(dcl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_fn_no_return_but_not_auto) 15023 << FD->getReturnType(); 15024 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 15025 } else { 15026 // Falling off the end of the function is the same as 'return;'. 15027 Expr *Dummy = nullptr; 15028 if (DeduceFunctionTypeFromReturnExpr( 15029 FD, dcl->getLocation(), Dummy, 15030 FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>())) 15031 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 15032 } 15033 } 15034 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) { 15035 // In C++11, we don't use 'auto' deduction rules for lambda call 15036 // operators because we don't support return type deduction. 15037 auto *LSI = getCurLambda(); 15038 if (LSI->HasImplicitReturnType) { 15039 deduceClosureReturnType(*LSI); 15040 15041 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p4: 15042 // [...] if there are no return statements in the compound-statement 15043 // [the deduced type is] the type void 15044 QualType RetType = 15045 LSI->ReturnType.isNull() ? Context.VoidTy : LSI->ReturnType; 15046 15047 // Update the return type to the deduced type. 15048 const auto *Proto = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 15049 FD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(RetType, Proto->getParamTypes(), 15050 Proto->getExtProtoInfo())); 15051 } 15052 } 15053 15054 // If the function implicitly returns zero (like 'main') or is naked, 15055 // don't complain about missing return statements. 15056 if (FD->hasImplicitReturnZero() || FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) 15057 WP.disableCheckFallThrough(); 15058 15059 // MSVC permits the use of pure specifier (=0) on function definition, 15060 // defined at class scope, warn about this non-standard construct. 15061 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FD->isPure() && !FD->isOutOfLine()) 15062 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_pure_function_definition); 15063 15064 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 15065 // Don't diagnose unused parameters of defaulted, deleted or naked 15066 // functions. 15067 if (!FD->isDeleted() && !FD->isDefaulted() && !FD->hasSkippedBody() && 15068 !FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) 15069 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(FD->parameters()); 15070 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(FD->parameters(), 15071 FD->getReturnType(), FD); 15072 15073 // If this is a structor, we need a vtable. 15074 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) 15075 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Constructor->getParent()); 15076 else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 15077 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(FD)) 15078 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Destructor->getParent()); 15079 15080 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check 15081 // if we can do this here because lambdas keep return statements around 15082 // to deduce an implicit return type. 15083 if (FD->getReturnType()->isRecordType() && 15084 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !FD->isDependentContext())) 15085 computeNRVO(Body, FSI); 15086 } 15087 15088 // GNU warning -Wmissing-prototypes: 15089 // Warn if a global function is defined without a previous 15090 // prototype declaration. This warning is issued even if the 15091 // definition itself provides a prototype. The aim is to detect 15092 // global functions that fail to be declared in header files. 15093 const FunctionDecl *PossiblePrototype = nullptr; 15094 if (ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(FD, PossiblePrototype)) { 15095 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_prototype) << FD; 15096 15097 if (PossiblePrototype) { 15098 // We found a declaration that is not a prototype, 15099 // but that could be a zero-parameter prototype 15100 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = PossiblePrototype->getTypeSourceInfo()) { 15101 TypeLoc TL = TI->getTypeLoc(); 15102 if (FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAs<FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc>()) 15103 Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(), 15104 diag::note_declaration_not_a_prototype) 15105 << (FD->getNumParams() != 0) 15106 << (FD->getNumParams() == 0 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 15107 FTL.getRParenLoc(), "void") 15108 : FixItHint{}); 15109 } 15110 } else { 15111 // Returns true if the token beginning at this Loc is `const`. 15112 auto isLocAtConst = [&](SourceLocation Loc, const SourceManager &SM, 15113 const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 15114 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> LocInfo = SM.getDecomposedLoc(Loc); 15115 if (LocInfo.first.isInvalid()) 15116 return false; 15117 15118 bool Invalid = false; 15119 StringRef Buffer = SM.getBufferData(LocInfo.first, &Invalid); 15120 if (Invalid) 15121 return false; 15122 15123 if (LocInfo.second > Buffer.size()) 15124 return false; 15125 15126 const char *LexStart = Buffer.data() + LocInfo.second; 15127 StringRef StartTok(LexStart, Buffer.size() - LocInfo.second); 15128 15129 return StartTok.consume_front("const") && 15130 (StartTok.empty() || isWhitespace(StartTok[0]) || 15131 StartTok.startswith("/*") || StartTok.startswith("//")); 15132 }; 15133 15134 auto findBeginLoc = [&]() { 15135 // If the return type has `const` qualifier, we want to insert 15136 // `static` before `const` (and not before the typename). 15137 if ((FD->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() && 15138 FD->getReturnType()->getPointeeType().isConstQualified()) || 15139 FD->getReturnType().isConstQualified()) { 15140 // But only do this if we can determine where the `const` is. 15141 15142 if (isLocAtConst(FD->getBeginLoc(), getSourceManager(), 15143 getLangOpts())) 15144 15145 return FD->getBeginLoc(); 15146 } 15147 return FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(); 15148 }; 15149 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), 15150 diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage) 15151 << /* function */ 1 15152 << (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_None 15153 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(findBeginLoc(), "static ") 15154 : FixItHint{}); 15155 } 15156 } 15157 15158 // If the function being defined does not have a prototype, then we may 15159 // need to diagnose it as changing behavior in C2x because we now know 15160 // whether the function accepts arguments or not. This only handles the 15161 // case where the definition has no prototype but does have parameters 15162 // and either there is no previous potential prototype, or the previous 15163 // potential prototype also has no actual prototype. This handles cases 15164 // like: 15165 // void f(); void f(a) int a; {} 15166 // void g(a) int a; {} 15167 // See MergeFunctionDecl() for other cases of the behavior change 15168 // diagnostic. See GetFullTypeForDeclarator() for handling of a function 15169 // type without a prototype. 15170 if (!FD->hasWrittenPrototype() && FD->getNumParams() != 0 && 15171 (!PossiblePrototype || (!PossiblePrototype->hasWrittenPrototype() && 15172 !PossiblePrototype->isImplicit()))) { 15173 // The function definition has parameters, so this will change behavior 15174 // in C2x. If there is a possible prototype, it comes before the 15175 // function definition. 15176 // FIXME: The declaration may have already been diagnosed as being 15177 // deprecated in GetFullTypeForDeclarator() if it had no arguments, but 15178 // there's no way to test for the "changes behavior" condition in 15179 // SemaType.cpp when forming the declaration's function type. So, we do 15180 // this awkward dance instead. 15181 // 15182 // If we have a possible prototype and it declares a function with a 15183 // prototype, we don't want to diagnose it; if we have a possible 15184 // prototype and it has no prototype, it may have already been 15185 // diagnosed in SemaType.cpp as deprecated depending on whether 15186 // -Wstrict-prototypes is enabled. If we already warned about it being 15187 // deprecated, add a note that it also changes behavior. If we didn't 15188 // warn about it being deprecated (because the diagnostic is not 15189 // enabled), warn now that it is deprecated and changes behavior. 15190 15191 // This K&R C function definition definitely changes behavior in C2x, 15192 // so diagnose it. 15193 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior) 15194 << /*definition*/ 1 << /* not supported in C2x */ 0; 15195 15196 // If we have a possible prototype for the function which is a user- 15197 // visible declaration, we already tested that it has no prototype. 15198 // This will change behavior in C2x. This gets a warning rather than a 15199 // note because it's the same behavior-changing problem as with the 15200 // definition. 15201 if (PossiblePrototype) 15202 Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(), 15203 diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior) 15204 << /*declaration*/ 0 << /* conflicting */ 1 << /*subsequent*/ 1 15205 << /*definition*/ 1; 15206 } 15207 15208 // Warn on CPUDispatch with an actual body. 15209 if (FD->isMultiVersion() && FD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>() && Body) 15210 if (const auto *CmpndBody = dyn_cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)) 15211 if (!CmpndBody->body_empty()) 15212 Diag(CmpndBody->body_front()->getBeginLoc(), 15213 diag::warn_dispatch_body_ignored); 15214 15215 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 15216 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunction; 15217 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && (MD = MD->getCanonicalDecl()) && 15218 MD->isVirtual() && 15219 (KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent())) && 15220 MD == KeyFunction->getCanonicalDecl()) { 15221 // Update the key-function state if necessary for this ABI. 15222 if (FD->isInlined() && 15223 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) { 15224 Context.setNonKeyFunction(MD); 15225 15226 // If the newly-chosen key function is already defined, then we 15227 // need to mark the vtable as used retroactively. 15228 KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent()); 15229 const FunctionDecl *Definition; 15230 if (KeyFunction && KeyFunction->isDefined(Definition)) 15231 MarkVTableUsed(Definition->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 15232 } else { 15233 // We just defined they key function; mark the vtable as used. 15234 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 15235 } 15236 } 15237 } 15238 15239 assert( 15240 (FD == getCurFunctionDecl() || getCurLambda()->CallOperator == FD) && 15241 "Function parsing confused"); 15242 } else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(dcl)) { 15243 assert(MD == getCurMethodDecl() && "Method parsing confused"); 15244 MD->setBody(Body); 15245 if (!MD->isInvalidDecl()) { 15246 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(MD->parameters(), 15247 MD->getReturnType(), MD); 15248 15249 if (Body) 15250 computeNRVO(Body, FSI); 15251 } 15252 if (FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper) { 15253 Diag(MD->getEndLoc(), diag::warn_objc_missing_super_call) 15254 << MD->getSelector().getAsString(); 15255 FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper = false; 15256 } 15257 if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain) { 15258 const ObjCMethodDecl *InitMethod = nullptr; 15259 bool isDesignated = 15260 MD->isDesignatedInitializerForTheInterface(&InitMethod); 15261 assert(isDesignated && InitMethod); 15262 (void)isDesignated; 15263 15264 auto superIsNSObject = [&](const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) { 15265 auto IFace = MD->getClassInterface(); 15266 if (!IFace) 15267 return false; 15268 auto SuperD = IFace->getSuperClass(); 15269 if (!SuperD) 15270 return false; 15271 return SuperD->getIdentifier() == 15272 NSAPIObj->getNSClassId(NSAPI::ClassId_NSObject); 15273 }; 15274 // Don't issue this warning for unavailable inits or direct subclasses 15275 // of NSObject. 15276 if (!MD->isUnavailable() && !superIsNSObject(MD)) { 15277 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 15278 diag::warn_objc_designated_init_missing_super_call); 15279 Diag(InitMethod->getLocation(), 15280 diag::note_objc_designated_init_marked_here); 15281 } 15282 FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain = false; 15283 } 15284 if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation) { 15285 // Don't issue this warning for unavaialable inits. 15286 if (!MD->isUnavailable()) 15287 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 15288 diag::warn_objc_secondary_init_missing_init_call); 15289 FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation = false; 15290 } 15291 15292 diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(*this); 15293 } else { 15294 // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Pop the fake scope 15295 // we pushed on. 15296 PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl); 15297 return nullptr; 15298 } 15299 15300 if (Body && FSI->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations) 15301 DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(dcl); 15302 15303 assert(!FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper && 15304 "This should only be set for ObjC methods, which should have been " 15305 "handled in the block above."); 15306 15307 // Verify and clean out per-function state. 15308 if (Body && (!FD || !FD->isDefaulted())) { 15309 // C++ constructors that have function-try-blocks can't have return 15310 // statements in the handlers of that block. (C++ [except.handle]p14) 15311 // Verify this. 15312 if (FD && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD) && isa<CXXTryStmt>(Body)) 15313 DiagnoseReturnInConstructorExceptionHandler(cast<CXXTryStmt>(Body)); 15314 15315 // Verify that gotos and switch cases don't jump into scopes illegally. 15316 if (FSI->NeedsScopeChecking() && !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled()) 15317 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(Body); 15318 15319 if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(dcl)) { 15320 if (!Destructor->getParent()->isDependentType()) 15321 CheckDestructor(Destructor); 15322 15323 MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced(Destructor->getLocation(), 15324 Destructor->getParent()); 15325 } 15326 15327 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 15328 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up 15329 // for deletion in some later function. 15330 if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() || 15331 getDiagnostics().getSuppressAllDiagnostics()) { 15332 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 15333 } 15334 if (!hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) { 15335 // Since the body is valid, issue any analysis-based warnings that are 15336 // enabled. 15337 ActivePolicy = &WP; 15338 } 15339 15340 if (!IsInstantiation && FD && FD->isConstexpr() && !FD->isInvalidDecl() && 15341 !CheckConstexprFunctionDefinition(FD, CheckConstexprKind::Diagnose)) 15342 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 15343 15344 if (FD && FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) { 15345 for (const Stmt *S : Body->children()) { 15346 // Allow local register variables without initializer as they don't 15347 // require prologue. 15348 bool RegisterVariables = false; 15349 if (auto *DS = dyn_cast<DeclStmt>(S)) { 15350 for (const auto *Decl : DS->decls()) { 15351 if (const auto *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) { 15352 RegisterVariables = 15353 Var->hasAttr<AsmLabelAttr>() && !Var->hasInit(); 15354 if (!RegisterVariables) 15355 break; 15356 } 15357 } 15358 } 15359 if (RegisterVariables) 15360 continue; 15361 if (!isa<AsmStmt>(S) && !isa<NullStmt>(S)) { 15362 Diag(S->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_non_asm_stmt_in_naked_function); 15363 Diag(FD->getAttr<NakedAttr>()->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 15364 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 15365 break; 15366 } 15367 } 15368 } 15369 15370 assert(ExprCleanupObjects.size() == 15371 ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects && 15372 "Leftover temporaries in function"); 15373 assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() && 15374 "Unaccounted cleanups in function"); 15375 assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() && 15376 "Leftover expressions for odr-use checking"); 15377 } 15378 } // Pops the ExitFunctionBodyRAII scope, which needs to happen before we pop 15379 // the declaration context below. Otherwise, we're unable to transform 15380 // 'this' expressions when transforming immediate context functions. 15381 15382 if (!IsInstantiation) 15383 PopDeclContext(); 15384 15385 PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl); 15386 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 15387 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for 15388 // deletion in some later function. 15389 if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred()) { 15390 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 15391 } 15392 15393 if (FD && ((LangOpts.OpenMP && (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice || 15394 !LangOpts.OMPTargetTriples.empty())) || 15395 LangOpts.CUDA || LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice)) { 15396 auto ES = getEmissionStatus(FD); 15397 if (ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted || 15398 ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown) 15399 DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(FD); 15400 } 15401 15402 if (FD && !FD->isDeleted()) 15403 checkTypeSupport(FD->getType(), FD->getLocation(), FD); 15404 15405 return dcl; 15406 } 15407 15408 /// When we finish delayed parsing of an attribute, we must attach it to the 15409 /// relevant Decl. 15410 void Sema::ActOnFinishDelayedAttribute(Scope *S, Decl *D, 15411 ParsedAttributes &Attrs) { 15412 // Always attach attributes to the underlying decl. 15413 if (TemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) 15414 D = TD->getTemplatedDecl(); 15415 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, D, Attrs); 15416 15417 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) 15418 if (Method->isStatic()) 15419 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionAttributes(Method); 15420 } 15421 15422 /// ImplicitlyDefineFunction - An undeclared identifier was used in a function 15423 /// call, forming a call to an implicitly defined function (per C99 6.5.1p2). 15424 NamedDecl *Sema::ImplicitlyDefineFunction(SourceLocation Loc, 15425 IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 15426 // It is not valid to implicitly define a function in C2x. 15427 assert(LangOpts.implicitFunctionsAllowed() && 15428 "Implicit function declarations aren't allowed in this language mode"); 15429 15430 // Find the scope in which the identifier is injected and the corresponding 15431 // DeclContext. 15432 // FIXME: C89 does not say what happens if there is no enclosing block scope. 15433 // In that case, we inject the declaration into the translation unit scope 15434 // instead. 15435 Scope *BlockScope = S; 15436 while (!BlockScope->isCompoundStmtScope() && BlockScope->getParent()) 15437 BlockScope = BlockScope->getParent(); 15438 15439 Scope *ContextScope = BlockScope; 15440 while (!ContextScope->getEntity()) 15441 ContextScope = ContextScope->getParent(); 15442 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, ContextScope->getEntity()); 15443 15444 // Before we produce a declaration for an implicitly defined 15445 // function, see whether there was a locally-scoped declaration of 15446 // this name as a function or variable. If so, use that 15447 // (non-visible) declaration, and complain about it. 15448 NamedDecl *ExternCPrev = findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(&II); 15449 if (ExternCPrev) { 15450 // We still need to inject the function into the enclosing block scope so 15451 // that later (non-call) uses can see it. 15452 PushOnScopeChains(ExternCPrev, BlockScope, /*AddToContext*/false); 15453 15454 // C89 footnote 38: 15455 // If in fact it is not defined as having type "function returning int", 15456 // the behavior is undefined. 15457 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev) || 15458 !Context.typesAreCompatible( 15459 cast<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev)->getType(), 15460 Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Context.IntTy))) { 15461 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_use_out_of_scope_declaration) 15462 << ExternCPrev << !getLangOpts().C99; 15463 Diag(ExternCPrev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15464 return ExternCPrev; 15465 } 15466 } 15467 15468 // Extension in C99 (defaults to error). Legal in C89, but warn about it. 15469 unsigned diag_id; 15470 if (II.getName().startswith("__builtin_")) 15471 diag_id = diag::warn_builtin_unknown; 15472 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.u - Implicit function declaration is not supported. 15473 else if (getLangOpts().C99) 15474 diag_id = diag::ext_implicit_function_decl_c99; 15475 else 15476 diag_id = diag::warn_implicit_function_decl; 15477 15478 TypoCorrection Corrected; 15479 // Because typo correction is expensive, only do it if the implicit 15480 // function declaration is going to be treated as an error. 15481 // 15482 // Perform the corection before issuing the main diagnostic, as some consumers 15483 // use typo-correction callbacks to enhance the main diagnostic. 15484 if (S && !ExternCPrev && 15485 (Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag_id, Loc) >= DiagnosticsEngine::Error)) { 15486 DeclFilterCCC<FunctionDecl> CCC{}; 15487 Corrected = CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(&II, Loc), LookupOrdinaryName, 15488 S, nullptr, CCC, CTK_NonError); 15489 } 15490 15491 Diag(Loc, diag_id) << &II; 15492 if (Corrected) { 15493 // If the correction is going to suggest an implicitly defined function, 15494 // skip the correction as not being a particularly good idea. 15495 bool Diagnose = true; 15496 if (const auto *D = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()) 15497 Diagnose = !D->isImplicit(); 15498 if (Diagnose) 15499 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::note_function_suggestion), 15500 /*ErrorRecovery*/ false); 15501 } 15502 15503 // If we found a prior declaration of this function, don't bother building 15504 // another one. We've already pushed that one into scope, so there's nothing 15505 // more to do. 15506 if (ExternCPrev) 15507 return ExternCPrev; 15508 15509 // Set a Declarator for the implicit definition: int foo(); 15510 const char *Dummy; 15511 AttributeFactory attrFactory; 15512 DeclSpec DS(attrFactory); 15513 unsigned DiagID; 15514 bool Error = DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, Loc, Dummy, DiagID, 15515 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 15516 (void)Error; // Silence warning. 15517 assert(!Error && "Error setting up implicit decl!"); 15518 SourceLocation NoLoc; 15519 Declarator D(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::Block); 15520 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getFunction(/*HasProto=*/false, 15521 /*IsAmbiguous=*/false, 15522 /*LParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 15523 /*Params=*/nullptr, 15524 /*NumParams=*/0, 15525 /*EllipsisLoc=*/NoLoc, 15526 /*RParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 15527 /*RefQualifierIsLvalueRef=*/true, 15528 /*RefQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc, 15529 /*MutableLoc=*/NoLoc, EST_None, 15530 /*ESpecRange=*/SourceRange(), 15531 /*Exceptions=*/nullptr, 15532 /*ExceptionRanges=*/nullptr, 15533 /*NumExceptions=*/0, 15534 /*NoexceptExpr=*/nullptr, 15535 /*ExceptionSpecTokens=*/nullptr, 15536 /*DeclsInPrototype=*/None, Loc, 15537 Loc, D), 15538 std::move(DS.getAttributes()), SourceLocation()); 15539 D.SetIdentifier(&II, Loc); 15540 15541 // Insert this function into the enclosing block scope. 15542 FunctionDecl *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(ActOnDeclarator(BlockScope, D)); 15543 FD->setImplicit(); 15544 15545 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FD); 15546 15547 return FD; 15548 } 15549 15550 /// If this function is a C++ replaceable global allocation function 15551 /// (C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation], C++2a [new.delete]), 15552 /// adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on the standard. 15553 /// 15554 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written 15555 /// attributes are applied to declarations. 15556 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction( 15557 FunctionDecl *FD) { 15558 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 15559 return; 15560 15561 if (FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_New && 15562 FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Array_New) 15563 return; 15564 15565 Optional<unsigned> AlignmentParam; 15566 bool IsNothrow = false; 15567 if (!FD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(&AlignmentParam, &IsNothrow)) 15568 return; 15569 15570 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p4: 15571 // An allocation function that has a non-throwing exception specification 15572 // indicates failure by returning a null pointer value. Any other allocation 15573 // function never returns a null pointer value and indicates failure only by 15574 // throwing an exception [...] 15575 if (!IsNothrow && !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsNonNullAttr>()) 15576 FD->addAttr(ReturnsNonNullAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15577 15578 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2: 15579 // An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of 15580 // storage. [...] If the request succeeds, the value returned by a 15581 // replaceable allocation function is a [...] pointer value p0 different 15582 // from any previously returned value p1 [...] 15583 // 15584 // However, this particular information is being added in codegen, 15585 // because there is an opt-out switch for it (-fno-assume-sane-operator-new) 15586 15587 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2: 15588 // An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of 15589 // storage. If it is successful, it returns the address of the start of a 15590 // block of storage whose length in bytes is at least as large as the 15591 // requested size. 15592 if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocSizeAttr>()) { 15593 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit( 15594 Context, /*ElemSizeParam=*/ParamIdx(1, FD), 15595 /*NumElemsParam=*/ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 15596 } 15597 15598 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3: 15599 // For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful 15600 // call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows: 15601 // (3.1) If the allocation function takes an argument of type 15602 // std::align_val_t, the storage will have the alignment 15603 // specified by the value of this argument. 15604 if (AlignmentParam && !FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>()) { 15605 FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit( 15606 Context, ParamIdx(AlignmentParam.value(), FD), FD->getLocation())); 15607 } 15608 15609 // FIXME: 15610 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3: 15611 // For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful 15612 // call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows: 15613 // (3.2) Otherwise, if the allocation function is named operator new[], 15614 // the storage is aligned for any object that does not have 15615 // new-extended alignment ([basic.align]) and is no larger than the 15616 // requested size. 15617 // (3.3) Otherwise, the storage is aligned for any object that does not 15618 // have new-extended alignment and is of the requested size. 15619 } 15620 15621 /// Adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on 15622 /// the declaration of this function. 15623 /// 15624 /// These attributes can apply both to implicitly-declared builtins 15625 /// (like __builtin___printf_chk) or to library-declared functions 15626 /// like NSLog or printf. 15627 /// 15628 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written 15629 /// attributes are applied to declarations. 15630 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FunctionDecl *FD) { 15631 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 15632 return; 15633 15634 // If this is a built-in function, map its builtin attributes to 15635 // actual attributes. 15636 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 15637 // Handle printf-formatting attributes. 15638 unsigned FormatIdx; 15639 bool HasVAListArg; 15640 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPrintfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, HasVAListArg)) { 15641 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) { 15642 const char *fmt = "printf"; 15643 unsigned int NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); 15644 if (FormatIdx < NumParams && // NumParams may be 0 (e.g. vfprintf) 15645 FD->getParamDecl(FormatIdx)->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 15646 fmt = "NSString"; 15647 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15648 &Context.Idents.get(fmt), 15649 FormatIdx+1, 15650 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 15651 FD->getLocation())); 15652 } 15653 } 15654 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isScanfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, 15655 HasVAListArg)) { 15656 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 15657 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15658 &Context.Idents.get("scanf"), 15659 FormatIdx+1, 15660 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 15661 FD->getLocation())); 15662 } 15663 15664 // Handle automatically recognized callbacks. 15665 SmallVector<int, 4> Encoding; 15666 if (!FD->hasAttr<CallbackAttr>() && 15667 Context.BuiltinInfo.performsCallback(BuiltinID, Encoding)) 15668 FD->addAttr(CallbackAttr::CreateImplicit( 15669 Context, Encoding.data(), Encoding.size(), FD->getLocation())); 15670 15671 // Mark const if we don't care about errno and that is the only thing 15672 // preventing the function from being const. This allows IRgen to use LLVM 15673 // intrinsics for such functions. 15674 if (!getLangOpts().MathErrno && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>() && 15675 Context.BuiltinInfo.isConstWithoutErrno(BuiltinID)) 15676 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15677 15678 // We make "fma" on GNU or Windows const because we know it does not set 15679 // errno in those environments even though it could set errno based on the 15680 // C standard. 15681 const llvm::Triple &Trip = Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 15682 if ((Trip.isGNUEnvironment() || Trip.isOSMSVCRT()) && 15683 !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) { 15684 switch (BuiltinID) { 15685 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fma: 15686 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmaf: 15687 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmal: 15688 case Builtin::BIfma: 15689 case Builtin::BIfmaf: 15690 case Builtin::BIfmal: 15691 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15692 break; 15693 default: 15694 break; 15695 } 15696 } 15697 15698 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isReturnsTwice(BuiltinID) && 15699 !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsTwiceAttr>()) 15700 FD->addAttr(ReturnsTwiceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15701 FD->getLocation())); 15702 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) 15703 FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15704 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPure(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<PureAttr>()) 15705 FD->addAttr(PureAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15706 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isConst(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) 15707 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15708 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.BuiltinInfo.isTSBuiltin(BuiltinID) && 15709 !FD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() && !FD->hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>()) { 15710 // Add the appropriate attribute, depending on the CUDA compilation mode 15711 // and which target the builtin belongs to. For example, during host 15712 // compilation, aux builtins are __device__, while the rest are __host__. 15713 if (getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice != 15714 Context.BuiltinInfo.isAuxBuiltinID(BuiltinID)) 15715 FD->addAttr(CUDADeviceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15716 else 15717 FD->addAttr(CUDAHostAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15718 } 15719 15720 // Add known guaranteed alignment for allocation functions. 15721 switch (BuiltinID) { 15722 case Builtin::BImemalign: 15723 case Builtin::BIaligned_alloc: 15724 if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>()) 15725 FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 15726 FD->getLocation())); 15727 break; 15728 default: 15729 break; 15730 } 15731 15732 // Add allocsize attribute for allocation functions. 15733 switch (BuiltinID) { 15734 case Builtin::BIcalloc: 15735 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit( 15736 Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), ParamIdx(2, FD), FD->getLocation())); 15737 break; 15738 case Builtin::BImemalign: 15739 case Builtin::BIaligned_alloc: 15740 case Builtin::BIrealloc: 15741 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(2, FD), 15742 ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 15743 break; 15744 case Builtin::BImalloc: 15745 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 15746 ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 15747 break; 15748 default: 15749 break; 15750 } 15751 } 15752 15753 AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(FD); 15754 15755 // If C++ exceptions are enabled but we are told extern "C" functions cannot 15756 // throw, add an implicit nothrow attribute to any extern "C" function we come 15757 // across. 15758 if (getLangOpts().CXXExceptions && getLangOpts().ExternCNoUnwind && 15759 FD->isExternC() && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) { 15760 const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 15761 if (!FPT || FPT->getExceptionSpecType() == EST_None) 15762 FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15763 } 15764 15765 IdentifierInfo *Name = FD->getIdentifier(); 15766 if (!Name) 15767 return; 15768 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 15769 FD->getDeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) || 15770 (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()) && 15771 cast<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getLanguage() == 15772 LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c)) { 15773 // Okay: this could be a libc/libm/Objective-C function we know 15774 // about. 15775 } else 15776 return; 15777 15778 if (Name->isStr("asprintf") || Name->isStr("vasprintf")) { 15779 // FIXME: asprintf and vasprintf aren't C99 functions. Should they be 15780 // target-specific builtins, perhaps? 15781 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 15782 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15783 &Context.Idents.get("printf"), 2, 15784 Name->isStr("vasprintf") ? 0 : 3, 15785 FD->getLocation())); 15786 } 15787 15788 if (Name->isStr("__CFStringMakeConstantString")) { 15789 // We already have a __builtin___CFStringMakeConstantString, 15790 // but builds that use -fno-constant-cfstrings don't go through that. 15791 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatArgAttr>()) 15792 FD->addAttr(FormatArgAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 15793 FD->getLocation())); 15794 } 15795 } 15796 15797 TypedefDecl *Sema::ParseTypedefDecl(Scope *S, Declarator &D, QualType T, 15798 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { 15799 assert(D.getIdentifier() && "Wrong callback for declspec without declarator"); 15800 assert(!T.isNull() && "GetTypeForDeclarator() returned null type"); 15801 15802 if (!TInfo) { 15803 assert(D.isInvalidType() && "no declarator info for valid type"); 15804 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 15805 } 15806 15807 // Scope manipulation handled by caller. 15808 TypedefDecl *NewTD = 15809 TypedefDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, D.getBeginLoc(), 15810 D.getIdentifierLoc(), D.getIdentifier(), TInfo); 15811 15812 // Bail out immediately if we have an invalid declaration. 15813 if (D.isInvalidType()) { 15814 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 15815 return NewTD; 15816 } 15817 15818 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 15819 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 15820 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 15821 << 2 << NewTD 15822 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 15823 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 15824 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 15825 else 15826 NewTD->setModulePrivate(); 15827 } 15828 15829 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p8: 15830 // If the typedef declaration defines an unnamed class (or 15831 // enum), the first typedef-name declared by the declaration 15832 // to be that class type (or enum type) is used to denote the 15833 // class type (or enum type) for linkage purposes only. 15834 // We need to check whether the type was declared in the declaration. 15835 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecType()) { 15836 case TST_enum: 15837 case TST_struct: 15838 case TST_interface: 15839 case TST_union: 15840 case TST_class: { 15841 TagDecl *tagFromDeclSpec = cast<TagDecl>(D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsDecl()); 15842 setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(tagFromDeclSpec, NewTD); 15843 break; 15844 } 15845 15846 default: 15847 break; 15848 } 15849 15850 return NewTD; 15851 } 15852 15853 /// Check that this is a valid underlying type for an enum declaration. 15854 bool Sema::CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TypeSourceInfo *TI) { 15855 SourceLocation UnderlyingLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 15856 QualType T = TI->getType(); 15857 15858 if (T->isDependentType()) 15859 return false; 15860 15861 // This doesn't use 'isIntegralType' despite the error message mentioning 15862 // integral type because isIntegralType would also allow enum types in C. 15863 if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 15864 if (BT->isInteger()) 15865 return false; 15866 15867 if (T->isBitIntType()) 15868 return false; 15869 15870 return Diag(UnderlyingLoc, diag::err_enum_invalid_underlying) << T; 15871 } 15872 15873 /// Check whether this is a valid redeclaration of a previous enumeration. 15874 /// \return true if the redeclaration was invalid. 15875 bool Sema::CheckEnumRedeclaration(SourceLocation EnumLoc, bool IsScoped, 15876 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy, bool IsFixed, 15877 const EnumDecl *Prev) { 15878 if (IsScoped != Prev->isScoped()) { 15879 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_scoped_mismatch) 15880 << Prev->isScoped(); 15881 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15882 return true; 15883 } 15884 15885 if (IsFixed && Prev->isFixed()) { 15886 if (!EnumUnderlyingTy->isDependentType() && 15887 !Prev->getIntegerType()->isDependentType() && 15888 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(EnumUnderlyingTy, 15889 Prev->getIntegerType())) { 15890 // TODO: Highlight the underlying type of the redeclaration. 15891 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_type_mismatch) 15892 << EnumUnderlyingTy << Prev->getIntegerType(); 15893 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration) 15894 << Prev->getIntegerTypeRange(); 15895 return true; 15896 } 15897 } else if (IsFixed != Prev->isFixed()) { 15898 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_fixed_mismatch) 15899 << Prev->isFixed(); 15900 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15901 return true; 15902 } 15903 15904 return false; 15905 } 15906 15907 /// Get diagnostic %select index for tag kind for 15908 /// redeclaration diagnostic message. 15909 /// WARNING: Indexes apply to particular diagnostics only! 15910 /// 15911 /// \returns diagnostic %select index. 15912 static unsigned getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) { 15913 switch (Tag) { 15914 case TTK_Struct: return 0; 15915 case TTK_Interface: return 1; 15916 case TTK_Class: return 2; 15917 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid tag kind for redecl diagnostic!"); 15918 } 15919 } 15920 15921 /// Determine if tag kind is a class-key compatible with 15922 /// class for redeclaration (class, struct, or __interface). 15923 /// 15924 /// \returns true iff the tag kind is compatible. 15925 static bool isClassCompatTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) 15926 { 15927 return Tag == TTK_Struct || Tag == TTK_Class || Tag == TTK_Interface; 15928 } 15929 15930 Sema::NonTagKind Sema::getNonTagTypeDeclKind(const Decl *PrevDecl, 15931 TagTypeKind TTK) { 15932 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15933 return NTK_Typedef; 15934 else if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15935 return NTK_TypeAlias; 15936 else if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15937 return NTK_Template; 15938 else if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15939 return NTK_TypeAliasTemplate; 15940 else if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15941 return NTK_TemplateTemplateArgument; 15942 switch (TTK) { 15943 case TTK_Struct: 15944 case TTK_Interface: 15945 case TTK_Class: 15946 return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? NTK_NonClass : NTK_NonStruct; 15947 case TTK_Union: 15948 return NTK_NonUnion; 15949 case TTK_Enum: 15950 return NTK_NonEnum; 15951 } 15952 llvm_unreachable("invalid TTK"); 15953 } 15954 15955 /// Determine whether a tag with a given kind is acceptable 15956 /// as a redeclaration of the given tag declaration. 15957 /// 15958 /// \returns true if the new tag kind is acceptable, false otherwise. 15959 bool Sema::isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(const TagDecl *Previous, 15960 TagTypeKind NewTag, bool isDefinition, 15961 SourceLocation NewTagLoc, 15962 const IdentifierInfo *Name) { 15963 // C++ [dcl.type.elab]p3: 15964 // The class-key or enum keyword present in the 15965 // elaborated-type-specifier shall agree in kind with the 15966 // declaration to which the name in the elaborated-type-specifier 15967 // refers. This rule also applies to the form of 15968 // elaborated-type-specifier that declares a class-name or 15969 // friend class since it can be construed as referring to the 15970 // definition of the class. Thus, in any 15971 // elaborated-type-specifier, the enum keyword shall be used to 15972 // refer to an enumeration (7.2), the union class-key shall be 15973 // used to refer to a union (clause 9), and either the class or 15974 // struct class-key shall be used to refer to a class (clause 9) 15975 // declared using the class or struct class-key. 15976 TagTypeKind OldTag = Previous->getTagKind(); 15977 if (OldTag != NewTag && 15978 !(isClassCompatTagKind(OldTag) && isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag))) 15979 return false; 15980 15981 // Tags are compatible, but we might still want to warn on mismatched tags. 15982 // Non-class tags can't be mismatched at this point. 15983 if (!isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag)) 15984 return true; 15985 15986 // Declarations for which -Wmismatched-tags is disabled are entirely ignored 15987 // by our warning analysis. We don't want to warn about mismatches with (eg) 15988 // declarations in system headers that are designed to be specialized, but if 15989 // a user asks us to warn, we should warn if their code contains mismatched 15990 // declarations. 15991 auto IsIgnoredLoc = [&](SourceLocation Loc) { 15992 return getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch, 15993 Loc); 15994 }; 15995 if (IsIgnoredLoc(NewTagLoc)) 15996 return true; 15997 15998 auto IsIgnored = [&](const TagDecl *Tag) { 15999 return IsIgnoredLoc(Tag->getLocation()); 16000 }; 16001 while (IsIgnored(Previous)) { 16002 Previous = Previous->getPreviousDecl(); 16003 if (!Previous) 16004 return true; 16005 OldTag = Previous->getTagKind(); 16006 } 16007 16008 bool isTemplate = false; 16009 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Previous)) 16010 isTemplate = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 16011 16012 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) { 16013 if (OldTag != NewTag) { 16014 // In a template instantiation, do not offer fix-its for tag mismatches 16015 // since they usually mess up the template instead of fixing the problem. 16016 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 16017 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 16018 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 16019 // FIXME: Note previous location? 16020 } 16021 return true; 16022 } 16023 16024 if (isDefinition) { 16025 // On definitions, check all previous tags and issue a fix-it for each 16026 // one that doesn't match the current tag. 16027 if (Previous->getDefinition()) { 16028 // Don't suggest fix-its for redefinitions. 16029 return true; 16030 } 16031 16032 bool previousMismatch = false; 16033 for (const TagDecl *I : Previous->redecls()) { 16034 if (I->getTagKind() != NewTag) { 16035 // Ignore previous declarations for which the warning was disabled. 16036 if (IsIgnored(I)) 16037 continue; 16038 16039 if (!previousMismatch) { 16040 previousMismatch = true; 16041 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_previous_tag_mismatch) 16042 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 16043 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(I->getTagKind()); 16044 } 16045 Diag(I->getInnerLocStart(), diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 16046 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) 16047 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(I->getInnerLocStart(), 16048 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(NewTag)); 16049 } 16050 } 16051 return true; 16052 } 16053 16054 // Identify the prevailing tag kind: this is the kind of the definition (if 16055 // there is a non-ignored definition), or otherwise the kind of the prior 16056 // (non-ignored) declaration. 16057 const TagDecl *PrevDef = Previous->getDefinition(); 16058 if (PrevDef && IsIgnored(PrevDef)) 16059 PrevDef = nullptr; 16060 const TagDecl *Redecl = PrevDef ? PrevDef : Previous; 16061 if (Redecl->getTagKind() != NewTag) { 16062 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 16063 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 16064 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 16065 Diag(Redecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 16066 16067 // If there is a previous definition, suggest a fix-it. 16068 if (PrevDef) { 16069 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 16070 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(Redecl->getTagKind()) 16071 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(NewTagLoc), 16072 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Redecl->getTagKind())); 16073 } 16074 } 16075 16076 return true; 16077 } 16078 16079 /// Add a minimal nested name specifier fixit hint to allow lookup of a tag name 16080 /// from an outer enclosing namespace or file scope inside a friend declaration. 16081 /// This should provide the commented out code in the following snippet: 16082 /// namespace N { 16083 /// struct X; 16084 /// namespace M { 16085 /// struct Y { friend struct /*N::*/ X; }; 16086 /// } 16087 /// } 16088 static FixItHint createFriendTagNNSFixIt(Sema &SemaRef, NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S, 16089 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 16090 // While the decl is in a namespace, do repeated lookup of that name and see 16091 // if we get the same namespace back. If we do not, continue until 16092 // translation unit scope, at which point we have a fully qualified NNS. 16093 SmallVector<IdentifierInfo *, 4> Namespaces; 16094 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 16095 for (; !DC->isTranslationUnit(); DC = DC->getParent()) { 16096 // This tag should be declared in a namespace, which can only be enclosed by 16097 // other namespaces. Bail if there's an anonymous namespace in the chain. 16098 NamespaceDecl *Namespace = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 16099 if (!Namespace || Namespace->isAnonymousNamespace()) 16100 return FixItHint(); 16101 IdentifierInfo *II = Namespace->getIdentifier(); 16102 Namespaces.push_back(II); 16103 NamedDecl *Lookup = SemaRef.LookupSingleName( 16104 S, II, NameLoc, Sema::LookupNestedNameSpecifierName); 16105 if (Lookup == Namespace) 16106 break; 16107 } 16108 16109 // Once we have all the namespaces, reverse them to go outermost first, and 16110 // build an NNS. 16111 SmallString<64> Insertion; 16112 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Insertion); 16113 if (DC->isTranslationUnit()) 16114 OS << "::"; 16115 std::reverse(Namespaces.begin(), Namespaces.end()); 16116 for (auto *II : Namespaces) 16117 OS << II->getName() << "::"; 16118 return FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, Insertion); 16119 } 16120 16121 /// Determine whether a tag originally declared in context \p OldDC can 16122 /// be redeclared with an unqualified name in \p NewDC (assuming name lookup 16123 /// found a declaration in \p OldDC as a previous decl, perhaps through a 16124 /// using-declaration). 16125 static bool isAcceptableTagRedeclContext(Sema &S, DeclContext *OldDC, 16126 DeclContext *NewDC) { 16127 OldDC = OldDC->getRedeclContext(); 16128 NewDC = NewDC->getRedeclContext(); 16129 16130 if (OldDC->Equals(NewDC)) 16131 return true; 16132 16133 // In MSVC mode, we allow a redeclaration if the contexts are related (either 16134 // encloses the other). 16135 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 16136 (OldDC->Encloses(NewDC) || NewDC->Encloses(OldDC))) 16137 return true; 16138 16139 return false; 16140 } 16141 16142 /// This is invoked when we see 'struct foo' or 'struct {'. In the 16143 /// former case, Name will be non-null. In the later case, Name will be null. 16144 /// TagSpec indicates what kind of tag this is. TUK indicates whether this is a 16145 /// reference/declaration/definition of a tag. 16146 /// 16147 /// \param IsTypeSpecifier \c true if this is a type-specifier (or 16148 /// trailing-type-specifier) other than one in an alias-declaration. 16149 /// 16150 /// \param SkipBody If non-null, will be set to indicate if the caller should 16151 /// skip the definition of this tag and treat it as if it were a declaration. 16152 Decl *Sema::ActOnTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK, 16153 SourceLocation KWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 16154 IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, 16155 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, AccessSpecifier AS, 16156 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc, 16157 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, 16158 bool &OwnedDecl, bool &IsDependent, 16159 SourceLocation ScopedEnumKWLoc, 16160 bool ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, TypeResult UnderlyingType, 16161 bool IsTypeSpecifier, bool IsTemplateParamOrArg, 16162 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 16163 // If this is not a definition, it must have a name. 16164 IdentifierInfo *OrigName = Name; 16165 assert((Name != nullptr || TUK == TUK_Definition) && 16166 "Nameless record must be a definition!"); 16167 assert(TemplateParameterLists.size() == 0 || TUK != TUK_Reference); 16168 16169 OwnedDecl = false; 16170 TagTypeKind Kind = TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindForTypeSpec(TagSpec); 16171 bool ScopedEnum = ScopedEnumKWLoc.isValid(); 16172 16173 // FIXME: Check member specializations more carefully. 16174 bool isMemberSpecialization = false; 16175 bool Invalid = false; 16176 16177 // We only need to do this matching if we have template parameters 16178 // or a scope specifier, which also conveniently avoids this work 16179 // for non-C++ cases. 16180 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0 || 16181 (SS.isNotEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference)) { 16182 if (TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 16183 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 16184 KWLoc, NameLoc, SS, nullptr, TemplateParameterLists, 16185 TUK == TUK_Friend, isMemberSpecialization, Invalid)) { 16186 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16187 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_enum_template); 16188 return nullptr; 16189 } 16190 16191 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 16192 // This is a declaration or definition of a class template (which may 16193 // be a member of another template). 16194 16195 if (Invalid) 16196 return nullptr; 16197 16198 OwnedDecl = false; 16199 DeclResult Result = CheckClassTemplate( 16200 S, TagSpec, TUK, KWLoc, SS, Name, NameLoc, Attrs, TemplateParams, 16201 AS, ModulePrivateLoc, 16202 /*FriendLoc*/ SourceLocation(), TemplateParameterLists.size() - 1, 16203 TemplateParameterLists.data(), SkipBody); 16204 return Result.get(); 16205 } else { 16206 // The "template<>" header is extraneous. 16207 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), diag::err_template_tag_noparams) 16208 << TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Kind) << Name; 16209 isMemberSpecialization = true; 16210 } 16211 } 16212 16213 if (!TemplateParameterLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization && 16214 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParameterLists.back())) 16215 return nullptr; 16216 } 16217 16218 // Figure out the underlying type if this a enum declaration. We need to do 16219 // this early, because it's needed to detect if this is an incompatible 16220 // redeclaration. 16221 llvm::PointerUnion<const Type*, TypeSourceInfo*> EnumUnderlying; 16222 bool IsFixed = !UnderlyingType.isUnset() || ScopedEnum; 16223 16224 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16225 if (UnderlyingType.isInvalid() || (!UnderlyingType.get() && ScopedEnum)) { 16226 // No underlying type explicitly specified, or we failed to parse the 16227 // type, default to int. 16228 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16229 } else if (UnderlyingType.get()) { 16230 // C++0x 7.2p2: The type-specifier-seq of an enum-base shall name an 16231 // integral type; any cv-qualification is ignored. 16232 TypeSourceInfo *TI = nullptr; 16233 GetTypeFromParser(UnderlyingType.get(), &TI); 16234 EnumUnderlying = TI; 16235 16236 if (CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TI)) 16237 // Recover by falling back to int. 16238 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16239 16240 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TI, 16241 UPPC_FixedUnderlyingType)) 16242 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16243 16244 } else if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) { 16245 // For MSVC ABI compatibility, unfixed enums must use an underlying type 16246 // of 'int'. However, if this is an unfixed forward declaration, don't set 16247 // the underlying type unless the user enables -fms-compatibility. This 16248 // makes unfixed forward declared enums incomplete and is more conforming. 16249 if (TUK == TUK_Definition || getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16250 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 16251 } 16252 } 16253 16254 DeclContext *SearchDC = CurContext; 16255 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 16256 bool isStdBadAlloc = false; 16257 bool isStdAlignValT = false; 16258 16259 RedeclarationKind Redecl = forRedeclarationInCurContext(); 16260 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) 16261 Redecl = NotForRedeclaration; 16262 16263 /// Create a new tag decl in C/ObjC. Since the ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C 16264 /// implemented asks for structural equivalence checking, the returned decl 16265 /// here is passed back to the parser, allowing the tag body to be parsed. 16266 auto createTagFromNewDecl = [&]() -> TagDecl * { 16267 assert(!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "not meant for C++ usage"); 16268 // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the 16269 // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union 16270 // keyword. 16271 SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc; 16272 TagDecl *New = nullptr; 16273 16274 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16275 New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, nullptr, 16276 ScopedEnum, ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed); 16277 // If this is an undefined enum, bail. 16278 if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) 16279 return nullptr; 16280 if (EnumUnderlying) { 16281 EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16282 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo *>()) 16283 ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI); 16284 else 16285 ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type *>(), 0)); 16286 QualType EnumTy = ED->getIntegerType(); 16287 ED->setPromotionType(EnumTy->isPromotableIntegerType() 16288 ? Context.getPromotedIntegerType(EnumTy) 16289 : EnumTy); 16290 } 16291 } else { // struct/union 16292 New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16293 nullptr); 16294 } 16295 16296 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) { 16297 // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked 16298 // when the ASTContext lays out the structure. 16299 // 16300 // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this 16301 // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is 16302 // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at 16303 // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because 16304 // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the 16305 // parsing of the struct). 16306 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) { 16307 AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD); 16308 AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD); 16309 } 16310 } 16311 New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 16312 return New; 16313 }; 16314 16315 LookupResult Previous(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupTagName, Redecl); 16316 if (Name && SS.isNotEmpty()) { 16317 // We have a nested-name tag ('struct foo::bar'). 16318 16319 // Check for invalid 'foo::'. 16320 if (SS.isInvalid()) { 16321 Name = nullptr; 16322 goto CreateNewDecl; 16323 } 16324 16325 // If this is a friend or a reference to a class in a dependent 16326 // context, don't try to make a decl for it. 16327 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 16328 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false); 16329 if (!DC) { 16330 IsDependent = true; 16331 return nullptr; 16332 } 16333 } else { 16334 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, true); 16335 if (!DC) { 16336 Diag(SS.getRange().getBegin(), diag::err_dependent_nested_name_spec) 16337 << SS.getRange(); 16338 return nullptr; 16339 } 16340 } 16341 16342 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 16343 return nullptr; 16344 16345 SearchDC = DC; 16346 // Look-up name inside 'foo::'. 16347 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 16348 16349 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 16350 return nullptr; 16351 16352 if (Previous.empty()) { 16353 // Name lookup did not find anything. However, if the 16354 // nested-name-specifier refers to the current instantiation, 16355 // and that current instantiation has any dependent base 16356 // classes, we might find something at instantiation time: treat 16357 // this as a dependent elaborated-type-specifier. 16358 // But this only makes any sense for reference-like lookups. 16359 if (Previous.wasNotFoundInCurrentInstantiation() && 16360 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)) { 16361 IsDependent = true; 16362 return nullptr; 16363 } 16364 16365 // A tag 'foo::bar' must already exist. 16366 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_not_tag_in_scope) 16367 << Kind << Name << DC << SS.getRange(); 16368 Name = nullptr; 16369 Invalid = true; 16370 goto CreateNewDecl; 16371 } 16372 } else if (Name) { 16373 // C++14 [class.mem]p14: 16374 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 16375 // name different from T: 16376 // -- every member of class T that is itself a type 16377 if (TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 16378 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(SearchDC, DeclarationNameInfo(Name, NameLoc))) 16379 return nullptr; 16380 16381 // If this is a named struct, check to see if there was a previous forward 16382 // declaration or definition. 16383 // FIXME: We're looking into outer scopes here, even when we 16384 // shouldn't be. Doing so can result in ambiguities that we 16385 // shouldn't be diagnosing. 16386 LookupName(Previous, S); 16387 16388 // When declaring or defining a tag, ignore ambiguities introduced 16389 // by types using'ed into this scope. 16390 if (Previous.isAmbiguous() && 16391 (TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration)) { 16392 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 16393 while (F.hasNext()) { 16394 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 16395 if (!ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 16396 SearchDC->getRedeclContext())) 16397 F.erase(); 16398 } 16399 F.done(); 16400 } 16401 16402 // C++11 [namespace.memdef]p3: 16403 // If the name in a friend declaration is neither qualified nor 16404 // a template-id and the declaration is a function or an 16405 // elaborated-type-specifier, the lookup to determine whether 16406 // the entity has been previously declared shall not consider 16407 // any scopes outside the innermost enclosing namespace. 16408 // 16409 // MSVC doesn't implement the above rule for types, so a friend tag 16410 // declaration may be a redeclaration of a type declared in an enclosing 16411 // scope. They do implement this rule for friend functions. 16412 // 16413 // Does it matter that this should be by scope instead of by 16414 // semantic context? 16415 if (!Previous.empty() && TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16416 DeclContext *EnclosingNS = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 16417 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 16418 bool FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = false; 16419 while (F.hasNext()) { 16420 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 16421 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 16422 if (DC->isFileContext() && 16423 !EnclosingNS->Encloses(ND->getDeclContext())) { 16424 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16425 FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = true; 16426 else 16427 F.erase(); 16428 } 16429 } 16430 F.done(); 16431 16432 // Diagnose this MSVC extension in the easy case where lookup would have 16433 // unambiguously found something outside the enclosing namespace. 16434 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace) { 16435 NamedDecl *ND = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 16436 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_friend_tag_redecl_outside_namespace) 16437 << createFriendTagNNSFixIt(*this, ND, S, NameLoc); 16438 } 16439 } 16440 16441 // Note: there used to be some attempt at recovery here. 16442 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 16443 return nullptr; 16444 16445 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK != TUK_Reference) { 16446 // FIXME: This makes sure that we ignore the contexts associated 16447 // with C structs, unions, and enums when looking for a matching 16448 // tag declaration or definition. See the similar lookup tweak 16449 // in Sema::LookupName; is there a better way to deal with this? 16450 while (isa<RecordDecl, EnumDecl, ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC)) 16451 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 16452 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16453 // Inside ObjCContainer want to keep it as a lexical decl context but go 16454 // past it (most often to TranslationUnit) to find the semantic decl 16455 // context. 16456 while (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC)) 16457 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 16458 } 16459 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16460 // Don't use ObjCContainerDecl as the semantic decl context for anonymous 16461 // TagDecl the same way as we skip it for named TagDecl. 16462 while (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC)) 16463 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 16464 } 16465 16466 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 16467 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 16468 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 16469 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(NameLoc, Previous.getFoundDecl()); 16470 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 16471 Previous.clear(); 16472 } 16473 16474 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Name && DC && StdNamespace && 16475 DC->Equals(getStdNamespace())) { 16476 if (Name->isStr("bad_alloc")) { 16477 // This is a declaration of or a reference to "std::bad_alloc". 16478 isStdBadAlloc = true; 16479 16480 // If std::bad_alloc has been implicitly declared (but made invisible to 16481 // name lookup), fill in this implicit declaration as the previous 16482 // declaration, so that the declarations get chained appropriately. 16483 if (Previous.empty() && StdBadAlloc) 16484 Previous.addDecl(getStdBadAlloc()); 16485 } else if (Name->isStr("align_val_t")) { 16486 isStdAlignValT = true; 16487 if (Previous.empty() && StdAlignValT) 16488 Previous.addDecl(getStdAlignValT()); 16489 } 16490 } 16491 16492 // If we didn't find a previous declaration, and this is a reference 16493 // (or friend reference), move to the correct scope. In C++, we 16494 // also need to do a redeclaration lookup there, just in case 16495 // there's a shadow friend decl. 16496 if (Name && Previous.empty() && 16497 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || IsTemplateParamOrArg)) { 16498 if (Invalid) goto CreateNewDecl; 16499 assert(SS.isEmpty()); 16500 16501 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || IsTemplateParamOrArg) { 16502 // C++ [basic.scope.pdecl]p5: 16503 // -- for an elaborated-type-specifier of the form 16504 // 16505 // class-key identifier 16506 // 16507 // if the elaborated-type-specifier is used in the 16508 // decl-specifier-seq or parameter-declaration-clause of a 16509 // function defined in namespace scope, the identifier is 16510 // declared as a class-name in the namespace that contains 16511 // the declaration; otherwise, except as a friend 16512 // declaration, the identifier is declared in the smallest 16513 // non-class, non-function-prototype scope that contains the 16514 // declaration. 16515 // 16516 // C99 6.7.2.3p8 has a similar (but not identical!) provision for 16517 // C structs and unions. 16518 // 16519 // It is an error in C++ to declare (rather than define) an enum 16520 // type, including via an elaborated type specifier. We'll 16521 // diagnose that later; for now, declare the enum in the same 16522 // scope as we would have picked for any other tag type. 16523 // 16524 // GNU C also supports this behavior as part of its incomplete 16525 // enum types extension, while GNU C++ does not. 16526 // 16527 // Find the context where we'll be declaring the tag. 16528 // FIXME: We would like to maintain the current DeclContext as the 16529 // lexical context, 16530 SearchDC = getTagInjectionContext(SearchDC); 16531 16532 // Find the scope where we'll be declaring the tag. 16533 S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts()); 16534 } else { 16535 assert(TUK == TUK_Friend); 16536 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p3: 16537 // If a friend declaration in a non-local class first declares a 16538 // class or function, the friend class or function is a member of 16539 // the innermost enclosing namespace. 16540 SearchDC = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 16541 } 16542 16543 // In C++, we need to do a redeclaration lookup to properly 16544 // diagnose some problems. 16545 // FIXME: redeclaration lookup is also used (with and without C++) to find a 16546 // hidden declaration so that we don't get ambiguity errors when using a 16547 // type declared by an elaborated-type-specifier. In C that is not correct 16548 // and we should instead merge compatible types found by lookup. 16549 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16550 // FIXME: This can perform qualified lookups into function contexts, 16551 // which are meaningless. 16552 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 16553 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, SearchDC); 16554 } else { 16555 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 16556 LookupName(Previous, S); 16557 } 16558 } 16559 16560 // If we have a known previous declaration to use, then use it. 16561 if (Previous.empty() && SkipBody && SkipBody->Previous) 16562 Previous.addDecl(SkipBody->Previous); 16563 16564 if (!Previous.empty()) { 16565 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 16566 NamedDecl *DirectPrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 16567 16568 // It's okay to have a tag decl in the same scope as a typedef 16569 // which hides a tag decl in the same scope. Finding this 16570 // with a redeclaration lookup can only actually happen in C++. 16571 // 16572 // This is also okay for elaborated-type-specifiers, which is 16573 // technically forbidden by the current standard but which is 16574 // okay according to the likely resolution of an open issue; 16575 // see http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#407 16576 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16577 if (TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16578 if (const TagType *TT = TD->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<TagType>()) { 16579 TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 16580 if (Tag->getDeclName() == Name && 16581 Tag->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() 16582 ->Equals(TD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) { 16583 PrevDecl = Tag; 16584 Previous.clear(); 16585 Previous.addDecl(Tag); 16586 Previous.resolveKind(); 16587 } 16588 } 16589 } 16590 } 16591 16592 // If this is a redeclaration of a using shadow declaration, it must 16593 // declare a tag in the same context. In MSVC mode, we allow a 16594 // redefinition if either context is within the other. 16595 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(DirectPrevDecl)) { 16596 auto *OldTag = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl); 16597 if (SS.isEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 16598 isDeclInScope(Shadow, SearchDC, S, isMemberSpecialization) && 16599 !(OldTag && isAcceptableTagRedeclContext( 16600 *this, OldTag->getDeclContext(), SearchDC))) { 16601 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 16602 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 16603 diag::note_using_decl_target); 16604 Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) 16605 << 0; 16606 // Recover by ignoring the old declaration. 16607 Previous.clear(); 16608 goto CreateNewDecl; 16609 } 16610 } 16611 16612 if (TagDecl *PrevTagDecl = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16613 // If this is a use of a previous tag, or if the tag is already declared 16614 // in the same scope (so that the definition/declaration completes or 16615 // rementions the tag), reuse the decl. 16616 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || 16617 isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 16618 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) { 16619 // Make sure that this wasn't declared as an enum and now used as a 16620 // struct or something similar. 16621 if (!isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(PrevTagDecl, Kind, 16622 TUK == TUK_Definition, KWLoc, 16623 Name)) { 16624 bool SafeToContinue 16625 = (PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() != TTK_Enum && 16626 Kind != TTK_Enum); 16627 if (SafeToContinue) 16628 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) 16629 << Name 16630 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(KWLoc), 16631 PrevTagDecl->getKindName()); 16632 else 16633 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) << Name; 16634 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 16635 16636 if (SafeToContinue) 16637 Kind = PrevTagDecl->getTagKind(); 16638 else { 16639 // Recover by making this an anonymous redefinition. 16640 Name = nullptr; 16641 Previous.clear(); 16642 Invalid = true; 16643 } 16644 } 16645 16646 if (Kind == TTK_Enum && PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() == TTK_Enum) { 16647 const EnumDecl *PrevEnum = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevTagDecl); 16648 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) 16649 return PrevTagDecl; 16650 16651 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy; 16652 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 16653 EnumUnderlyingTy = TI->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 16654 else if (const Type *T = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<const Type*>()) 16655 EnumUnderlyingTy = QualType(T, 0); 16656 16657 // All conflicts with previous declarations are recovered by 16658 // returning the previous declaration, unless this is a definition, 16659 // in which case we want the caller to bail out. 16660 if (CheckEnumRedeclaration(NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc, 16661 ScopedEnum, EnumUnderlyingTy, 16662 IsFixed, PrevEnum)) 16663 return TUK == TUK_Declaration ? PrevTagDecl : nullptr; 16664 } 16665 16666 // C++11 [class.mem]p1: 16667 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification, 16668 // except that a nested class or member class template can be declared 16669 // and then later defined. 16670 if (TUK == TUK_Declaration && PrevDecl->isCXXClassMember() && 16671 S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 16672 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_member_redeclared); 16673 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 16674 } 16675 16676 if (!Invalid) { 16677 // If this is a use, just return the declaration we found, unless 16678 // we have attributes. 16679 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16680 if (!Attrs.empty()) { 16681 // FIXME: Diagnose these attributes. For now, we create a new 16682 // declaration to hold them. 16683 } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference && 16684 (PrevTagDecl->getFriendObjectKind() == 16685 Decl::FOK_Undeclared || 16686 PrevDecl->getOwningModule() != getCurrentModule()) && 16687 SS.isEmpty()) { 16688 // This declaration is a reference to an existing entity, but 16689 // has different visibility from that entity: it either makes 16690 // a friend visible or it makes a type visible in a new module. 16691 // In either case, create a new declaration. We only do this if 16692 // the declaration would have meant the same thing if no prior 16693 // declaration were found, that is, if it was found in the same 16694 // scope where we would have injected a declaration. 16695 if (!getTagInjectionContext(CurContext)->getRedeclContext() 16696 ->Equals(PrevDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) 16697 return PrevTagDecl; 16698 // This is in the injected scope, create a new declaration in 16699 // that scope. 16700 S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts()); 16701 } else { 16702 return PrevTagDecl; 16703 } 16704 } 16705 16706 // Diagnose attempts to redefine a tag. 16707 if (TUK == TUK_Definition) { 16708 if (NamedDecl *Def = PrevTagDecl->getDefinition()) { 16709 // If we're defining a specialization and the previous definition 16710 // is from an implicit instantiation, don't emit an error 16711 // here; we'll catch this in the general case below. 16712 bool IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = false; 16713 if (isMemberSpecialization) { 16714 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Def)) 16715 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 16716 RD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 16717 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 16718 else if (EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Def)) 16719 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 16720 ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 16721 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 16722 } 16723 16724 // Note that clang allows ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C, i.e., do 16725 // not keep more that one definition around (merge them). However, 16726 // ensure the decl passes the structural compatibility check in 16727 // C11 6.2.7/1 (or 6.1.2.6/1 in C89). 16728 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 16729 if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Def, &Hidden)) { 16730 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. We 16731 // explicitly make use of C++'s one definition rule here, and 16732 // assume that this definition is identical to the hidden one 16733 // we already have. Make the existing definition visible and 16734 // use it in place of this one. 16735 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16736 // Postpone making the old definition visible until after we 16737 // complete parsing the new one and do the structural 16738 // comparison. 16739 SkipBody->CheckSameAsPrevious = true; 16740 SkipBody->New = createTagFromNewDecl(); 16741 SkipBody->Previous = Def; 16742 return Def; 16743 } else { 16744 SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true; 16745 SkipBody->Previous = Def; 16746 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden); 16747 // Carry on and handle it like a normal definition. We'll 16748 // skip starting the definitiion later. 16749 } 16750 } else if (!IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation) { 16751 // A redeclaration in function prototype scope in C isn't 16752 // visible elsewhere, so merely issue a warning. 16753 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && S->containedInPrototypeScope()) 16754 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_redefinition_in_param_list) << Name; 16755 else 16756 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Name; 16757 notePreviousDefinition(Def, 16758 NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc); 16759 // If this is a redefinition, recover by making this 16760 // struct be anonymous, which will make any later 16761 // references get the previous definition. 16762 Name = nullptr; 16763 Previous.clear(); 16764 Invalid = true; 16765 } 16766 } else { 16767 // If the type is currently being defined, complain 16768 // about a nested redefinition. 16769 auto *TD = Context.getTagDeclType(PrevTagDecl)->getAsTagDecl(); 16770 if (TD->isBeingDefined()) { 16771 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_nested_redefinition) << Name; 16772 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), 16773 diag::note_previous_definition); 16774 Name = nullptr; 16775 Previous.clear(); 16776 Invalid = true; 16777 } 16778 } 16779 16780 // Okay, this is definition of a previously declared or referenced 16781 // tag. We're going to create a new Decl for it. 16782 } 16783 16784 // Okay, we're going to make a redeclaration. If this is some kind 16785 // of reference, make sure we build the redeclaration in the same DC 16786 // as the original, and ignore the current access specifier. 16787 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 16788 SearchDC = PrevTagDecl->getDeclContext(); 16789 AS = AS_none; 16790 } 16791 } 16792 // If we get here we have (another) forward declaration or we 16793 // have a definition. Just create a new decl. 16794 16795 } else { 16796 // If we get here, this is a definition of a new tag type in a nested 16797 // scope, e.g. "struct foo; void bar() { struct foo; }", just create a 16798 // new decl/type. We set PrevDecl to NULL so that the entities 16799 // have distinct types. 16800 Previous.clear(); 16801 } 16802 // If we get here, we're going to create a new Decl. If PrevDecl 16803 // is non-NULL, it's a definition of the tag declared by 16804 // PrevDecl. If it's NULL, we have a new definition. 16805 16806 // Otherwise, PrevDecl is not a tag, but was found with tag 16807 // lookup. This is only actually possible in C++, where a few 16808 // things like templates still live in the tag namespace. 16809 } else { 16810 // Use a better diagnostic if an elaborated-type-specifier 16811 // found the wrong kind of type on the first 16812 // (non-redeclaration) lookup. 16813 if ((TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) && 16814 !Previous.isForRedeclaration()) { 16815 NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind); 16816 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_non_tag) << PrevDecl << NTK 16817 << Kind; 16818 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 16819 Invalid = true; 16820 16821 // Otherwise, only diagnose if the declaration is in scope. 16822 } else if (!isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 16823 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) { 16824 // do nothing 16825 16826 // Diagnose implicit declarations introduced by elaborated types. 16827 } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16828 NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind); 16829 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_conflict) << NTK; 16830 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 16831 Invalid = true; 16832 16833 // Otherwise it's a declaration. Call out a particularly common 16834 // case here. 16835 } else if (TypedefNameDecl *TND = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16836 unsigned Kind = 0; 16837 if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 1; 16838 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_definition_of_typedef) 16839 << Name << Kind << TND->getUnderlyingType(); 16840 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 16841 Invalid = true; 16842 16843 // Otherwise, diagnose. 16844 } else { 16845 // The tag name clashes with something else in the target scope, 16846 // issue an error and recover by making this tag be anonymous. 16847 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) << Name; 16848 notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, NameLoc); 16849 Name = nullptr; 16850 Invalid = true; 16851 } 16852 16853 // The existing declaration isn't relevant to us; we're in a 16854 // new scope, so clear out the previous declaration. 16855 Previous.clear(); 16856 } 16857 } 16858 16859 CreateNewDecl: 16860 16861 TagDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 16862 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) 16863 PrevDecl = cast<TagDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 16864 16865 // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the 16866 // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union 16867 // keyword. 16868 SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc; 16869 16870 // Otherwise, create a new declaration. If there is a previous 16871 // declaration of the same entity, the two will be linked via 16872 // PrevDecl. 16873 TagDecl *New; 16874 16875 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16876 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 16877 // enum X { A, B, C } D; D should chain to X. 16878 New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16879 cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl), ScopedEnum, 16880 ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed); 16881 16882 if (isStdAlignValT && (!StdAlignValT || getStdAlignValT()->isImplicit())) 16883 StdAlignValT = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16884 16885 // If this is an undefined enum, warn. 16886 if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) { 16887 TagDecl *Def; 16888 if (IsFixed && cast<EnumDecl>(New)->isFixed()) { 16889 // C++0x: 7.2p2: opaque-enum-declaration. 16890 // Conflicts are diagnosed above. Do nothing. 16891 } 16892 else if (PrevDecl && (Def = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl)->getDefinition())) { 16893 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_forward_ref_enum_def) 16894 << New; 16895 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 16896 } else { 16897 unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_forward_ref_enum; 16898 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16899 DiagID = diag::ext_ms_forward_ref_enum; 16900 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 16901 DiagID = diag::err_forward_ref_enum; 16902 Diag(Loc, DiagID); 16903 } 16904 } 16905 16906 if (EnumUnderlying) { 16907 EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16908 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 16909 ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI); 16910 else 16911 ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type *>(), 0)); 16912 QualType EnumTy = ED->getIntegerType(); 16913 ED->setPromotionType(EnumTy->isPromotableIntegerType() 16914 ? Context.getPromotedIntegerType(EnumTy) 16915 : EnumTy); 16916 assert(ED->isComplete() && "enum with type should be complete"); 16917 } 16918 } else { 16919 // struct/union/class 16920 16921 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 16922 // struct X { int A; } D; D should chain to X. 16923 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16924 // FIXME: Look for a way to use RecordDecl for simple structs. 16925 New = CXXRecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16926 cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 16927 16928 if (isStdBadAlloc && (!StdBadAlloc || getStdBadAlloc()->isImplicit())) 16929 StdBadAlloc = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New); 16930 } else 16931 New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16932 cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 16933 } 16934 16935 // C++11 [dcl.type]p3: 16936 // A type-specifier-seq shall not define a class or enumeration [...]. 16937 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && (IsTypeSpecifier || IsTemplateParamOrArg) && 16938 TUK == TUK_Definition) { 16939 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_type_specifier) 16940 << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16941 Invalid = true; 16942 } 16943 16944 if (!Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK == TUK_Definition && 16945 DC->getDeclKind() == Decl::Enum) { 16946 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_enum) 16947 << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16948 Invalid = true; 16949 } 16950 16951 // Maybe add qualifier info. 16952 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) { 16953 if (SS.isSet()) { 16954 // If this is either a declaration or a definition, check the 16955 // nested-name-specifier against the current context. 16956 if ((TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration) && 16957 diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(SS, DC, OrigName, Loc, 16958 isMemberSpecialization)) 16959 Invalid = true; 16960 16961 New->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 16962 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0) { 16963 New->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParameterLists); 16964 } 16965 } 16966 else 16967 Invalid = true; 16968 } 16969 16970 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) { 16971 // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked when 16972 // the ASTContext lays out the structure. 16973 // 16974 // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this 16975 // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is 16976 // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at 16977 // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because 16978 // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the 16979 // parsing of the struct). 16980 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) { 16981 AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD); 16982 AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD); 16983 } 16984 } 16985 16986 if (ModulePrivateLoc.isValid()) { 16987 if (isMemberSpecialization) 16988 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 16989 << 2 16990 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 16991 // __module_private__ does not apply to local classes. However, we only 16992 // diagnose this as an error when the declaration specifiers are 16993 // freestanding. Here, we just ignore the __module_private__. 16994 else if (!SearchDC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 16995 New->setModulePrivate(); 16996 } 16997 16998 // If this is a specialization of a member class (of a class template), 16999 // check the specialization. 17000 if (isMemberSpecialization && CheckMemberSpecialization(New, Previous)) 17001 Invalid = true; 17002 17003 // If we're declaring or defining a tag in function prototype scope in C, 17004 // note that this type can only be used within the function and add it to 17005 // the list of decls to inject into the function definition scope. 17006 if ((Name || Kind == TTK_Enum) && 17007 getNonFieldDeclScope(S)->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) { 17008 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17009 // C++ [dcl.fct]p6: 17010 // Types shall not be defined in return or parameter types. 17011 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && !IsTypeSpecifier) { 17012 Diag(Loc, diag::err_type_defined_in_param_type) 17013 << Name; 17014 Invalid = true; 17015 } 17016 } else if (!PrevDecl) { 17017 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_decl_in_param_list) << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 17018 } 17019 } 17020 17021 if (Invalid) 17022 New->setInvalidDecl(); 17023 17024 // Set the lexical context. If the tag has a C++ scope specifier, the 17025 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 17026 New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 17027 17028 // Mark this as a friend decl if applicable. 17029 // In Microsoft mode, a friend declaration also acts as a forward 17030 // declaration so we always pass true to setObjectOfFriendDecl to make 17031 // the tag name visible. 17032 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) 17033 New->setObjectOfFriendDecl(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat); 17034 17035 // Set the access specifier. 17036 if (!Invalid && SearchDC->isRecord()) 17037 SetMemberAccessSpecifier(New, PrevDecl, AS); 17038 17039 if (PrevDecl) 17040 CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, PrevDecl); 17041 17042 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) 17043 New->startDefinition(); 17044 17045 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs); 17046 AddPragmaAttributes(S, New); 17047 17048 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 17049 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) { 17050 // We might be replacing an existing declaration in the lookup tables; 17051 // if so, borrow its access specifier. 17052 if (PrevDecl) 17053 New->setAccess(PrevDecl->getAccess()); 17054 17055 DeclContext *DC = New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 17056 DC->makeDeclVisibleInContext(New); 17057 if (Name) // can be null along some error paths 17058 if (Scope *EnclosingScope = getScopeForDeclContext(S, DC)) 17059 PushOnScopeChains(New, EnclosingScope, /* AddToContext = */ false); 17060 } else if (Name) { 17061 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 17062 PushOnScopeChains(New, S, true); 17063 } else { 17064 CurContext->addDecl(New); 17065 } 17066 17067 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 17068 if (IdentifierInfo *II = New->getIdentifier()) 17069 if (!New->isInvalidDecl() && 17070 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 17071 II->isStr("FILE")) 17072 Context.setFILEDecl(New); 17073 17074 if (PrevDecl) 17075 mergeDeclAttributes(New, PrevDecl); 17076 17077 if (auto *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New)) 17078 inferGslOwnerPointerAttribute(CXXRD); 17079 17080 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 17081 // record. 17082 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(New); 17083 17084 if (isMemberSpecialization && !New->isInvalidDecl()) 17085 CompleteMemberSpecialization(New, Previous); 17086 17087 OwnedDecl = true; 17088 // In C++, don't return an invalid declaration. We can't recover well from 17089 // the cases where we make the type anonymous. 17090 if (Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17091 if (New->isBeingDefined()) 17092 if (auto RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) 17093 RD->completeDefinition(); 17094 return nullptr; 17095 } else if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) { 17096 return SkipBody->Previous; 17097 } else { 17098 return New; 17099 } 17100 } 17101 17102 void Sema::ActOnTagStartDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 17103 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 17104 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 17105 17106 // Enter the tag context. 17107 PushDeclContext(S, Tag); 17108 17109 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 17110 17111 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 17112 // record. 17113 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(Tag); 17114 } 17115 17116 bool Sema::ActOnDuplicateDefinition(Decl *Prev, SkipBodyInfo &SkipBody) { 17117 if (!hasStructuralCompatLayout(Prev, SkipBody.New)) 17118 return false; 17119 17120 // Make the previous decl visible. 17121 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(SkipBody.Previous); 17122 return true; 17123 } 17124 17125 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(ObjCContainerDecl *IDecl) { 17126 assert(IDecl->getLexicalParent() == CurContext && 17127 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 17128 CurContext = IDecl; 17129 } 17130 17131 void Sema::ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 17132 SourceLocation FinalLoc, 17133 bool IsFinalSpelledSealed, 17134 bool IsAbstract, 17135 SourceLocation LBraceLoc) { 17136 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 17137 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagD); 17138 17139 FieldCollector->StartClass(); 17140 17141 if (!Record->getIdentifier()) 17142 return; 17143 17144 if (IsAbstract) 17145 Record->markAbstract(); 17146 17147 if (FinalLoc.isValid()) { 17148 Record->addAttr(FinalAttr::Create( 17149 Context, FinalLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, 17150 static_cast<FinalAttr::Spelling>(IsFinalSpelledSealed))); 17151 } 17152 // C++ [class]p2: 17153 // [...] The class-name is also inserted into the scope of the 17154 // class itself; this is known as the injected-class-name. For 17155 // purposes of access checking, the injected-class-name is treated 17156 // as if it were a public member name. 17157 CXXRecordDecl *InjectedClassName = CXXRecordDecl::Create( 17158 Context, Record->getTagKind(), CurContext, Record->getBeginLoc(), 17159 Record->getLocation(), Record->getIdentifier(), 17160 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr, 17161 /*DelayTypeCreation=*/true); 17162 Context.getTypeDeclType(InjectedClassName, Record); 17163 InjectedClassName->setImplicit(); 17164 InjectedClassName->setAccess(AS_public); 17165 if (ClassTemplateDecl *Template = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 17166 InjectedClassName->setDescribedClassTemplate(Template); 17167 PushOnScopeChains(InjectedClassName, S); 17168 assert(InjectedClassName->isInjectedClassName() && 17169 "Broken injected-class-name"); 17170 } 17171 17172 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 17173 SourceRange BraceRange) { 17174 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 17175 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 17176 Tag->setBraceRange(BraceRange); 17177 17178 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 17179 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 17180 assert(Tag->isInvalidDecl() && "We should already have completed it"); 17181 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 17182 RD->completeDefinition(); 17183 } 17184 17185 if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 17186 FieldCollector->FinishClass(); 17187 if (RD->hasAttr<SYCLSpecialClassAttr>()) { 17188 auto *Def = RD->getDefinition(); 17189 assert(Def && "The record is expected to have a completed definition"); 17190 unsigned NumInitMethods = 0; 17191 for (auto *Method : Def->methods()) { 17192 if (!Method->getIdentifier()) 17193 continue; 17194 if (Method->getName() == "__init") 17195 NumInitMethods++; 17196 } 17197 if (NumInitMethods > 1 || !Def->hasInitMethod()) 17198 Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::err_sycl_special_type_num_init_method); 17199 } 17200 } 17201 17202 // Exit this scope of this tag's definition. 17203 PopDeclContext(); 17204 17205 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 17206 Tag->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 17207 Tag->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 17208 17209 // Notify the consumer that we've defined a tag. 17210 if (!Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 17211 Consumer.HandleTagDeclDefinition(Tag); 17212 17213 // Clangs implementation of #pragma align(packed) differs in bitfield layout 17214 // from XLs and instead matches the XL #pragma pack(1) behavior. 17215 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSAIX() && 17216 AlignPackStack.hasValue()) { 17217 AlignPackInfo APInfo = AlignPackStack.CurrentValue; 17218 // Only diagnose #pragma align(packed). 17219 if (!APInfo.IsAlignAttr() || APInfo.getAlignMode() != AlignPackInfo::Packed) 17220 return; 17221 const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag); 17222 if (!RD) 17223 return; 17224 // Only warn if there is at least 1 bitfield member. 17225 if (llvm::any_of(RD->fields(), 17226 [](const FieldDecl *FD) { return FD->isBitField(); })) 17227 Diag(BraceRange.getBegin(), diag::warn_pragma_align_not_xl_compatible); 17228 } 17229 } 17230 17231 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition() { 17232 // Exit this scope of this interface definition. 17233 PopDeclContext(); 17234 } 17235 17236 void Sema::ActOnObjCTemporaryExitContainerContext(ObjCContainerDecl *ObjCCtx) { 17237 assert(ObjCCtx == CurContext && "Mismatch of container contexts"); 17238 OriginalLexicalContext = ObjCCtx; 17239 ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition(); 17240 } 17241 17242 void Sema::ActOnObjCReenterContainerContext(ObjCContainerDecl *ObjCCtx) { 17243 ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(ObjCCtx); 17244 OriginalLexicalContext = nullptr; 17245 } 17246 17247 void Sema::ActOnTagDefinitionError(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 17248 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 17249 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 17250 Tag->setInvalidDecl(); 17251 17252 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 17253 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 17254 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 17255 RD->completeDefinition(); 17256 } 17257 17258 // We're undoing ActOnTagStartDefinition here, not 17259 // ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations, so we don't have to mess with 17260 // the FieldCollector. 17261 17262 PopDeclContext(); 17263 } 17264 17265 // Note that FieldName may be null for anonymous bitfields. 17266 ExprResult Sema::VerifyBitField(SourceLocation FieldLoc, 17267 IdentifierInfo *FieldName, QualType FieldTy, 17268 bool IsMsStruct, Expr *BitWidth) { 17269 assert(BitWidth); 17270 if (BitWidth->containsErrors()) 17271 return ExprError(); 17272 17273 // C99 6.7.2.1p4 - verify the field type. 17274 // C++ 9.6p3: A bit-field shall have integral or enumeration type. 17275 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType() && !FieldTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 17276 // Handle incomplete and sizeless types with a specific error. 17277 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(FieldLoc, FieldTy, 17278 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) 17279 return ExprError(); 17280 if (FieldName) 17281 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_bitfield) 17282 << FieldName << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 17283 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_anon_bitfield) 17284 << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 17285 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(const_cast<Expr *>(BitWidth), 17286 UPPC_BitFieldWidth)) 17287 return ExprError(); 17288 17289 // If the bit-width is type- or value-dependent, don't try to check 17290 // it now. 17291 if (BitWidth->isValueDependent() || BitWidth->isTypeDependent()) 17292 return BitWidth; 17293 17294 llvm::APSInt Value; 17295 ExprResult ICE = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(BitWidth, &Value, AllowFold); 17296 if (ICE.isInvalid()) 17297 return ICE; 17298 BitWidth = ICE.get(); 17299 17300 // Zero-width bitfield is ok for anonymous field. 17301 if (Value == 0 && FieldName) 17302 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_zero_width) << FieldName; 17303 17304 if (Value.isSigned() && Value.isNegative()) { 17305 if (FieldName) 17306 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_negative_width) 17307 << FieldName << toString(Value, 10); 17308 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_has_negative_width) 17309 << toString(Value, 10); 17310 } 17311 17312 // The size of the bit-field must not exceed our maximum permitted object 17313 // size. 17314 if (Value.getActiveBits() > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) { 17315 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_too_wide) 17316 << !FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10); 17317 } 17318 17319 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType()) { 17320 uint64_t TypeStorageSize = Context.getTypeSize(FieldTy); 17321 uint64_t TypeWidth = Context.getIntWidth(FieldTy); 17322 bool BitfieldIsOverwide = Value.ugt(TypeWidth); 17323 17324 // Over-wide bitfields are an error in C or when using the MSVC bitfield 17325 // ABI. 17326 bool CStdConstraintViolation = 17327 BitfieldIsOverwide && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 17328 bool MSBitfieldViolation = 17329 Value.ugt(TypeStorageSize) && 17330 (IsMsStruct || Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()); 17331 if (CStdConstraintViolation || MSBitfieldViolation) { 17332 unsigned DiagWidth = 17333 CStdConstraintViolation ? TypeWidth : TypeStorageSize; 17334 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 17335 << (bool)FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10) 17336 << !CStdConstraintViolation << DiagWidth; 17337 } 17338 17339 // Warn on types where the user might conceivably expect to get all 17340 // specified bits as value bits: that's all integral types other than 17341 // 'bool'. 17342 if (BitfieldIsOverwide && !FieldTy->isBooleanType() && FieldName) { 17343 Diag(FieldLoc, diag::warn_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 17344 << FieldName << toString(Value, 10) 17345 << (unsigned)TypeWidth; 17346 } 17347 } 17348 17349 return BitWidth; 17350 } 17351 17352 /// ActOnField - Each field of a C struct/union is passed into this in order 17353 /// to create a FieldDecl object for it. 17354 Decl *Sema::ActOnField(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart, 17355 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth) { 17356 FieldDecl *Res = HandleField(S, cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(TagD), 17357 DeclStart, D, static_cast<Expr*>(BitfieldWidth), 17358 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit, AS_public); 17359 return Res; 17360 } 17361 17362 /// HandleField - Analyze a field of a C struct or a C++ data member. 17363 /// 17364 FieldDecl *Sema::HandleField(Scope *S, RecordDecl *Record, 17365 SourceLocation DeclStart, 17366 Declarator &D, Expr *BitWidth, 17367 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 17368 AccessSpecifier AS) { 17369 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 17370 const DecompositionDeclarator &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator(); 17371 Diag(Decomp.getLSquareLoc(), diag::err_decomp_decl_context) 17372 << Decomp.getSourceRange(); 17373 return nullptr; 17374 } 17375 17376 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 17377 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 17378 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 17379 17380 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 17381 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 17382 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17383 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 17384 17385 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 17386 UPPC_DataMemberType)) { 17387 D.setInvalidType(); 17388 T = Context.IntTy; 17389 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc); 17390 } 17391 } 17392 17393 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 17394 17395 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) 17396 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 17397 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 17398 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 17399 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 17400 diag::err_invalid_thread) 17401 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 17402 17403 // Check to see if this name was declared as a member previously 17404 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 17405 LookupResult Previous(*this, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, 17406 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 17407 LookupName(Previous, S); 17408 switch (Previous.getResultKind()) { 17409 case LookupResult::Found: 17410 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 17411 PrevDecl = Previous.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>(); 17412 break; 17413 17414 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 17415 PrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 17416 break; 17417 17418 case LookupResult::NotFound: 17419 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 17420 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 17421 break; 17422 } 17423 Previous.suppressDiagnostics(); 17424 17425 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 17426 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 17427 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 17428 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 17429 PrevDecl = nullptr; 17430 } 17431 17432 if (PrevDecl && !isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Record, S)) 17433 PrevDecl = nullptr; 17434 17435 bool Mutable 17436 = (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable); 17437 SourceLocation TSSL = D.getBeginLoc(); 17438 FieldDecl *NewFD 17439 = CheckFieldDecl(II, T, TInfo, Record, Loc, Mutable, BitWidth, InitStyle, 17440 TSSL, AS, PrevDecl, &D); 17441 17442 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 17443 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17444 17445 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 17446 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 17447 17448 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && PrevDecl) { 17449 // Don't introduce NewFD into scope; there's already something 17450 // with the same name in the same scope. 17451 } else if (II) { 17452 PushOnScopeChains(NewFD, S); 17453 } else 17454 Record->addDecl(NewFD); 17455 17456 return NewFD; 17457 } 17458 17459 /// Build a new FieldDecl and check its well-formedness. 17460 /// 17461 /// This routine builds a new FieldDecl given the fields name, type, 17462 /// record, etc. \p PrevDecl should refer to any previous declaration 17463 /// with the same name and in the same scope as the field to be 17464 /// created. 17465 /// 17466 /// \returns a new FieldDecl. 17467 /// 17468 /// \todo The Declarator argument is a hack. It will be removed once 17469 FieldDecl *Sema::CheckFieldDecl(DeclarationName Name, QualType T, 17470 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 17471 RecordDecl *Record, SourceLocation Loc, 17472 bool Mutable, Expr *BitWidth, 17473 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 17474 SourceLocation TSSL, 17475 AccessSpecifier AS, NamedDecl *PrevDecl, 17476 Declarator *D) { 17477 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 17478 bool InvalidDecl = false; 17479 if (D) InvalidDecl = D->isInvalidType(); 17480 17481 // If we receive a broken type, recover by assuming 'int' and 17482 // marking this declaration as invalid. 17483 if (T.isNull() || T->containsErrors()) { 17484 InvalidDecl = true; 17485 T = Context.IntTy; 17486 } 17487 17488 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(T); 17489 if (!EltTy->isDependentType() && !EltTy->containsErrors()) { 17490 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Loc, EltTy, 17491 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) { 17492 // Fields of incomplete type force their record to be invalid. 17493 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17494 InvalidDecl = true; 17495 } else { 17496 NamedDecl *Def; 17497 EltTy->isIncompleteType(&Def); 17498 if (Def && Def->isInvalidDecl()) { 17499 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17500 InvalidDecl = true; 17501 } 17502 } 17503 } 17504 17505 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address space 17506 if (T.hasAddressSpace() || T->isDependentAddressSpaceType() || 17507 T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe()->isDependentAddressSpaceType()) { 17508 Diag(Loc, diag::err_field_with_address_space); 17509 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17510 InvalidDecl = true; 17511 } 17512 17513 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) { 17514 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9b,r & OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The following types cannot be 17515 // used as structure or union field: image, sampler, event or block types. 17516 if (T->isEventT() || T->isImageType() || T->isSamplerT() || 17517 T->isBlockPointerType()) { 17518 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_type_struct_or_union_field) << T; 17519 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17520 InvalidDecl = true; 17521 } 17522 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.c: bitfields are not supported, unless Clang extension 17523 // is enabled. 17524 if (BitWidth && !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 17525 "__cl_clang_bitfields", LangOpts)) { 17526 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_bitfields); 17527 InvalidDecl = true; 17528 } 17529 } 17530 17531 // Anonymous bit-fields cannot be cv-qualified (CWG 2229). 17532 if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !II && BitWidth && 17533 T.hasQualifiers()) { 17534 InvalidDecl = true; 17535 Diag(Loc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_qualifiers); 17536 } 17537 17538 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 17539 // than a variably modified type. 17540 if (!InvalidDecl && T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 17541 if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType( 17542 TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_field_variable_size)) 17543 InvalidDecl = true; 17544 } 17545 17546 // Fields can not have abstract class types 17547 if (!InvalidDecl && RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, T, 17548 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 17549 AbstractFieldType)) 17550 InvalidDecl = true; 17551 17552 if (InvalidDecl) 17553 BitWidth = nullptr; 17554 // If this is declared as a bit-field, check the bit-field. 17555 if (BitWidth) { 17556 BitWidth = 17557 VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, Record->isMsStruct(Context), BitWidth).get(); 17558 if (!BitWidth) { 17559 InvalidDecl = true; 17560 BitWidth = nullptr; 17561 } 17562 } 17563 17564 // Check that 'mutable' is consistent with the type of the declaration. 17565 if (!InvalidDecl && Mutable) { 17566 unsigned DiagID = 0; 17567 if (T->isReferenceType()) 17568 DiagID = getLangOpts().MSVCCompat ? diag::ext_mutable_reference 17569 : diag::err_mutable_reference; 17570 else if (T.isConstQualified()) 17571 DiagID = diag::err_mutable_const; 17572 17573 if (DiagID) { 17574 SourceLocation ErrLoc = Loc; 17575 if (D && D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc().isValid()) 17576 ErrLoc = D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(); 17577 Diag(ErrLoc, DiagID); 17578 if (DiagID != diag::ext_mutable_reference) { 17579 Mutable = false; 17580 InvalidDecl = true; 17581 } 17582 } 17583 } 17584 17585 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 17586 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 17587 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 17588 if (InitStyle != ICIS_NoInit) 17589 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), Loc); 17590 17591 FieldDecl *NewFD = FieldDecl::Create(Context, Record, TSSL, Loc, II, T, TInfo, 17592 BitWidth, Mutable, InitStyle); 17593 if (InvalidDecl) 17594 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17595 17596 if (PrevDecl && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 17597 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 17598 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 17599 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17600 } 17601 17602 if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17603 if (Record->isUnion()) { 17604 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17605 CXXRecordDecl* RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 17606 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 17607 // C++ [class.union]p1: An object of a class with a non-trivial 17608 // constructor, a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial 17609 // destructor, or a non-trivial copy assignment operator 17610 // cannot be a member of a union, nor can an array of such 17611 // objects. 17612 if (CheckNontrivialField(NewFD)) 17613 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17614 } 17615 } 17616 17617 // C++ [class.union]p1: If a union contains a member of reference type, 17618 // the program is ill-formed, except when compiling with MSVC extensions 17619 // enabled. 17620 if (EltTy->isReferenceType()) { 17621 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt ? 17622 diag::ext_union_member_of_reference_type : 17623 diag::err_union_member_of_reference_type) 17624 << NewFD->getDeclName() << EltTy; 17625 if (!getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 17626 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17627 } 17628 } 17629 } 17630 17631 // FIXME: We need to pass in the attributes given an AST 17632 // representation, not a parser representation. 17633 if (D) { 17634 // FIXME: The current scope is almost... but not entirely... correct here. 17635 ProcessDeclAttributes(getCurScope(), NewFD, *D); 17636 17637 if (NewFD->hasAttrs()) 17638 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewFD); 17639 } 17640 17641 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for fields of 17642 // retainable type. 17643 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewFD)) 17644 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17645 17646 if (T.isObjCGCWeak()) 17647 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_field); 17648 17649 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as field types. 17650 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 17651 CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewFD->getLocation())) 17652 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17653 17654 NewFD->setAccess(AS); 17655 return NewFD; 17656 } 17657 17658 bool Sema::CheckNontrivialField(FieldDecl *FD) { 17659 assert(FD); 17660 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "valid check only for C++"); 17661 17662 if (FD->isInvalidDecl() || FD->getType()->isDependentType()) 17663 return false; 17664 17665 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17666 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17667 CXXRecordDecl *RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 17668 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 17669 // We check for copy constructors before constructors 17670 // because otherwise we'll never get complaints about 17671 // copy constructors. 17672 17673 CXXSpecialMember member = CXXInvalid; 17674 // We're required to check for any non-trivial constructors. Since the 17675 // implicit default constructor is suppressed if there are any 17676 // user-declared constructors, we just need to check that there is a 17677 // trivial default constructor and a trivial copy constructor. (We don't 17678 // worry about move constructors here, since this is a C++98 check.) 17679 if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor()) 17680 member = CXXCopyConstructor; 17681 else if (!RDecl->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) 17682 member = CXXDefaultConstructor; 17683 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyAssignment()) 17684 member = CXXCopyAssignment; 17685 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) 17686 member = CXXDestructor; 17687 17688 if (member != CXXInvalid) { 17689 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 17690 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && RDecl->hasObjectMember()) { 17691 // Objective-C++ ARC: it is an error to have a non-trivial field of 17692 // a union. However, system headers in Objective-C programs 17693 // occasionally have Objective-C lifetime objects within unions, 17694 // and rather than cause the program to fail, we make those 17695 // members unavailable. 17696 SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation(); 17697 if (getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Loc)) { 17698 if (!FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) 17699 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, "", 17700 UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, Loc)); 17701 return false; 17702 } 17703 } 17704 17705 Diag(FD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? 17706 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_nontrivial_union_or_anon_struct_member : 17707 diag::err_illegal_union_or_anon_struct_member) 17708 << FD->getParent()->isUnion() << FD->getDeclName() << member; 17709 DiagnoseNontrivial(RDecl, member); 17710 return !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11; 17711 } 17712 } 17713 } 17714 17715 return false; 17716 } 17717 17718 /// TranslateIvarVisibility - Translate visibility from a token ID to an 17719 /// AST enum value. 17720 static ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl 17721 TranslateIvarVisibility(tok::ObjCKeywordKind ivarVisibility) { 17722 switch (ivarVisibility) { 17723 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown visitibility kind"); 17724 case tok::objc_private: return ObjCIvarDecl::Private; 17725 case tok::objc_public: return ObjCIvarDecl::Public; 17726 case tok::objc_protected: return ObjCIvarDecl::Protected; 17727 case tok::objc_package: return ObjCIvarDecl::Package; 17728 } 17729 } 17730 17731 /// ActOnIvar - Each ivar field of an objective-c class is passed into this 17732 /// in order to create an IvarDecl object for it. 17733 Decl *Sema::ActOnIvar(Scope *S, 17734 SourceLocation DeclStart, 17735 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth, 17736 tok::ObjCKeywordKind Visibility) { 17737 17738 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 17739 Expr *BitWidth = (Expr*)BitfieldWidth; 17740 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 17741 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 17742 17743 // FIXME: Unnamed fields can be handled in various different ways, for 17744 // example, unnamed unions inject all members into the struct namespace! 17745 17746 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 17747 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 17748 17749 if (BitWidth) { 17750 // 6.7.2.1p3, 6.7.2.1p4 17751 BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, /*IsMsStruct*/false, BitWidth).get(); 17752 if (!BitWidth) 17753 D.setInvalidType(); 17754 } else { 17755 // Not a bitfield. 17756 17757 // validate II. 17758 17759 } 17760 if (T->isReferenceType()) { 17761 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_reference_type); 17762 D.setInvalidType(); 17763 } 17764 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 17765 // than a variably modified type. 17766 else if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 17767 if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType( 17768 TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_ivar_variable_size)) 17769 D.setInvalidType(); 17770 } 17771 17772 // Get the visibility (access control) for this ivar. 17773 ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl ac = 17774 Visibility != tok::objc_not_keyword ? TranslateIvarVisibility(Visibility) 17775 : ObjCIvarDecl::None; 17776 // Must set ivar's DeclContext to its enclosing interface. 17777 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingDecl = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext); 17778 if (!EnclosingDecl || EnclosingDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 17779 return nullptr; 17780 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingContext; 17781 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 17782 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17783 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile()) { 17784 // Case of ivar declared in an implementation. Context is that of its class. 17785 EnclosingContext = IMPDecl->getClassInterface(); 17786 assert(EnclosingContext && "Implementation has no class interface!"); 17787 } 17788 else 17789 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 17790 } else { 17791 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 17792 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17793 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || !CDecl->IsClassExtension()) { 17794 Diag(Loc, diag::err_misplaced_ivar) << CDecl->IsClassExtension(); 17795 return nullptr; 17796 } 17797 } 17798 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 17799 } 17800 17801 // Construct the decl. 17802 ObjCIvarDecl *NewID = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, EnclosingContext, 17803 DeclStart, Loc, II, T, 17804 TInfo, ac, (Expr *)BitfieldWidth); 17805 17806 if (II) { 17807 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, 17808 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 17809 if (PrevDecl && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, EnclosingContext, S) 17810 && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 17811 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 17812 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 17813 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17814 } 17815 } 17816 17817 // Process attributes attached to the ivar. 17818 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewID, D); 17819 17820 if (D.isInvalidType()) 17821 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17822 17823 // In ARC, infer 'retaining' for ivars of retainable type. 17824 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewID)) 17825 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17826 17827 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 17828 NewID->setModulePrivate(); 17829 17830 if (II) { 17831 // FIXME: When interfaces are DeclContexts, we'll need to add 17832 // these to the interface. 17833 S->AddDecl(NewID); 17834 IdResolver.AddDecl(NewID); 17835 } 17836 17837 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isNonFragile() && 17838 !NewID->isInvalidDecl() && isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) 17839 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivars_in_interface); 17840 17841 return NewID; 17842 } 17843 17844 /// ActOnLastBitfield - This routine handles synthesized bitfields rules for 17845 /// class and class extensions. For every class \@interface and class 17846 /// extension \@interface, if the last ivar is a bitfield of any type, 17847 /// then add an implicit `char :0` ivar to the end of that interface. 17848 void Sema::ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclLoc, 17849 SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &AllIvarDecls) { 17850 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || AllIvarDecls.empty()) 17851 return; 17852 17853 Decl *ivarDecl = AllIvarDecls[AllIvarDecls.size()-1]; 17854 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(ivarDecl); 17855 17856 if (!Ivar->isBitField() || Ivar->isZeroLengthBitField(Context)) 17857 return; 17858 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CurContext); 17859 if (!ID) { 17860 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CurContext)) { 17861 if (!CD->IsClassExtension()) 17862 return; 17863 } 17864 // No need to add this to end of @implementation. 17865 else 17866 return; 17867 } 17868 // All conditions are met. Add a new bitfield to the tail end of ivars. 17869 llvm::APInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), 0); 17870 Expr * BW = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, DeclLoc); 17871 17872 Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext), 17873 DeclLoc, DeclLoc, nullptr, 17874 Context.CharTy, 17875 Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Context.CharTy, 17876 DeclLoc), 17877 ObjCIvarDecl::Private, BW, 17878 true); 17879 AllIvarDecls.push_back(Ivar); 17880 } 17881 17882 namespace { 17883 /// [class.dtor]p4: 17884 /// At the end of the definition of a class, overload resolution is 17885 /// performed among the prospective destructors declared in that class with 17886 /// an empty argument list to select the destructor for the class, also 17887 /// known as the selected destructor. 17888 /// 17889 /// We do the overload resolution here, then mark the selected constructor in the AST. 17890 /// Later CXXRecordDecl::getDestructor() will return the selected constructor. 17891 void ComputeSelectedDestructor(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Record) { 17892 if (!Record->hasUserDeclaredDestructor()) { 17893 return; 17894 } 17895 17896 SourceLocation Loc = Record->getLocation(); 17897 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 17898 17899 for (auto *Decl : Record->decls()) { 17900 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Decl)) { 17901 if (DD->isInvalidDecl()) 17902 continue; 17903 S.AddOverloadCandidate(DD, DeclAccessPair::make(DD, DD->getAccess()), {}, 17904 OCS); 17905 assert(DD->isIneligibleOrNotSelected() && "Selecting a destructor but a destructor was already selected."); 17906 } 17907 } 17908 17909 if (OCS.empty()) { 17910 return; 17911 } 17912 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 17913 unsigned Msg = 0; 17914 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind DisplayKind; 17915 17916 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, Loc, Best)) { 17917 case OR_Success: 17918 case OR_Deleted: 17919 Record->addedSelectedDestructor(dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Best->Function)); 17920 break; 17921 17922 case OR_Ambiguous: 17923 Msg = diag::err_ambiguous_destructor; 17924 DisplayKind = OCD_AmbiguousCandidates; 17925 break; 17926 17927 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 17928 Msg = diag::err_no_viable_destructor; 17929 DisplayKind = OCD_AllCandidates; 17930 break; 17931 } 17932 17933 if (Msg) { 17934 // OpenCL have got their own thing going with destructors. It's slightly broken, 17935 // but we allow it. 17936 if (!S.LangOpts.OpenCL) { 17937 PartialDiagnostic Diag = S.PDiag(Msg) << Record; 17938 OCS.NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt(Loc, Diag), S, DisplayKind, {}); 17939 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17940 } 17941 // It's a bit hacky: At this point we've raised an error but we want the 17942 // rest of the compiler to continue somehow working. However almost 17943 // everything we'll try to do with the class will depend on there being a 17944 // destructor. So let's pretend the first one is selected and hope for the 17945 // best. 17946 Record->addedSelectedDestructor(dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(OCS.begin()->Function)); 17947 } 17948 } 17949 } // namespace 17950 17951 void Sema::ActOnFields(Scope *S, SourceLocation RecLoc, Decl *EnclosingDecl, 17952 ArrayRef<Decl *> Fields, SourceLocation LBrac, 17953 SourceLocation RBrac, 17954 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { 17955 assert(EnclosingDecl && "missing record or interface decl"); 17956 17957 // If this is an Objective-C @implementation or category and we have 17958 // new fields here we should reset the layout of the interface since 17959 // it will now change. 17960 if (!Fields.empty() && isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17961 ObjCContainerDecl *DC = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17962 switch (DC->getKind()) { 17963 default: break; 17964 case Decl::ObjCCategory: 17965 Context.ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 17966 break; 17967 case Decl::ObjCImplementation: 17968 Context. 17969 ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 17970 break; 17971 } 17972 } 17973 17974 RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17975 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17976 17977 if (CXXRecord && !CXXRecord->isDependentType()) 17978 ComputeSelectedDestructor(*this, CXXRecord); 17979 17980 // Start counting up the number of named members; make sure to include 17981 // members of anonymous structs and unions in the total. 17982 unsigned NumNamedMembers = 0; 17983 if (Record) { 17984 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 17985 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 17986 if (IFD->getDeclName()) 17987 ++NumNamedMembers; 17988 } 17989 } 17990 17991 // Verify that all the fields are okay. 17992 SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 32> RecFields; 17993 17994 for (ArrayRef<Decl *>::iterator i = Fields.begin(), end = Fields.end(); 17995 i != end; ++i) { 17996 FieldDecl *FD = cast<FieldDecl>(*i); 17997 17998 // Get the type for the field. 17999 const Type *FDTy = FD->getType().getTypePtr(); 18000 18001 if (!FD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) { 18002 // Remember all fields written by the user. 18003 RecFields.push_back(FD); 18004 } 18005 18006 // If the field is already invalid for some reason, don't emit more 18007 // diagnostics about it. 18008 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 18009 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 18010 continue; 18011 } 18012 18013 // C99 6.7.2.1p2: 18014 // A structure or union shall not contain a member with 18015 // incomplete or function type (hence, a structure shall not 18016 // contain an instance of itself, but may contain a pointer to 18017 // an instance of itself), except that the last member of a 18018 // structure with more than one named member may have incomplete 18019 // array type; such a structure (and any union containing, 18020 // possibly recursively, a member that is such a structure) 18021 // shall not be a member of a structure or an element of an 18022 // array. 18023 bool IsLastField = (i + 1 == Fields.end()); 18024 if (FDTy->isFunctionType()) { 18025 // Field declared as a function. 18026 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_field_declared_as_function) 18027 << FD->getDeclName(); 18028 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 18029 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 18030 continue; 18031 } else if (FDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() && 18032 (Record || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl))) { 18033 if (Record) { 18034 // Flexible array member. 18035 // Microsoft and g++ is more permissive regarding flexible array. 18036 // It will accept flexible array in union and also 18037 // as the sole element of a struct/class. 18038 unsigned DiagID = 0; 18039 if (!Record->isUnion() && !IsLastField) { 18040 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_not_at_end) 18041 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType() << Record->getTagKind(); 18042 Diag((*(i + 1))->getLocation(), diag::note_next_field_declaration); 18043 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 18044 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 18045 continue; 18046 } else if (Record->isUnion()) 18047 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 18048 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_ms 18049 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 18050 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_gnu 18051 : diag::err_flexible_array_union; 18052 else if (NumNamedMembers < 1) 18053 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 18054 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_ms 18055 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 18056 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_gnu 18057 : diag::err_flexible_array_empty_aggregate; 18058 18059 if (DiagID) 18060 Diag(FD->getLocation(), DiagID) << FD->getDeclName() 18061 << Record->getTagKind(); 18062 // While the layout of types that contain virtual bases is not specified 18063 // by the C++ standard, both the Itanium and Microsoft C++ ABIs place 18064 // virtual bases after the derived members. This would make a flexible 18065 // array member declared at the end of an object not adjacent to the end 18066 // of the type. 18067 if (CXXRecord && CXXRecord->getNumVBases() != 0) 18068 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_virtual_base) 18069 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 18070 if (!getLangOpts().C99) 18071 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_flexible_array_member) 18072 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 18073 18074 // If the element type has a non-trivial destructor, we would not 18075 // implicitly destroy the elements, so disallow it for now. 18076 // 18077 // FIXME: GCC allows this. We should probably either implicitly delete 18078 // the destructor of the containing class, or just allow this. 18079 QualType BaseElem = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 18080 if (!BaseElem->isDependentType() && BaseElem.isDestructedType()) { 18081 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_has_nontrivial_dtor) 18082 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 18083 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 18084 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 18085 continue; 18086 } 18087 // Okay, we have a legal flexible array member at the end of the struct. 18088 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 18089 } else { 18090 // In ObjCContainerDecl ivars with incomplete array type are accepted, 18091 // unless they are followed by another ivar. That check is done 18092 // elsewhere, after synthesized ivars are known. 18093 } 18094 } else if (!FDTy->isDependentType() && 18095 RequireCompleteSizedType( 18096 FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 18097 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) { 18098 // Incomplete type 18099 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 18100 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 18101 continue; 18102 } else if (const RecordType *FDTTy = FDTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 18103 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 18104 // A type which contains a flexible array member is considered to be a 18105 // flexible array member. 18106 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 18107 if (!Record->isUnion()) { 18108 // If this is a struct/class and this is not the last element, reject 18109 // it. Note that GCC supports variable sized arrays in the middle of 18110 // structures. 18111 if (!IsLastField) 18112 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variable_sized_type_in_struct) 18113 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 18114 else { 18115 // We support flexible arrays at the end of structs in 18116 // other structs as an extension. 18117 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_flexible_array_in_struct) 18118 << FD->getDeclName(); 18119 } 18120 } 18121 } 18122 if (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl) && 18123 RequireNonAbstractType(FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 18124 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 18125 AbstractIvarType)) { 18126 // Ivars can not have abstract class types 18127 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 18128 } 18129 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 18130 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 18131 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasVolatileMember()) 18132 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 18133 } else if (FDTy->isObjCObjectType()) { 18134 /// A field cannot be an Objective-c object 18135 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 18136 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FD->getLocation(), "*"); 18137 QualType T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(FD->getType()); 18138 FD->setType(T); 18139 } else if (Record && Record->isUnion() && 18140 FD->getType().hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime() && 18141 getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(FD->getLocation()) && 18142 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>() && 18143 (FD->getType().getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 18144 !Context.hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(FD->getType()))) { 18145 // For backward compatibility, fields of C unions declared in system 18146 // headers that have non-trivial ObjC ownership qualifications are marked 18147 // as unavailable unless the qualifier is explicit and __strong. This can 18148 // break ABI compatibility between programs compiled with ARC and MRR, but 18149 // is a better option than rejecting programs using those unions under 18150 // ARC. 18151 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit( 18152 Context, "", UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, 18153 FD->getLocation())); 18154 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 18155 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC && Record && 18156 !Record->hasObjectMember()) { 18157 if (FD->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 18158 FD->getType().isObjCGCStrong()) 18159 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 18160 else if (Context.getAsArrayType(FD->getType())) { 18161 QualType BaseType = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 18162 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && 18163 BaseType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 18164 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 18165 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 18166 BaseType.isObjCGCStrong()) 18167 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 18168 } 18169 } 18170 18171 if (Record && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18172 !shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) { 18173 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 18174 if (FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize()) { 18175 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize(true); 18176 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 18177 Record->isUnion()) 18178 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion(true); 18179 } 18180 QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK = FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(); 18181 if (PCK != QualType::PCK_Trivial && PCK != QualType::PCK_VolatileTrivial) { 18182 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(true); 18183 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion() || Record->isUnion()) 18184 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion(true); 18185 } 18186 if (FT.isDestructedType()) { 18187 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestroy(true); 18188 Record->setParamDestroyedInCallee(true); 18189 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || Record->isUnion()) 18190 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion(true); 18191 } 18192 18193 if (const auto *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>()) { 18194 if (RT->getDecl()->getArgPassingRestrictions() == 18195 RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs) 18196 Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs); 18197 } else if (FT.getQualifiers().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) 18198 Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs); 18199 } 18200 18201 if (Record && FD->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 18202 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 18203 // Keep track of the number of named members. 18204 if (FD->getIdentifier()) 18205 ++NumNamedMembers; 18206 } 18207 18208 // Okay, we successfully defined 'Record'. 18209 if (Record) { 18210 bool Completed = false; 18211 if (CXXRecord) { 18212 if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) { 18213 // Set access bits correctly on the directly-declared conversions. 18214 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator 18215 I = CXXRecord->conversion_begin(), 18216 E = CXXRecord->conversion_end(); I != E; ++I) 18217 I.setAccess((*I)->getAccess()); 18218 } 18219 18220 // Add any implicitly-declared members to this class. 18221 AddImplicitlyDeclaredMembersToClass(CXXRecord); 18222 18223 if (!CXXRecord->isDependentType()) { 18224 if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) { 18225 // If we have virtual base classes, we may end up finding multiple 18226 // final overriders for a given virtual function. Check for this 18227 // problem now. 18228 if (CXXRecord->getNumVBases()) { 18229 CXXFinalOverriderMap FinalOverriders; 18230 CXXRecord->getFinalOverriders(FinalOverriders); 18231 18232 for (CXXFinalOverriderMap::iterator M = FinalOverriders.begin(), 18233 MEnd = FinalOverriders.end(); 18234 M != MEnd; ++M) { 18235 for (OverridingMethods::iterator SO = M->second.begin(), 18236 SOEnd = M->second.end(); 18237 SO != SOEnd; ++SO) { 18238 assert(SO->second.size() > 0 && 18239 "Virtual function without overriding functions?"); 18240 if (SO->second.size() == 1) 18241 continue; 18242 18243 // C++ [class.virtual]p2: 18244 // In a derived class, if a virtual member function of a base 18245 // class subobject has more than one final overrider the 18246 // program is ill-formed. 18247 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_multiple_final_overriders) 18248 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << Record; 18249 Diag(M->first->getLocation(), 18250 diag::note_overridden_virtual_function); 18251 for (OverridingMethods::overriding_iterator 18252 OM = SO->second.begin(), 18253 OMEnd = SO->second.end(); 18254 OM != OMEnd; ++OM) 18255 Diag(OM->Method->getLocation(), diag::note_final_overrider) 18256 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << OM->Method->getParent(); 18257 18258 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 18259 } 18260 } 18261 CXXRecord->completeDefinition(&FinalOverriders); 18262 Completed = true; 18263 } 18264 } 18265 } 18266 } 18267 18268 if (!Completed) 18269 Record->completeDefinition(); 18270 18271 // Handle attributes before checking the layout. 18272 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Record, Attrs); 18273 18274 // Check to see if a FieldDecl is a pointer to a function. 18275 auto IsFunctionPointer = [&](const Decl *D) { 18276 const FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D); 18277 if (!FD) 18278 return false; 18279 QualType FieldType = FD->getType().getDesugaredType(Context); 18280 if (isa<PointerType>(FieldType)) { 18281 QualType PointeeType = cast<PointerType>(FieldType)->getPointeeType(); 18282 return PointeeType.getDesugaredType(Context)->isFunctionType(); 18283 } 18284 return false; 18285 }; 18286 18287 // Maybe randomize the record's decls. We automatically randomize a record 18288 // of function pointers, unless it has the "no_randomize_layout" attribute. 18289 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18290 (Record->hasAttr<RandomizeLayoutAttr>() || 18291 (!Record->hasAttr<NoRandomizeLayoutAttr>() && 18292 llvm::all_of(Record->decls(), IsFunctionPointer))) && 18293 !Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().RandstructSeed.empty() && 18294 !Record->isRandomized()) { 18295 SmallVector<Decl *, 32> NewDeclOrdering; 18296 if (randstruct::randomizeStructureLayout(Context, Record, 18297 NewDeclOrdering)) 18298 Record->reorderDecls(NewDeclOrdering); 18299 } 18300 18301 // We may have deferred checking for a deleted destructor. Check now. 18302 if (CXXRecord) { 18303 auto *Dtor = CXXRecord->getDestructor(); 18304 if (Dtor && Dtor->isImplicit() && 18305 ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Dtor, CXXDestructor)) { 18306 CXXRecord->setImplicitDestructorIsDeleted(); 18307 SetDeclDeleted(Dtor, CXXRecord->getLocation()); 18308 } 18309 } 18310 18311 if (Record->hasAttrs()) { 18312 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Record); 18313 18314 if (const MSInheritanceAttr *IA = Record->getAttr<MSInheritanceAttr>()) 18315 checkMSInheritanceAttrOnDefinition(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), 18316 IA->getRange(), IA->getBestCase(), 18317 IA->getInheritanceModel()); 18318 } 18319 18320 // Check if the structure/union declaration is a type that can have zero 18321 // size in C. For C this is a language extension, for C++ it may cause 18322 // compatibility problems. 18323 bool CheckForZeroSize; 18324 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 18325 CheckForZeroSize = true; 18326 } else { 18327 // For C++ filter out types that cannot be referenced in C code. 18328 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record); 18329 CheckForZeroSize = 18330 CXXRecord->getLexicalDeclContext()->isExternCContext() && 18331 !CXXRecord->isDependentType() && !inTemplateInstantiation() && 18332 CXXRecord->isCLike(); 18333 } 18334 if (CheckForZeroSize) { 18335 bool ZeroSize = true; 18336 bool IsEmpty = true; 18337 unsigned NonBitFields = 0; 18338 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator I = Record->field_begin(), 18339 E = Record->field_end(); 18340 (NonBitFields == 0 || ZeroSize) && I != E; ++I) { 18341 IsEmpty = false; 18342 if (I->isUnnamedBitfield()) { 18343 if (!I->isZeroLengthBitField(Context)) 18344 ZeroSize = false; 18345 } else { 18346 ++NonBitFields; 18347 QualType FieldType = I->getType(); 18348 if (FieldType->isIncompleteType() || 18349 !Context.getTypeSizeInChars(FieldType).isZero()) 18350 ZeroSize = false; 18351 } 18352 } 18353 18354 // Empty structs are an extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7). They are 18355 // allowed in C++, but warn if its declaration is inside 18356 // extern "C" block. 18357 if (ZeroSize) { 18358 Diag(RecLoc, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? 18359 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_in_extern_c : 18360 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_compat) 18361 << IsEmpty << Record->isUnion() << (NonBitFields > 1); 18362 } 18363 18364 // Structs without named members are extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7), 18365 // but are accepted by GCC. 18366 if (NonBitFields == 0 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 18367 Diag(RecLoc, IsEmpty ? diag::ext_empty_struct_union : 18368 diag::ext_no_named_members_in_struct_union) 18369 << Record->isUnion(); 18370 } 18371 } 18372 } else { 18373 ObjCIvarDecl **ClsFields = 18374 reinterpret_cast<ObjCIvarDecl**>(RecFields.data()); 18375 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 18376 ID->setEndOfDefinitionLoc(RBrac); 18377 // Add ivar's to class's DeclContext. 18378 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18379 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(ID); 18380 ID->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 18381 } 18382 // Must enforce the rule that ivars in the base classes may not be 18383 // duplicates. 18384 if (ID->getSuperClass()) 18385 DiagnoseDuplicateIvars(ID, ID->getSuperClass()); 18386 } else if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 18387 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 18388 assert(IMPDecl && "ActOnFields - missing ObjCImplementationDecl"); 18389 for (unsigned I = 0, N = RecFields.size(); I != N; ++I) 18390 // Ivar declared in @implementation never belongs to the implementation. 18391 // Only it is in implementation's lexical context. 18392 ClsFields[I]->setLexicalDeclContext(IMPDecl); 18393 CheckImplementationIvars(IMPDecl, ClsFields, RecFields.size(), RBrac); 18394 IMPDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 18395 IMPDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 18396 } else if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 18397 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 18398 // case of ivars in class extension; all other cases have been 18399 // reported as errors elsewhere. 18400 // FIXME. Class extension does not have a LocEnd field. 18401 // CDecl->setLocEnd(RBrac); 18402 // Add ivar's to class extension's DeclContext. 18403 // Diagnose redeclaration of private ivars. 18404 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CDecl->getClassInterface(); 18405 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18406 if (IDecl) { 18407 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsIvar = 18408 IDecl->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 18409 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 18410 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 18411 Diag(ClsIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 18412 continue; 18413 } 18414 for (const auto *Ext : IDecl->known_extensions()) { 18415 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsExtIvar 18416 = Ext->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 18417 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 18418 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 18419 Diag(ClsExtIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 18420 continue; 18421 } 18422 } 18423 } 18424 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(CDecl); 18425 CDecl->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 18426 } 18427 CDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 18428 CDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 18429 } 18430 } 18431 } 18432 18433 /// Determine whether the given integral value is representable within 18434 /// the given type T. 18435 static bool isRepresentableIntegerValue(ASTContext &Context, 18436 llvm::APSInt &Value, 18437 QualType T) { 18438 assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || T->isEnumeralType()) && 18439 "Integral type required!"); 18440 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getIntWidth(T); 18441 18442 if (Value.isUnsigned() || Value.isNonNegative()) { 18443 if (T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()) 18444 --BitWidth; 18445 return Value.getActiveBits() <= BitWidth; 18446 } 18447 return Value.getMinSignedBits() <= BitWidth; 18448 } 18449 18450 // Given an integral type, return the next larger integral type 18451 // (or a NULL type of no such type exists). 18452 static QualType getNextLargerIntegralType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T) { 18453 // FIXME: Int128/UInt128 support, which also needs to be introduced into 18454 // enum checking below. 18455 assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || 18456 T->isEnumeralType()) && "Integral type required!"); 18457 const unsigned NumTypes = 4; 18458 QualType SignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 18459 Context.ShortTy, Context.IntTy, Context.LongTy, Context.LongLongTy 18460 }; 18461 QualType UnsignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 18462 Context.UnsignedShortTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy, 18463 Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 18464 }; 18465 18466 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getTypeSize(T); 18467 QualType *Types = T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()? SignedIntegralTypes 18468 : UnsignedIntegralTypes; 18469 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTypes; ++I) 18470 if (Context.getTypeSize(Types[I]) > BitWidth) 18471 return Types[I]; 18472 18473 return QualType(); 18474 } 18475 18476 EnumConstantDecl *Sema::CheckEnumConstant(EnumDecl *Enum, 18477 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst, 18478 SourceLocation IdLoc, 18479 IdentifierInfo *Id, 18480 Expr *Val) { 18481 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 18482 llvm::APSInt EnumVal(IntWidth); 18483 QualType EltTy; 18484 18485 if (Val && DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Val, UPPC_EnumeratorValue)) 18486 Val = nullptr; 18487 18488 if (Val) 18489 Val = DefaultLvalueConversion(Val).get(); 18490 18491 if (Val) { 18492 if (Enum->isDependentType() || Val->isTypeDependent() || 18493 Val->containsErrors()) 18494 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 18495 else { 18496 // FIXME: We don't allow folding in C++11 mode for an enum with a fixed 18497 // underlying type, but do allow it in all other contexts. 18498 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Enum->isFixed()) { 18499 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: If the underlying type is fixed, [...] the 18500 // constant-expression in the enumerator-definition shall be a converted 18501 // constant expression of the underlying type. 18502 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18503 ExprResult Converted = 18504 CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Val, EltTy, EnumVal, 18505 CCEK_Enumerator); 18506 if (Converted.isInvalid()) 18507 Val = nullptr; 18508 else 18509 Val = Converted.get(); 18510 } else if (!Val->isValueDependent() && 18511 !(Val = 18512 VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Val, &EnumVal, AllowFold) 18513 .get())) { 18514 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: Make sure we have an integer constant expression. 18515 } else { 18516 if (Enum->isComplete()) { 18517 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18518 18519 // In Obj-C and Microsoft mode, require the enumeration value to be 18520 // representable in the underlying type of the enumeration. In C++11, 18521 // we perform a non-narrowing conversion as part of converted constant 18522 // expression checking. 18523 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 18524 if (Context.getTargetInfo() 18525 .getTriple() 18526 .isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) { 18527 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 18528 } else { 18529 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 18530 } 18531 } 18532 18533 // Cast to the underlying type. 18534 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, EltTy, 18535 EltTy->isBooleanType() ? CK_IntegralToBoolean 18536 : CK_IntegralCast) 18537 .get(); 18538 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 18539 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: 18540 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 18541 // is the type of its initializing value: 18542 // - If an initializer is specified for an enumerator, the 18543 // initializing value has the same type as the expression. 18544 EltTy = Val->getType(); 18545 } else { 18546 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: 18547 // The expression that defines the value of an enumeration constant 18548 // shall be an integer constant expression that has a value 18549 // representable as an int. 18550 18551 // Complain if the value is not representable in an int. 18552 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, Context.IntTy)) 18553 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 18554 << toString(EnumVal, 10) << Val->getSourceRange() 18555 << (EnumVal.isUnsigned() || EnumVal.isNonNegative()); 18556 else if (!Context.hasSameType(Val->getType(), Context.IntTy)) { 18557 // Force the type of the expression to 'int'. 18558 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, Context.IntTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 18559 } 18560 EltTy = Val->getType(); 18561 } 18562 } 18563 } 18564 } 18565 18566 if (!Val) { 18567 if (Enum->isDependentType()) 18568 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 18569 else if (!LastEnumConst) { 18570 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 18571 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 18572 // is the type of its initializing value: 18573 // - If no initializer is specified for the first enumerator, the 18574 // initializing value has an unspecified integral type. 18575 // 18576 // GCC uses 'int' for its unspecified integral type, as does 18577 // C99 6.7.2.2p3. 18578 if (Enum->isFixed()) { 18579 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18580 } 18581 else { 18582 EltTy = Context.IntTy; 18583 } 18584 } else { 18585 // Assign the last value + 1. 18586 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 18587 ++EnumVal; 18588 EltTy = LastEnumConst->getType(); 18589 18590 // Check for overflow on increment. 18591 if (EnumVal < LastEnumConst->getInitVal()) { 18592 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 18593 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 18594 // is the type of its initializing value: 18595 // 18596 // - Otherwise the type of the initializing value is the same as 18597 // the type of the initializing value of the preceding enumerator 18598 // unless the incremented value is not representable in that type, 18599 // in which case the type is an unspecified integral type 18600 // sufficient to contain the incremented value. If no such type 18601 // exists, the program is ill-formed. 18602 QualType T = getNextLargerIntegralType(Context, EltTy); 18603 if (T.isNull() || Enum->isFixed()) { 18604 // There is no integral type larger enough to represent this 18605 // value. Complain, then allow the value to wrap around. 18606 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 18607 EnumVal = EnumVal.zext(EnumVal.getBitWidth() * 2); 18608 ++EnumVal; 18609 if (Enum->isFixed()) 18610 // When the underlying type is fixed, this is ill-formed. 18611 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_wrapped) 18612 << toString(EnumVal, 10) 18613 << EltTy; 18614 else 18615 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_increment_too_large) 18616 << toString(EnumVal, 10); 18617 } else { 18618 EltTy = T; 18619 } 18620 18621 // Retrieve the last enumerator's value, extent that type to the 18622 // type that is supposed to be large enough to represent the incremented 18623 // value, then increment. 18624 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 18625 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 18626 EnumVal = EnumVal.zextOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 18627 ++EnumVal; 18628 18629 // If we're not in C++, diagnose the overflow of enumerator values, 18630 // which in C99 means that the enumerator value is not representable in 18631 // an int (C99 6.7.2.2p2). However, we support GCC's extension that 18632 // permits enumerator values that are representable in some larger 18633 // integral type. 18634 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !T.isNull()) 18635 Diag(IdLoc, diag::warn_enum_value_overflow); 18636 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18637 !isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 18638 // Enforce C99 6.7.2.2p2 even when we compute the next value. 18639 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 18640 << toString(EnumVal, 10) << 1; 18641 } 18642 } 18643 } 18644 18645 if (!EltTy->isDependentType()) { 18646 // Make the enumerator value match the signedness and size of the 18647 // enumerator's type. 18648 EnumVal = EnumVal.extOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 18649 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 18650 } 18651 18652 return EnumConstantDecl::Create(Context, Enum, IdLoc, Id, EltTy, 18653 Val, EnumVal); 18654 } 18655 18656 Sema::SkipBodyInfo Sema::shouldSkipAnonEnumBody(Scope *S, IdentifierInfo *II, 18657 SourceLocation IILoc) { 18658 if (!(getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) || 18659 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18660 return SkipBodyInfo(); 18661 18662 // We have an anonymous enum definition. Look up the first enumerator to 18663 // determine if we should merge the definition with an existing one and 18664 // skip the body. 18665 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, IILoc, LookupOrdinaryName, 18666 forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 18667 auto *PrevECD = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl); 18668 if (!PrevECD) 18669 return SkipBodyInfo(); 18670 18671 EnumDecl *PrevED = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevECD->getDeclContext()); 18672 NamedDecl *Hidden; 18673 if (!PrevED->getDeclName() && !hasVisibleDefinition(PrevED, &Hidden)) { 18674 SkipBodyInfo Skip; 18675 Skip.Previous = Hidden; 18676 return Skip; 18677 } 18678 18679 return SkipBodyInfo(); 18680 } 18681 18682 Decl *Sema::ActOnEnumConstant(Scope *S, Decl *theEnumDecl, Decl *lastEnumConst, 18683 SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id, 18684 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, 18685 SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *Val) { 18686 EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = cast<EnumDecl>(theEnumDecl); 18687 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst = 18688 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(lastEnumConst); 18689 18690 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 18691 // we find one that is. 18692 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 18693 18694 // Verify that there isn't already something declared with this name in this 18695 // scope. 18696 LookupResult R(*this, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName, ForVisibleRedeclaration); 18697 LookupName(R, S); 18698 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>(); 18699 18700 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 18701 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 18702 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(IdLoc, PrevDecl); 18703 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 18704 PrevDecl = nullptr; 18705 } 18706 18707 // C++ [class.mem]p15: 18708 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a name 18709 // different from T: 18710 // - every enumerator of every member of class T that is an unscoped 18711 // enumerated type 18712 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !TheEnumDecl->isScoped()) 18713 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(TheEnumDecl->getDeclContext(), 18714 DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc)); 18715 18716 EnumConstantDecl *New = 18717 CheckEnumConstant(TheEnumDecl, LastEnumConst, IdLoc, Id, Val); 18718 if (!New) 18719 return nullptr; 18720 18721 if (PrevDecl) { 18722 if (!TheEnumDecl->isScoped() && isa<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 18723 // Check for other kinds of shadowing not already handled. 18724 CheckShadow(New, PrevDecl, R); 18725 } 18726 18727 // When in C++, we may get a TagDecl with the same name; in this case the 18728 // enum constant will 'hide' the tag. 18729 assert((getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) && 18730 "Received TagDecl when not in C++!"); 18731 if (!isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl) && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, CurContext, S)) { 18732 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl)) 18733 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition_of_enumerator) << Id; 18734 else 18735 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Id; 18736 notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, IdLoc); 18737 return nullptr; 18738 } 18739 } 18740 18741 // Process attributes. 18742 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs); 18743 AddPragmaAttributes(S, New); 18744 18745 // Register this decl in the current scope stack. 18746 New->setAccess(TheEnumDecl->getAccess()); 18747 PushOnScopeChains(New, S); 18748 18749 ActOnDocumentableDecl(New); 18750 18751 return New; 18752 } 18753 18754 // Returns true when the enum initial expression does not trigger the 18755 // duplicate enum warning. A few common cases are exempted as follows: 18756 // Element2 = Element1 18757 // Element2 = Element1 + 1 18758 // Element2 = Element1 - 1 18759 // Where Element2 and Element1 are from the same enum. 18760 static bool ValidDuplicateEnum(EnumConstantDecl *ECD, EnumDecl *Enum) { 18761 Expr *InitExpr = ECD->getInitExpr(); 18762 if (!InitExpr) 18763 return true; 18764 InitExpr = InitExpr->IgnoreImpCasts(); 18765 18766 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(InitExpr)) { 18767 if (!BO->isAdditiveOp()) 18768 return true; 18769 IntegerLiteral *IL = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(BO->getRHS()); 18770 if (!IL) 18771 return true; 18772 if (IL->getValue() != 1) 18773 return true; 18774 18775 InitExpr = BO->getLHS(); 18776 } 18777 18778 // This checks if the elements are from the same enum. 18779 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InitExpr); 18780 if (!DRE) 18781 return true; 18782 18783 EnumConstantDecl *EnumConstant = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 18784 if (!EnumConstant) 18785 return true; 18786 18787 if (cast<EnumDecl>(TagDecl::castFromDeclContext(ECD->getDeclContext())) != 18788 Enum) 18789 return true; 18790 18791 return false; 18792 } 18793 18794 // Emits a warning when an element is implicitly set a value that 18795 // a previous element has already been set to. 18796 static void CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, 18797 EnumDecl *Enum, QualType EnumType) { 18798 // Avoid anonymous enums 18799 if (!Enum->getIdentifier()) 18800 return; 18801 18802 // Only check for small enums. 18803 if (Enum->getNumPositiveBits() > 63 || Enum->getNumNegativeBits() > 64) 18804 return; 18805 18806 if (S.Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values, Enum->getLocation())) 18807 return; 18808 18809 typedef SmallVector<EnumConstantDecl *, 3> ECDVector; 18810 typedef SmallVector<std::unique_ptr<ECDVector>, 3> DuplicatesVector; 18811 18812 typedef llvm::PointerUnion<EnumConstantDecl*, ECDVector*> DeclOrVector; 18813 18814 // DenseMaps cannot contain the all ones int64_t value, so use unordered_map. 18815 typedef std::unordered_map<int64_t, DeclOrVector> ValueToVectorMap; 18816 18817 // Use int64_t as a key to avoid needing special handling for map keys. 18818 auto EnumConstantToKey = [](const EnumConstantDecl *D) { 18819 llvm::APSInt Val = D->getInitVal(); 18820 return Val.isSigned() ? Val.getSExtValue() : Val.getZExtValue(); 18821 }; 18822 18823 DuplicatesVector DupVector; 18824 ValueToVectorMap EnumMap; 18825 18826 // Populate the EnumMap with all values represented by enum constants without 18827 // an initializer. 18828 for (auto *Element : Elements) { 18829 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Element); 18830 18831 // Null EnumConstantDecl means a previous diagnostic has been emitted for 18832 // this constant. Skip this enum since it may be ill-formed. 18833 if (!ECD) { 18834 return; 18835 } 18836 18837 // Constants with initalizers are handled in the next loop. 18838 if (ECD->getInitExpr()) 18839 continue; 18840 18841 // Duplicate values are handled in the next loop. 18842 EnumMap.insert({EnumConstantToKey(ECD), ECD}); 18843 } 18844 18845 if (EnumMap.size() == 0) 18846 return; 18847 18848 // Create vectors for any values that has duplicates. 18849 for (auto *Element : Elements) { 18850 // The last loop returned if any constant was null. 18851 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(Element); 18852 if (!ValidDuplicateEnum(ECD, Enum)) 18853 continue; 18854 18855 auto Iter = EnumMap.find(EnumConstantToKey(ECD)); 18856 if (Iter == EnumMap.end()) 18857 continue; 18858 18859 DeclOrVector& Entry = Iter->second; 18860 if (EnumConstantDecl *D = Entry.dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl*>()) { 18861 // Ensure constants are different. 18862 if (D == ECD) 18863 continue; 18864 18865 // Create new vector and push values onto it. 18866 auto Vec = std::make_unique<ECDVector>(); 18867 Vec->push_back(D); 18868 Vec->push_back(ECD); 18869 18870 // Update entry to point to the duplicates vector. 18871 Entry = Vec.get(); 18872 18873 // Store the vector somewhere we can consult later for quick emission of 18874 // diagnostics. 18875 DupVector.emplace_back(std::move(Vec)); 18876 continue; 18877 } 18878 18879 ECDVector *Vec = Entry.get<ECDVector*>(); 18880 // Make sure constants are not added more than once. 18881 if (*Vec->begin() == ECD) 18882 continue; 18883 18884 Vec->push_back(ECD); 18885 } 18886 18887 // Emit diagnostics. 18888 for (const auto &Vec : DupVector) { 18889 assert(Vec->size() > 1 && "ECDVector should have at least 2 elements."); 18890 18891 // Emit warning for one enum constant. 18892 auto *FirstECD = Vec->front(); 18893 S.Diag(FirstECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values) 18894 << FirstECD << toString(FirstECD->getInitVal(), 10) 18895 << FirstECD->getSourceRange(); 18896 18897 // Emit one note for each of the remaining enum constants with 18898 // the same value. 18899 for (auto *ECD : llvm::drop_begin(*Vec)) 18900 S.Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::note_duplicate_element) 18901 << ECD << toString(ECD->getInitVal(), 10) 18902 << ECD->getSourceRange(); 18903 } 18904 } 18905 18906 bool Sema::IsValueInFlagEnum(const EnumDecl *ED, const llvm::APInt &Val, 18907 bool AllowMask) const { 18908 assert(ED->isClosedFlag() && "looking for value in non-flag or open enum"); 18909 assert(ED->isCompleteDefinition() && "expected enum definition"); 18910 18911 auto R = FlagBitsCache.insert(std::make_pair(ED, llvm::APInt())); 18912 llvm::APInt &FlagBits = R.first->second; 18913 18914 if (R.second) { 18915 for (auto *E : ED->enumerators()) { 18916 const auto &EVal = E->getInitVal(); 18917 // Only single-bit enumerators introduce new flag values. 18918 if (EVal.isPowerOf2()) 18919 FlagBits = FlagBits.zext(EVal.getBitWidth()) | EVal; 18920 } 18921 } 18922 18923 // A value is in a flag enum if either its bits are a subset of the enum's 18924 // flag bits (the first condition) or we are allowing masks and the same is 18925 // true of its complement (the second condition). When masks are allowed, we 18926 // allow the common idiom of ~(enum1 | enum2) to be a valid enum value. 18927 // 18928 // While it's true that any value could be used as a mask, the assumption is 18929 // that a mask will have all of the insignificant bits set. Anything else is 18930 // likely a logic error. 18931 llvm::APInt FlagMask = ~FlagBits.zextOrTrunc(Val.getBitWidth()); 18932 return !(FlagMask & Val) || (AllowMask && !(FlagMask & ~Val)); 18933 } 18934 18935 void Sema::ActOnEnumBody(SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceRange BraceRange, 18936 Decl *EnumDeclX, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, Scope *S, 18937 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { 18938 EnumDecl *Enum = cast<EnumDecl>(EnumDeclX); 18939 QualType EnumType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Enum); 18940 18941 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Enum, Attrs); 18942 18943 if (Enum->isDependentType()) { 18944 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18945 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 18946 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 18947 if (!ECD) continue; 18948 18949 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18950 } 18951 18952 Enum->completeDefinition(Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, 0, 0); 18953 return; 18954 } 18955 18956 // TODO: If the result value doesn't fit in an int, it must be a long or long 18957 // long value. ISO C does not support this, but GCC does as an extension, 18958 // emit a warning. 18959 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 18960 unsigned CharWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getCharWidth(); 18961 unsigned ShortWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getShortWidth(); 18962 18963 // Verify that all the values are okay, compute the size of the values, and 18964 // reverse the list. 18965 unsigned NumNegativeBits = 0; 18966 unsigned NumPositiveBits = 0; 18967 18968 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18969 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 18970 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 18971 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18972 18973 const llvm::APSInt &InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18974 18975 // Keep track of the size of positive and negative values. 18976 if (InitVal.isUnsigned() || InitVal.isNonNegative()) { 18977 // If the enumerator is zero that should still be counted as a positive 18978 // bit since we need a bit to store the value zero. 18979 unsigned ActiveBits = InitVal.getActiveBits(); 18980 NumPositiveBits = std::max({NumPositiveBits, ActiveBits, 1u}); 18981 } else { 18982 NumNegativeBits = std::max(NumNegativeBits, 18983 (unsigned)InitVal.getMinSignedBits()); 18984 } 18985 } 18986 18987 // If we have have an empty set of enumerators we still need one bit. 18988 // From [dcl.enum]p8 18989 // If the enumerator-list is empty, the values of the enumeration are as if 18990 // the enumeration had a single enumerator with value 0 18991 if (!NumPositiveBits && !NumNegativeBits) 18992 NumPositiveBits = 1; 18993 18994 // Figure out the type that should be used for this enum. 18995 QualType BestType; 18996 unsigned BestWidth; 18997 18998 // C++0x N3000 [conv.prom]p3: 18999 // An rvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying 19000 // type is not fixed can be converted to an rvalue of the first 19001 // of the following types that can represent all the values of 19002 // the enumeration: int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long 19003 // int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 19004 // C99 6.4.4.3p2: 19005 // An identifier declared as an enumeration constant has type int. 19006 // The C99 rule is modified by a gcc extension 19007 QualType BestPromotionType; 19008 19009 bool Packed = Enum->hasAttr<PackedAttr>(); 19010 // -fshort-enums is the equivalent to specifying the packed attribute on all 19011 // enum definitions. 19012 if (LangOpts.ShortEnums) 19013 Packed = true; 19014 19015 // If the enum already has a type because it is fixed or dictated by the 19016 // target, promote that type instead of analyzing the enumerators. 19017 if (Enum->isComplete()) { 19018 BestType = Enum->getIntegerType(); 19019 if (BestType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 19020 BestPromotionType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(BestType); 19021 else 19022 BestPromotionType = BestType; 19023 19024 BestWidth = Context.getIntWidth(BestType); 19025 } 19026 else if (NumNegativeBits) { 19027 // If there is a negative value, figure out the smallest integer type (of 19028 // int/long/longlong) that fits. 19029 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 19030 if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= CharWidth && NumPositiveBits < CharWidth) { 19031 BestType = Context.SignedCharTy; 19032 BestWidth = CharWidth; 19033 } else if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= ShortWidth && 19034 NumPositiveBits < ShortWidth) { 19035 BestType = Context.ShortTy; 19036 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 19037 } else if (NumNegativeBits <= IntWidth && NumPositiveBits < IntWidth) { 19038 BestType = Context.IntTy; 19039 BestWidth = IntWidth; 19040 } else { 19041 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth(); 19042 19043 if (NumNegativeBits <= BestWidth && NumPositiveBits < BestWidth) { 19044 BestType = Context.LongTy; 19045 } else { 19046 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 19047 19048 if (NumNegativeBits > BestWidth || NumPositiveBits >= BestWidth) 19049 Diag(Enum->getLocation(), diag::ext_enum_too_large); 19050 BestType = Context.LongLongTy; 19051 } 19052 } 19053 BestPromotionType = (BestWidth <= IntWidth ? Context.IntTy : BestType); 19054 } else { 19055 // If there is no negative value, figure out the smallest type that fits 19056 // all of the enumerator values. 19057 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 19058 if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= CharWidth) { 19059 BestType = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 19060 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 19061 BestWidth = CharWidth; 19062 } else if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= ShortWidth) { 19063 BestType = Context.UnsignedShortTy; 19064 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 19065 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 19066 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= IntWidth) { 19067 BestType = Context.UnsignedIntTy; 19068 BestWidth = IntWidth; 19069 BestPromotionType 19070 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 19071 ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy; 19072 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= 19073 (BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())) { 19074 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 19075 BestPromotionType 19076 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 19077 ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy; 19078 } else { 19079 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 19080 assert(NumPositiveBits <= BestWidth && 19081 "How could an initializer get larger than ULL?"); 19082 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 19083 BestPromotionType 19084 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 19085 ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy; 19086 } 19087 } 19088 19089 // Loop over all of the enumerator constants, changing their types to match 19090 // the type of the enum if needed. 19091 for (auto *D : Elements) { 19092 auto *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 19093 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 19094 19095 // Standard C says the enumerators have int type, but we allow, as an 19096 // extension, the enumerators to be larger than int size. If each 19097 // enumerator value fits in an int, type it as an int, otherwise type it the 19098 // same as the enumerator decl itself. This means that in "enum { X = 1U }" 19099 // that X has type 'int', not 'unsigned'. 19100 19101 // Determine whether the value fits into an int. 19102 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 19103 19104 // If it fits into an integer type, force it. Otherwise force it to match 19105 // the enum decl type. 19106 QualType NewTy; 19107 unsigned NewWidth; 19108 bool NewSign; 19109 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 19110 !Enum->isFixed() && 19111 isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, InitVal, Context.IntTy)) { 19112 NewTy = Context.IntTy; 19113 NewWidth = IntWidth; 19114 NewSign = true; 19115 } else if (ECD->getType() == BestType) { 19116 // Already the right type! 19117 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 19118 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 19119 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 19120 // enumeration. 19121 ECD->setType(EnumType); 19122 continue; 19123 } else { 19124 NewTy = BestType; 19125 NewWidth = BestWidth; 19126 NewSign = BestType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 19127 } 19128 19129 // Adjust the APSInt value. 19130 InitVal = InitVal.extOrTrunc(NewWidth); 19131 InitVal.setIsSigned(NewSign); 19132 ECD->setInitVal(InitVal); 19133 19134 // Adjust the Expr initializer and type. 19135 if (ECD->getInitExpr() && 19136 !Context.hasSameType(NewTy, ECD->getInitExpr()->getType())) 19137 ECD->setInitExpr(ImplicitCastExpr::Create( 19138 Context, NewTy, CK_IntegralCast, ECD->getInitExpr(), 19139 /*base paths*/ nullptr, VK_PRValue, FPOptionsOverride())); 19140 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 19141 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 19142 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 19143 // enumeration. 19144 ECD->setType(EnumType); 19145 else 19146 ECD->setType(NewTy); 19147 } 19148 19149 Enum->completeDefinition(BestType, BestPromotionType, 19150 NumPositiveBits, NumNegativeBits); 19151 19152 CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(*this, Elements, Enum, EnumType); 19153 19154 if (Enum->isClosedFlag()) { 19155 for (Decl *D : Elements) { 19156 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 19157 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 19158 19159 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 19160 if (InitVal != 0 && !InitVal.isPowerOf2() && 19161 !IsValueInFlagEnum(Enum, InitVal, true)) 19162 Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_flag_enum_constant_out_of_range) 19163 << ECD << Enum; 19164 } 19165 } 19166 19167 // Now that the enum type is defined, ensure it's not been underaligned. 19168 if (Enum->hasAttrs()) 19169 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Enum); 19170 } 19171 19172 Decl *Sema::ActOnFileScopeAsmDecl(Expr *expr, 19173 SourceLocation StartLoc, 19174 SourceLocation EndLoc) { 19175 StringLiteral *AsmString = cast<StringLiteral>(expr); 19176 19177 FileScopeAsmDecl *New = FileScopeAsmDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, 19178 AsmString, StartLoc, 19179 EndLoc); 19180 CurContext->addDecl(New); 19181 return New; 19182 } 19183 19184 void Sema::ActOnPragmaRedefineExtname(IdentifierInfo* Name, 19185 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 19186 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 19187 SourceLocation NameLoc, 19188 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 19189 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, 19190 LookupOrdinaryName); 19191 AttributeCommonInfo Info(AliasName, SourceRange(AliasNameLoc), 19192 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma); 19193 AsmLabelAttr *Attr = AsmLabelAttr::CreateImplicit( 19194 Context, AliasName->getName(), /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, Info); 19195 19196 // If a declaration that: 19197 // 1) declares a function or a variable 19198 // 2) has external linkage 19199 // already exists, add a label attribute to it. 19200 if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) { 19201 if (isDeclExternC(PrevDecl)) 19202 PrevDecl->addAttr(Attr); 19203 else 19204 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 19205 << /*Variable*/(isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) ? 0 : 1) << PrevDecl; 19206 // Otherwise, add a label atttibute to ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers. 19207 } else 19208 (void)ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert(std::make_pair(Name, Attr)); 19209 } 19210 19211 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakID(IdentifierInfo* Name, 19212 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 19213 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 19214 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 19215 19216 if (PrevDecl) { 19217 PrevDecl->addAttr(WeakAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, PragmaLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 19218 } else { 19219 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers[Name].insert(WeakInfo(nullptr, NameLoc)); 19220 } 19221 } 19222 19223 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakAlias(IdentifierInfo* Name, 19224 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 19225 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 19226 SourceLocation NameLoc, 19227 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 19228 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, AliasName, AliasNameLoc, 19229 LookupOrdinaryName); 19230 WeakInfo W = WeakInfo(Name, NameLoc); 19231 19232 if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) { 19233 if (!PrevDecl->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) 19234 if (NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(PrevDecl)) 19235 DeclApplyPragmaWeak(TUScope, ND, W); 19236 } else { 19237 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers[AliasName].insert(W); 19238 } 19239 } 19240 19241 ObjCContainerDecl *Sema::getObjCDeclContext() const { 19242 return (dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext)); 19243 } 19244 19245 Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus Sema::getEmissionStatus(FunctionDecl *FD, 19246 bool Final) { 19247 assert(FD && "Expected non-null FunctionDecl"); 19248 19249 // SYCL functions can be template, so we check if they have appropriate 19250 // attribute prior to checking if it is a template. 19251 if (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice && FD->hasAttr<SYCLKernelAttr>()) 19252 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19253 19254 // Templates are emitted when they're instantiated. 19255 if (FD->isDependentContext()) 19256 return FunctionEmissionStatus::TemplateDiscarded; 19257 19258 // Check whether this function is an externally visible definition. 19259 auto IsEmittedForExternalSymbol = [this, FD]() { 19260 // We have to check the GVA linkage of the function's *definition* -- if we 19261 // only have a declaration, we don't know whether or not the function will 19262 // be emitted, because (say) the definition could include "inline". 19263 FunctionDecl *Def = FD->getDefinition(); 19264 19265 return Def && !isDiscardableGVALinkage( 19266 getASTContext().GetGVALinkageForFunction(Def)); 19267 }; 19268 19269 if (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice) { 19270 // In OpenMP device mode we will not emit host only functions, or functions 19271 // we don't need due to their linkage. 19272 Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy = 19273 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl()); 19274 // DevTy may be changed later by 19275 // #pragma omp declare target to(*) device_type(*). 19276 // Therefore DevTy having no value does not imply host. The emission status 19277 // will be checked again at the end of compilation unit with Final = true. 19278 if (DevTy) 19279 if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_Host) 19280 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 19281 // If we have an explicit value for the device type, or we are in a target 19282 // declare context, we need to emit all extern and used symbols. 19283 if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext() || DevTy) 19284 if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol()) 19285 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19286 // Device mode only emits what it must, if it wasn't tagged yet and needed, 19287 // we'll omit it. 19288 if (Final) 19289 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 19290 } else if (LangOpts.OpenMP > 45) { 19291 // In OpenMP host compilation prior to 5.0 everything was an emitted host 19292 // function. In 5.0, no_host was introduced which might cause a function to 19293 // be ommitted. 19294 Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy = 19295 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl()); 19296 if (DevTy) 19297 if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_NoHost) 19298 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 19299 } 19300 19301 if (Final && LangOpts.OpenMP && !LangOpts.CUDA) 19302 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19303 19304 if (LangOpts.CUDA) { 19305 // When compiling for device, host functions are never emitted. Similarly, 19306 // when compiling for host, device and global functions are never emitted. 19307 // (Technically, we do emit a host-side stub for global functions, but this 19308 // doesn't count for our purposes here.) 19309 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget T = IdentifyCUDATarget(FD); 19310 if (LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && T == Sema::CFT_Host) 19311 return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded; 19312 if (!LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && 19313 (T == Sema::CFT_Device || T == Sema::CFT_Global)) 19314 return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded; 19315 19316 if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol()) 19317 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 19318 } 19319 19320 // Otherwise, the function is known-emitted if it's in our set of 19321 // known-emitted functions. 19322 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown; 19323 } 19324 19325 bool Sema::shouldIgnoreInHostDeviceCheck(FunctionDecl *Callee) { 19326 // Host-side references to a __global__ function refer to the stub, so the 19327 // function itself is never emitted and therefore should not be marked. 19328 // If we have host fn calls kernel fn calls host+device, the HD function 19329 // does not get instantiated on the host. We model this by omitting at the 19330 // call to the kernel from the callgraph. This ensures that, when compiling 19331 // for host, only HD functions actually called from the host get marked as 19332 // known-emitted. 19333 return LangOpts.CUDA && !LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && 19334 IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) == CFT_Global; 19335 } 19336